As filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on September 14, 2020

File No. 001-39473

 

 

 

UNITED STATES

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D.C. 20549

 

 

Amendment No. 1

to

Form 10

 

 

GENERAL FORM FOR REGISTRATION OF SECURITIES

PURSUANT TO SECTION 12 (b) OR (g) OF

THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

 

 

LENSAR, INC.

(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)

 

 

 

Delaware   32-0125724

(State or other jurisdiction of

incorporation or organization)

 

(I.R.S. Employer

Identification No.)

 

2800 Discovery Drive,

Orlando, Florida

  32826
(Address of principal executive offices)   (Zip Code)

Registrant’s telephone number, including area code: (888) 536-7271

Securities to be registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:

 

Title of each class to be so registered

 

Name of each exchange on which each class is to be registered

Common stock,

par value $0.01 per share

  The Nasdaq Capital Market

Securities to be registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act: None

 

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, a smaller reporting company, or an emerging growth company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer,” “smaller reporting company,” and “emerging growth company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.

 

Large accelerated filer      Accelerated filer  
Non-accelerated filer      Smaller reporting company  
     Emerging growth company  

If an emerging growth company, indicate by check mark if the registrant has elected not to use the extended transition period for complying with any new or revised financial accounting standards provided pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Exchange Act.  ☐

 

 

 


LENSAR, INC.

INFORMATION REQUIRED IN REGISTRATION STATEMENT

CROSS-REFERENCE SHEET BETWEEN INFORMATION STATEMENT AND ITEMS OF FORM 10

Certain information required to be included in this Form 10 is incorporated by reference to specifically-identified portions of the body of the information statement filed herewith as Exhibit 99.1. None of the information contained in the information statement shall be incorporated by reference herein or deemed to be a part hereof unless such information is specifically incorporated by reference.

Item 1. Business.

The information required by this item is contained under the sections of the information statement entitled “Information Statement Summary,” “Risk Factors,” “Special Note Regarding Forward-Looking Statements,” “The Spin-Off,” “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations,” “Business,” “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions” and “Where You Can Find More Information.” Those sections are incorporated herein by reference.

Item 1A. Risk Factors.

The information required by this item is contained under the sections of the information statement entitled “Risk Factors” and “Special Note Regarding Forward-Looking Statements.” Those sections are incorporated herein by reference.

Item 2. Financial Information

The information required by this item is contained under the sections of the information statement entitled “Summary Historical Financial Data,” and “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.” Those sections are incorporated herein by reference.

Item 3. Properties.

The information required by this item is contained under the section of the information statement entitled “Business—Facilities.” That section is incorporated herein by reference.

Item 4. Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management.

The information required by this item is contained under the section of the information statement entitled “Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management.” That section is incorporated herein by reference.

Item 5. Directors and Executive Officers.

The information required by this item is contained under the sections of the information statement entitled “Management.” Those sections are incorporated herein by reference.

Item 6. Executive Compensation.

The information required by this item is contained under the sections of the information statement entitled “Executive Compensation.” Those sections are incorporated herein by reference.

Item 7. Certain Relationships and Related Transactions.

The information required by this item is contained under the sections of the information statement entitled “Management” and “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions.” Those sections are incorporated herein by reference.


Item 8. Legal Proceedings.

The information required by this item is contained under the section of the information statement entitled “Business—Legal Proceedings.” That section is incorporated herein by reference.

Item 9. Market Price of, and Dividends on, the Registrant’s Common Equity and Related Stockholder Matters.

The information required by this item is contained under the section of the information statement entitled “Information Statement Summary,” “The Spin-Off,” “Dividend Policy” and “Description of LENSAR Capital Stock.” Those sections are incorporated herein by reference.

Item 10. Recent Sales of Unregistered Securities.

The information required by this item is contained under the section of the information statement entitled “Recent Sales of Unregistered Securities.” That section is incorporated herein by reference.

Item 11. Description of Registrant’s Securities to be Registered.

The information required by this item is contained under the section of the information statement entitled “The Spin-Off” and “Description of LENSAR Capital Stock.” Those sections are incorporated herein by reference.

Item 12. Indemnification of Directors and Officers.

The information required by this item is contained under the section of the information statement entitled “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions—Indemnification Agreements” and “Indemnification and Limitation of Liability of Directors and Officer.” Those sections are incorporated herein by reference.

Item 13. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data.

The information required by this item is contained under the section of the information statement entitled “Index to Financial Statements” (and the financial statements and related notes referenced therein). That section is incorporated herein by reference.

Item 14. Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure.

Not applicable.

Item 15. Financial Statements and Exhibits.

 

  (a)

Financial Statements

The information required by this item is contained under the section of the information statement entitled “Index to Financial Statements” (and the financial statements and related noted referenced therein). That section is incorporated herein by reference.


  (b)

Exhibits

See below.

The following documents are filed as exhibits hereto:

 

Exhibit
Number

  

Exhibit Description

  2.1+*    Form of Separation and Distribution Agreement between PDL BioPharma, Inc. and LENSAR, Inc.
  3.1*    Form of Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of LENSAR, Inc.
  3.2*    Form of Amended and Restated Bylaws of LENSAR, Inc.
  4.1    Form of Certificate of Common Stock
10.1+*    Form of Transition Services Agreement between PDL BioPharma, Inc. and LENSAR, Inc.
10.2*    Form of Tax Matters Agreement between PDL BioPharma, Inc. and LENSAR, Inc.
10.3#*    2017 Phantom Stock Plan
10.4#*    2020 Incentive Award Plan
10.4.1#*    Form of Restricted Stock Agreement pursuant to 2020 Incentive Award Plan
10.5#    2020 Employee Stock Purchase Plan
10.6#*    Employment Agreement, dated as of July 21, 2020, by and between LENSAR, Inc. and Nicholas Curtis
10.7#*    Employment Agreement, dated as of July 21, 2020, by and between LENSAR, Inc. and Alan Connaughton
10.8#*    Employment Agreement, dated as of July 21, 2020, by and between LENSAR, Inc. and Thomas Staab, II
10.9*    Form of Indemnification Agreement between LENSAR, Inc. and its directors and officers
10.10†*    Exclusive License Agreement, dated September 23, 2019, by and among Doug Patton, Ophthalmic Synergies, LLC and LENSAR, Inc.
10.11†*    Development Agreement, dated January 29, 2020, by and between LENSAR, Inc. and Oertli Instrumente AG
10.12+    Industrial Real Estate Lease, dated as of July 30, 2010, by and between LENSAR, Inc. and Challenger-Discovery, LLC, as amended as of March 15, 2016, December 16, 2016, August  20, 2020 and September 9, 2020.
10.13#*    Non-Employee Director Compensation Program
99.1    Preliminary Information Statement of LENSAR, Inc., subject to completion, dated September 14, 2020

 

*

Previously filed.

#

Indicates management contract or compensatory plan.

Certain portions of this exhibit (indicated by “[***]”) have been omitted pursuant to Regulation S-K, Item (601)(b)(10).

+

Certain schedules and attachments to certain of these exhibits have been omitted pursuant to Regulation S-K, Item 601(a)(5).


SIGNATURES

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 12 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has caused this registration statement to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.

 

LENSAR, Inc.
By:  

/s/ Nicholas Curtis

  Name:   Nicholas Curtis
  Title:   Chief Executive Officer

Date: September 14, 2020

Exhibit 4.1

 

LOGO

.ZQ|CERT#|COY|CLS|RGSTRY|ACCT#|TRANSTYPE|RUN#|TRANS# COMMON STOCK [GRAPHIC APPEARS HERE]PAR VALUE $.01 COMMON STOCK Certificate Number ZQ00000000 THIS CERTIFIES THAT is the owner of LENSAR, INC. INCORPORATED UNDER THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF DELAWARE ** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Alexander David Sample **** Mr. Sample **** Mr. Sample **000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares*** *000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares**** 000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****0 00000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****00 0000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000 000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****0000 00**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****00000 0**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000 **Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000* *Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000** Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**Shares****000000**S Shares * * 000000 * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * 000000 * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * 000000 * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * 000000 * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * 000000 * * * * * * * * * * * * * * SEE REVERSE FOR CERTAIN DEFINITIONS THIS CERTIFICATE IS TRANSFERABLE IN CITIES DESIGNATED BY THE TRANSFER AGENT, AVAILABLE ONLINE AT www.computershare.com FULLY-PAID AND NON-ASSESSABLE SHARES OF COMMON STOCK OF LENSAR, Inc. (hereinafter called the “Company”), transferable on the books of the Company in person or by duly authorized attorney, upon surrender of this Certificate properly endorsed. This Certificate and the shares represented hereby, are issued and shall be held subject to all of the provisions of the Articles of Incorporation, as amended, and the By-Laws, as amended, of the Company (copies of which are on file with the Company and with the Transfer Agent), to all of which each holder, by acceptance hereof, assents. This Certificate is not valid unless countersigned and registered by the Transfer Agent and Registrar. Witness the facsimile seal of the Company and the facsimile signatures of its duly authorized officers. DATED DD-MMM-YYYY President & CEO COUNTERSIGNED AND REGISTERED: COMPUTERSHARE TRUST COMPANY, N.A. TRANSFER AGENT AND REGISTRAR, 08/20/2004 A Secretary By AUTHORIZED SIGNATURE


LOGO

. LENSAR, INC. THE COMPANY WILL FURNISH WITHOUT CHARGE TO EACH SHAREHOLDER WHO SO REQUESTS, A SUMMARY OF THE POWERS, DESIGNATIONS, PREFERENCES AND RELATIVE, PARTICIPATING, OPTIONAL OR OTHER SPECIAL RIGHTS OF EACH CLASS OF STOCK OF THE COMPANY AND THE QUALIFICATIONS, LIMITATIONS OR RESTRICTIONS OF SUCH PREFERENCES AND RIGHTS, AND THE VARIATIONS IN RIGHTS, PREFERENCES AND LIMITATIONS DETERMINED FOR EACH SERIES, WHICH ARE FIXED BY THE ARTICLES OF INCORPORATION OF THE COMPANY, AS AMENDED, AND THE RESOLUTIONS OF THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS OF THE COMPANY, AND THE AUTHORITY OF THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS TO DETERMINE VARIATIONS FOR FUTURE SERIES. SUCH REQUEST MAY BE MADE TO THE OFFICE OF THE SECRETARY OF THE COMPANY OR TO THE TRANSFER AGENT. THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS MAY REQUIRE THE OWNER OF A LOST OR DESTROYED STOCK CERTIFICATE, OR HIS LEGAL REPRESENTATIVES, TO GIVE THE COMPANY A BOND TO INDEMNIFY IT AND ITS TRANSFER AGENTS AND REGISTRARS AGAINST ANY CLAIM THAT MAY BE MADE AGAINST THEM ON ACCOUNT OF THE ALLEGED LOSS OR DESTRUCTION OF ANY SUCH CERTIFICATE. For value received,     hereby sell, assign and transfer unto PLEASE INSERT SOCIAL SECURITY OR OTHER IDENTIFYING NUMBER OF ASSIGNEE (PLEASE PRINT OR TYPEWRITE NAME AND ADDRESS, INCLUDING POSTAL ZIP CODE, OF ASSIGNEE) Shares of the common stock represented by the within Certificate, and do hereby irrevocably constitute and appoint Attorney to transfer the said stock on the books of the within-named Company with full power of substitution in the premises. Dated:     20 Signature:      Signature: Notice: The signature to this assignment must correspond with the name as written upon the face of the certificate, in every particular, without alteration or enlargement, or any change whatever. The IRS requires that the named transfer agent (“we”) report the cost basis of certain shares or units acquired after January 1, 2011. If your shares or units are covered by the legislation, and you requested to sell or transfer the shares or units using a specific cost basis calculation method, then we have processed as you requested. If you did not specify a cost basis calculation method, then we have defaulted to the first in, first out (FIFO) method. Please consult your tax advisor if you need additional information about cost basis. If you do not keep in contact with the issuer or do not have any activity in your account for the time period specified by state law, your property may become subject to state unclaimed property laws and transferred to the appropriate state.

Exhibit 10.5

LENSAR, INC.

2020 EMPLOYEE STOCK PURCHASE PLAN

ARTICLE I.

PURPOSE

The purposes of this LENSAR, Inc. 2020 Employee Stock Purchase Plan (as it may be amended or restated from time to time, the “Plan”) are to assist Eligible Employees of LENSAR, Inc., a Delaware corporation (the “Company”), and its Designated Subsidiaries in acquiring a stock ownership interest in the Company pursuant to a plan which is intended to qualify as an “employee stock purchase plan” within the meaning of Section 423(b) of the Code, and to help Eligible Employees provide for their future security and to encourage them to remain in the employment of the Company and its Designated Subsidiaries.

ARTICLE II.

DEFINITIONS AND CONSTRUCTION

Wherever the following terms are used in the Plan they shall have the meanings specified below, unless the context clearly indicates otherwise. The singular pronoun shall include the plural where the context so indicates. Masculine, feminine and neuter pronouns are used interchangeably and each comprehends the others.

2.1 “Administrator” means the entity that conducts the general administration of the Plan as provided in Article XI. The term “Administrator” shall refer to the Committee unless the Board has assumed the authority for administration of the Plan as provided in Article XI.

2.2 “Applicable Law” means the requirements relating to the administration of equity incentive plans under U.S. federal and state securities, tax and other applicable laws, rules and regulations, the applicable rules of any stock exchange or quotation system on which the Common Stock is listed or quoted and the applicable laws and rules of any foreign country or other jurisdiction where rights under this Plan are granted.

2.3 “Board” means the Board of Directors of the Company.

2.4 “Change in Control” means and includes each of the following:

(a) A transaction or series of transactions (other than an offering of Common Stock to the general public through a registration statement filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission or a transaction or series of transactions that meets the requirements of clauses (i) and (ii) of subsection (c) below) whereby any “person” or related “group” of “persons” (as such terms are used in Sections 13(d) and 14(d)(2) of the Exchange Act) (other than the Company, any of its Subsidiaries, an employee benefit plan maintained by the Company or any of its Subsidiaries or a “person” that, prior to such transaction, directly or indirectly controls, is controlled by, or is under common control with, the Company) directly or indirectly acquires beneficial ownership (within the meaning of Rule 13d-3 under the Exchange Act) of securities of the Company possessing more than 50% of the total combined voting power of the Company’s securities outstanding immediately after such acquisition; or

(b) During any period of two consecutive years, individuals who, at the beginning of such period, constitute the Board together with any new Director(s) (other than a Director designated by a person who shall have entered into an agreement with the Company to effect a transaction described in


subsections (a) or (c)) whose election by the Board or nomination for election by the Company’s stockholders was approved by a vote of at least two-thirds of the Directors then still in office who either were Directors at the beginning of the two-year period or whose election or nomination for election was previously so approved, cease for any reason to constitute a majority thereof; or

(c) The consummation by the Company (whether directly involving the Company or indirectly involving the Company through one or more intermediaries) of (x) a merger, consolidation, reorganization, or business combination or (y) a sale or other disposition of all or substantially all of the Company’s assets in any single transaction or series of related transactions or (z) the acquisition of assets or stock of another entity, in each case other than a transaction:

(i) which results in the Company’s voting securities outstanding immediately before the transaction continuing to represent (either by remaining outstanding or by being converted into voting securities of the Company or the person that, as a result of the transaction, controls, directly or indirectly, the Company or owns, directly or indirectly, all or substantially all of the Company’s assets or otherwise succeeds to the business of the Company (the Company or such person, the “Successor Entity”)) directly or indirectly, at least a majority of the combined voting power of the Successor Entity’s outstanding voting securities immediately after the transaction, and

(ii) after which no person or group beneficially owns voting securities representing 50% or more of the combined voting power of the Successor Entity; provided, however, that no person or group shall be treated for purposes of this clause (ii) as beneficially owning 50% or more of the combined voting power of the Successor Entity solely as a result of the voting power held in the Company prior to the consummation of the transaction.

The Administrator shall have full and final authority, which shall be exercised in its sole discretion, to determine conclusively whether a Change in Control has occurred pursuant to the above definition, the date of such Change in Control and any incidental matters relating thereto.

2.5 “Code” means the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended and the regulations issued thereunder.

2.6 “Common Stock” means the common stock of the Company and such other securities of the Company that may be substituted therefor pursuant to Article VIII.

2.7 “Company” means LENSAR, Inc., a Delaware corporation.

2.8 “Compensation” of an Eligible Employee means the gross base compensation received by such Eligible Employee as compensation for services to the Company or any Designated Subsidiary, including prior week adjustment and overtime payments but excluding vacation pay, holiday pay, jury duty pay, funeral leave pay, military leave pay, commissions, incentive compensation, one-time bonuses (e.g., retention or sign on bonuses), education or tuition reimbursements, travel expenses, business and moving reimbursements, income received in connection with any stock options, stock appreciation rights, restricted stock, restricted stock units or other compensatory equity awards, fringe benefits, other special payments and all contributions made by the Company or any Designated Subsidiary for the Employee’s benefit under any employee benefit plan now or hereafter established.

2.9 “Designated Subsidiary” means any Subsidiary designated by the Administrator in accordance with Section 11.3(b).

2.10 “Director” means a Board member.

 

2


2.11 “Effective Date” has the meaning given to such term in Article X.

2.12 “Eligible Employee” means an Employee who does not, immediately after any rights under this Plan are granted, own (directly or through attribution) stock possessing 5% or more of the total combined voting power or value of all classes of Common Stock and other stock of the Company, a Parent or a Subsidiary (as determined under Section 423(b)(3) of the Code). For purposes of the foregoing sentence, the rules of Section 424(d) of the Code with regard to the attribution of stock ownership shall apply in determining the stock ownership of an individual, and stock that an Employee may purchase under outstanding options shall be treated as stock owned by the Employee; provided, however, that the Administrator may provide in an Offering Document that an Employee shall not be eligible to participate in an Offering Period if: (a) such Employee is a highly compensated employee within the meaning of Section 423(b)(4)(D) of the Code, (b) such Employee has not met a service requirement designated by the Administrator pursuant to Section 423(b)(4)(A) of the Code (which service requirement may not exceed two years), (c) such Employee’s customary employment is for twenty hours or less per week, (d) such Employee’s customary employment is for less than five months in any calendar year and/or (e) such Employee is a citizen or resident of a foreign jurisdiction and the grant of a right to purchase Common Stock under the Plan to such Employee would be prohibited under the laws of such foreign jurisdiction or the grant of a right to purchase Common Stock under the Plan to such Employee in compliance with the laws of such foreign jurisdiction would cause the Plan to violate the requirements of Section 423 of the Code, as determined by the Administrator in its sole discretion; provided, further, that any exclusion in clauses (a), (b), (c), (d) or (e) shall be applied in an identical manner under each Offering Period to all Employees, in accordance with Treasury Regulation Section 1.423-2(e).

2.13 “Employee” means any officer or other employee (as defined in accordance with Section 3401(c) of the Code) of the Company or any Designated Subsidiary. “Employee” shall not include any director of the Company or a Designated Subsidiary who does not render services to the Company or a Designated Subsidiary as an employee within the meaning of Section 3401(c) of the Code. For purposes of the Plan, the employment relationship shall be treated as continuing intact while the individual is on sick leave or other leave of absence approved by the Company or Designated Subsidiary and meeting the requirements of Treasury Regulation Section 1.421-1(h)(2). Where the period of leave exceeds three months and the individual’s right to reemployment is not guaranteed either by statute or by contract, the employment relationship shall be deemed to have terminated on the first day immediately following such three-month period.

2.14 “Enrollment Date” means the first day of each Offering Period.

2.15 “Exchange Act” means the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended from time to time.

2.16 “Fair Market Value” means, as of any date, the value of a share of Common Stock determined as follows: (a) if the Common Stock is listed on any established stock exchange, its Fair Market Value will be the closing sales price for such Common Stock as quoted on such exchange for such date, or if no sale occurred on such date, the last day preceding such date during which a sale occurred, as reported in The Wall Street Journal or another source the Administrator deems reliable; (b) if the Common Stock is not traded on a stock exchange but is quoted on a national market or other quotation system, the closing sales price on such date, or if no sales occurred on such date, then on the last date preceding such date during which a sale occurred, as reported in The Wall Street Journal or another source the Administrator deems reliable; or (c) without an established market for the Common Stock, the Administrator will determine the Fair Market Value in its discretion.

2.17 “Grant Date” means the first Trading Day of an Offering Period.

 

3


2.18 “Offering Document” shall have the meaning given to such term in Section 4.1.

2.19 “Offering Period” shall have the meaning given to such term in Section 4.1.

2.20 “Parent” means any corporation, other than the Company, in an unbroken chain of corporations ending with the Company if, at the time of the determination, each of the corporations other than the Company owns stock possessing 50% or more of the total combined voting power of all classes of stock in one of the other corporations in such chain.

2.21 “Participant” means any Eligible Employee who has executed a subscription agreement and been granted rights to purchase Common Stock pursuant to the Plan.

2.22 “Plan” means this LENSAR, Inc. 2020 Employee Stock Purchase Plan, as it may be amended from time to time.

2.23 “Public Trading Date means the first date upon which the Common Stock is listed (or approved for listing) upon notice of issuance on any securities exchange or designated (or approved for designation) upon notice of issuance as a national market security on an interdealer quotation system, or, if earlier, the date on which the Company becomes a “publicly held corporation” for purposes of Treasury Regulation Section 1.162-27(c)(1).

2.24 “Purchase Date” means the last Trading Day of each Purchase Period.

2.25 “Purchase Period” shall refer to one or more periods within an Offering Period, as designated in the applicable Offering Document; provided, however, that, in the event no Purchase Period is designated by the Administrator in the applicable Offering Document, the Purchase Period for each Offering Period covered by such Offering Document shall be the same as the applicable Offering Period.

2.26 “Purchase Price” means the purchase price designated by the Administrator in the applicable Offering Document (which purchase price shall not be less than 85% of the Fair Market Value of a Share on the Grant Date or on the Purchase Date, whichever is lower); provided, however, that, in the event no purchase price is designated by the Administrator in the applicable Offering Document, the purchase price for the Offering Periods covered by such Offering Document shall be 85% of the Fair Market Value of a Share on the Grant Date or on the Purchase Date, whichever is lower; provided, further, that the Purchase Price may be adjusted by the Administrator pursuant to Article VIII and shall not be less than the par value of a Share.

2.27 “Securities Act” means the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.

2.28 “Share” means a share of Common Stock.

2.29 “Subsidiary” means any corporation, other than the Company, in an unbroken chain of corporations beginning with the Company if, at the time of the determination, each of the corporations other than the last corporation in an unbroken chain owns stock possessing 50% or more of the total combined voting power of all classes of stock in one of the other corporations in such chain; provided, however, that a limited liability company or partnership may be treated as a Subsidiary to the extent either (a) such entity is treated as a disregarded entity under Treasury Regulation Section 301.7701-3(a) by reason of the Company or any other Subsidiary that is a corporation being the sole owner of such entity, or (b) such entity elects to be classified as a corporation under Treasury Regulation Section 301.7701-3(a) and such entity would otherwise qualify as a Subsidiary.

2.30 “Trading Day” means a day on which national stock exchanges in the United States are open for trading.

 

4


ARTICLE III.

SHARES SUBJECT TO THE PLAN

3.1 Number of Shares. Subject to Article VIII, the aggregate number of Shares that may be issued pursuant to rights granted under the Plan shall be 340,000 Shares. In addition to the foregoing, subject to Article VIII, on the first day of each calendar year beginning on January 1, 2022 and ending on and including January 1, 2030, the number of Shares available for issuance under the Plan shall be increased by that number of Shares equal to the lesser of (a) 1% of the Shares outstanding on the final day of the immediately preceding calendar year, and (b) such smaller number of Shares as determined by the Board. If any right granted under the Plan shall for any reason terminate without having been exercised, the Common Stock not purchased under such right shall again become available for issuance under the Plan. Notwithstanding anything in this Section 3.1 to the contrary, the number of Shares that may be issued or transferred pursuant to the rights granted under the Plan shall not exceed an aggregate of 5,000,000 Shares, subject to Article 8.

3.2 Stock Distributed. Any Common Stock distributed pursuant to the Plan may consist, in whole or in part, of authorized and unissued Common Stock, treasury stock or Common Stock purchased on the open market.

ARTICLE IV.

OFFERING PERIODS; OFFERING DOCUMENTS; PURCHASE DATES

4.1 Offering Periods. The Administrator may from time to time grant or provide for the grant of rights to purchase Common Stock under the Plan to Eligible Employees during one or more periods (each, an “Offering Period”) selected by the Administrator. The terms and conditions applicable to each Offering Period shall be set forth in an “Offering Document” adopted by the Administrator, which Offering Document shall be in such form and shall contain such terms and conditions as the Administrator shall deem appropriate and shall be incorporated by reference into and made part of the Plan and shall be attached hereto as part of the Plan. The Administrator shall establish in each Offering Document one or more Purchase Periods during such Offering Period during which rights granted under the Plan shall be exercised and purchases of Shares carried out during such Offering Period in accordance with such Offering Document and the Plan. The provisions of separate Offering Periods under the Plan need not be identical.

4.2 Offering Documents. Each Offering Document with respect to an Offering Period shall specify (through incorporation of the provisions of this Plan by reference or otherwise):

(a) the length of the Offering Period, which period shall not exceed twenty-seven months;

(b) the length of the Purchase Period(s) within the Offering Period;

(c) the maximum number of Shares that may be purchased by any Eligible Employee during such Offering Period, which, in the absence of a contrary designation by the Administrator, shall be 50,000 Shares;

(d) in connection with each Offering Period that contains more than one Purchase Period, the maximum aggregate number of shares which may be purchased by any Eligible Employee during each Purchaser Period, which, in the absence of a contrary designation by the Administrator, shall be 50,000 Shares; and

(e) such other provisions as the Administrator determines are appropriate, subject to the Plan.

 

5


ARTICLE V.

ELIGIBILITY AND PARTICIPATION

5.1 Eligibility. Any Eligible Employee who shall be employed by the Company or a Designated Subsidiary on a given Enrollment Date for an Offering Period shall be eligible to participate in the Plan during such Offering Period, subject to the requirements of this Article V and the limitations imposed by Section 423(b) of the Code.

5.2 Enrollment in Plan.

(a) Except as otherwise set forth in an Offering Document or determined by the Administrator, an Eligible Employee may become a Participant in the Plan for an Offering Period by delivering a subscription agreement to the Company by such time prior to the Enrollment Date for such Offering Period (or such other date specified in the Offering Document) designated by the Administrator and in such form as the Company provides.

(b) Each subscription agreement shall designate a whole percentage of such Eligible Employee’s Compensation to be withheld by the Company or the Designated Subsidiary employing such Eligible Employee on each payday during the Offering Period as payroll deductions under the Plan or, if permitted by the Administrator, contributions to be made by such Eligible Employee. The designated percentage may not be less than 1% and may not be more than the maximum percentage specified by the Administrator in the applicable Offering Document (which percentage shall be 20% in the absence of any such designation). The payroll deductions or, if permitted by the Administrator, contributions made for each Participant shall be credited to an account for such Participant under the Plan and shall be deposited with the general funds of the Company.

(c) A Participant may increase or decrease the percentage of Compensation designated in his or her subscription agreement, subject to the limits of this Section 5.2, or may suspend his or her payroll deductions, or, if permitted by the Administrator, contributions, at any time during an Offering Period; provided, however, that the Administrator may limit the number of changes a Participant may make to his or her payroll deduction elections or, if permitted by the Administrator, contributions, during each Offering Period in the applicable Offering Document (and in the absence of any specific designation by the Administrator, a Participant shall be allowed one change to his or her payroll deduction elections or, if permitted by the Administrator, contributions, during each Offering Period). Any such change or suspension of payroll deductions, or, if permitted by the Administrator, contributions, shall be effective with the first full payroll period that is at least five business days after the Company’s receipt of the new subscription agreement (or such shorter or longer period as may be specified by the Administrator in the applicable Offering Document). In the event a Participant suspends his or her payroll deductions or contributions, such Participant’s cumulative payroll deductions or contributions prior to the suspension shall remain in his or her account and shall be applied to the purchase of Shares on the next occurring Purchase Date and shall not be paid to such Participant unless he or she withdraws from participation in the Plan pursuant to Article VII.

(d) Except as set forth in Section 5.8, as otherwise set forth in an Offering Document or determined by the Administrator, a Participant may participate in the Plan only by means of payroll deduction and may not make contributions by lump sum payment for any Offering Period.

5.3 Payroll Deductions. Except as otherwise provided in the applicable Offering Document or Section 5.8, payroll deductions for a Participant shall commence on the first payroll following the Enrollment Date and shall end on the last payroll in the Offering Period to which the Participant’s authorization is applicable, unless sooner terminated by the Participant as provided in Article VII or suspended by the Participant or the Administrator as provided in Section 5.2 and Section 5.6, respectively.

 

6


5.4 Effect of Enrollment. A Participant’s completion of a subscription agreement will enroll such Participant in the Plan for each subsequent Offering Period on the terms contained therein until the Participant either submits a new subscription agreement, withdraws from participation under the Plan as provided in Article VII or otherwise becomes ineligible to participate in the Plan.

5.5 Limitation on Purchase of Common Stock. An Eligible Employee may be granted rights under the Plan only if such rights, together with any other rights granted to such Eligible Employee under “employee stock purchase plans” of the Company, any Parent or any Subsidiary, as specified by Section 423(b)(8) of the Code, do not permit such employee’s rights to purchase stock of the Company or any Parent or Subsidiary to accrue at a rate that exceeds $25,000 of the fair market value of such stock (determined as of the time which such rights are granted) for each calendar year in which such rights are outstanding at any time. This limitation shall be applied in accordance with Section 423(b)(8) of the Code.

5.6 Decrease or Suspension of Payroll Deductions or Contributions. Notwithstanding the foregoing, to the extent necessary to comply with Section 423(b)(8) of the Code and Section 5.5 or the other limitations set forth in this Plan, a Participant’s payroll deductions or contributions may be suspended or discontinued by the Administrator at any time during an Offering Period. The balance of the amount credited to the account of each Participant that has not been applied to the purchase of Shares by reason of Section 423(b)(8) of the Code, Section 5.5 or the other limitations set forth in this Plan shall be paid to such Participant in one lump sum in cash as soon as reasonably practicable after the Purchase Date.

5.7 Foreign Employees. In order to facilitate participation in the Plan, the Administrator may provide for such special terms applicable to Participants who are citizens or residents of a foreign jurisdiction, or who are employed by a Designated Subsidiary outside of the United States, as the Administrator may consider necessary or appropriate to accommodate differences in local law, tax policy or custom. Such special terms may not be more favorable than the terms of rights granted under the Plan to Eligible Employees who are residents of the United States. Moreover, the Administrator may approve such supplements to, or amendments, restatements or alternative versions of, this Plan as it may consider necessary or appropriate for such purposes without thereby affecting the terms of this Plan as in effect for any other purpose. No such special terms, supplements, amendments or restatements shall include any provisions that are inconsistent with the terms of this Plan as then in effect unless this Plan could have been amended to eliminate such inconsistency without further approval by the stockholders of the Company.

5.8 Leave of Absence. During leaves of absence approved by the Company meeting the requirements of Treasury Regulation Section 1.421-1(h)(2) under the Code, a Participant may continue participation in the Plan by making cash payments to the Company on his or her normal payday equal to his or her authorized payroll deduction.

ARTICLE VI.

GRANT AND EXERCISE OF RIGHTS

6.1 Grant of Rights. On the Grant Date of each Offering Period, each Eligible Employee participating in such Offering Period shall be granted a right to purchase the maximum number of Shares specified under Section 4.2, subject to the limits in Section 5.5, and shall have the right to buy, on each Purchase Date during such Offering Period (at the applicable Purchase Price), such number of whole Shares as is determined by dividing (a) such Participant’s payroll deductions or permitted contributions accumulated prior to such Purchase Date and retained in the Participant’s account as of the Purchase Date, by (b) the applicable Purchase Price (rounded down to the nearest Share). The right shall expire on the earlier of: (x) the last Purchase Date of the Offering Period, (y) last day of the Offering Period and (z) the date on which the Participant withdraws in accordance with Section 7.1 or Section 7.3.

 

7


6.2 Exercise of Rights. On each Purchase Date, each Participant’s accumulated payroll deductions or permitted contributions and any other additional payments specifically provided for in the applicable Offering Document will be applied to the purchase of whole Shares, up to the maximum number of Shares permitted pursuant to the terms of the Plan and the applicable Offering Document, at the Purchase Price. No fractional Shares shall be issued upon the exercise of rights granted under the Plan, unless the Offering Document specifically provides otherwise. Any cash in lieu of fractional Shares remaining after the purchase of whole Shares upon exercise of a purchase right will be credited to a Participant’s account and returned to the Participant in one lump sum payment in a subsequent payroll check as soon as practicable after the Exercise Date, unless the Administrator provides that such amounts should be rolled over to the next occurring Offering Period in the applicable Offering Document. Shares issued pursuant to the Plan may be evidenced in such manner as the Administrator may determine and may be issued in certificated form or issued pursuant to book-entry procedures.

6.3 Pro Rata Allocation of Shares. If the Administrator determines that, on a given Purchase Date, the number of Shares with respect to which rights are to be exercised may exceed (a) the number of Shares that were available for issuance under the Plan on the Enrollment Date of the applicable Offering Period, or (b) the number of Shares available for issuance under the Plan on such Purchase Date, the Administrator may in its sole discretion provide that the Company shall make a pro rata allocation of the Shares available for purchase on such Enrollment Date or Purchase Date, as applicable, in as uniform a manner as shall be practicable and as it shall determine in its sole discretion to be equitable among all Participants for whom rights to purchase Common Stock are to be exercised pursuant to this Article VI on such Purchase Date, and shall either (i) continue all Offering Periods then in effect, or (ii) terminate any or all Offering Periods then in effect pursuant to Article IX. The Company may make pro rata allocation of the Shares available on the Enrollment Date of any applicable Offering Period pursuant to the preceding sentence, notwithstanding any authorization of additional Shares for issuance under the Plan by the Company’s stockholders subsequent to such Enrollment Date. The balance of the amount credited to the account of each Participant that has not been applied to the purchase of Shares shall be paid to such Participant in one lump sum in cash as soon as reasonably practicable after the Purchase Date.

6.4 Withholding. At the time a Participant’s rights under the Plan are exercised, in whole or in part, or at the time some or all of the Common Stock issued under the Plan is disposed of, the Participant must make adequate provision for the Company’s federal, state, or other tax withholding obligations, if any, that arise upon the exercise of the right or the disposition of the Common Stock. At any time, the Company may, but shall not be obligated to, withhold from the Participant’s compensation the amount necessary for the Company to meet applicable withholding obligations, including any withholding required to make available to the Company any tax deductions or benefits attributable to sale or early disposition of Common Stock by the Participant.

6.5 Conditions to Issuance of Common Stock. The Company shall not be required to issue or deliver any certificate or certificates for, or make any book entries evidencing, Shares purchased upon the exercise of rights under the Plan prior to fulfillment of all of the following conditions:

(a) The admission of such Shares to listing on all stock exchanges, if any, on which the Common Stock is then listed;

(b) The completion of any registration or other qualification of such Shares under any state or federal law or under the rulings or regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission or any other governmental regulatory body, that the Administrator shall, in its absolute discretion, deem necessary or advisable;

 

8


(c) The obtaining of any approval or other clearance from any state or federal governmental agency that the Administrator shall, in its absolute discretion, determine to be necessary or advisable;

(d) The payment to the Company of all amounts that it is required to withhold under federal, state or local law upon exercise of the rights, if any; and

(e) The lapse of such reasonable period of time following the exercise of the rights as the Administrator may from time to time establish for reasons of administrative convenience.

ARTICLE VII.

WITHDRAWAL; CESSATION OF ELIGIBILITY

7.1 Withdrawal. A Participant may withdraw all but not less than all of the payroll deductions or contributions credited to his or her account and not yet used to exercise his or her rights under the Plan at any time by giving written notice to the Company in a form acceptable to the Company no later than one week prior to the end of the Offering Period (or such shorter or longer period specified by the Administrator in the Offering Document). All of the Participant’s payroll deductions credited to his or her account or contributions made by the Participant during an Offering Period shall be paid to such Participant as soon as reasonably practicable after receipt of notice of withdrawal and such Participant’s rights for the Offering Period shall be automatically terminated, and no further payroll deductions for the purchase of Shares shall be made or contributions accepted for such Offering Period. If a Participant withdraws from an Offering Period, payroll deductions shall not resume at the beginning of the next Offering Period unless the Participant timely delivers to the Company a new subscription agreement.

7.2 Future Participation. A Participant’s withdrawal from an Offering Period shall not have any effect upon his or her eligibility to participate in any similar plan that may hereafter be adopted by the Company or a Designated Subsidiary or in subsequent Offering Periods that commence after the termination of the Offering Period from which the Participant withdraws.

7.3 Cessation of Eligibility. Upon a Participant’s ceasing to be an Eligible Employee for any reason, he or she shall be deemed to have elected to withdraw from the Plan pursuant to this Article VII and the payroll deductions credited to such Participant’s account or contributions made by such Participant during the Offering Period shall be paid to such Participant or, in the case of his or her death, to the person or persons entitled thereto under Section 12.4, as soon as reasonably practicable, and such Participant’s rights for the Offering Period shall be automatically terminated.

ARTICLE VIII.

ADJUSTMENTS UPON CHANGES IN STOCK

8.1 Changes in Capitalization. Subject to Section 8.3, in the event that the Administrator determines that any dividend or other distribution (whether in the form of cash, Common Stock, other securities, or other property), Change in Control, reorganization, merger, amalgamation, consolidation, combination, repurchase, recapitalization, liquidation, dissolution, or sale, transfer, exchange or other disposition of all or substantially all of the assets of the Company, or sale or exchange of Common Stock or other securities of the Company, issuance of warrants or other rights to purchase Common Stock or other securities of the Company, or other similar corporate transaction or event, as determined by the Administrator, affects the Common Stock such that an adjustment is determined by the Administrator to be appropriate in order to prevent dilution or enlargement of the benefits or potential benefits intended by the Company to be made available under the Plan or with respect to any outstanding purchase rights under the Plan, the Administrator shall make equitable adjustments, if any, to reflect such change with respect to (a) the aggregate number and type of Shares (or other securities or property) that may be issued under the Plan (including, but not limited to, adjustments of the limitations in Section 3.1 and the limitations established

 

9


in each Offering Document pursuant to Section 4.2 on the maximum number of Shares that may be purchased); (b) the class(es) and number of Shares and price per Share subject to outstanding rights; and (c) the Purchase Price with respect to any outstanding rights.

8.2 Other Adjustments. Subject to Section 8.3, in the event of any transaction or event described in Section 8.1 or any unusual or nonrecurring transactions or events affecting the Company, any affiliate of the Company, or the financial statements of the Company or any affiliate (including without limitation any Change in Control), or of changes in Applicable Law or accounting principles, the Administrator, in its discretion, and on such terms and conditions as it deems appropriate, is hereby authorized to take any one or more of the following actions whenever the Administrator determines that such action is appropriate in order to prevent the dilution or enlargement of the benefits or potential benefits intended to be made available under the Plan or with respect to any right under the Plan, to facilitate such transactions or events or to give effect to such changes in laws, regulations or principles:

(a) To provide for either (i) termination of any outstanding right in exchange for an amount of cash, if any, equal to the amount that would have been obtained upon the exercise of such right had such right been currently exercisable or (ii) the replacement of such outstanding right with other rights or property selected by the Administrator in its sole discretion;

(b) To provide that the outstanding rights under the Plan shall be assumed by the successor or survivor corporation, or a parent or subsidiary thereof, or shall be substituted for by similar rights covering the stock of the successor or survivor corporation, or a parent or subsidiary thereof, with appropriate adjustments as to the number and kind of shares and prices;

(c) To make adjustments in the number and type of Shares (or other securities or property) subject to outstanding rights under the Plan and/or in the terms and conditions of outstanding rights and rights that may be granted in the future;

(d) To provide that Participants’ accumulated payroll deductions or contributions may be used to purchase Common Stock prior to the next occurring Purchase Date on such date as the Administrator determines in its sole discretion and the Participants’ rights under the ongoing Offering Period(s) shall be terminated; and

(e) To provide that all outstanding rights shall terminate without being exercised.

8.3 No Adjustment Under Certain Circumstances. No adjustment or action described in this Article VIII or in any other provision of the Plan shall be authorized to the extent that such adjustment or action would cause the Plan to fail to satisfy the requirements of Section 423 of the Code.

8.4 No Other Rights. Except as expressly provided in the Plan, no Participant shall have any rights by reason of any subdivision or consolidation of shares of stock of any class, the payment of any dividend, any increase or decrease in the number of shares of stock of any class or any dissolution, liquidation, merger, or consolidation of the Company or any other corporation. Except as expressly provided in the Plan or pursuant to action of the Administrator under the Plan, no issuance by the Company of shares of stock of any class, or securities convertible into shares of stock of any class, shall affect, and no adjustment by reason thereof shall be made with respect to, the number of Shares subject to outstanding rights under the Plan or the Purchase Price with respect to any outstanding rights.

 

10


ARTICLE IX.

AMENDMENT, MODIFICATION AND TERMINATION

9.1 Amendment, Modification and Termination. The Administrator may amend, suspend or terminate the Plan at any time and from time to time; provided, however, that approval of the Company’s stockholders shall be required to amend the Plan to: (a) increase the aggregate number, or change the type, of shares that may be sold pursuant to rights under the Plan under Section 3.1 (other than an adjustment as provided by Article VIII); (b) change the corporations or classes of corporations whose employees may be granted rights under the Plan; or (c) change the Plan in any manner that would cause the Plan to no longer be an “employee stock purchase plan” within the meaning of Section 423(b) of the Code.

9.2 Certain Changes to Plan. Without stockholder consent and without regard to whether any Participant rights may be considered to have been adversely affected, to the extent permitted by Section 423 of the Code, the Administrator shall be entitled to change or terminate the Offering Periods, limit the frequency and/or number of changes in the amount withheld from Compensation during an Offering Period, establish the exchange ratio applicable to amounts withheld in a currency other than U.S. dollars, permit payroll withholding in excess of the amount designated by a Participant in order to adjust for delays or mistakes in the Company’s processing of payroll withholding elections, establish reasonable waiting and adjustment periods and/or accounting and crediting procedures to ensure that amounts applied toward the purchase of Common Stock for each Participant properly correspond with amounts withheld from the Participant’s Compensation, and establish such other limitations or procedures as the Administrator determines in its sole discretion to be advisable that are consistent with the Plan.

9.3 Actions In the Event of Unfavorable Financial Accounting Consequences. In the event the Administrator determines that the ongoing operation of the Plan may result in unfavorable financial accounting consequences, the Administrator may, in its discretion and, to the extent necessary or desirable, modify or amend the Plan to reduce or eliminate such accounting consequence including, but not limited to:

(a) altering the Purchase Price for any Offering Period including an Offering Period underway at the time of the change in Purchase Price;

(b) shortening any Offering Period so that the Offering Period ends on a new Purchase Date, including an Offering Period underway at the time of the Administrator action; and

(c) allocating Shares.

Such modifications or amendments shall not require stockholder approval or the consent of any Participant.

9.4 Payments Upon Termination of Plan. Upon termination of the Plan, the balance in each Participant’s Plan account shall be refunded as soon as practicable after such termination, without any interest thereon.

ARTICLE X.

TERM OF PLAN

The Plan shall be effective on the date on which the Board approves and adopts the Plan (the“Effective Date”). The Plan shall be submitted for the approval of the Company’s stockholders within twelve (12) months after the date of the Board’s initial adoption of the Plan. No purchase rights granted under this Plan shall be exercised, and no shares of Stock shall be issued hereunder, until this Plan shall have been approved by the stockholders of the Company. In the event this Plan shall not have been

 

11


approved by the stockholders of the Company prior to the end of said twelve (12)-month period, all purchase rights granted under this Plan shall be canceled and become null and void without being exercised. The Plan shall be in effect until terminated under Section 9.1 hereof. No rights may be granted under the Plan during any period of suspension of the Plan or after termination of the Plan.

ARTICLE XI.

ADMINISTRATION

11.1 Administrator. Unless otherwise determined by the Board, the Administrator of the Plan shall be the Compensation Committee of the Board (or another committee or a subcommittee of the Board to which the Board delegates administration of the Plan) (such committee, the “Committee”). The Board may at any time vest in the Board any authority or duties for administration of the Plan.

11.2 Action by the Administrator. Unless otherwise established by the Board or in any charter of the Administrator, a majority of the Administrator shall constitute a quorum. The acts of a majority of the members present at any meeting at which a quorum is present and, subject to Applicable Law and the Bylaws of the Company, acts approved in writing by a majority of the Administrator in lieu of a meeting, shall be deemed the acts of the Administrator. Each member of the Administrator is entitled to, in good faith, rely or act upon any report or other information furnished to that member by any officer or other employee of the Company or any Designated Subsidiary, the Company’s independent certified public accountants, or any executive compensation consultant or other professional retained by the Company to assist in the administration of the Plan.

11.3 Authority of Administrator. The Administrator shall have the power, subject to, and within the limitations of, the express provisions of the Plan:

(a) To determine when and how rights to purchase Common Stock shall be granted and the provisions of each offering of such rights (which need not be identical).

(b) To designate from time to time which Subsidiaries of the Company shall be Designated Subsidiaries, which designation may be made without the approval of the stockholders of the Company.

(c) To construe and interpret the Plan and rights granted under it, and to establish, amend and revoke rules and regulations for its administration. The Administrator, in the exercise of this power, may correct any defect, omission or inconsistency in the Plan, in a manner and to the extent it shall deem necessary or expedient to make the Plan fully effective.

(d) To amend, suspend or terminate the Plan as provided in Article IX.

(e) Generally, to exercise such powers and to perform such acts as the Administrator deems necessary or expedient to promote the best interests of the Company and its Subsidiaries and to carry out the intent that the Plan be treated as an “employee stock purchase plan” within the meaning of Section 423 of the Code.

11.4 Decisions Binding. The Administrator’s interpretation of the Plan, any rights granted pursuant to the Plan, any subscription agreement and all decisions and determinations by the Administrator with respect to the Plan are final, binding, and conclusive on all parties.

 

12


ARTICLE XII.

MISCELLANEOUS

12.1 Restriction upon Assignment. A right granted under the Plan shall not be transferable other than by will or the applicable laws of descent and distribution, and is exercisable during the Participant’s lifetime only by the Participant. Except as provided in Section 12.4 hereof, a right under the Plan may not be exercised to any extent except by the Participant. The Company shall not recognize and shall be under no duty to recognize any assignment or alienation of the Participant’s interest in the Plan, the Participant’s rights under the Plan or any rights thereunder.

12.2 Rights as a Stockholder. With respect to Shares subject to a right granted under the Plan, a Participant shall not be deemed to be a stockholder of the Company, and the Participant shall not have any of the rights or privileges of a stockholder, until such Shares have been issued to the Participant or his or her nominee following exercise of the Participant’s rights under the Plan. No adjustments shall be made for dividends (ordinary or extraordinary, whether in cash securities, or other property) or distribution or other rights for which the record date occurs prior to the date of such issuance, except as otherwise expressly provided herein or as determined by the Administrator.

12.3 Interest. No interest shall accrue on the payroll deductions or contributions of a Participant under the Plan.

12.4 Designation of Beneficiary.

(a) A Participant may, in the manner determined by the Administrator, file a written designation of a beneficiary who is to receive any Shares and/or cash, if any, from the Participant’s account under the Plan in the event of such Participant’s death subsequent to a Purchase Date on which the Participant’s rights are exercised but prior to delivery to such Participant of such Shares and cash. In addition, a Participant may file a written designation of a beneficiary who is to receive any cash from the Participant’s account under the Plan in the event of such Participant’s death prior to exercise of the Participant’s rights under the Plan. If the Participant is married and resides in a community property state, a designation of a person other than the Participant’s spouse as his or her beneficiary shall not be effective without the prior written consent of the Participant’s spouse.

(b) Such designation of beneficiary may be changed by the Participant at any time by written notice to the Company. In the event of the death of a Participant and in the absence of a beneficiary validly designated under the Plan who is living at the time of such Participant’s death, the Company shall deliver such Shares and/or cash to the executor or administrator of the estate of the Participant, or if no such executor or administrator has been appointed (to the knowledge of the Company), the Company, in its discretion, may deliver such Shares and/or cash to the spouse or to any one or more dependents or relatives of the Participant, or if no spouse, dependent or relative is known to the Company, then to such other person as the Company may designate.

12.5 Notices. All notices or other communications by a Participant to the Company under or in connection with the Plan shall be deemed to have been duly given when received in the form specified by the Company at the location, or by the person, designated by the Company for the receipt thereof.

12.6 Equal Rights and Privileges. Subject to Section 5.7, all Eligible Employees will have equal rights and privileges under this Plan so that this Plan qualifies as an “employee stock purchase plan” within the meaning of Section 423 of the Code. Subject to Section 5.7, any provision of this Plan that is inconsistent with Section 423 of the Code will, without further act or amendment by the Company, the Board or the Administrator, be reformed to comply with the equal rights and privileges requirement of Section 423 of the Code.

12.7 Use of Funds. All payroll deductions or contributions received or held by the Company under the Plan may be used by the Company for any corporate purpose, and the Company shall not be obligated to segregate such payroll deductions or contributions.

 

13


12.8 Reports. Statements of account shall be given to Participants at least annually, which statements shall set forth the amounts of payroll deductions or contributions, the Purchase Price, the number of Shares purchased and the remaining cash balance, if any.

12.9 No Employment Rights. Nothing in the Plan shall be construed to give any person (including any Eligible Employee or Participant) the right to remain in the employ of the Company or any Parent or Subsidiary or affect the right of the Company or any Parent or Subsidiary to terminate the employment of any person (including any Eligible Employee or Participant) at any time, with or without cause.

12.10 Notice of Disposition of Shares. Each Participant shall give prompt notice to the Company of any disposition or other transfer of any Shares purchased upon exercise of a right under the Plan if such disposition or transfer is made: (a) within two years from the Grant Date of the Offering Period in which the Shares were purchased or (b) within one year after the Purchase Date on which such Shares were purchased. Such notice shall specify the date of such disposition or other transfer and the amount realized, in cash, other property, assumption of indebtedness or other consideration, by the Participant in such disposition or other transfer.

12.11 Governing Law. The Plan and any agreements hereunder shall be administered, interpreted and enforced under the internal laws of the State of Delaware without regard to conflicts of laws thereof or of any other jurisdiction.

12.12 Electronic Forms. To the extent permitted by Applicable Law and in the discretion of the Administrator, an Eligible Employee may submit any form or notice as set forth herein by means of an electronic form approved by the Administrator. Before the commencement of an Offering Period, the Administrator shall prescribe the time limits within which any such electronic form shall be submitted to the Administrator with respect to such Offering Period in order to be a valid election.

 

14

Exhibit 10.12

INDUSTRIAL REAL ESTATE LEASE

DISCOVERY TECH CENTER

ORLANDO, FLORIDA

by and between

CHALLENGER-DISCOVERY, LLC, Landlord

and

LENSAR, INC., Tenant

July 30, 2010


TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

ARTICLE

   PAGE  

ARTICLE 1 BASIC TERMS

     1  

ARTICLE 2 PREMISES

     3  

ARTICLE 3 LEASE TERM

     3  

ARTICLE 4 RENT

     4  

ARTICLE 5 PROPERTY TAXES

     6  

ARTICLE 6 UTILITIES

     6  

ARTICLE 7 INSURANCE

     7  

ARTICLE 8 COMMON AREAS

     10  

ARTICLE 9 USE OF PREMISES

     11  

ARTICLE 10 CONDITION AND MAINTENANCE OF PREMISES

     14  

ARTICLE 11 DAMAGE OR DESTRUCTION

     17  

ARTICLE 12 CONDEMNATION

     18  

ARTICLE 13 ASSIGNMENT AND SUBLETTING

     18  

ARTICLE 14 DEFAULTS AND REMEDIES

     20  

ARTICLE 15 PROTECTION OF LENDERS

     23  

ARTICLE 16 LEGAL COSTS

     25  

ARTICLE 17 MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS

     25  

ARTICLE 18 RENEWAL OPTION

     29  

ARTICLE 19 RIGHT OF FIRST REFUSAL

     30  

ARTICLE 20 OPTION TO TERMINATE

     31  

 

EXHIBIT A – THE LAND
EXHIBIT B – THE PREMISES
EXHIBIT C – RULES AND REGULATIONS
EXHIBIT D – WORK LETTER
EXHIBIT E – COMMENCEMENT LETTER AND ACCEPTANCE OF PREMISES
EXHIBIT F – HAZARDOUS MATERIALS DISCLOSURE CERTIFICATE
EXHIBIT G – INITIAL DISCLOSURE CERTIFICATE
EXHIBIT H – 2010 BUDGET OF TOTAL OPERATING COSTS


ARTICLE 1

BASIC TERMS

The following terms used in this Lease shall have the meanings set forth below.

1.01 Date of Lease: July 30, 2010

1.02 Landlord (legal entity): Challenger-Discovery, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company

1.03 Tenant (legal entity): LensAR, Inc., a Delaware corporation

1.04 Tenant’s Guarantor: None

1.05 Address of Property: 2800 Discovery Drive, Orlando, Florida 32826

1.06 Property Rentable Area: 44,765 (subject to Section 2.02 below)

1.07 Premises Rentable Area: 34,758 (subject to Section 2.02 below)

1.08 Tenant’s Initial Pro Rata Share: 77.65% (subject to adjustment based on Section 2.02 below)

1.09 Lease Term: Sixty-six (66) months, commencing on the Lease Commencement Date.

1.10 Lease Commencement Date: The date Landlord delivers possession of the Premises with Landlord’s Work (as defined in Paragraph 1 of the Work Letter) substantially complete (as defined in Paragraph 7 of the Work Letter) and with a Certificate of Occupancy (subject to a Delay as defined in Paragraph 8 of the Work Letter).

1.11 Target Lease Commencement Date: September 1, 2010

1.12 Permitted Uses: General office use and research and development in optics and visual science and marketing of ophthalmic therapeutic medical devices including the assembly of finished products from components.

1.13 Broker: Lincoln Property Company of Florida, Inc. and Dunhill Properties, Inc.

1.14 Security Deposit Requirement: $112,963.50

1.15 Parking Spaces Allocated to Tenant: 145

1.16 Base Rent (subject to adjustment based on Section 2.02 below):

 

Months

   Rate Per Sq. Ft.    Annual Base Rent
(or a portion
thereof)
   Monthly Installment

1

   $0.00    $0.00    $0.00

2-11

   $6.50    $188,272.50    $18,827.25

12

   $13.00    $37,654.50    $37,654.50


Months

   Rate Per Sq. Ft.    Annual Base Rent
(or a portion
thereof)
   Monthly Installment

13-24

   $13.39    $465,409.62    $38,784.14

25-36

   $13.79    $479,312.82    $39,942.74

37-48

   $14.20    $493,563.60    $41,130.30

49-60

   $14.63    $508,509.54    $42,375.80

61-66

   $15.07    $261,901.56    $43,650.26

Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained herein, so long as Tenant is not in default hereunder, Tenant’s obligation to pay the Base Rent otherwise due for the first (1st) calendar month of the Lease Term (the “Base Rent Abatement Period”) shall be abated; provided, however, that if the Lease Commencement Date occurs on a date other than the first day of a calendar month, then the Base Rent Abatement Period shall consist of the first thirty (30) consecutive days of the Lease Term. Subject to the provisions of this paragraph, the total amount of Base Rent abated during the Base Rent Abatement Period shall equal $37,654.50 (the “Abated Base Rent”). If Landlord elects to terminate this Lease or Tenant’s right to possession of the Premises due to a default by Tenant not cured during any applicable grace or curative period, then (i) the portion of the Abated Base Rent unamortized as of the date of such default (with the Abated Base Rent being deemed to have been amortized in equal monthly installments together with interest thereon at the rate of five percent (5%) per annum over the Lease Term) shall immediately become due and payable; and (ii) Tenant shall not be entitled to any further abatement of the Abated Base Rent pursuant to this paragraph. The payment by Tenant of the Abated Base Rent in the event of a default shall not limit or affect any of Landlord’s other rights or remedies, in the event of a default by Tenant, pursuant to this Lease or at law or in equity.

Tenant shall also pay all applicable Florida State Sales Taxes.

1.17 Other Charges Payable by Tenant:

 

  (a)

Real Property Taxes (Article Five);

 

  (b)

Utilities (Article Six);

 

  (c)

Insurance Premiums (Article Seven);

 

  (d)

CAM Expenses (Article Eight);

1.18 Address of Landlord for Notices:

c/o Marcent Development Company. Inc.

5401 South Kirkman Road, Suite 650

Orlando, Florida 32819

 

2


1.19 Address of Tenant for Notices:

LensAR, Inc.

Attn: Corporate Secretary

2800 Discovery Drive, Suite 100

Orlando, FL 32826

(prior to Lease Commencement Date, as defined herein:)

250 S. Park Avenue, Suite 310

Winter Park, FL 32789

1.20 Landlord’s Management Agent and Address:

Elite Management of Orlando, Inc.

5401 South Kirkman Road

Suite 650

Orlando, Florida 32819

or such other Management Agent as Landlord may designate from time to time.

1.21 Fiscal Year: Calendar year ending April 30th

1.22 Exhibits:

Exhibit A – The Land

Exhibit B – The Premises

Exhibit C – Rules and Regulations

Exhibit D – Work Letter

Exhibit E – Commencement Letter and Acceptance of the Premises

Exhibit F – Hazardous Materials Disclosure Certificate

Exhibit G – Initial Disclosure Certificate

ARTICLE 2

PREMISES

2.01 Premises. The Premises are depicted on Exhibit B and are situated on the land which is legally described in Exhibit A (the “Land”). The Property includes the Land, the building constructed on the Land (the “Building”), and all other improvements located on the Land including the common areas described in Article Eight.

2.02 BOMA Standards Calculation. The Property Rentable Area and Premises Rentable Area shall mean the rentable area of the Property and the Premises, respectively, measured and calculated in accordance with BOMA standards (BOMA 265.1-1996). Accordingly, the Property Rentable Area, Premises Rentable Area, Tenant’s Initial Pro Rata Share and Base Rent are subject to adjustment before the Lease Commencement Date by mutual written agreement of the parties.

2.03 Quiet Enjoyment. Provided Tenant has performed all of the terms, covenants and conditions of this Lease to be performed by Tenant, Tenant shall peaceably and quietly hold and enjoy the Premises for the term hereof, without hindrance from anyone, subject to the terms and conditions of this Lease.

 

3


ARTICLE 3

LEASE TERM

3.01 Lease of Premises for Lease Term. Landlord leases the Premises to Tenant and Tenant leases the Premises from Landlord for the Lease Term. Landlord shall complete the leasehold improvements described in Exhibit D attached hereto and incorporated herein by this reference. The Lease Term shall begin on the Lease Commencement Date.

3.02 Delay in Commencement. Landlord shall not be liable to Tenant if Landlord shall not deliver possession of the Premises to Tenant on the Target Lease Commencement Date. Landlord’s non-delivery of the Premises to Tenant on that date shall not affect this Lease or the obligations of Tenant under this Lease.

3.03 Early Access. Tenant shall be permitted access to the Premises no less than two (2) weeks prior to the Lease Commencement Date in order to install Tenant’s furniture, fixtures, data/phone and cabling systems. Tenant’s early access of the Premises shall be subject to all of the provisions of this Lease. Early access of the Premises for such space preparation purposes shall not advance the Lease Commencement Date or expiration date of this Lease. In addition to the foregoing, Landlord shall instruct its contractor undertaking the Landlord’s Work to contact Tenant when the walls and/or ceilings have been opened up so as to be most conducive to installation of cabling, networks and security systems and allow Tenant’s vendors to install the foregoing; provided that Landlord’s Work shall in no way be delayed or impeded.

3.04 Holding Over. Tenant shall vacate the Premises upon the expiration or earlier termination of this Lease. Tenant shall reimburse Landlord for, and indemnify Landlord against, all damages, costs, liabilities and expenses, including attorneys’ fees, which Landlord shall incur on account of Tenant’s delay in so vacating the Premises. If Tenant shall not vacate the Premises upon the expiration or earlier termination of this Lease, the Base Rent shall be increased to 150% times the Base Rent then in effect and Tenant’s obligation to pay Additional Rent shall continue, but nothing herein shall limit any of Landlord’s rights or Tenant’s obligations arising from Tenant’s failure to vacate the Premises, including, without limitation. Landlord’s right to repossess the Premises and remove Tenant therefrom at any time after the expiration or earlier termination of this Lease and Tenant’s obligation to reimburse and indemnify Landlord as provided in the preceding sentence.

ARTICLE 4

RENT

4.01 Base Rent. On the first day of each month during the Lease Term, Tenant shall pay to Landlord the Base Rent in lawful money of the United States, in advance and without offset, deduction, or prior demand. The Base Rent shall be payable at Landlord’s address or at such other place or to such other person as Landlord may designate in writing from time to time. However, the Landlord may not unreasonably withhold a request by the Tenant to arrange for ACH transfer of the Rent and/or other payments that may become due and payable hereunder in this Lease to effect timely delivery of such payment that is not to a physical address. Notwithstanding the foregoing, Tenant shall pay $37,654.50 upon full execution of this Lease which represents the Base Rent payment for the twelfth (12th) month of the Lease Term.

 

4


4.02 Additional Rent. All sums payable by Tenant under this Lease other than Base Rent shall be deemed “Additional Rent;” the term “Rent” shall mean Base Rent and Additional Rent. Landlord shall estimate in advance and charge to Tenant the following costs, to be paid with the Base Rent on a monthly basis throughout the Lease Term, but commencing with the first day of the first month of the Lease Term: (i) all Real Property Taxes for which Tenant is liable under Sections 5.01 and 5.02 of this Lease, (ii) all utility costs (if utilities are not separately metered) for which Tenant is liable under Section 6.01 of this Lease, (iii) all insurance premiums for which Tenant is liable under Sections 7.01 and 7.06 of this Lease and (iv) all CAM Expenses for which Tenant is liable under Section 8.04 of this Lease. Collectively, the aforementioned Real Property Taxes, insurance, utility, and CAM Expenses shall be referred to as the “Total Operating Costs”. For reference purposes only and not as any representation by Landlord as to such information, the 2010 budget for the Total Operating Costs is attached hereto as Exhibit H and incorporated herein by this reference. Landlord may adjust its estimates of Total Operating Costs at any time based upon Landlord’s experience and reasonable anticipation of costs. Such adjustments shall be effective as of the next Rent payment date after notice to Tenant. Within one hundred twenty (120) days after the end of each Fiscal Year during the Lease Term, Landlord shall deliver to Tenant a statement prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles setting forth, in reasonable detail, the Total Operating Costs paid or incurred by Landlord during the preceding Fiscal Year and Tenant’s Pro Rata Share of such expenses. Within thirty (30) days after Tenant’s receipt of such statement, there shall be an adjustment between Landlord and Tenant, with payment to or credit given by Landlord (as the case may be) in order that Landlord shall receive the entire amount of Tenant’s Pro Rata of such costs and expenses for such period. In addition to its obligation to pay Base Rent and its Pro Rata Share of Total Operating Costs, Tenant is required hereunder to pay directly to its suppliers, vendors, carriers and contractors, certain insurance premiums, utility costs, personal property taxes, maintenance and repair costs and other expenses, collectively “Additional Expenses.” If Landlord pays for any Additional Expenses in accordance with the terms of this Lease, Tenant’s obligation to reimburse such costs shall be an Additional Rent obligation payable in full with the next monthly Rent payment.

4.03 Late Charge. Tenant hereby acknowledges that late payment by Tenant to Landlord of Rent and other amounts due hereunder will cause Landlord to incur costs not contemplated by this Lease, the exact amount of which will be extremely difficult to ascertain. Such costs include, but are not limited to, processing and accounting charges, and late charges which may be imposed on Landlord by the terms of any loan secured by the Building. Accordingly, if any installment of Rent or any other sums due from Tenant shall not be received by Landlord within five (5) days following the due date, Tenant shall pay to Landlord a late charge equal to ten percent (10%) of such overdue amount; provided, however, Tenant shall not be obligated to pay such late charge for the first (1st) late payment m any twelve (12) month period in the Lease Term. The parties hereby agree that such late charge represents a fair and reasonable estimate of the costs Landlord will incur by reason of late payment by Tenant. Acceptance of such late charge by Landlord shall in no event constitute a waiver of Tenant’s default with respect to such overdue amount, nor prevent Landlord from exercising any of the other rights and remedies granted hereunder.

4.04 Interest. Any Rent or other amount due to Landlord, if not received by Landlord within five (5) days from when due, shall bear interest from the date due until paid

 

5


at the rate of eighteen percent (18%) per annum or, if a higher rate is legally permissible, at the highest rate legally permitted, provided that interest shall not be payable on late charges incurred by Tenant nor on any amounts upon which late charges are paid by Tenant to the extent such interest would cause the total interest to be in excess of that legally permitted. Payment of interest shall not excuse or cure any default hereunder by Tenant.

4.05 Tenant’s Pro Rata Share. Tenant’s Pro Rata Share shall be calculated by dividing the Premises Rentable Area by the Property Rentable Area, which is leased or held for lease by tenants, as of the date on which the computation shall be made. Tenant’s Initial Pro Rata Share is set forth in Section 1.08 and is subject to adjustment based on the aforementioned formula.

ARTICLE 5

PROPERTY TAXES

5.01 Real Property Taxes. Tenant shall pay Tenant’s Pro Rata Share of Real Property Taxes on the Property payable during the Lease Term. Tenant shall make such payments in accordance with Section 4.02. If Landlord shall receive a refund of any Real Property Taxes with respect to which Tenant shall have paid Tenant’s Pro Rata Share, Landlord shall refund to Tenant Tenant’s Pro Rata Share of such refund after deducting therefrom the costs and expenses incurred in connection therewith.

5.02 Definition of “Real Property Tax”. “Real Property Tax” shall mean taxes, assessments (special, betterment, or otherwise), levies, fees, rent taxes, excises, impositions, charges, water and sewer rents and charges, and all other government levies and charges, general and special, ordinary and extraordinary, foreseen and unforeseen, which are imposed or levied upon or assessed against the Property or any Rent or other sums payable by any tenants or occupants thereof. Real Property Tax shall include Landlord’s costs and expenses of contesting any Real Property Tax. Real Property Tax shall not include any permit fees, impact fees or connection fees related to preparation and use of Additional Space on the Property unless such preparation and use is related to an exercise of the Right of First Refusal pursuant to Article 19 herein. If at any time during the Lease Term the present system of ad valorem taxation of real property shall be changed so that in lieu of the whole or any part of the ad valorem tax on real property, or in lieu of increases therein, there shall be assessed on Landlord a capital levy or other tax on the gross rents received with respect to the Property or a federal, state, county, municipal, or other local income, franchise, excise or similar tax, assessment, levy, or charge (distinct from any now in effect) measured by or based, in whole or in part, upon gross rents, then all of such taxes, assessments, levies, or charges, to the extent so measured or based, shall be deemed to be a Real Property Tax.

5.03 Personal Property Taxes. Tenant shall pay directly all taxes charged against trade fixtures, furnishings, equipment, inventory, or any other personal property belonging to Tenant. Tenant shall use its best efforts to have personal property taxed separately from the Property. If any of Tenant’s personal property shall be taxed with the Property, Tenant shall pay Landlord the taxes for such personal property within fifteen (15) days after Tenant receives a written statement from Landlord for such personal property taxes.

5.04 Real Estate Appraisal Appeal. In the event the Real Property Tax assessment in any tax year in the Lease Term exceeds the previous year’s Real Property Tax assessment by more than 5%, and Landlord fails to appeal such tax assesment within a reasonable period

 

6


of time after receipt of such assessment. Tenant shall be entitled to appeal the valuation of the Property for Real Property Tax purposes. Landlord shall reasonably cooperate by furnishing Tenant such reasonable information as necessary or helpful to do so, as well as execute all appeal forms; provided, however, Landlord shall incur no out of pocket expense for the foregoing appeal.

ARTICLE 6

UTILITIES

6.01 Utilities. Tenant shall promptly pay, directly to the appropriate supplier, the cost of all natural gas, heat, cooling, energy, light, power, sewer service, telephone, water, refuse disposal and other utilities and services supplied to the Premises, allocable to the period from the time Tenant shall first enter the Premises, throughout the Lease Term and thereafter as long as Tenant shall remain in the Premises (collectively, “the Occupancy Period”), together with any related installation or connection charges or deposits (collectively “Utility Costs”). If any services or utilities are jointly metered with other premises, Landlord shall make a reasonable determination of Tenant’s proportionate share of such Utility Costs and Tenant shall pay such share to Landlord in accordance with Section 4.02. Landlord shall not be liable for damages, consequential or otherwise, nor shall there be any rent abatement, arising out of any curtailment or interruption whatsoever in utility services unless the Premises is not separately metered and the curtailment or interruption is related to the misconduct or gross negligence of Landlord (and Tenant has paid its Pro Rata Share). Utilities serving the Common Areas (as defined in Article Eight) exclusively shall be accounted for as described in Article Eight.

ARTICLE 7

INSURANCE

7.01 Liability Insurance. During the Occupancy Period, Tenant shall maintain in effect commercial general liability insurance insuring Tenant against liability for bodily injury, property damage (including loss of use of property) and personal injury at the Premises, including contractual liability. Such insurance shall name Landlord, its property manager, and any mortgagee, as additional insureds. The initial amount of such insurance shall be Three Million Dollars ($3,000,000) per occurrence and shall be subject to periodic increases specified by Landlord based upon inflation, recommendation of Landlord’s professional insurance advisers, and insurance coverage trends for comparable Orlando area commercial “flex” space buildings. The liability insurance obtained by Tenant under this Section 7.01 shall (i) be primary and (ii) insure Tenant’s obligations to Landlord under Section 7.09. The amount and coverage of such insurance shall not limit Tenant’s liability nor relieve Tenant of any other obligation under this Lease. Landlord may also obtain commercial general liability insurance in an amount and with coverage determined by Landlord insuring Landlord against liability with respect to the Premises and the Property. The policy obtained by Landlord shall not provide primary insurance, shall not be contributory and shall be excess over any insurance maintained by Tenant.

7.02 Worker’s Compensation Insurance. During the Occupancy Period. Tenant shall maintain in effect Worker’s Compensation Insurance (including Employers’ Liability Insurance) in the statutory amount covering all employees of Tenant employed or performing services at the Premises, in order to provide the statutory benefits required by the laws of the state in which the Premises are located.

 

7


7.03 Automobile Liability Insurance. During the Occupancy Period, Tenant shall maintain in effect Automobile Liability Insurance, including but not limited to, passenger liability, on all Tenant owned, leased, and hired vehicles used in connection with the Premises, with a combined single limit per occurrence of not less than One Million Dollars ($1,000,000) for injuries or death of one or more persons or loss or damage to property.

7.04 Personal Property Insurance. During the Occupancy Period, Tenant shall maintain in effect Personal Property Insurance covering leasehold improvements paid for by Tenant and Tenant’s personal property and fixtures from time to time in, on or at the Premises, in an amount not less than 100% of the full replacement cost, without deduction for depreciation, providing protection against events protected under “All Risk Coverage,” as well as against sprinkler damage, vandalism and malicious mischief. Any proceeds from the Personal Property Insurance shall be used for the repair or replacement of the property damaged or destroyed unless this Lease is terminated under an applicable provision herein. If the Premises are not repaired or restored following damage or destruction in accordance with other provisions herein. Landlord shall receive any proceeds from the Personal Property Insurance allocable to Tenant’s leasehold improvements.

7.05 Intentionally Omitted.

7.06 Landlord’s Property and Rental Income Insurance. During the Lease Term, Landlord shall maintain in effect all risk insurance covering loss of or damage to the Property in the amount of its replacement value with such endorsements and deductibles as Landlord shall determine from time to time. Landlord shall have the right to obtain flood, earthquake, and such other insurance as Landlord shall determine from time to time or shall be required by any lender holding a security interest in the Property. Landlord shall not obtain insurance for Tenant’s fixtures or equipment or building improvements installed by Tenant. During the Lease Term, Landlord shall also maintain a rental income insurance policy, with loss payable to Landlord, in an amount equal to one (1) year’s Base Rent, plus estimated Real Property Taxes, CAM Expenses, Utility Costs and insurance premiums for one (1) year. Tenant shall be liable for the payment of any deductible amount under Landlord’s insurance maintained pursuant to this Article 7, in an amount not to exceed Twenty Five Thousand Dollars ($25,000.00) in the aggregate. Tenant shall not do or permit anything to be done which shall invalidate any such insurance. Any increase in the cost of Landlord’s insurance due to Tenant’s use or activities at the Premises shall be paid by Tenant to Landlord as Additional Rent hereunder.

7.07 Payment of Insurance Premiums. Landlord shall pay the premiums of the insurance policies maintained by Landlord under Section 7.06 and Section 7.01 (if applicable), and Tenant shall reimburse Landlord for Tenant’s Pro Rata Share of such premiums in accordance with Section 4.02. Tenant shall pay directly the premiums of the insurance policies maintained by Tenant under Sections 7.01, 7.02, 7.03, 7.04 and 7.05.

7.08 General Insurance Provisions.

(a) Any insurance which Tenant shall be required to maintain under this Lease shall include a provision which requires the insurance carrier to give Landlord not less than thirty (30) days’ written notice prior to any cancellation or modification of such coverage.

 

8


(b) Prior to the earlier of Tenant’s entry into the Premises or the Lease Commencement Date, Tenant shall deliver to Landlord an insurance company certificate that Tenant maintains the insurance required by Sections 7.01, 7.02, 7.03, 7.04 and 7.05 and not less than thirty (30) days prior to the expiration or termination of any such insurance, Tenant shall deliver to Landlord renewal certificates therefor. Tenant shall provide Landlord with copies of the policies promptly upon request from time to time. If Tenant shall fail to deliver any certificate or renewal certificate to Landlord required under this Lease within the prescribed time period or if any such policy shall be canceled or modified during the Lease Term without Landlord’s consent, Landlord may obtain such insurance, in which case Tenant shall reimburse Landlord, as Additional Rent, for 105% the cost of such insurance within ten (10) days after receipt of a statement of the cost of such insurance.

(c) Tenant shall maintain all insurance required under this Lease with companies having a “General Policy Rating” of A -; X or better, as set forth in the most current issue of the Best Key Rating Guide.

(d) Landlord and Tenant, on behalf of themselves and their insurers, each hereby waive any and all rights of recovery against the other, the officers, members, partners, employees, agents, or representatives of the other and the officers, members, partners, employees, agents or representatives of each of the foregoing, for loss of or damage to its property or the property of others under its control, if such loss or damage shall be covered by any insurance policy in force (whether or not described in this Lease) at the time of such loss or damage, or required to be carried under this Article Seven. All property insurance carried by either party shall contain a waiver of subrogation against the other party to the extent such right shall have been waived by the insured party prior to the occurrence of loss or injury.

7.09 Indemnity.

(a) To the fullest extent permitted by law. Tenant hereby waives all claims against Landlord, its agents, advisors, employees, members, officers, directors, partners, trustees, beneficiaries and shareholders (each a “Landlord Party”) and the agents, advisors, employees, members, officers, directors, partners, trustees, beneficiaries and shareholders of each Landlord Party (collectively, the “Indemnitees”) for damage to any property or injury to or death of any person in, upon or about the Premises or the Property arising at any time and from any cause, and Tenant shall hold Indemnitees harmless from and defend Indemnitees from and against all claims, liabilities, judgments, demands, causes of action, losses, damages, costs and expenses, including reasonable attorney’s fees, for damage to any property or injury to or death of any person arising in or from (i) the use or occupancy of the Premises by Tenant or persons claiming under Tenant, except such as is caused by the sole negligence or willful misconduct of Landlord, its agents, employees or contractors, or (ii) arising from the negligence or willful misconduct of Tenant, its employees, agents, contractors, or invitees in, upon or about the Property, or (iii) arising out of any breach or default by Tenant under this Lease. 1 he foregoing shall include investigation costs and expenses incurred by Landlord in connection with any claim or demand made under this Section. The provisions of this Section 7.09(a) shall survive the expiration or termination of this Lease with respect to any damage, injury or death occurring prior to such time.

 

9


(b) To the fullest extent permitted by law, Landlord hereby waives all claims against Tenant, its agents, advisors, employees, members, officers, directors, partners, trustees, beneficiaries and shareholders (each a “Tenant Party”) and the agents, advisors, employees, members, officers, directors, partners, trustees, beneficiaries and shareholders of each Tenant Party (collectively, the “Tenant Indemnitees”) for damage to any property or injury to or death of any person in, upon or about the Premises or the Property arising at any time and from any cause, and Landlord shall hold Tenant Indemnitees harmless from and defend Tenant Indemnitees from and against all claims, liabilities, judgments, demands, causes of action, losses, damages, costs and expenses, including reasonable attorney’s fees, for damage to any property or injury to or death of any person arising in or from (i) arising from the negligence or willful misconduct of Landlord, its employees, agents, contractors, or invitees in, upon or about the Property, or (ii) arising out of any breach or default by Landlord under this Lease. The foregoing shall include investigation costs and expenses incurred by Tenant in connection with any claim or demand made under this Section. The provisions of this Section 7.09(b) shall survive the expiration or termination of this Lease with respect to any damage, injury or death occurring prior to such time.

ARTICLE 8

COMMON AREAS

8.01 Common Areas. As used in this Lease, “Common Areas” shall mean all areas within the Property which are available for the common use of tenants of the Property and which are not leased or held for the exclusive use of Tenant or other tenants, including, but not limited to, parking areas, driveways, sidewalks, access roads, landscaping, and planted areas. Landlord, from time to time, may change the size, location, nature, and use of any of the Common Areas, convert Common Areas into leasable areas, construct additional parking facilities (including parking structures) in the Common Areas, and increase or decrease Common Area land or facilities. Tenant acknowledges that such activities may result in inconvenience to Tenant and Landlord warrants that any such activities shall be undertaken so as to reasonably minimize any such inconvenience. Such activities and changes are permitted if they do not materially affect Tenant’s use of the Premises. The bathrooms located adjacent to the Premises and the corridor leading to them shall be a Shared Area (defined herein), but shall only be available for use by Tenant and any tenant of the other leased space located adjacent to those bathrooms. For purposes of this Section 8.01, the term “Shared Area” shall mean the space to be used only by Tenant and the tenant to be located adjacent to the Premises. The costs related to the Shared Area are shared equally by Tenant and such other tenant.

8.02 Use of Common Areas. Tenant shall have the non-exclusive right (in common with other tenants and all others to whom Landlord has granted or may grant such rights) to use the Common Areas for the purposes intended, subject to such reasonable rules and regulations (the “Rules and Regulations”) as Landlord may establish or modify from time to time and as initially set forth in Exhibit C. Landlord shall uniformly enforce all Rules and Regulations for all tenants in the building. Tenant shall abide by all such Rules and Regulations and shall use its best efforts to cause others who use the Common Areas with Tenant’s express or implied permission to abide by Landlord’s Rules and Regulations. At any time, Landlord may close any Common Areas to perform any acts in the Common Areas as, in Landlord’s reasonable judgment, are desirable to maintain or improve the Property. Tenant shall not interfere with the rights of Landlord, other tenants, or any other person entitled to use the Common Areas.

 

10


8.03 Vehicle Parking. Tenant shall be entitled to use the Parking Spaces Allocated to Tenant without paying any additional Rent. Of the Parking Spaces Allocated to Tenant, Tenant shall be entitled to reserve ten (10) spaces (the “Reserved Spaces”) and shall be entitled to mark such space with signage stating “LensAR Reserved”. All such signage shall be subject to the approval of all applicable municipalities and Landlord. Other than the Reserved Spaces, Tenant’s parking shall not be reserved and shall be limited to vehicles no larger than standard size automobiles or pickup utility vehicles. Tenant shall not cause large trucks or other large vehicles to be parked within the Property or on the adjacent public streets except in accordance with the Rules and Regulations. Vehicles shall be parked only in striped parking spaces and not in driveways or other locations not specifically designated for parking. Handicapped spaces shall only be used by those legally permitted to use them. Tenant shall not park at any time more vehicles in the parking area than the number of Parking Spaces Allocated to Tenant. Tenant’s use of the Property for parking purposes shall at all times comply with all applicable laws, codes and ordinances.

8.04 Common Area Maintenance. Subject to Articles Eleven and Twelve, Landlord shall maintain the Common Areas in good order, condition, and repair. Common Area Maintenance expenses (“CAM Expenses”) are all costs and expenses associated with the operation and maintenance of the Common Areas and the repair and maintenance of the heating, ventilation, air conditioning, plumbing, electrical, utility and safety systems (to the extent not performed by Tenant), including, but not limited to, the following: gardening and landscaping; snow removal; utility, water, sewage and property drainage services for the Common Area; maintenance of signs (other than tenants’ signs); worker’s compensation insurance; personal property taxes; rentals or lease payments paid by Landlord for rented or leased personal property used in the operation or maintenance of the Common Areas; fees for required licenses and permits routine maintenance and repair of roof membrane, flashings, gutters, downspouts, roof drains, skylights and waterproofing; maintenance of paving, (including sweeping, striping, repairing, resurfacing and repaving); general maintenance; painting; lighting; cleaning; refuse removal; security and similar items; reserves for roof replacement, exterior painting and other appropriate reserves; and a property management fee not to exceed five percent (5%) of building revenues. Landlord may cause any or all of such services to be provided by third parties and the cost of such services shall be included in CAM Expenses. With respect to any CAM Expenses which are included for the benefit of the Property and other property. Landlord shall make a reasonable allocation of such cost between the Property and such other property. CAM Expenses shall not include the cost of capital repairs and replacements; provided, however, that (a) the annual depreciation (based on the useful life of the item under generally accepted accounting principles) of any such capital repair or replacement to the Common Areas or the heating, ventilating, air-conditioning, plumbing, electrical, utility and safety systems serving the Property, shall be included in the CAM Expenses each year during the Lease Term; and (b) the cost of capital improvements undertaken to reduce CAM Expenses or made in order to comply with legal requirements shall be included in CAM Expenses each year during the term of this Lease.

8.05 Tenant’s Payment of CAM Expenses. Tenant shall pay Tenant’s Pro Rata Share of all CAM Expenses in accordance with Section 4.02.

 

11


ARTICLE 9

USE OF PREMISES

9.01 Permitted Uses. Tenant may use the Premises only for the Permitted Uses.

9.02 Manner of Use. Tenant shall not cause or permit the Premises (including all parking, dock and trailer areas used in connection therewith) to be used in any way which shall constitute a violation of any law, ordinance, restrictive covenants, governmental regulation or order, which shall annoy or interfere with the rights of tenants of the Property, or which shall constitute a nuisance or waste. As part of the Construction Allowance, Landlord shall obtain and pay for all permits, including a certificate of occupancy. As of the Lease Commencement Date, Landlord warrants that Landlord’s Work will be designed and installed in a manner to assure initial compliance with the Occupational Safety and Health Act (“OSHA”) and the Americans With Disabilities Act (“ADA”) requirements for the Premises. Following the Commencement Date and throughout the Lease Term, including any Option Period(s), Tenant shall promptly take all actions necessary to comply with all applicable statutes, ordinances, codes, regulations, orders, covenants and requirements regulating the use by Tenant of the Premises, including OSHA and the ADA.

9.03 Hazardous Materials. Prior to executing this Lease, Tenant has completed, executed and delivered to Landlord a Hazardous Materials Disclosure Certificate (“Initial Disclosure Certificate”), a fully completed copy of which is attached hereto as Exhibit G and incorporated herein by this reference. Tenant covenants, represents and warrants to Landlord that the information on the Initial Disclosure Certificate is true and correct and accurately describes all Hazardous Materials (as defined below) which will be manufactured, treated, used or stored on or about the Premises by Tenant or Tenant’s Agents. Tenant shall on each anniversary of the Commencement Date and at such other times as Tenant desires to manufacture, treat, use or store on or about the Premises new or additional Hazardous Materials which were not listed on the Initial Disclosure Certificate, complete, execute and deliver to Landlord an updated Disclosure Certificate (each, an “Updated Disclosure Certificate”) describing Tenant’s then current and proposed future uses of Hazardous Materials on or about the Premises, which Updated Disclosure Certificate shall be in the same format as that which is set forth in Exhibit F or in such updated format as Landlord may require from time to time. Tenant shall deliver an Updated Disclosure Certificate to Landlord not less than thirty days prior to the date Tenant intends to commence the manufacture, treatment, use or storage of new or additional Hazardous Materials on or about the Premises, and Landlord shall have the right to approve or disapprove such new or additional Hazardous Materials in its sole and absolute discretion. Tenant shall make no use of Hazardous Materials on or about the Premises except as described in the Initial Disclosure Certificate or as otherwise approved by Landlord in writing, in accordance with this Section 9.03.

As used in this Lease, the term “Hazardous Material” shall mean any flammable items, explosives, radioactive materials, oil, hazardous or toxic substances, material or waste or related materials, including any substances defined as or included in the definition of “hazardous substances”, “hazardous wastes”, “hazardous materials” or “toxic substances” now or subsequently regulated under any applicable federal, state or local laws or regulations, including without limitation petroleum-based products, paints, solvents, lead, cyanide, DDT, printing inks, acids, pesticides, ammonia compounds and other chemical products, asbestos, PCBs and similar compounds, and including any different products and materials which are subsequently found to have adverse effects on the environment or the health and safety of

 

12


persons. Tenant shall not cause or permit any Hazardous Material to be generated, produced, brought upon. used, stored, treated or disposed of in or about the Property by Tenant. its agents, employees, contractors, sublessees or invitees without (a) the prior written consent of Landlord, and (b) complying with all applicable Federal, State and Local laws or ordinances pertaining to the transportation, storage, use or disposal of such Hazardous Materials, including but not limited to obtaining proper permits. Landlord shall be entitled to take into account such other factors or facts as Landlord may reasonably determine to be relevant in determining whether to grant or withhold consent to Tenant’s proposed activity with respect to Hazardous Material. In no event, however, shall Landlord be required to consent to the installation or use of any storage tanks on the Property.

If Tenant’s transportation, storage, use or disposal of Hazardous Materials on the Premises results in the contamination of the soil or surface or ground water or loss or damage to person(s) or property, then Tenant agrees to: (a) notify Landlord immediately of any contamination, claim of contamination, loss or damage, (b) after consultation with the Landlord, clean up the contamination in full compliance with all applicable statutes, regulations and standards and (c) indemnify, defend and hold Landlord harmless from and against any claims, suits, causes of action, costs and fees, including attorney’s fees and costs, arising from or connected with any such contamination, claim of contamination, loss or damage. Tenant agrees to fully cooperate with Landlord and provide such documents, affidavits and information as may be requested by Landlord (i) to comply with any environmental law, (ii) to comply with the request of any lender, purchaser or tenant, and/or (iii) for any other reason deemed necessary by Landlord in its sole, but reasonable, discretion. Tenant shall notify Landlord promptly in the event of any spill or other release of any Hazardous Material at, in, on, under or about the Premises which is required to be reported to a governmental authority under any environmental law, will promptly forward to Landlord copies of any notices received by Tenant relating to alleged violations of any environmental law and will promptly pay when due any fine or assessment against Landlord (if related to a breach of this Section 9.03 by Tenant), Tenant or the Premises relating to any violation of an environmental law during the term of this Lease. If a lien is filed against the Premises by any governmental authority resulting from the need to expend or the actual expending of monies arising from an act or omission, whether intentional or unintentional, of Tenant, its agents, employees or invitees, or for which Tenant is responsible, resulting in the releasing, spilling, leaking, leaching, pumping, emitting, pouring, emptying or dumping of any Hazardous Material into the waters or onto land located within or without the State where the Premises is located, then Tenant shall, within thirty (30) days from the date that Tenant is first given notice that such lien has been placed against the Premises (or within such shorter period of time as may be specified by Landlord if such governmental authority has commenced steps to cause the Premises to be sold pursuant to such lien) either (i) pay the claim and remove the lien, or (ii) furnish a cash deposit, bond, or such other security with respect thereto as is satisfactory in all respects to Landlord and is sufficient to effect a complete discharge of such lien on the Premises. Landlord shall have the right, but not the obligation, without in any way limiting Landlord’s other rights and remedies under this Lease, to enter upon the Premises, or to take such other actions as it deems necessary or advisable, to investigate, clean up, remove or remediate any Hazardous Materials or contamination by Hazardous Materials present on, in, at, under or emanating from the Premises or the Property in violation of Tenant’s obligations under this Lease or under any laws regulating Hazardous Materials. Notwithstanding any other provision of this Lease. Landlord shall have the right, at its election, in its own name or as Tenant’s agent, to negotiate, defend, approve and appeal, at Tenant’s expense, any action taken or order issued by any governmental agency or authority with any governmental agency or authority against Tenant, Landlord or the

 

13


Premises or Property relating to any Hazardous Materials or under any related law or the occurrence of any event or existence of any condition that would cause a breach of any of the covenants Set forth in this Section 9.03. Prior to or promptly after the expiration or termination of this Lease, Landlord may require an environmental audit of the Premises by a qualified environmental consultant. Tenant shall pay the costs of such an environmental audit and shall, at it sole cost and expense, take all actions recommended in such audit to remediate any environmental conditions. The provisions of this Section 9.03 shall survive the expiration or earlier termination of this Lease.

Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in this Section 9.03, Landlord shall indemnify and hold Tenant harmless from and against claims, causes of action, costs and fees (including attorney’s fees and costs) arising out of the presence of Hazardous Materials on, in, at or under the Property and existing prior to the Lease Commencement Date.

9.04 Signs and Auctions. Tenant shall not place any signs on the Property without Landlord’s prior written consent. Tenant shall not conduct or permit any auctions or sheriffs sales at the Property.

9.05 Landlord’s Access. Subject to reasonable notice under the circumstances (other than in the case of an emergency), with Tenant always having the complete ability to keep its business activities and materials confidential, Landlord or its agents may enter the Premises at all reasonable times to show the Premises to potential buyers, investors or tenants or other parties; to do any other act or to inspect and conduct tests in order to monitor Tenant’s compliance with all applicable environmental laws and all laws governing the presence and use of Hazardous Material; or for any other purpose Landlord deems necessary. Landlord shall give Tenant prior notice (which may be oral) of such entry, except in the case of an emergency, in which event Landlord shall make reasonable efforts to notify Tenant. Landlord may place customary “For Sale” or “For Lease” signs on the Premises.

ARTICLE 10

CONDITION AND MAINTENANCE OF PREMISES

10.01 Existing Conditions. Subject in all events to Landlord’s successful completion of Landlord’s Work as set forth in the Work Letter attached hereto as Exhibit D, Tenant shall accept the Property and the Premises in the condition described in the Work Letter and the plans generated in accordance therewith, as of the Lease Commencement Date, subject to all recorded matters, laws, ordinances, and governmental regulations and orders. Except as provided herein, Tenant acknowledges that neither Landlord nor any agent of Landlord has made any representation as to the condition of the Property or the suitability of the Property for Tenant’s intended use. Tenant represents and warrants that Tenant has made its own inspection of and inquiry regarding the condition of the Property and is not relying on any representations of Landlord or any Broker with respect thereto. Tenant agrees to execute promptly a Commencement Letter and Acceptance of the Premises in the form set forth in Exhibit E to this Lease.

10.02 Exemption of Landlord from Liability. Tenant shall insure its personal property under an all risk full replacement cost property insurance policy as provided in Section 7.04. Landlord shall not be liable for any damage or injury to the person, business (or any loss of income therefrom), goods, wares, merchandise or other property of Tenant. Tenant’s employees, invitees, customers or any other person or about the Property, whether

 

14


such damage or injury is caused by or results from: (a) fire, steam, electricity, water, gas or rain; (b) the breakage, leakage, obstruction or other defects of pipes, sprinklers, wires, appliances, plumbing, air conditioning or lighting fixtures or any other cause; (c) conditions arising in or about Property, or from other sources or places; or (d) any act or omission of any other tenant of the Property. Tenant shall give Landlord prompt notice upon the occurrence of any accident or casualty at the Premises. Landlord shall not be liable for any such damage or injury even though the cause of or the means of repairing such damage or injury are not accessible to Tenant. The provisions of this Section 10.02 shall not, however, exempt Landlord from liability for Landlord’s gross negligence or willful misconduct.

10.03 Landlord’s Obligations. Subject to the provisions of Article Eleven (Damage or Destruction) and Article Twelve (Condemnation), and except for damage caused by any act or omission of Tenant, or Tenant’s employees, agents, contractors or invitees. Landlord shall keep the foundation, roof, building systems (other than the heating, ventilating and air conditioning system serving only the Premises), structural supports and exterior walls of the improvements on the Property in good order, condition and repair. However, Landlord shall not be obligated to maintain or repair windows, doors, plate glass (whether interior or exterior) or the interior surfaces of walls of the Premises. Tenant shall promptly (but in no event not less than five (5) days, except in the event of an emergency, when notice shall be given immediately) report in writing to Landlord any defective condition known to it which Landlord is required to repair. If further damage is caused as a result of Tenant’s failure to notify Landlord as set forth herein of any defective condition, then Tenant shall be responsible for the cost of the repair of such further damage. Tenant hereby waives the benefit of any present or future law which provides Tenant the right to repair the Premises or Property at Landlord’s expense or to terminate this Lease because of the condition of the Property or Premises.

10.04 Tenant’s Obligations.

(a) Repair and Maintenance. Tenant shall keep all portions of the Premises (including systems and equipment) and the heating, ventilating and air conditioning system in good order, condition and repair (including repainting and refinishing, as needed). If any portion of the Premises or any system or equipment in the Premises which Tenant shall be obligated to repair cannot be fully repaired or restored, Tenant shall, in Tenant’s and its service providers’ discretion, promptly replace or repair, as the case may be, such portion of the Premises or system or equipment. If applicable. Tenant shall maintain a preventive maintenance contract providing for the regular inspection and maintenance of the heating and air conditioning system by a heating and air conditioning contractor, such contract and such contractor to be approved by Landlord. Landlord shall have the right, upon written notice to Tenant, to undertake the responsibility for maintenance of the heating and air conditioning system at Tenant’s expense. Landlord shall, at Tenant’s expense, repair any damage to the portions of the Property Landlord shall be required to maintain caused by Tenant’s acts or omissions. In the event Tenant makes repairs or replacements to systems within the Premises, Tenant shall deliver written evidence, including detail of the work completed, of such repair or replacement to Landlord.

(b) Tenant’s Expense. Tenant shall fulfill all of Tenant’s obligations under this Section 10.04 at Tenant’s sole expense. If Tenant shall fail to maintain, repair or replace the Premises as required by this Section 10.04, Landlord may, upon ten (10) days’ prior notice to Tenant (except that no notice shall be required in the case of an emergency), enter the Premises and perform such maintenance or repair (including

 

15


replacement, as needed) on behalf of Tenant. In such case, Tenant shall reimburse Landlord for all costs reasonably incurred in performing such maintenance, repair or replacement immediately upon demand.

10.05 Alterations, Additions, and Improvements.

(a) Tenant’s Work. Tenant shall not make any installations, alterations, additions, or improvements in or to the Premises, except for non-structural interior alterations, additions or improvements which cost less than $25,000.00, without obtaining Landlord’s prior written consent, which will not be unreasonably withheld. Any such work so approved by Landlord shall be performed only in accordance with plans and specifications therefor approved by Landlord. Tenant shall procure at Tenant’s sole expense all necessary permits and licenses before undertaking any work on the Premises and shall perform all such work in a good and workmanlike manner employing materials of good quality and so as to conform with all applicable zoning, building, fire, health and other codes, regulations, ordinances and laws and with all applicable insurance requirements. If requested by Landlord, Tenant shall furnish to Landlord prior to commencement of any such work a bond or other security acceptable to Landlord assuring that any work by Tenant will be completed in accordance with the approved plans and specifications and that all subcontractors will be paid. Tenant shall employ for such work only contractors approved by Landlord (such approval not to be unreasonably withheld) and shall require all contractors employed by Tenant to carry worker’s compensation insurance in accordance with statutory requirements and commercial general liability insurance covering such contractors on or about the Premises with a combined single limit not less than $2,000,000 and shall submit certificates evidencing such coverage to Landlord prior to the commencement of such work. Tenant shall indemnify and hold harmless Landlord from all injury, loss, claims or damage to any person or property occasioned by or growing out of such work. Landlord may inspect the work of Tenant at reasonable times and given notice of observed defects. Upon completion of any such work, Tenant shall provide Landlord with “as built” plans, copies of all construction contracts and proof of payment for all labor and materials.

(b) No Liens. Tenant shall pay when due all claims for labor and material furnished to the Premises and shall at all times keep the Property free from liens for labor and materials. Tenant shall give Landlord at least twenty (20) days’ prior written notice of the commencement of any work on the Premises, regardless of whether Landlord’s consent to such work is required. Landlord may record and post notices of non-responsibility on the Premises.

10.06 Condition Upon Termination. Upon the expiration or termination of this Lease, Tenant shall surrender the Premises to Landlord broom clean and in the condition which Tenant shall have been required to maintain the Premises under this Lease. Tenant shall not be obligated to repair any damage which Landlord is required to repair under Article Eleven (Damage or Destruction). Except for improvements made prior to the Commencement Date, Landlord may require Tenant to remove any alterations, additions or improvements (whether or not made with Landlord’s consent) prior to the expiration of this Lease and to restore the Premises to their prior condition, all at Tenant’s expense. With respect to any alterations, additions or improvements which require Landlord’s approval, at the time of such approval, Landlord shall specify if Tenant shall not be required to remove the same, and such items shall become Landlord’s property and shall be surrendered to Landlord upon the expiration or earlier

 

16


termination of this Lease, except that Tenant may remove any of Tenant’s machinery or equipment which can be removed without damage to the Property. Tenant shall repair, at Tenant’s expense, any damage to the Property caused by the removal of any such machinery or equipment. In no event, however, shall Tenant remove any of the following materials or equipment (which shall be deemed Landlord’s property), without Landlord’s prior written consent; unless the same shall have been installed by Tenant at its expense: any power wiring or wiring panels; lighting or lighting fixtures; wall coverings; drapes, blinds or other window coverings; carpets or other floor coverings; heaters, air conditioners or any other heating or air conditioning equipment; fencing or security gates; or other similar building operating equipment.

ARTICLE 11

DAMAGE OR DESTRUCTION

11.01 Damage to Premises.

(a) If the Premises shall be destroyed or rendered untenantable, either wholly or in part, by fire or other casualty (“Casualty”), Tenant shall immediately notify Landlord in writing upon the occurrence of such Casualty. In the event of any Casualty, Landlord may elect either to (i) repair the damage caused by such casualty as soon as reasonably possible, in which case this Lease shall remain in full force and effect, or (ii) terminate this Lease as of the date the casualty occurred. Landlord shall notify Tenant within thirty (30) days after receipt of notice of the occurrence of the casualty whether Landlord elects to repair the damage or terminate this Lease. If Landlord shall elect to repair the damage, Tenant shall pay Landlord the portion of the “deductible amount” (if any) under Landlord’s insurance allocable to the damage to the Premises and, if the damage shall have been due to an act or omission of Tenant, or Tenant’s employees, agents, contractors or invitees, the difference between the actual cost of repair and any insurance proceeds received by Landlord.

(b) If the casualty to the Premises shall occur during the last six (6) months of the Lease Term and the damage shall be estimated by Landlord to require more than thirty (30) days to repair, either Landlord or Tenant may elect to terminate this Lease as of the date the casualty shall have occurred, regardless of the sufficiency of any insurance proceeds. The party electing to terminate this Lease shall give written notification to the other party of such election within ten (10) days after Tenant’s notice to Landlord of the occurrence of the casualty.

11.02 Temporary Reduction of Rent. If the Property shall be destroyed or damaged by casualty and Landlord shall determine to repair or restore the Property pursuant to the provisions of this Article Eleven, any Rent payable during the period of such damage, repair and/or restoration shall be reduced according to the degree, if any, to which Tenant’s use of the Premises shall be impaired. Except for such possible reduction in Base Rent, insurance premiums and Real Property Taxes, Tenant shall not be entitled to any compensation, reduction or reimbursement from Landlord as a result of any damage, destruction, repair, or restoration of the Property.

11.03 Waiver. Tenant waives the protection of any statute, code or judicial decision which shall grant a tenant the right to terminate a lease in the event of the damage or destruction of the leased property and the provisions of this Article Eleven shall govern the rights and obligations of Landlord and Tenant in the event of any damage or destruction of or to the Property.

 

17


ARTICLE 12

CONDEMNATION

12.01 Condemnation. If more than twenty percent (20%) of the floor area of the Premises or more than twenty-five percent (25%) of the parking on the Property shall be taken by eminent domain, either Landlord or Tenant may terminate this Lease as of the date the condemning authority takes title or possession, by delivering notice to the other within ten (10) days after receipt of written notice of such taking (or in the absence of such notice, within ten (10) days after the condemning authority shall take title or possession). If neither Landlord nor Tenant shall terminate this Lease, this Lease shall remain in effect as to the portion of the Premises not taken, except that the Base Rent shall be reduced in proportion to the reduction in the floor area of the Premises. If this Lease shall be terminated, any condemnation award or payment shall be distributed to the Landlord. Tenant shall have no claim against Landlord for the value of the unexpired lease term or otherwise. So long as it does not interfere with any claim made by Landlord against the condemning authority. Tenant shall be expressly permitted by the Landlord to make a claim to the condemning authority for moving expenses and the value of any leasehold fixtures or improvements paid for directly by Tenant.

ARTICLE 13

ASSIGNMENT AND SUBLETTING

13.01 Landlord’s Consent Required. No portion of the Premises or of Tenant’s interest in this Lease shall be acquired by any other person or entity, whether by sale, assignment, mortgage, sublease, transfer, operation of law, or act of Tenant, without Landlord’s prior written consent, which consent shall be provided to Landlord at least thirty (30) days in advance. Landlord shall have the right to grant or withhold its consent as provided in Section 13.04 below. Any attempted transfer without consent shall be void and shall constitute a non-curable breach of this Lease.13.02 No Release of Tenant. No assignment or transfer, including any transfer under Section 13.05 hereof, shall release Tenant or change Tenant’s primary liability to pay the Rent and to perform all other obligations of Tenant under this Lease. Landlord’s acceptance of Rent from any other person shall not be a waiver of any provision of this Article Thirteen. Consent to one transfer shall not be deemed a consent to any subsequent transfer or a waiver of the obligation to obtain consent on subsequent occasions. If Tenant’s assignee or transferee shall default under this Lease, Landlord may proceed directly against Tenant without pursuing remedies against the assignee or transferee. Landlord may consent to subsequent assignments or modifications of this Lease by Tenant’s transferee without notifying Tenant or obtaining its consent, and such action shall not release Tenant from any of its obligations or liabilities under this Lease as so assigned or modified.

13.02 No Release of Tenant. No assignment or transfer, including any transfer under Section 13.05 hereof, shall release Tenant or change Tenant’s primary liability to pay the Rent and to perform all other obligations of Tenant under this Lease. Landlord’s acceptance of Rent from any other person shall not be a waiver of any provision of this Article Thirteen. Consent to one transfer shall not be deemed a consent to any subsequent transfer or a waiver of the obligation to obtain consent on subsequent occasions. If Tenant’s assignee or transferee shall default under this Lease, Landlord may proceed directly against Tenant without pursuing remedies againstthe assignee or transferee. Landlord may consent to subsequent assignments or modifications of this Lease by Tenant’s transferee without notifying Tenant or obtaining its consent, and such action shall not release Tenant from any of its obligations or liabilities under this Lease as so assigned or modified.

13.03 Offer to Terminate. Except as provided in Section 13.05 below, Tenant shall desire to assign this Lease or sublease all or any part of the Premises, Tenant shall offer to Landlord in writing, the right to terminate this Lease as of the date specified in the offer. If Landlord shall elect in writing to accept the offer to terminate within twenty (20) days after receipt of notice of the offer, this Lease shall terminate as of the date specified in such offer

 

18


and all the terms and provisions of this Lease governing termination shall apply. If Landlord shall not so elect, Tenant shall then comply with the provisions of this Article Thirteen applicable to such assignment of sublease.

13.04 Landlord’s Consent. Tenant’s request for consent under Section 13.01 shall set forth the details of the proposed sublease, assignment or transfer, including the name, business and financial condition of the prospective transferee, financial details of the proposed transaction (e.g., the term of and the rent and security deposit payable under any proposed assignment or sublease), and any other information Landlord deems relevant. Landlord shall have the right to withhold consent, reasonably exercised, or to grant consent, based on the following factors: (i) the business of the proposed assignee or subtenant and the proposed use of the Premises; (ii) the net worth and financial condition of the proposed assignee or subtenant; (iii) Tenant’s compliance with all of its obligations under this Lease; and (iv) such other factors as Landlord may reasonably deem relevant. So long as Section 13.05 does not apply, if Tenant shall assign or sublease, the following shall apply: Tenant shall pay to Landlord as Additional Rent fifty percent (50%) of the Proceeds (defined below) on such transaction (such amount being Landlord’s share) as and when received by Tenant, unless Landlord shall give notice to Tenant and the assignee or subtenant that Landlord’s Share shall be paid by the assignee or subtenant to Landlord directly. Proceeds shall mean (a) all rent and all fees and other consideration paid for or in respect of the assignment or sublease, including reasonable fees under any collateral agreements less (b) the rent and other sums payable under this Lease (in the case of a sublease of less than all of the Premises, allocable to the subleased premises) and all costs and expenses directly incurred by Tenant in connection with the execution and performance of such assignment or sublease for reasonable real estate broker’s commissions and reasonable costs of renovation or construction of tenant improvements required under such assignment or sublease. Tenant shall be entitled to recover such reasonable costs and expenses before Tenant shall be obligated to pay Landlord’s Share to Landlord. Tenant shall provide Landlord a written statement certifying all amounts to be paid from any assignment or sublease of the Premises within thirty (30) days after the transaction shall be signed and from time to time thereafter on Landlord’s request, and Landlord may inspect Tenant’s books and records to verify the accuracy of such statement. On written request, Tenant shall promptly furnish to Landlord copies of all the transaction documentation, all of which shall be certified by Tenant to be complete, true and correct. Tenant shall promptly reimburse Landlord for all legal costs and expenses incurred by Landlord in connection with a request for a sublease or assignment of this Lease.

13.05 Assignment/Sublease to Affiliates. Notwithstanding anything in this Article 13 to the contrary, Tenant may assign this Lease or sublet all or any portion of the Premises without the prior written consent of Landlord to Tenant’s Affiliate (as hereinafter defined) provided that: (a) Tenant is not at such time, and such Affiliate on the effective date of such assignment or sublease will not be, in monetary or material non-monetary default hereunder; (b) such Affiliate shall execute an instrument in writing assuming by assignment the terms of this Lease or acknowledging that such sublease is subject and subordinate to all of the terms and conditions of this Lease; and (c) all documents and information required hereunder shall be delivered by Tenant to Landlord at least thirty (30) days prior to the effective date of such assignment or sublease, and (d) in the case of an assignment, such Affiliate has a Net Worth at least equal to or greater $10,000,000.00. For purposes of this Article 13, the term “Affiliate” shall mean (i) any corporation or other entity succeeding to Tenant’s business or a substantial part thereof whether by merger, consolidation or acquisition of the stock or assets of Tenant or otherwise, or (ii) any entity which controls, is controlled by, or is under common

 

19


control with, the original named Tenant under this Lease. For purposes of this Article 13, the term “Net Worth” with respect to any entity shall mean the value of its assets plus equity, less liabilities, with the book carrying value of any preferred stock included as part of equity.

ARTICLE 14

DEFAULTS AND REMEDIES

14.01 Covenants and Conditions. Tenant’s performance of each of Tenant’s obligations under this Lease is a condition as well as a covenant. Tenant’s right to continue in possession of the Premises is conditioned upon such performance. Time is of the essence in the performance by Tenant of all covenants and conditions.

14.02 Defaults. Each of the following shall be an “Event of Default” under this Lease:

(a) Tenant shall abandon the Premises: provided, however, cessation of business activities shall not constitute a default so long as Tenant abides by its other obligations herein;

(b) Tenant shall fail to pay Rent or any other sum payable under this Lease within five (5) days after it is due;

(c) Tenant shall fail to perform any of Tenant’s other obligations under this Lease and such failure shall continue for a period of thirty (30) days after notice from Landlord; provided that if more than thirty (30) days shall be required to complete such performance, Tenant shall not be in default if Tenant shall commence such performance within the thirty (30) day period and shall thereafter diligently pursue its completion.

(d) (i) Tenant shall make a general assignment or general arrangement for the benefit of creditors; (ii) a petition for adjudication of bankruptcy or for reorganization or rearrangement shall be filed by or against Tenant and shall not be dismissed within sixty (60) days; (iii) a trustee or receiver shall be appointed to take possession of substantially all of Tenant’s assets located at the Premises or Tenant’s interest in this Lease and possession shall be subjected to attachment, execution or other judicial seizure which shall not be discharged within sixty (60) days. If a court of competent jurisdiction shall determine that any of the acts described in this Subsection (d) is not a default under this Lease, and a trustee shall be appointed to take possession (or if Tenant shall remain a debtor in possession) and such trustee or Tenant shall assign, sublease, or transfer Tenant’s interest hereunder, then Landlord shall receive, as Additional Rent, the excess, if any, of the rent (or any other consideration) paid in connection with such assignment, transfer or sublease over the rent payable by Tenant under this Lease.

14.03 Remedies. On the occurrence of an Event of Default by Tenant, Landlord may, at any time thereafter, with or without notice or demand (except as provided in Section 14.02) and without limiting Landlord in the exercise of any right or remedy which Landlord may have:

Terminate this Lease by written notice to Tenant or by entry, at Landlord’s option. Tenant shall then immediately quit and surrender the Premises to Landlord, but Tenant shall remain liable as hereinafter provided. Following termination, without prejudice to other remedies Landlord may have by reason of Tenant’s default or of such

 

20


termination, Landlord may (i) peaceably reenter the Premises upon voluntary surrender by Tenant or remove Tenant therefrom and any other persons occupying the Premises, using such legal proceedings as may be available; (ii) repossess the Premises or relet the Premises or any part thereof for such term (which may be for a term extending beyond the Lease Term), at such rental and upon such other terms and conditions as Landlord in Landlord’s sole discretion shall determine, with the right to make alterations and repairs to the Premises; and (iii) remove all personal property therefrom. Following termination, Landlord shall have all the rights and remedies of a landlord provided at law and in equity. The amount of damages Tenant shall pay to Landlord following termination shall include all Rent unpaid up to the termination of this Lease, costs and expenses incurred by Landlord due to such Event of Default and, in addition, Tenant shall pay to Landlord as damages, at the election of Landlord (if Landlord shall elect subsection (y) below, it may cease such election at any time), either (x) the discounted present value (at the then one year Treasury Bill rate) of the aggregate Rent and other charges due during the period commencing with such termination and ending on the expiration date of this Lease, or (y) amounts equal to the Rent and other charges payable by Tenant as they accrue on the due dates therefor specified herein following such termination and until the expiration date of this Lease, provided, however, that if Landlord shall re-let the Premises during such period, Landlord shall credit Tenant with the net rents received by Landlord from such reletting, such net rents to be determined by first deducting from the gross rents as and when received by Landlord from such re-letting the expenses incurred or paid by Landlord in terminating this Lease, and the expenses of re-letting, including, without limitation, altering and preparing the Premises for new tenants, brokers’ commissions, legal fees and all other similar and dissimilar expenses properly chargeable against the Premises and the rental therefrom, it being understood that any such re-letting may be for a period equal to or shorter or longer than the remaining Lease Term; and provided, further, that (i) in the no event shall Tenant be entitled to receive any excess of such net rents over the sums payable by Tenant to Landlord hereunder and (ii) in no event shall Tenant be entitled in any suit for the collection of damages pursuant to this subsection (y) to a credit in respect of any net rents from a re-letting except to the extent that such net rents are actually received by Landlord prior to the commencement of such suit. If the Premises or any part thereof should be re-let in combination with other space, then proper apportionment on a square foot area basis shall be made of the rent received from such re-letting and of the expenses of re-letting. In calculating the Rent and other charges under subsection (x) above, there shall be included, in addition to the Rent other considerations agreed to be paid or performed by Tenant, on the assumption that all such considerations would have remained constant (except as herein otherwise provided) for the balance of the full Lease Term hereby granted. Landlord may, but need not, re-let the Premises or any part thereof for such rent and on such terms as it shall determine (including the right to re-let the Premises for a greater or lesser term than the Lease Term, the right to re-let the Premises as part of a larger area and the right to change the character or use made of the Premises). Suit or suits for the recovery of such damages, or any installments thereof, may be brought by Landlord from time to time at its election, and nothing contained herein shall be deemed to require Landlord to postpone suit until the date when the Lease Term would have expired if it had not been terminated hereunder. In lieu of any other damages or indemnity and in lieu of full recovery by Landlord of all sums payable under the foregoing provisions of this Section 14.03(a), Landlord may, by notice to Tenant, at any time after this Lease shall be terminated under this Article Fourteen or shall be otherwise terminated for an Event of Default and before such full

 

21


recovery, elect to recover, and Tenant shall thereupon pay, as liquidated damages, an amount equal to the aggregate of the Base Rent and Additional Rent due for the twelve (12) months ended immediately prior to such termination plus the amount of Base Rent and Additional Rent of any kind accrued and unpaid at the time of termination.

(a) Maintain Tenant’s right to possession, in which case this Lease shall continue in effect whether or not Tenant has abandoned the Premises. In such event, Landlord shall be entitled to enforce all of Landlord’s rights and remedies under this Lease, including the right to recover the rent as it becomes due.

(b) Pursue any other remedy now or hereafter available to Landlord under the laws or judicial decisions of the state in which the Property is located.

14.04 Automatic Termination, Damages. Notwithstanding any other term or provision hereof to the contrary, this Lease shall terminate on the occurrence of any act which affirms the Landlord’s intention to terminate this Lease as provided in Section 14.03 hereof, including the filing of an unlawful detainer action against Tenant. On any termination. Landlord’s damages for default shall include all costs and fees, including reasonable attorneys’ fees that Landlord shall incur in connection with the filing, commencement, pursuing and/or defending of any action in any bankruptcy court or other court with respect to this Lease, the obtaining of relief from any stay in bankruptcy restraining any action to evict Tenant, or the pursuing of any action with respect to Landlord’s right to possession of the Premises. All such damages suffered (apart from Base Rent and other Rent payable hereunder) shall constitute pecuniary damages which shall be reimbursed to Landlord prior to assumption of this Lease by Tenant or any successor to Tenant in any bankruptcy or other proceedings.

14.05 Cumulative Remedies. Except as otherwise expressly provided herein, any and all rights and remedies which Landlord may have under this Lease and at law and equity shall be cumulative and shall not be deemed inconsistent with each other, and any two or more of all such rights and remedies may be exercised at the same time to the greatest extent permitted by law.

ARTICLE 15

PROTECTION OF LENDERS

15.01 Subordination. At Landlord’s election, this Lease shall be automatically subordinate to any ground lease, deed of trust or mortgage encumbering the Property, any advances made on the security thereof and any renewals, modifications, consolidations, replacements or extensions thereof, whenever made or recorded. Tenant shall cooperate with Landlord and any lender which shall acquire a security interest in the Property or this Lease. Tenant shall execute such further documents and assurances as such lender may reasonably require, provided that Tenant’s obligations under this Lease shall not be increased in any material way (the performance of ministerial acts shall not be deemed material), and Tenant shall not be deprived of its rights under this Lease. If any ground lessor, beneficiary or mortgagee elects to have this Lease prior to the lien of its ground lease, deed of trust or mortgage and gives written notice thereof to Tenant, this Lease shall be deemed prior to such ground lease, deed of trust or mortgage whether this Lease is dated prior or subsequent to the date of said ground lease, deed of trust or mortgage or the date of recording thereof.

 

22


15.02 Attornment. If Landlord’s interest in the Property is acquired by any ground lessor, beneficiary under a deed of trust, mortgagee, or purchaser at a foreclosure sale, Tenant shall attorn to the transferee of or successor to Landlord’s interest in the Property and recognize such transferee or successor as Landlord under this Lease. Tenant waives the protection of any statute or rule of law which shall give Tenant any right to terminate this Lease or surrender possession of the Premises upon the transfer of Landlord’s interest.

15.03 Signing of Documents. Within forty-five (45) days of the execution of this Lease, Landlord shall provide to Tenant a commercially reasonable form, acceptable to Landlord’s lender, of subordination, non-disturbance and attornment agreement for Tenant’s review and execution. Further, each party to this Lease shall sign and deliver any additional instrument or documents necessary or appropriate to evidence the foregoing.

15.04 Estoppel Certificates. Within ten (10) days after Landlord’s request, Tenant shall execute, acknowledge and deliver to Landlord a written statement certifying: (i) that none of the terms or provisions of this Lease have been changed (or if they have been changed, stating how they have been changed); (ii) that this Lease has not been canceled or terminated; (iii) the last date of payment of the Base Rent and other charges and the time period covered by such payment; (iv) that Landlord is not in default under this Lease (or if Landlord is claimed to be in default, setting forth such default in reasonable detail); and (v) such other information with respect to Tenant or this Lease as Landlord may reasonably request or which any prospective purchaser or encumbrancer of the Property may reasonably require. Landlord may deliver any such statement by Tenant to any prospective purchaser or encumbrancer of the Property, and such purchaser or encumbrancer may rely conclusively upon such statement as true and correct. If Tenant shall not deliver such statement to Landlord within such ten (10) day period, Landlord, and any prospective purchaser or encumbrancer, may conclusively presume and rely upon the following statements as facts: (i) that the terms and provisions of this Lease have not been changed except as otherwise represented by Landlord, (ii) that this Lease has not been canceled or terminated except as otherwise represented by Landlord; (iii) that not more than one month’s Base Rent or other charges have been paid in advance; and (iv) that Landlord is not in default under this Lease. In such event, Tenant shall be estopped from denying the truth of such statements.

15.05 Tenant’s Financial Condition. Within ten (10) days after request from Landlord from time to time, Tenant shall deliver to Landlord Tenant’s audited financial statements for the latest available two (2) fiscal years as may then be in Tenant’s possession. Such financial statements may be delivered to Landlord’s mortgagees and lenders and prospective mortgagees, lenders and purchasers. Tenant represents and warrants to Landlord that each such financial statement shall be materially true and accurate as of the date of such statement. All financial statements shall be confidential and shall be used only for the purposes set forth in this Lease.

ARTICLE 16

LEGAL COSTS

16.01 Legal Proceedings. In any enforcement proceeding brought by either party with respect to this Lease, the non-prevailing party will pay to the prevailing party in such proceeding all costs, including reasonable attorneys’ fees and court costs incurred by such other party with respect to such proceeding and any appeals therefrom.

 

23


ARTICLE 17

MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS

17.01 Signage. Tenant shall be permitted to have (i) a sign panel on the pylon sign located in front of the Building, and (ii) standard signage identifying Tenant at the primary entry of the Premises and at the point designated for Tenant’s shipping and receiving activities. All signage installed by Tenant shall be subject to the prior written approval of Landlord and any approvals required by Central Florida Research Park. Further, Tenant shall be responsible for all costs and expenses with respect to its signage, including, installation and maintenance costs.

17.02 Non-Discrimination. Tenant agrees that it will not permit any discrimination against, or segregation of, any person or group of persons on the basis of race, color, sex, creed, national origin or ancestry in the subleasing, transferring, occupancy, tenure or use of the Premises or any portion thereof. Landlord agrees that it will not permit any discrimination against, or segregation of, any person or group of persons on the basis of race, color, sex, creed, national origin or ancestry in the leasing and management of the Premises or any portion thereof.

17.03 Landlord’s Liability; Certain Duties.

(a) Bind and Inure; Limitation of Landlord’s Liability. The obligations of this Lease shall run with the land, and this Lease shall be binding upon and inure to the benefit of the parties hereto and their respective successors and assigns. No owner of the Property shall be liable under this Lease except for breaches of Landlord’s obligations occurring while owner of the Property. The obligations of Landlord shall be binding upon the assets of Landlord which comprise the Property but not upon other assets of Landlord. No individual partner, trustee, stockholder, officer, member, director, employee, advisors or beneficiary of Landlord or any partner, trustee, stockholder, officer, member, director, employee, advisor or beneficiary of any of the foregoing, shall be personally liable under this Lease and Tenant shall look solely to Landlord’s interest in the Property in pursuit of its remedies upon an event of default hereunder, and the general assets of Landlord, its partners, trustees, stockholders, members, officers, employees, advisors or beneficiaries of Landlord, and the partners, trustees, stockholders, members, officers, employees, advisors or beneficiary of any of the foregoing, shall not be subject to levy, execution or other enforcement procedure for the satisfaction of the remedies of Tenant.

(b) Notice. Tenant shall give written notice of any failure by Landlord to perform any of its obligations under this Lease to Landlord and to any ground lessor, mortgagee or beneficiary under any deed of trust encumbering the Property whose name and address shall have been furnished to Tenant. Landlord shall not be in default under this Lease unless Landlord (or such ground lessor, mortgagee or beneficiary) shall fail to cure such non-performanee within thirty (30) days after receipt of Tenant’s notice. However, if such non-performance shall reasonably require more than thirty (30) days to cure, Landlord shall not be in default if such cure shall be commenced within such thirty (30) day period and thereafter diligently pursued to completion.

 

24


17.04 Severability. A determination by a court of competent jurisdiction that any provision of this Lease or any part thereof is illegal or unenforceable shall not cancel or invalidate the remainder of such provision of this Lease, which shall remain in full force and effect.

17.05 Interpretation. The captions of the Articles or Sections of this Lease are not a part of the terms or provisions of this Lease. Whenever required by the context of this Lease, the singular shall include the plural and the plural shall include the singular. The masculine, feminine and neuter genders shall each include the other, in any provision relating to the conduct, acts or omissions of Tenant, the term “Tenant” shall include Tenant’s agents, employees, contractors, invitees, successors or others using the Premises with Tenant’s expressed or implied permission. This Lease shall not, and nothing contained herein, shall create a partnership or other joint venture between Landlord and Tenant.

17.06 Incorporation of Prior Agreements; Modifications. This Lease is the only agreement between the parties pertaining to the lease of the Premises and no other agreements shall be effective. All amendments to this Lease shall be in writing and signed by all parties. Any other attempted amendment shall be void.17.07 Notices. All notices, requests and other communications required or permitted under this Lease shall be in writing and shall be personally delivered or sent by certified mail, return receipt requested, postage prepaid or by a national overnight delivery service which maintains delivery records. Notices to Tenant shall be delivered to Tenant’s Address for Notices. Notices to Landlord shall be delivered to Landlord’s Address for Notices. All notices shall be effective upon delivery (or refusal to accept delivery). Either party may change its notice address upon written notice to the other party.

17.08 Waivers. All waivers shall be in writing and signed by the waiving party. Landlord’s failure to enforce any provision of this Lease or its acceptance of Rent shall not be a waiver and shall not prevent Landlord from enforcing that provision or any other provision of this Lease in the future. No statement on a payment check from Tenant or in a letter accompanying a payment check shall be binding on Landlord. Landlord may, with or without notice to Tenant, negotiate such check without being bound by or to the conditions of such statement.

17.09 No Recordation. Tenant shall not record this Lease. Either Landlord or Tenant may require that a notice, short form or memorandum of this Lease executed by both parties be recorded. The party requiring such recording shall pay all transfer taxes and recording fees.

17.10 Binding Effect; Choice of Law. This Lease shall bind any party who shall legally acquire any rights or interest in this Lease from Landlord or Tenant, provided that Landlord shall have no obligation to Tenant’s successor unless the rights or interests of Tenant’s successor are acquired in accordance with the terms of this Lease. The laws of the state in which the Property is located shall govern this Lease.

17.11 Corporate Authority; Partnership Authority. If Tenant is a corporation, each person signing this Lease on behalf of Tenant represents and warrants that (s)he has full authority to do so and that this Lease binds the corporation. Within thirty (30) days after this Lease is signed, Tenant shall deliver to Landlord a certified copy of a resolution of Tenant’s Board of Directors authorizing the execution of this Lease or other evidence of such authority reasonably acceptable to Landlord. If Tenant is a partnership or limited liability company, each

 

25


person or entity signing this Lease for Tenant represents and warrants that he or it is a general partner of the partnership or a manager or managing member of the company, that (s)he or it has full authority to sign for the partnership and that this Lease binds the partnership or company and all general partners of the partnership or the company and its members. Within thirty (30) days after this Lease is signed, Tenant shall deliver to Landlord a copy of Tenant’s recorded statement of partnership or certificate of limited partnership or certificate of formation or organization.

17.12 Intentionally omitted.

17.13 Force Majeure. Other than payment of Rent, if either Landlord or Tenant cannot perform any of its obligations due to events beyond their respective reasonable control, the time provided for performing such obligations shall be extended by a period of time equal to the duration of such events. Events beyond reasonable control include, but are not limited to, acts of God, war, civil commotion, labor disputes, strikes, fire, flood or other casualty, shortages of labor or material, government regulation or restriction and weather conditions.

17.14 Execution of Lease. This Lease may be executed in counterparts and, when all counterpart documents are executed, the counterparts shall constitute a single binding instrument. Landlord’s delivery of this Lease to Tenant shall not be deemed to be an offer to lease and shall not be binding upon either party until executed and delivered by both parties.

17.15 Survival. All representations and warranties of Landlord and Tenant, and all obligations of Tenant to pay Additional Rent hereunder, shall survive the termination of this Lease.

17.16 Examination of Lease. Submission of this Lease to Tenant shall not constitute an option to lease, and this Lease shall not be effective until execution and delivery by both Landlord and Tenant.

17.17 Security Deposit. Upon execution of this Lease by Tenant, Tenant shall pay to Landlord a Security Deposit in the amount set forth in Section 1.13, hereinabove, to be held by Landlord for the faithful performance by Tenant of Tenant’s covenants and obligations hereunder, it being expressly understood that the Security Deposit shall not be considered as an advance payment of Rent or as a measure of Landlord’s damages in the event of a default by Tenant. If at any time during the Lease Term hereof, or the Lease Term as it may be extended, an Event of Default shall have occurred in connection with payment of Rent or any other sum due Landlord as Additional Rent, Landlord may, but shall not be obligated to, apply all or part of the Security Deposit for such payment. Landlord may also apply all or part of the Security Deposit to repair damages to the Premises during or upon the termination of the tenancy created by this Lease. In such event, Tenant shall, on demand, pay to Landlord a like sum to replenish the Security Deposit. If Tenant is not in default at the termination of this Lease, then Landlord shall promptly return the Security Deposit to Tenant. Landlord shall not be required to keep the Security Deposit separate from its general funds, and Tenant shall not be entitled to interest on the Security Deposit. Landlord and Tenant agree that Landlord shall be entitled to immediately endorse and cash Tenant’s Rent and Security Deposit check(s) accompanying this Lease. It is further agreed and understood that such action shall not guarantee acceptance of this Lease by Landlord, but in the event Landlord does not accept this Lease, Tenant’s Rent and Security Deposit checks so delivered shall be refunded in full to Tenant. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Security Deposit shall reduce as follows: (i) if Tenant has not been in default at any time under this Lease, on the thirty-sixth (36th) month of

 

26


the Lease Term the Security Deposit shall reduce to two (2) month’s Base Rent to be held for the remainder of the Lease Term; (ii) if Tenant shall receive a funding infusion equal to or greater than Thirty Million and 00/100 Dollars ($30,000,000.00) (subject to the review of documentation evidencing same by Landlord) (“Tenant Funding”) and Tenant has not been in default at any time under this Lease, within forty-five (45) days following Landlord’s approval of such documentation the Security Deposit shall reduce to two (2) month’s Base Rent to be held for the remainder of the Lease Term; or (iii) in the event Tenant has received the Tenant Funding, Landlord has approved same and Tenant has not been in default at any time under this Lease, on the thirty-sixth (36th) month of the Lease Term the Security Deposit shall reduce to one (1) month’s Base Rent to be held for the remainder of the Lease Term.

17.18 Limitation of Warranties. Landlord and Tenant expressly agree that there are and shall be no implied warranties of merchantability, habitability, suitability, fitness for a particular purpose or of any other kind arising out of this Lease, and there are no warranties which extend beyond those expressly set forth in this Lease. Without limiting the generality of the foregoing, Tenant expressly acknowledges that Landlord has made no warranties or representations concerning any hazardous materials or other environmental matters affecting any part of the Property and Landlord hereby expressly disclaims and Tenant waives any express or implied warranties with respect to any such matters.

17.19 No Other Brokers. Tenant represents and warrants to Landlord that the Brokers are the only agents, brokers, finders or other parties with whom Tenant has dealt who may be entitled to any commission or fee with respect to this Lease or the Premises or the Property. Tenant agrees to indemnify and hold Landlord harmless from any claim, demand, cost or liability, including, without limitation, attorneys’ fees and expenses, asserted by any party other than the Brokers based upon dealings of that party with Tenant. Landlord agrees to indemnify and hold Tenant harmless from any claim, demand, cost or liability, including, without limitation, attorneys’ fees and expenses, asserted by any party other than the Brokers based upon dealings of that party with Landlord.

17.20 Radon Gas. Radon is a naturally occurring radioactive gas that, when it has accumulated in a building in sufficient quantities, may present health risks to persons who are exposed to it over time. Levels of radon that exceed Federal and State guidelines have been found in buildings in Florida. Additional information regarding radon and radon testing may be obtained from your county public health unit.

17.21 Central Florida Research Park. Tenant hereby acknowledges that (i) the Building is located in the Central Florida Research Park (the “Research Park”) and (ii) this Lease is subject to the deed restrictions (the “Deed Restrictions”) affecting the Research Park. Tenant hereby agrees to (a) obtain any necessary approvals required by the Research Park in connection with Tenant’s business in the Premises, (b) complete, execute and deliver any applicable forms or documents requested or required by the Research Park to comply with the Deed Restrictions and (c) comply with any and all rules and regulations established or modified from time to time by the Research Park.

ARTICLE 18

RENEWAL OPTION

Landlord hereby grants to Tenant the option to extend the initial Lease Term on the same terms, conditions and provisions as contained in this Lease, except as otherwise provided herein, for one (1) period of five (5) years, the option (the “Option Period”) commencing on the day following the expiration date of this Lease.

 

27


(a) Tenant’s option to extend shall be exercisable by written notice from Tenant to Landlord given no earlier than twelve (12) months, and no later than nine (9) months, prior to the expiration of the initial Lease Term, time being of the essence.

(b) Base Rent per square foot of Rentable Area of the Premises payable during the Option Period shall be at the Fair Market Rental Rate (as hereinafter defined).

(c) Tenant may only exercise its option to extend, and an exercise thereof shall only be effective, if at the time of Tenant’s exercise and on the Option Period commencement date, this Lease is in full force and effect and no uncured default has occurred under this Lease. In addition to the condition set forth in the first sentence of this subparagraph (c), if Tenant is in default under this Lease within thirty (30) days prior to the Option Period commencement date, and has not cured or is not in the process of diligently curing such default prior to said commencement date, then, at Landlord’s option, Tenant’s right to exercise its option may be terminated and rendered null and void by notice thereof from Landlord to Tenant. No sublessee or assignee (other than an Affiliate) shall be entitled to exercise such option.

(d) Upon the valid exercise by Tenant of its option to extend. Landlord and Tenant shall enter into a written amendment to this Lease confirming the terms, conditions and provisions applicable to the Option Period as determined in accordance with the provisions of this Section, with such revisions to the Base Rent provisions of this Lease as may be necessary to conform those provisions to the rental rate applicable to the Option Period. No new options to extend shall be deemed to be created by a valid exercise of the extension option and no other provisions inapplicable to the Option Period such as, but not limited to, an obligation to construct or pay for construction or improvements or to grant rent abatements, shall be construed to govern the Option Period.

(e) For purposes of this Article 18, the term “Fair Market Rental Rate” shall mean a rate comprised of (i) the prevailing base rental rate per square foot of rentable area available in the Pertinent Market (as defined below), and taking into account tenant improvement allowances, other tenant inducements, operating cost stops and tax cost stops, and brokerage commissions, all as determined by Landlord in good faith, and (ii) any escalation of any such base rental rate (based upon a fixed step and/or index) prevailing in the Pertinent Market, as determined by Landlord in good faith, taking into account (A) comparable leases (on the basis of factors such as, but not limited to, size and location of space and commencement date and term of lease), if any, recently executed for improved space in the Building, and (B) leases for comparable (on the basis of factors such as, but not limited to size and location of space and commencement date and term of lease) improved space in “flex” buildings in the Orlando, Florida, area which are comparable to the Building in reputation, quality, age, size, location and level and quality of services provided and which have reached economic stabilization and are not, for any other reason, offering below market rents (the foregoing factors not being exclusive in identifying comparable buildings) (the Building, together with such comparable buildings, if applicable, being herein referred to as the “Pertinent Market”).

 

28


(f) Landlord shall provide Tenant with its calculation of the Fair Market Rental Value no more than 60 days after Tenant delivers its notice of exercise to Landlord. Tenant shall have a period of 30 days to accept Landlord’s calculation or deliver notice to Landlord rescinding the notice of exercise.

ARTICLE 19

RIGHT OF FIRST REFUSAL

During the Lease Term, Tenant shall have a right of first refusal (each a “Right of First Refusal”) to lease rentable area located adjacent to the Premises as portions of it become available from time to time (each such portion being referred to herein as an “Additional Space”), on the same terms and conditions that Landlord is prepared to accept from any third party. When Landlord receives an offer to lease the Additional Space from a third party which Landlord desires to accept, Landlord shall present the same, in writing, to Tenant, and Tenant shall thereafter have ten (10) days in which to accept or reject that offer by notice to Landlord. The Right of First Refusal shall apply only with respect to the entire Additional Space subject of the third party offer, and may not be exercised with respect to only a portion thereof. If Tenant rejects that offer or fails to accept the same in writing within such time period, then Landlord shall be free to lease the Additional Space to the third party on substantially similar terms and conditions to those offered to Tenant in the foregoing manner.

Each Right of First Refusal shall, at Landlord’s election, be null and void if Tenant is in default under the Lease at the date Landlord would otherwise notify Tenant of the offer concerning the Additional Space or at any time thereafter and before commencement of the Lease for the Additional Space. After Tenant validly exercises a Right of First Refusal provided in this Lease, the parties shall execute an amendment to the Lease adding the Additional Space, or a new lease for the Additional Space, or such other documentation as Landlord shall require, promptly after Landlord shall prepare the same, confirm the leasing of such Additional Space to Tenant, but an otherwise valid exercise of the Right of First Refusal contained in this Lease shall be fully effective, whether or not such confirmatory documentation is executed. If the term of an Additional Space lease extends (including by an option timely exercised) beyond the Lease Term, then, (i) the Lease Term shall be extended to coincide with the term of the Additional Space Lease and (ii) Base Rent for the Premises from and after expiration of the Lease Term shall be the higher of the Base Rent per square foot during the last calendar month of the Lease Term or the Base Rent per square foot of the Additional Space for the corresponding time period.

If Tenant shall exercise a Right of First Refusal granted in this Lease. Landlord does not guarantee that the Additional Space will be available on the commencement date for the Lease thereof if the then existing occupants of the Additional Space shall holdover, or for any other reason beyond Landlord’s reasonable control. In that event, Tenant’s sole recourse shall be that the Base Rent with respect to the Additional Space shall be abated until Landlord legally delivers the same to Tenant. Tenant’s exercise of that Right of First Refusal shall not operate to cure any default by Tenant of any of the terms or provisions in this Lease, nor to extinguish or impair any rights or remedies of Landlord arising by virtue of such default. Each and all Rights of First Refusal are personal to Tenant and may not be exercised or enjoyed by any other person. If the Lease or Tenant’s right to possession of the Premises shall terminate in any manner whatsoever before Tenant shall exercise a Right of First Refusal, or if Tenant shall have subleased or assigned its interest in Tenant or its right to possess all or any portion of the Premises, then immediately upon such termination, sublease or assignment, the Right of First

 

29


Refusal shall simultaneously terminate and become null and void. Under no circumstances whatsoever shall a subtenant under a sublease of the Premises, or the assignee under a full or a partial assignment of the Lease, have any right to exercise a Right of First Refusal granted in this Lease.

ARTICLE 20

OPTION TO TERMINATE

Provided that Tenant is not then in default under this Lease, Tenant shall have an ongoing option to terminate this Lease (the “Termination Option”). The effective date of this termination shall be the date that is specified in the Termination Notice (defined below) (the “Early Termination Date”). Tenant shall exercise the Termination Option by (i) delivering to Landlord no less than ninety (90) days’ prior written notice (the “Termination Notice”) of such election to terminate this Lease and (ii) paying to Landlord the Termination Payment (as hereinafter defined) concurrently with the Termination Notice. If Tenant properly delivers the Termination Notice and makes the Termination Payment in a timely manner, then this Lease shall be deemed to have expired by lapse of time on the Early Termination Date. Tenant shall return the Premises to Landlord on the Early Termination Date in accordance with the terms of this Lease. If Tenant fails to make the Termination Payment in a timely manner, then the Termination Option shall, at Landlord’s option, be void. Unless Landlord otherwise agrees in writing, Tenant may not exercise the Termination Option, and no exercise thereof shall be effective, if a default shall exist under this Lease as of the date on which the Termination Notice is given or as of the Early Termination Date provided, however, notwithstanding anything in this Lease to the contrary. Landlord’s acceptance of the Termination Payment shall constitute Landlord’s approval of Tenant’s exercise of the Termination Option for all purposes. Upon Tenant’s delivering the Termination Notice, any and all rights of Tenant to extend the Term or to lease additional space in the Building, whether pursuant to a right of first offer, a right of first refusal, an expansion option, or otherwise, shall immediately be void and of no further force or effect. All obligations of either party to the other which accrue under this Lease on or before the Early Termination Date shall survive such termination. As used herein. “Termination Payment” shall mean an amount equal to the remaining Rent due under this Lease for the remainder of the Term as of the Early Termination Date discounted at a rate of five percent (5%). If Tenant leases additional space in the Building, then the Termination Payment shall be increased by the unamortized balance of the leasing costs described in any lease amendment executed by Tenant in connection therewith attributable to the leasing of such additional space (e.g., construction allowances, brokerage commissions, attorneys’ fees and abated rent) as of the Early Termination Date. The amortization of the leasing costs for such additional space shall be from the commencement date of the term of the Lease with respect to such other space through the expiration date on a straight line basis.

 

30


LANDLORD:     WITNESS:
CHALLENGER-DISCOVERY, LLC, a    
Delaware limited liability company    
By:  

/s/Kathleen Keller

   

/s/ Ashley Dederino

  Name:   Kathleen Keller    

/s/ Isabel Rachel Lantry

  Title:   Secretary/Treasurer    

 

LANDLORD:     WITNESS:
LENSAR, INC., a Delaware corporation    
By:  

/s/ Monty K. Allen

   

/s/ Mary K. Zimmerman

  Name:   Monty K. Allen    

/s/ Amy R. Brooks

  Title:   Secretary and Treasurer    

 

31


FIRST AMENDMENT TO LEASE

THIS FIRST AMENDMENT TO LEASE (this “Amendment”) is entered into as of March 15, 2016 (the “Effective Date”), by and between CHALLENGER-DISCOVERY, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (“Landlord”), and LENSAR, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (“Tenant”).

R E C I T A L S:

A. Landlord and Lensar, Inc., a Delaware corporation, entered into that certain Industrial Real Estate Lease dated July 30, 2010, as assigned to Tenant by that certain Assignment and Assumption of Lease dated December 15, 2015 (collectively, the “Lease”), pursuant to which Tenant leases from Landlord that certain premises known as Suite 100, consisting of approximately 34,758 square feet of rentable area (the “Original Premises”) in the building located at 2800 Discovery Dive, Orlando, Florida (the “Building”).

B. Landlord and Tenant have agreed that Tenant shall reduce the size of the Original Premises by approximately 812 square feet of rentable area by eliminating the common restrooms located on the north end of the Premises (the “Terminated Space”) as more fully depicted on Exhibit B attached hereto. The Original Premises minus the Terminated Space shall total approximately 33,946 rentable square feet (subject to verification upon final measurement by Landlord) and shall be known, collectively, as the “Premises”. The Premises is more fully depicted on Exhibit A attached hereto.

C. The current term of the Lease is scheduled to expire on April 30, 2016. D. Subject to the terms hereof, Landlord and Tenant have agreed to extend the term of the Lease to July 31, 2021.

NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the mutual covenants contained herein and for other good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, Landlord and Tenant agree to amend the Lease as follows:

1. Extension of the Term of the Lease. The term of the Lease is hereby extended for a period of sixty-three months (63) commencing on May 1, 2016 (the “Commencement Date”) and expiring on July 31, 2021 (the “Extension Term”). All of the terms and provisions of the Lease shall continue to apply with respect to the Extension Term, except as specifically modified herein. Except as provided in Section 7 of this Amendment entitled “Renewal Option”, Tenant acknowledges that Tenant has no further right or option to extend the term of the Lease.

2. Terminated Space. Effective on the Commencement Date, the Premises shall be reduced to approximately 33,946 rentable square feet of space in the Building as shown on Exhibit A. Upon the later to occur of the Commencement Date or the Restroom Completion Date (as defined below), Tenant shall vacate and deliver full possession of the Terminated Space in the condition required by the Lease, including, without limitation, performance of Tenant’s restoration obligations. Tenant shall not have any rights, liabilities, or obligations under this Lease with respect to the Terminated Space for the period first accruing after the Commencement Date, except those that, by the provisions of the Lease, are intended to survive the expiration or termination of the Lease (specifically including, without limitation, the obligation to make a final reconciliation of Additional Rent owing for the Terminated Space, as required by the Lease).


3. Base Rent. From and after the Commencement Date, Tenant shall pay to Landlord Base Rent in the manner and at the times set forth in Article 4 of the Lease and in an amount hereinafter provided, without demand, deduction or setoff, except as expressly provided in the Lease. From and after the Commencement Date, Base Rent shall be as follows:

 

Period Installment

   RSF      Annual Base Rent      Monthly  

Commencement Date –

        

October 31, 2016*

   $ 7.375      $ 250,351.75      $ 20,862.65  

November 1, 2016 – April 30, 2017

   $ 14.75      $ 500,703.50      $ 41,725.29  

May 1, 2017 – April 30, 2018

   $ 15.19      $ 515,639.74      $ 42,969.98  

May 1, 2018 – April 30, 2019

   $ 15.65      $ 531,254.90      $ 44,271.24  

May 1, 2019 – April 30, 2020

   $ 16.12      $ 547,209.52      $ 45,600.79  

May 1, 2020 – April 30, 2021

   $ 16.60      $ 563,503.60      $ 46,958.63  

May 1, 2021 – July 31, 2021

   $ 17.10      $ 580,476.60      $ 48,373.05  

 

*

Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained herein, so long as Tenant is not in default under the Lease, Tenant’s obligation to pay fifty percent (50%) of the Base Rent otherwise due for the Premises for the Commencement Date – October 31, 2016 (the “Abatement Period”) shall be abated. Accordingly, the total amount of Base Rent abated during the Abatement Period shall equal $125,175.87 (the “Abated Base Rent”). If Landlord elects to terminate the Lease or Tenant’s right to possession of the Premises due to a default by Tenant not cured during any applicable grace or curative period, then (i) the portion of the Abated Base Rent unamortized as of the date of such default, shall immediately become due and payable; and (ii) Tenant shall not be entitled to any further abatement of Base Rent pursuant to this paragraph. The payment by Tenant of the Abated Base Rent in the event of a default shall not limit or affect any of Landlord’s other rights or remedies, in the event of a default by Tenant, pursuant to the Lease or at law or in equity.

4. Additional Rent. Tenant shall continue to pay, in accordance with the Lease, Tenant’s proportionate share of Total Operating Costs for each year on a net basis, and without regard to any base year. As of the Commencement Date, Tenant’s proportionate share of Total Operating Costs (or Pro Rata Share as defined in the Lease) shall be 75.83%. The Total Operating Costs for 2016 are estimated to be approximately $5.22 per square foot. For purposes of calculating Total Operating Costs, Controllable Operating Costs (as hereinafter defined) shall be deemed to have increased by the actual amount of such increase over the preceding year, but not to exceed six percent (6%) (on a cumulative basis) of such actual (i.e. following end of year reconciliation) costs in each year of this Amendment commencing on the Commencement Date. The term “Controllable Operating Costs” shall include all Total Operating Costs with the exception of Real Property Taxes, Building insurance costs, utilities, management fees not to exceed five percent (5%) and any research park fees.

5. Florida State Sales Tax. Tenant shall continue pay all applicable Florida State Sales Taxes concurrently with each installment of Base Rent for the Premises.

 

2


6. Tenant Improvements. All improvements described in this Amendment to be constructed in and upon the Premises are described in the Work Letter attached hereto as Exhibit D (the “Work Letter”). In addition to Landlord’s Work, Landlord, at Landlord’s sole cost and expense and not as part of Landlord’s Work, will construct one single unisex stall restroom within the Premises (the “New Restroom”) as more fully depicted on Exhibit C attached hereto. Landlord shall complete the construction of the New Restroom within ninety (90) days following the execution of this Amendment (the “Restroom Completion Date”). Tenant and its employees, agents and invitees shall not disturb Landlord and its contractors in the construction of the New Restroom and shall fully cooperate with Landlord’s process to ensure expediency in the completion of the New Restroom. Other than with respect to Landlord’s Work (as defined in the Work Letter), or as otherwise provided in the Lease, including construction of the New Restroom, Tenant accepts the Premises in its “as-is” condition and Landlord shall have no obligation to perform any work at the Premises. Landlord agrees to provide Tenant with full access to and use of the Terminated Space (i.e., the existing north restrooms) until the Restroom Completion Date.

7. Renewal Option. Landlord hereby grants to Tenant the option to extend the Extension Term on the same terms, conditions and provisions as contained in the Lease, as modified and except as otherwise provided herein, for one (1) period of five (5) years (the “Option Period”) commencing on the day following the expiration of the Extension Term.

(a) Tenant’s option to extend shall be exercisable by written notice from Tenant to Landlord given no more than twelve (12) months and no less than nine (9) months prior to the expiration of the Extension Term, time being of the essence.

(b) Base Rent per rentable square foot of the Premises payable during the Option Period shall be at one hundred percent (100%) of the Fair Market Rental Rate (as hereinafter defined).

(c) Tenant may only exercise its option to extend, and an exercise thereof shall only be effective, if at the time of Tenant’s exercise and on the Option Period commencement date, the Lease is in full force and effect and no event of default by Tenant has occurred under the Lease which remains uncured after the giving of any applicable notice and the expiration of any applicable cure period. In addition to the condition set forth in the first sentence of this subparagraph (c), if Tenant is in default under the Lease (after the giving of any applicable notice and the expiration of any applicable cure period) within thirty (30) days prior to the Option Period commencement date, then, at Landlord’s option, Tenant’s right to exercise its option may be terminated and rendered null and void by written notice thereof from Landlord to Tenant.

(d) Upon the valid exercise by Tenant of its option to extend, Landlord and Tenant shall enter into a written amendment to the Lease confirming the terms, conditions and provisions applicable to the Option Period as determined in accordance with the provisions of this Section, with such revisions to the rent provisions of the Lease as may be necessary to conform those provisions to the rental rate applicable to the Option Period. No new options to extend shall be deemed to be created by a valid exercise of the extension option and no other provisions inapplicable to the Option Period such as, but not limited to, an obligation to construct or pay for construction or improvements or to grant rent abatements, shall be construed to govern the Option Period.

 

3


For purposes of this Section, the term “Fair Market Rental Rate” shall mean a rate comprised of (i) the prevailing base rental rate per square foot of rentable area available in the Pertinent Market (as defined below), and taking into account tenant improvement allowances, other tenant inducements, operating cost stops and tax cost stops, and brokerage commissions, all as determined by an MAI appraiser mutually acceptable to Landlord and Tenant in their reasonable discretion, and (ii) any escalation of any such base rental rate (based upon a fixed step and/or index) prevailing in the Pertinent Market, as also determined by said appraiser, taking into account (A) comparable lease renewals (on the basis of factors such as, but not limited to, size and location of space and commencement date and term of lease), if any, recently executed for improved space in the Building, and (B) lease renewals for comparable (on the basis of factors such as, but not limited to, size and location of space and commencement date and term of lease) improved space in “flex” buildings in the Research Park which are comparable to the Building in reputation, quality, condition, age, size, location and level and quality of services provided and which have reached economic stabilization and are not, for any other reason, offering below market rents (the foregoing factors not being exclusive in identifying comparable buildings) (the Building, together with such comparable buildings, if applicable, being herein referred to as the “Pertinent Market”). Tenant may, after the determinations of the appraiser set forth above, elect to withdraw its notice of renewal at no obligation or expense of Tenant and, in such event, the Term shall not be extended and Tenant shall lose its renewal option.

8. Right of First Offer. Landlord hereby grants to Tenant a one-time right (the “Right of First Refusal”) to lease Suite 270 (consisting of approximately 10,819 square feet of rentable space) located contiguous to the Premises (“Expansion Space”) on the same terms, conditions and provisions as contained in the Lease, as modified and except as otherwise provided herein.

(a) In the event Landlord receives a letter of intent to lease the Expansion Space from a third party (an “Offer”), Landlord shall notify Tenant of such Offer. The Right of First Refusal shall be exercisable by Tenant only by written notice given by Tenant to Landlord not later than five (5) business days after Tenant receives the Offer from Landlord.

(b) Tenant may only exercise its Right of First Refusal, and an exercise thereof shall only be effective, if at the time of Tenant’s exercise, the Lease is in full force and effect and no event of default by Tenant has occurred under the Lease which remains uncured after the giving of any applicable notice and the expiration of any applicable cure period. In addition to the condition set forth in the first sentence of this subparagraph (b), if Tenant is in default under the Lease (after the giving of any applicable notice and the expiration of any applicable cure period) within thirty (30) days prior to Tenant taking occupancy of the Expansion Space, then, at Landlord’s option, Tenant’s right to exercise its Right of First Refusal may be terminated and rendered null and void by written notice thereof from Landlord to Tenant

 

4


(c) Upon the valid exercise by Tenant of its Right of First Refusal, Landlord and Tenant shall enter into a written amendment to the Lease confirming the terms, conditions and provisions applicable to the Expansion Space as determined in accordance with the provisions of this Section, with such revisions to the rent provisions of the Lease as may be necessary to conform those provisions to the rental rate applicable to the Expansion Space.

(d) The Right of First Refusal is not transferable by any assignment or subletting and, in the event of an assignment or subletting, the Right of First Refusal shall be null and void.

9. Brokers. Landlord and Tenant each represent and warrant to the other that the only brokers they have dealt with in connection with this Amendment are Avison Young and Coughlin Commercial whose commissions and fees shall be paid by Landlord pursuant to separate written agreements. Landlord and Tenant each agree to defend, indemnify and hold the other harmless from and against all claims by any other broker for fees, commissions or other compensation to the extent such broker alleges to have been retained by the indemnifying party in connection with the execution of this Amendment. The provisions of this paragraph shall survive the expiration or sooner termination of the Lease.

10. Miscellaneous. Except as modified herein, the Lease and all of the terms and provisions thereof shall remain unmodified and in full force and effect as originally written. In the event of any conflict or inconsistency between the provisions of the Lease and the provisions of this Amendment, the provisions of this Amendment shall control. All terms used herein but not defined herein which are defined in the Lease shall have the same meaning for purposes hereof as they do for purposes of the Lease. The Recitals set forth above in this Amendment are hereby incorporated by this reference. This Amendment shall be binding upon and shall inure to the benefit of the parties hereto and their respective beneficiaries, successors and assigns.

11. Counterparts. This Amendment may be executed in any number of counterparts and by each of the undersigned on separate counterparts, which counterparts taken together shall constitute one and the same instrument.

[SIGNATURE PAGE FOLLOWS]

 

5


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned have executed this First Amendment to Lease as of the day and year first above written.

 

WITNESS/ATTEST:    LANDLORD:
By: /s/ Simone DaSilva                                                      CHALLENGER-DISCOVERY, LLC, a
       Name: Simone DaSilva    Delaware limited liability company
By: /s/ Bret Anderson                                                         By: /s/ Kathleen Keller                                                         
       Name: Bret Anderson           Name: Kathleen Keller
          Title: Secretary/Treasurer
WITNESS/ATTEST:    TENANT:
By: /s/ Alan Connaughton                                                   LENSAR, LLC, a Delaware limited liability
       Name: Alan Connaughton    company
By: /s/ Monty K. Allen                                                        By: /s/ Nick T. Curtis                                                             
       Name: Monty K. Allen           Name: Nick T. Curtis
          Title: CEO

 

6


SECOND AMENDMENT TO LEASE

THIS SECOND AMENDMENT TO LEASE (this “Amendment”) is entered into as of December 16, 2016 (the “Effective Date”), by and between CHALLENGER-DISCOVERY, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (“Landlord”), and LENSAR, INC., a Delaware corporation (f/k/a Lensar, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company) (“Tenant”).

R E C I T A L S:

A. Landlord and Lensar, Inc., a Delaware corporation, entered into that certain Industrial Real Estate Lease dated July 30, 2010, as assigned to Tenant by that certain Assignment and Assumption of Lease dated December 15, 2015, and as amended by that certain First Amendment to Lease dated March 15, 2016 (collectively, the “Lease”), pursuant to which Tenant leases from Landlord that certain premises known as Suite 100, consisting of approximately 33,946 square feet of rentable area in the building located at 2800 Discovery Dive, Orlando, Florida.

B. Landlord and Tenant agree to modify the terms of the Lease as set forth herein.

NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the mutual covenants contained herein and for other good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, Landlord and Tenant agree to amend the Lease as follows:

1. Corporate Name. Pursuant to a certain corporate reorganization of Tenant as evidenced in that certain Asset Purchase Agreement dated as of the Effective Date between Tenant and Alphaeon Corporation, Tenant changed its name back to Lensar, Inc., a Delaware corporation effective as of the Effective Date. Such entity shall be responsible as “Tenant” under all Lease provisions.

2. Brokers. Landlord and Tenant each represent and warrant to the other that they have not dealt with any brokers in connection with this Amendment. Landlord and Tenant each agree to defend, indemnify and hold the other harmless from and against all claims by any other broker for fees, commissions or other compensation to the extent such broker alleges to have been retained by the indemnifying party in connection with the execution of this Amendment. The provisions of this paragraph shall survive the expiration or sooner termination of the Lease.

3. Miscellaneous. Except as modified herein, the Lease and all of the terms and provisions thereof shall remain unmodified and in full force and effect as originally written. In the event of any conflict or inconsistency between the provisions of the Lease and the provisions of this Amendment, the provisions of this Amendment shall control. All terms used herein but not defined herein which are defined in the Lease shall have the same meaning for purposes hereof as they do for purposes of the Lease. The Recitals set forth above in this Amendment are hereby incorporated by this reference. This Amendment shall be binding upon and shall inure to the benefit of the parties hereto and their respective beneficiaries, successors and assigns.

4. Counterparts. This Amendment may be executed in any number of counterparts and by each of the undersigned on separate counterparts, which counterparts taken together shall constitute one and the same instrument.


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned have executed this Second Amendment to Lease as of the day and year first above written.

 

WITNESS/ATTEST:    

LANDLORD:

By:  

/s/ Brett Anderson

    CHALLENGER-DISCOVERY, LLC, a
  Name: Brett Anderson     Delaware limited liability company
By:  

/s/ Steven C. Heetland

    By:  

/s/ Kathleen Keller

  Name: Steven C. Heetland       Name: Kathleen Keller
        Title: Secretary/Treasurer
       
WITNESS/ATTEST:     TENANT:
By:  

/s/ Greg S. Lipsit

    LENSAR, INC., a Delaware corporation
  Name: Greg S. Lipsit      
By:  

/s/ Adriana Bentz

    By:  

/s/ Alan Connaughton

  Name: Adriana Bentz       Name: Alan Connaughton
        Title: COO


THIRD AMENDMENT TO LEASE

THIS THIRD AMENDMENT TO LEASE (this “Amendment) is entered into as of August 20, 2020 (the “Effective Date”), by and between CHALLENGER-DISCOVERY, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (“Landlord”), and LENSAR, INC., a Delaware corporation (“Tenant”).

R E C I T A L S:

A. Landlord and Tenant entered into that certain Industrial Real Estate Lease dated July 30, 2010, as amended (the “Lease”), pursuant to which Tenant leases from Landlord that certain premises known as Suites 100 and 200, consisting of approximately 33,946 square feet of rentable area (the “Premises”) in the building located at 2800 Discovery Dive, Orlando, Florida (the “Building”).

B. Subject to the terms hereof, Landlord and Tenant have agreed to extend and amend the Lease as set forth herein.

NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the mutual covenants contained herein and for other good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, Landlord and Tenant agree to amend the Lease as follows:

1. Extension of the Term of the Lease. The term of the Lease is hereby extended for a period of seven (7) years and three (3) months commencing on September 1, 2020 (the “Commencement Date”) and expiring on November 30, 2027 (the “Extension Term”). All of the terms and provisions of the Lease shall continue to apply with respect to the Extension Term, except as specifically modified herein. Except as provided in Section 6 of this Amendment entitled “Renewal Option”, Tenant acknowledges that Tenant has no further right or option to extend the term of the Lease.

2. Base Rent. From and after the Commencement Date, Tenant shall pay to Landlord Base Rent in the manner and at the times set forth in Article 4 of the Lease and in an amount hereinafter provided, without demand, deduction or setoff, except as expressly provided in the Lease. From and after the Commencement Date, Base Rent shall be as follows:

 

Period

Installment

   RSF    Annual Base Rent    Monthly

*9/1/2020 – 11/30/2020

   $0.00    N/A    N/A

12/1/2020—8/31/2021

   $15.25    $517,676.50    $43,139.71

9/1/2021 – 8/31/2022

   $15.67    $531,933.82    $44,327.82

9/1/2022 – 8/31/2023

   $16.10    $546,530.60    $45,544.22

9/1/2023 – 8/31/2024

   $16.54    $561,466.84    $46,788.90

9/1/2024 – 8/31/2025

   $16.99    $576,742.54    $48,061.88

9/1/2025 – 8/31/2026

   $17.46    $592,697.16    $49,391.43

9/1/2027 – 11/30/2027

   $17.94    $608,991.24    $50,749.27


*Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained herein, so long as Tenant is not in default under the Lease, Tenant’s obligation to pay the Base Rent otherwise due for the Premises for the first three (3) months (the “Abatement Period”) shall be abated. Accordingly, the total amount of Base Rent abated during the Abatement Period shall equal $129,419.13 (the “Abated Base Rent”). If Landlord elects to terminate the Lease or Tenant’s right to possession of the Premises due to default by Tenant not cured during any applicable grace or curative period, then (i) the portion of the Abated Base Rent unamortized as of the date of such default, shall immediately become due and payable; and (ii) Tenant shall not be entitled to any further abatement of Base Rent pursuant to this paragraph. The payment by Tenant of the Abated Base Rent in the event of a default shall not limit or affect any of Landlord’s other rights or remedies, in the event of a default by Tenant, pursuant to the Lease or at law or in equity.

3. Additional Rent. Tenant shall continue to pay, in accordance with the Lease, Tenant’s proportionate share of Total Operating Costs for each year on a net basis, and without regard to any base year. As of the Commencement Date, Tenant’s proportionate share of Total Operating Costs (or Pro Rata Share as defined in the Lease) shall be 75.83%. The Total Operating Costs for 2020 are estimated to be approximately $5.91 per square foot. For purposes of calculating Total Operating Costs, Controllable Operating Costs (as hereinafter defined) shall be deemed to have increased by the actual amount of such increase over the preceding year, but not to exceed five percent (5%) (on a cumulative basis) of such actual (i.e. following end of year reconciliation) costs in each year of this Amendment commencing on the Commencement Date. The term “Controllable Operating Costs” shall include all Total Operating Costs with the exception of Real Property Taxes, Building insurance costs, utilities, management fees not to exceed five percent (5%) and any research park fees.

4. Florida State Sales Tax. Tenant shall continue pay all applicable Florida State Sales Taxes concurrently with each installment of Base Rent for the Premises.

5. Tenant Improvements. All improvements described in this Amendment to be constructed in and upon the Premises are described in the Work Letter attached hereto as Exhibit A (the “Work Letter”). Other than with respect to Landlord’s Work (as defined in the Work Letter), Tenant accepts the Premises in its “as-is” condition and Landlord shall have no obligation to perform any work at the Premises.

6. Renewal Option. Landlord hereby grants to Tenant the option to extend the Extension Term on the same terms, conditions and provisions as contained in the Lease, as modified and except as otherwise provided herein, for one (1) period of five (5) years (the “Option Period”) commencing on the day following the expiration of the Extension Term.

(a) Tenant’s option to extend shall be exercisable by written notice from Tenant to Landlord given no more than twelve (12) months and no less than nine (9) months prior to the expiration of the Extension Term, time being of the essence.

 

2


(b) Base Rent per rentable square foot of the Premises payable during the Option Period shall be at one hundred percent (100%) of the Fair Market Rental Rate (as hereinafter defined).

(c) Tenant may only exercise its option to extend, and an exercise thereof shall only be effective, if at the time of Tenant’s exercise and on the Option Period commencement date, the Lease is in full force and effect and no event of default by Tenant has occurred under the Lease which remains uncured after the giving of any applicable notice and the expiration of any applicable cure period. In addition to the condition set forth in the first sentence of this subparagraph (c), if Tenant is in default under the Lease (after the giving of any applicable notice and the expiration of any applicable cure period) within thirty (30) days prior to the Option Period commencement date, then, at Landlord’s option, Tenant’s right to exercise its option may be terminated and rendered null and void by written notice thereof from Landlord to Tenant.

(d) Upon the valid exercise by Tenant of its option to extend, Landlord and Tenant shall enter into a written amendment to the Lease confirming the terms, conditions and provisions applicable to the Option Period as determined in accordance with the provisions of this Section, with such revisions to the rent provisions of the Lease as may be necessary to conform those provisions to the rental rate applicable to the Option Period. No new options to extend shall be deemed to be created by a valid exercise of the extension option and no other provisions inapplicable to the Option Period such as, but not limited to, an obligation to construct or pay for construction or improvements or to grant rent abatements, shall be construed to govern the Option Period.

For purposes of this Section, the term “Fair Market Rental Rate” shall mean a rate comprised of (i) the prevailing base rental rate per square foot of rentable area available in the Pertinent Market (as defined below), and taking into account tenant improvement allowances, other tenant inducements, operating cost stops and tax cost stops, and brokerage commissions, all as determined by an MAI appraiser mutually acceptable to Landlord and Tenant in their reasonable discretion, and (ii) any escalation of any such base rental rate (based upon a fixed step and/or index) prevailing in the Pertinent Market, as also determined by said appraiser, taking into account (A) comparable lease renewals (on the basis of factors such as, but not limited to, size and location of space and commencement date and term of lease), if any, recently executed for improved space in the Building, and (B) lease renewals for comparable (on the basis of factors such as, but not limited to, size and location of space and commencement date and term of lease) improved space in “flex” buildings in the Research Park which are comparable to the Building in reputation, quality, condition, age, size, location and level and quality of services provided and which have reached economic stabilization and are not, for any other reason, offering below market rents (the foregoing factors not being exclusive in identifying comparable buildings) (the Building, together with such comparable buildings, if applicable, being herein referred to as the “Pertinent Market”). Tenant may, after the determinations of the appraiser set forth above, elect to withdraw its notice of renewal at no obligation or expense of Tenant and, in such event, the Term shall not be extended and Tenant shall lose its renewal option.

 

3


7. Right of First Refusal. Landlord hereby grants to Tenant an ongoing right (the “Right of First Refusal”) to lease any premises located contiguous to the Premises (“ROFR Space”) on the same terms, conditions and provisions as contained in the Lease, as modified and except as otherwise provided herein.

(a) In the event Landlord receives a letter of intent to lease any ROFR Space from a third party (the “Offer”), Landlord shall notify Tenant of such Offer. The Right of First Refusal shall be exercisable by Tenant only by written notice given by Tenant to Landlord not later than five (5) business days after Tenant receives the Offer from Landlord.

(b) Tenant may only exercise its Right of First Refusal, and an exercise thereof shall only be effective, if at the time of Tenant’s exercise, the Lease is in full force and effect and no event of default by Tenant has occurred under the Lease which remains uncured after the giving of any applicable notice and the expiration of any applicable cure period. In addition to the condition set forth in the first sentence of this subparagraph (b), if Tenant is in default under the Lease (after the giving of any applicable notice and the expiration of any applicable cure period) within thirty (30) days prior to Tenant taking occupancy of the ROFR Space, then, at Landlord’s option, Tenant’s right to exercise its Right of First Refusal may be terminated and rendered null and void by written notice thereof from Landlord to Tenant

(c) Upon the valid exercise by Tenant of its Right of First Refusal, Landlord and Tenant shall enter into a written amendment to the Lease confirming the terms, conditions and provisions applicable to the ROFR Space as determined in accordance with the provisions of this Section, with such revisions to the rent provisions of the Lease as may be necessary to conform those provisions to the rental rate applicable to the ROFR Space.

(d) The Right of First Refusal is not transferable by any assignment or subletting and, in the event of an assignment or subletting, the Right of First Refusal shall be null and void.

8. Assignment. Notwithstanding anything in Article 13 of the Lease to the contrary, Tenant may assign this Lease or sublet all or any portion of the Premises without prior written consent of Landlord to any entity or person succeeding to Tenant’s business or a substantial part thereof whether by merger, consolidation or acquisition of the stock or assets of Tenant or otherwise.

9. Brokers. Landlord and Tenant each represent and warrant to the other that the only brokers they have dealt with in connection with this Amendment are Avison Young and Coughlin Commercial whose commissions and fees shall be paid by Landlord pursuant to separate written agreements. Landlord and Tenant each agree to defend, indemnify and hold the

 

4


other harmless from and against all claims by any other broker for fees, commissions or other compensation to the extent such broker alleges to have been retained by the indemnifying party in connection with the execution of this Amendment. The provisions of this paragraph shall survive the expiration or sooner termination of the Lease.

10. Miscellaneous. Except as modified herein, the Lease and all of the terms and provisions thereof shall remain unmodified and in full force and effect as originally written. In the event of any conflict or inconsistency between the provisions of the Lease and the provisions of this Amendment, the provisions of this Amendment shall control. All terms used herein but not defined herein which are defined in the Lease shall have the same meaning for purposes hereof as they do for purposes of the Lease. The Recitals set forth above in this Amendment are hereby incorporated by this reference. This Amendment shall be binding upon and shall inure to the benefit of the parties hereto and their respective beneficiaries, successors and assigns.

11. Counterparts. This Amendment may be executed in any number of counterparts and by each of the undersigned on separate counterparts, which counterparts taken together shall constitute one and the same instrument.

[SIGNATURE PAGE FOLLOWS]

 

5


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned have executed this Third Amendment to Lease as of the day and year first above written.

 

LANDLORD:
CHALLENGER-DISCOVERY, LLC, a
Delaware limited liability company
By:  

/s/ Steven C. Hertland

  Name:  

Steven C. Hertland

  Title:  

Manager

TENANT:
LENSAR, INC. a Delaware corporation
By:  

/s/ Nick T. Curtis

  Name:  

Nick T. Curtis

  Title:  

CEO

 

6


ADDENDUM TO THIRD AMENDMENT TO LEASE

THIS ADDENDUM TO THIRD AMENDMENT TO LEASE is entered into as of September 9, 2020, by and between CHALLENGER-DISCOVERY, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (“Landlord”), and LENSAR, INC., a Delaware corporation (“Tenant”).

1.    Landlord and Tenant are parties to that certain Third Amendment to Lease dated August 20, 2020 (the “Third Amendment”).

2.    Due to a scrivener’s error in the Third Amendment, the parties agree that the following provision shall replace Section 2 of the Third Amendment in its entirety.

Base Rent. From and after the Commencement Date, Tenant shall pay to Landlord Base Rent in the manner and at the times set forth in Article 4 of the Lease and in an amount hereinafter provided, without demand, deduction or setoff, except as expressly provided in the Lease. From and after the Commencement Date, Base Rent shall be as follows:

 

Period Installment

   RSF      Annual Base
Rent
     Monthly  

*9/1/2020 – 11/30/2020

   $ 0.00        N/A        N/A  

12/1/2020 – 8/31/2021

   $ 15.25      $ 517,676.50      $ 43,139.71  

9/112021 – 8/31/2022

   $ 15.67      $ 531,933.82      $ 44,327.82  

9/1/2022 – 8/31/2023

   $ 16.10      $ 546,530.60      $ 45,544.22  

9/1/2023 – 8/31/2024

   $ 16.54      $ 561,466.84      $ 46,788.90  

911/2024 – 8/31/2025

   $ 16.99      $ 576,742.54      $ 48,061.88  

9/1/2025 – 8/31/2026

   $ 17.46      $ 592,697.16      $ 49,391.43  

9/1/2026 – 8/31/2027

   $ 17.94      $ 608,991.24      $ 50,749.27  

9/1/2027 – 11/30/2027

   $ 18.43      $ 625,624.78      $ 52,135.40  

 

*

Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained herein, so long as Tenant is not in default under the Lease, Tenant’s obligation to pay the Base Rent otherwise due for the Premises for the first three (3) months (the “Abatement Period”) shall be abated. Accordingly, the total amount of Base Rent abated during the Abatement Period shall equal $129,419.13 (the “Abated Base Rent”). If Landlord elects to terminate the Lease or Tenant’s right to possession of the Premises due to default by Tenant not cured during any applicable grace or curative period, then (i) the portion of the Abated Base Rent unamortized as of the date of such default, shall immediately become due and payable; and (ii) Tenant shall not be entitled to any further abatement of Base Rent pursuant to this paragraph. The payment by Tenant of the Abated Base Rent in the event of a default shall not limit or affect any of Landlord’s other rights or remedies, in the event of a default by Tenant, pursuant to the Lease or at law or in equity.”


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned have executed this Addendum to Third Amendment to Lease as of the day and year first above written.

 

LANDLORD:
CHALLENGER-DISCOVERY, LLC, a
Delaware limited liability company
By:  

/s/ Steven C. Heetland

Name:   Steven C. Heetland
Title:   Manager
TENANT:
LENSAR, INC. a Delaware corp. oration
By:  

/s/ Alan Connaughton

Name:   Alan Connaughton
Title:   COO
Table of Contents

Exhibit 99.1

PDL BioPharma, Inc.

932 Southwood

Boulevard

Incline Village, Nevada 89451

, 2020

Dear PDL Stockholder:

I am pleased to report that the previously announced separation from PDL BioPharma, Inc. (“PDL”) of its majority-owned subsidiary, LENSAR, Inc. (“LENSAR”) and the distribution of all of the outstanding shares of common stock of LENSAR held by PDL on a pro rata basis to holders of PDL common stock (together, the “Spin-Off”) , is expected to become effective on October 1, 2020 and that LENSAR will become a stand-alone company on that date. LENSAR is a commercial-stage medical device company focused on designing, developing and marketing an advanced femtosecond laser system for the treatment of cataracts and the management of pre-existing or surgically induced corneal astigmatism.

LENSAR has applied to list its common stock on the the Nasdaq Capital Market under the symbol “LNSR.”

Recognizing the difference between our share price and our higher book value, we previously announced that we would seek to increase stockholder value by distributing the value of the individual assets within PDL to our stockholders. We believe that the Spin-Off of LENSAR will enhance value for current PDL stockholders by allowing the markets to more efficiently value LENSAR and its assets separately from PDL.

Holders of record of PDL common stock as of 5:00 p.m., Eastern Time, on September 22, 2020, which will be the record date, will receive 0.075879 shares of LENSAR common stock for every one share of PDL common stock held by such holders. No action is required on your part to receive your LENSAR stock. You will not be required to pay anything for the new shares or to surrender any shares of PDL stock.

Fractional shares of LENSAR’s common stock will not be distributed. Fractional shares of LENSAR’s common stock that would otherwise be distributed to PDL stockholders will be aggregated and sold in the public market by the transfer agent. The aggregate net proceeds of these sales will be distributed ratably as cash payments to the stockholders who would otherwise have received fractional interests. In due course you will be provided with information to enable you to compute your tax basis in both the PDL and the LENSAR stock.

The enclosed information statement describes the distribution of shares of LENSAR stock and contains important information about LENSAR, including financial statements. I suggest that you read it carefully. If you have any questions regarding the distribution, please contact PDL’s transfer agent, Computershare Trust Company, N.A. at (877) 424-4271.

I believe the Spin-Off is a positive event for the owners of our stock. We remain committed to working on your behalf to provide a meaningful return for our stockholders.

Sincerely,

Elizabeth O’Farrell

Chairperson of the Board


Table of Contents

Information included herein is subject to completion or amendment. A Registration Statement on Form 10 relating to these securities has been filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.

 

PRELIMINARY INFORMATION STATEMENT

SUBJECT TO COMPLETION, DATED SEPTEMBER 14, 2020

LENSAR, Inc.

Common Stock

(par value $0.01)

 

 

PDL BioPharma, Inc. (“PDL”) is furnishing this information statement (the “information statement”) to its stockholders in connection with the planned distribution by PDL to its stockholders of all of the outstanding shares of common stock held by PDL of its direct, majority-owned subsidiary, LENSAR, Inc. (“LENSAR,” the “company,” “we,” “us” or “our”).

PDL will distribute all of the outstanding shares of common stock of LENSAR held by PDL on a pro rata basis to holders of PDL common stock, which we refer to as the “Distribution.” We refer to the separation of LENSAR from PDL as the “Separation,” and the Separation and Distribution together as the “Spin-Off.” Holders of PDL common stock as of 5:00 p.m., Eastern Time, on September 22, 2020, which will be the Record Date for the Distribution, will be entitled to receive 0.075879 shares of LENSAR common stock for every one share of PDL common stock held by such holders. The Distribution will be made in book-entry form. Immediately after the Distribution is completed, LENSAR will be an independent, publicly traded company. Fractional shares of our common stock will not be distributed. Fractional shares of our common stock that would otherwise be distributed to PDL stockholders will be aggregated and sold in the public market by the transfer agent. The aggregate net proceeds of these sales will be distributed ratably as cash payments to the stockholders who would otherwise have received fractional interests.

No action will be required of you to receive shares of LENSAR common stock, which means that:

 

   

PDL is not asking you for a proxy, and you should not send a proxy;

 

   

you will not be required to pay for the shares of LENSAR common stock that you receive in the Distribution; and

 

   

you do not need to surrender or exchange any of your PDL common stock in order to receive shares of LENSAR common stock, or take any other action in connection with the Spin-Off.

There is currently no trading market for LENSAR common stock. However, we expect that a limited market, commonly known as a “when-issued” trading market, for our common stock will develop shortly prior to the Record Date for the Distribution, and we expect that “regular-way” trading of our common stock will begin the first trading day after the completion of the Distribution. We have applied to list our common stock on the Nasdaq Capital Market under the symbol “LNSR.”

We are an “emerging growth company” and a “smaller reporting company” as defined under U.S. federal securities laws, and as such, may elect to comply with certain reduced public company reporting requirements for this and future filings.

Stockholders of PDL with inquiries related to the Distribution should contact PDL’s transfer agent, Computershare Trust Company, N.A. at (877) 424-4271.

 

 

WE ARE NOT ASKING YOU FOR A PROXY

AND YOU ARE REQUESTED NOT TO SEND US A PROXY

In reviewing this information statement, you should carefully consider the matters described under “Risk Factors” beginning on page 25 for a discussion of certain factors that should be considered by recipients of our common stock.

Neither the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”) nor any state securities commission has approved or disapproved of these securities or determined if this information statement is truthful or complete. Any representation to the contrary is a criminal offense.

This information statement does not constitute an offer to sell or the solicitation of an offer to buy any securities.

 

 

The date of this information statement is                     , 2020.


Table of Contents

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

INFORMATION STATEMENT SUMMARY

     1  

SUMMARY HISTORICAL FINANCIAL DATA

     15  

QUESTIONS AND ANSWERS ABOUT THE SEPARATION AND DISTRIBUTION

     19  

RISK FACTORS

     25  

SPECIAL NOTE REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

     74  

THE SPIN-OFF

     75  

MATERIAL U.S. FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES OF THE DISTRIBUTION

     80  

DIVIDEND POLICY

     87  

UNAUDITED CONDENSED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

     88  

MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

     95  

BUSINESS

     113  

MANAGEMENT

     140  

DIRECTOR COMPENSATION

     146  

EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

     148  

SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT

     163  

CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS

     165  

DESCRIPTION OF LENSAR CAPITAL STOCK

     170  

RECENT SALES OF UNREGISTERED SECURITIES

     173  

INDEMNIFICATION AND LIMITATION OF LIABILITY OF DIRECTORS AND OFFICERS

     174  

WHERE YOU CAN FIND MORE INFORMATION

     175  

INDEX TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

     F-1  

 

i


Table of Contents

INFORMATION STATEMENT SUMMARY

The following is a summary of some of the information contained in this information statement. This summary is included for convenience only and should not be considered complete. This summary is qualified in its entirety by the more detailed information contained elsewhere in this information statement, which should be read in its entirety.

All references in this information statement to “PDL” refer to PDL BioPharma, Inc., a Delaware corporation; all references in this information statement to “LENSAR,” “the company,” “we,” “us,” or “our” refer to LENSAR, Inc., a Delaware corporation. Where appropriate in context, the foregoing terms also include subsidiaries. Throughout this information statement, we refer to the shares of PDL common stock, $0.01 par value per share, as PDL common stock or as PDL shares, and the shares of LENSAR common stock, par value $0.01 per share, that will be distributed in the Distribution as LENSAR common stock, as our common stock or as LENSAR shares.

Overview

We are a commercial-stage medical device company focused on designing, developing and marketing an advanced femtosecond laser system for the treatment of cataracts and the management of pre-existing or surgically induced corneal astigmatism. Our LENSAR Laser System incorporates a range of proprietary technologies designed to assist the surgeon in obtaining better visual outcomes, efficiency and reproducibility by providing advanced imaging, simplified procedure planning, efficient design and precision. We believe the cumulative effect of these technologies results in a laser system that can be quickly and efficiently integrated into a surgeon’s existing practice, is easy to use and provides surgeons the ability to deliver improved visual outcomes. Surgeons have used our laser system to perform more than 430,000 cataract procedures, including 108,030 during the year ended December 31, 2019 and 41,490 during the six months ended June 30, 2020. As we continue to innovate, we are designing a next-generation, integrated workstation, ALLY, which combines an enhanced femtosecond laser with a phacoemulsification system in a compact, mobile workstation that is designed to allow surgeons to perform a femtosecond laser assisted cataract procedure in a single operating room using a single device. We expect this combination product could be a considerable advancement and will provide significant administrative and financial benefit to a surgeon’s practice at a cost less than the cost of our current system. We anticipate submitting an application for 510(k) clearance of ALLY to the U.S. Food and Drug Administration, or FDA, by the end of the first quarter of 2022 and to begin commercialization of ALLY in 2022.

A cataract occurs when the normally clear lens of the eye becomes cloudy or opaque, causing a decrease in vision. The majority of patients suffering from cataracts also present with visually significant astigmatism, which is an imperfection in the symmetry of the cornea that results in decreased visual acuity. In 2019, Market Scope estimated that approximately 70% to 90% of cataract patients present with addressable astigmatism prior to cataract surgery. Currently, the only way to treat cataracts is to surgically remove the natural lens of the eye. The principal steps in the procedure include a corneal incision, called an anterior capsulotomy; cataract phacoemulsification including the fragmentation, aspiration and removal of the cataract; and implantation of an artificial intraocular lens, or IOL. IOLs contain corrective power to replace the optical power of the natural lens. A variety of IOLs exist, including a standard monofocal IOL, or premium IOLs, such as multifocal, accommodating or toric IOLs.

Traditional cataract surgeries are performed by a surgeon using a metal or diamond blade to perform the anterior capsulotomy to enter the eye, and a bent needle to perform the anterior capsulotomy to provide the surgeon access to the nucleus of the cataract for fragmentation and subsequent removal. More recently, laser systems have been developed to assist surgeons in performing or facilitating these aspects of the cataract



 

1


Table of Contents

procedure, including assessing and fragmenting the cataract. In either case, cataract fragmentation and removal is achieved using a process called phacoemulsification. Currently, Medicare and most commercial third-party payors only cover the cost of traditional cataract surgery and the placement of a monofocal IOL, which may not produce the targeted visual outcome. To achieve their targeted visual outcome, patients may elect to have an advanced procedure that involves use of a laser system and implantation of a premium IOL, in which case the patient is responsible for the cost differential between the amount reimbursed by a third-party payor and the cost of the advanced procedure. However, based on management estimates derived from the 2019 Cataract Surgical Equipment Report, even when patients pay for and receive an advanced procedure that involves implantation of a premium IOL, approximately 43% still do not achieve the targeted visual outcome, typically characterized as a result within 0.5 diopters.

We believe the inability to achieve the targeted visual outcome is largely due to a failure to appropriately address corneal astigmatism even when using competing laser systems. We believe this lack of precision can be attributed to several limitations of competing laser devices, including imaging systems that require manual inputs, inaccuracies that result from reliance on manually transposing data and marking the eye for treatment, and the inability to use iris registration to integrate with preoperative devices. These devices also lack a cataract density imaging system, which allows the surgeon to customize the fragmentation and energy settings based on each individual patient’s cataract.

We developed our LENSAR Laser System to provide an alternative laser cataract treatment tool that allows the surgeon to better address astigmatism and improve visual outcomes. Our system incorporates a range of proprietary technology features that are designed to provide surgeons the following key benefits:

 

   

Advanced imaging. Our Augmented Reality imaging and processing technology collects a broad spectrum of biometric data and then reconstructs and presents a precise, three-dimensional model of each individual patient’s eye that is used to develop and implement the surgeon’s procedure plan.

 

   

Simplified procedures. Our system is designed to automate and perform various critical steps in the cataract procedure with the goal of providing surgeons with the confidence to perform these advanced procedures that include implantation of a premium IOL. For example, our IntelliAxis IV technology allows for the precise placement of arcuate corneal incisions, as well as the proprietary refractive capsulorhexis, or IntelliAxis Refractive Capsulorhexis, that creates tabs on the exact axis of astigmatism 180 degrees apart to help produce proper toric IOL placement. These tabs can even be visualized by the surgeon postoperatively to help further ensure proper placement without rotation, which can diminish the effectiveness of the toric IOL.

 

   

Efficient design. We designed the ergonomics of the system and its wireless capabilities to enable the system to integrate seamlessly into a surgeon’s existing surgical environment.

 

   

Precision and reproducibility. The system has multiple features specifically designed to enable precise placement and centration of the IOL in patients in a consistent and reproducible manner that is not possible in manual cataract surgery or using competing laser systems.

We believe the cumulative effect of these technologies is an advanced laser system that can be quickly integrated into a surgeon’s existing practice, is easy to use and provides surgeons the ability to deliver improved outcomes when addressing astigmatism in connection with cataract removal. In a retrospective study published in the Journal of Cataract Refractive Surgery, or the Arcuate Keratotomy Study, of 189 eyes that underwent arcuate keratotomy with our laser system 95.8% demonstrated post-operative refractive astigmatism of 0.5 diopters or less and 90% of eyes had a post-operative uncorrected distance visual acuity, or UDVA, of 20/30 or better.

We are focused on continuous innovation and are currently developing our proprietary, next-generation, integrated workstation, ALLY. ALLY is designed to combine our existing femtosecond laser technology with



 

2


Table of Contents

enhanced capabilities and a phacoemulsification system into a single unit and allow surgeons to perform a femtosecond laser assisted cataract procedure in a single operating room using this device. We anticipate submitting an application for 510(k) clearance to the FDA by the end of the first quarter of 2022 and to begin commercialization of ALLY in 2022. If ALLY is cleared by the FDA, we believe its lower operating costs and combined functions will help drive broader penetration for us into the overall cataract surgery market and could create a paradigm shift in the treatment of cataracts and management of astigmatism in cataract surgery.

We have built and are continuing to grow our commercial organization, which includes a direct sales force in the United States and distributors in Germany, China, South Korea and other targeted international geographies. We believe there is significant opportunity for us to expand our presence in these countries and other markets and regions. In the United States, we sell our products through a direct sales organization that, as of December 31, 2019, consisted of 30 commercial team professionals, including regional sales managers, clinical applications and outcomes specialists, field service, technology and customer support personnel.

We have experienced considerable growth since we began commercializing our products in the United States in 2012. Our revenue increased from $24.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2018 to $30.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2019, representing annual revenue growth of 25%. Our revenue for the six months ended June 30, 2020 was $11.0 million, compared to revenue of $14.0 million for the six months ended June 30, 2019, representing a decline of 22%, primarily on account of the impact of COVID-19. Our net losses were $6.4 million, $8.2 million, $12.6 million and $14.7 million for the six months ended June 30, 2019 and 2020 and the years ended December 31, 2018 and December 31, 2019, respectively. Additionally, our installed base of LENSAR Laser Systems had increased from 207 as of December 31, 2019 to 211 as of June 30, 2020.

Our Strengths

We attribute our current and anticipated future success to the following factors:

 

   

an established large and growing market for cataract surgery;

 

   

a disruptive technology platform providing improved visual outcomes;

 

   

demonstrated and growing commercial success;

 

   

improved visual outcomes that drive more advanced, patient-pay procedures;

 

   

a focus on innovation to facilitate surgeon adoption;

 

   

innovative intellectual property protected by a comprehensive patent portfolio; and

 

   

a proven management team and board of directors.

While we believe these factors will contribute to further growth and success, we cannot assure you that the market for cataract surgery will continue to grow as we anticipate or that new disruptive technologies will not be introduced to displace our laser systems. Moreover, we must maintain and grow market acceptance for our laser system and convince physicians and patients that the out of pocket costs associated with procedures that use our laser systems will produce their targeted results. If we are unable to accomplish those goals, our business could suffer.

Market Overview

Current Cataract Treatment Alternatives

Currently, the only way to treat cataracts is to surgically remove the natural lens of the eye. The standard cataract surgical procedure is typically performed in a hospital or in an outpatient ambulatory surgery center, or



 

3


Table of Contents

ASC. The patient receives drops topically, or an injection to numb the eye during the procedure and is usually released from the facility on the same day. The principal steps in the procedure include a corneal incision called an anterior capsulotomy, cataract fragmentation and removal of the cataract, and implantation of an IOL. IOLs contain corrective power to replace the optical power from the natural lens, and can also be used to correct the pre-existing visual errors in the natural lens removed in cataract surgery. Without an IOL, patients would need very thick eyeglasses or special contact lenses to see at all after cataract surgery. A variety of IOLs with different features exist. Some of the basic types include:

 

   

Monofocal IOLs. This type of lens has a single focus strength primarily used for distance vision. Most patients receiving this type of lens will typically require the use of reading glasses for near vision. More contemporary uses of these lenses are to correct one eye for distance and use a different power to correct one eye for reading. This is referred to as monovision and is not suitable for a large part of the population due to many patients being unable to adapt to the vision imbalance.

 

   

Accommodating IOLs. Similar to monofocal IOLs, these lenses have a single focus strength; however, they are designed to respond to eye muscle movements and shift focus from near to far. There are accommodating IOLs in development that have an optical fluid or multi-piece designs that are designed to move and shift focus but work on different principles.

 

   

Extended depth-of-focus or Multifocal IOLs. These IOLs are similar to glasses with bifocal or progressive trifocal lenses. Different areas of the lens have different focusing strengths that allow for near, far and medium vision.

 

   

Astigmatism correction, or toric IOLs. Toric IOLs are designed to correct astigmatism, as well as near or far vision. Some IOL technology may blend these features and include the toric or astigmatism-correcting aspect with the multi-focality or accommodating.

Traditional cataract surgeries are performed by a surgeon using a metal or diamond blade to create the incision necessary to perform the procedure. More recently, special laser systems have been developed to assist surgeons in performing or facilitating the various aspects of the cataract procedures.

The Transition to Advanced Refractive Cataract Procedures

Currently, Medicare and most commercial third-party payors only cover the cost of treating the medical condition of the cataract, which can be accomplished with traditional cataract surgery and the placement of a monofocal IOL. Standard or traditional cataract surgery does not specifically address the outcomes associated with astigmatism and presbyopia, which may be addressed in an advanced refractive procedure involving laser-assisted cataract removal and implantation of a premium IOL. However, since the advantages of these advanced refractive cataract procedures are not deemed medically necessary, patients undergoing an advanced refractive cataract procedure are paying a significant portion of the cost of the surgery out of pocket. As a result, they have heightened expectations for their visual outcomes, normally targeting vision correction within 0.5 diopters of their predicted refractive outcome, sometimes referred to as best uncorrected visual acuity. However, based on management’s calculations derived from the 2019 Cataract Surgical Equipment Report, even when patients pay for and receive an advanced procedure that involves implantation of a premium IOL, approximately 43% still do not achieve the targeted visual outcome, typically characterized as a result within 0.5 diopters. We believe this is largely attributable to an inability to appropriately address and manage the correction of the patient’s pre-existing astigmatism. We believe the failure to manage the astigmatism in such a large percentage of patients is due to the lack of useful technology in surgery. For example, research indicates that for each 1 degree that a toric IOL is off-axis, its ability to reduce astigmatism is decreased by approximately 3.3%. To that end, very small errors in the measurements, calculations and treatments used in the cataract procedure can significantly decrease its



 

4


Table of Contents

effectiveness in achieving the targeted visual outcome. We believe this lack of precision can be attributed to one or more of the following limitations of procedures performed with competing laser systems:

 

   

imaging that requires manual inputs;

 

   

inaccuracies that appear when managing astigmatism;

 

   

an inability to integrate with preoperative devices to guide surgical treatment; and

 

   

a deficient cataract density imaging system.

As a result, we believe a significant opportunity exists for a laser system that can improve surgeon precision and assist in achieving targeted visual outcomes in patients with astigmatism.

Market Opportunity

The global market for the treatment of cataracts is characterized by large patient populations with increases driven by the aging population and the availability of new technologies, such as laser-assisted systems and an influx of new, innovative IOLs, which can improve visual outcomes post-operatively. Cataract surgery is one of the highest volume surgical procedures in the world, and according to the American Academy of Ophthalmology, the most common procedure performed by an ophthalmic surgeon. According to the 2019 Cataract Surgical Equipment Market Report, global estimated cataract/refractive lens exchange surgical procedures are expected to grow from 29 million in 2019 to 34 million in 2024. In the United States, cataract surgery is expected to increase from almost 4.3 million procedures in 2019 to approximately 5.0 million in 2024. By contrast, worldwide laser-assisted cataract surgery is expected to grow from an estimated 815,000 procedures in 2019 to an estimated one million procedures in 2024. In 2019, Market Scope estimated that approximately 70% to 90% of cataract patients present with a treatable astigmatism prior to cataract surgery.

Care for cataract patients in the United States is administered by many of the approximately 20,000 ophthalmologists who diagnose the disease and provide medical management according to Market Scope. There are approximately 8,400 ophthalmic surgeons in the United States focused on performing cataract procedures.

Our Solution

We developed our LENSAR Laser System to provide an alternative laser cataract treatment that allows the surgeon to better address astigmatism and improve visual outcomes.

Benefits of the LENSAR Laser System

Our system incorporates a range of proprietary technology features that are designed to provide surgeons the following key benefits:

 

   

Advanced imaging. Our proprietary Augmented Reality imaging and processing technology collects a broad spectrum of biometric data while taking a series of scans from multiple positions and different angles to capture the radius of corneal curvature, corneal thickness, anterior chamber depth, anterior and posterior lens apex and lens thickness, as well as various anterior segment measurements and location.

 

   

Simplified procedures. Our system is designed to automate and perform various critical steps in the cataract procedure with the goal of providing surgeons with the confidence to perform advanced refractive procedures. Additionally, the system’s technology, including cataract density imaging, has the ability to detect and compensate for lens tilt, and to identify and treat tissue specific densities in the patients’ natural lens. These capabilities combine to enable the system to provide precise laser delivery;



 

5


Table of Contents
 

to produce easy to remove, free-floating capsulotomies; and to perform efficient lens fragmentation, while reducing the laser and phacoemulsification energy required to remove the cataract. The IntelliAxis IV technology allows for the precise placement of arcuate corneal incisions, as well as the proprietary refractive capsulorhexis that creates tabs on the exact axis of astigmatism 180 degrees apart to help produce proper toric IOL placement. These tabs can also be visualized by the surgeon postoperatively to help further ensure proper placement without rotation, which can diminish the effectiveness of the toric IOL. With these automated features, we believe surgeons can feel confident their treatment and execution will lead to better and more predictable outcomes.

 

   

Efficient design. We designed the ergonomics of the system to integrate seamlessly into a surgeon’s existing surgical environment and to enable preferred patient positioning during treatment. In addition, the system has wireless capabilities that allow it to collect and transmit data quickly between itself and multiple pre-operative diagnostic devices, such as corneal topographers, for the surgeons use while examining their patients in the office. The system also includes expanded remote diagnostics that allows us to view and check various software and hardware performance metrics, which helps us increase system reliability and encourages surgeon confidence.

 

   

Precision and reproducibility. The system has multiple features specifically designed to enhance a surgeon’s operating precision. The cloud-based or thumb-drive communication with pre-operative diagnostics, use of iris registration, and integrated surgeon’s tables enhance procedure planning and treatments by storing surgeon specific treatment algorithms and eliminating the need to manually mark the eye with an ink pen. Additionally, our system has automated surface identification and utilizes Augmented Reality and wave tracing capability to accurately and efficiently provide the choice to the surgeon to automatically center the capsulotomy on the pupil center or the patient’s optical axis.

Despite these benefits, many surgeons continue to rely on traditional cataract surgery procedures for a variety of reasons, including comfort with the process and the established reimbursement. Moreover, the use of our laser system requires a capital investment by the surgeon that may not be needed for traditional cataract surgery. In order to maintain and grow our market share, we must establish the ability to deliver improved visual outcomes relative to traditional cataract surgery and provide economic data that demonstrate the safety, efficacy and cost-effectiveness of our laser systems. We will also need to convince surgeons of the ease of use, reliability, precision and reproducibility afforded by our laser systems.

Improved Outcomes

We believe the cumulative effect of these technologies is an advanced laser system that can be quickly integrated into a surgeon’s existing practice, is easy to use and provides surgeons the ability to deliver improved outcomes when addressing astigmatism in connection with cataract removal. Several recent studies support the ability to achieve targeted visual outcomes using our laser system. Key findings in these studies include:

 

   

In a 2019 retrospective study presented at the 2019 Annual Meeting of the American Society of Cataract and Refractive Surgery, or the 2019 Annual ASCRS Meeting, of 60 eyes that underwent treatment with our laser system, we observed a reduction in mean corneal astigmatism from a mean of 2.11 diopters preoperatively to a mean of 0.15 diopters postoperatively, and 98% of eyes achieved postoperative astigmatism of 0.5 diopters or less.

 

   

In a retrospective study from the same year presented at the American Academy of Ophthalmology 2019 Meeting, or AAO 2019 Meeting, of 54 eyes that underwent treatment with our laser system, we observed a reduction in mean corneal astigmatism from a mean of 1.01 diopters preoperatively to a mean of 0.11 diopters postoperatively, and 95% of eyes achieved postoperative astigmatism of 0.5 diopters or less.



 

6


Table of Contents
   

In another retrospective study presented at the AAO 2019 Meeting, of 115 eyes that underwent treatment with our laser system and implantation of a toric IOL, we observed a reduction in mean corneal astigmatism from 1.55 diopters preoperatively to 0.47 diopters postoperatively.

 

   

In the Arcuate Keratotomy Study of 189 eyes that underwent arcuate keratotomy with our laser system, 95.8% demonstrated post-operative refractive astigmatism of 0.5 diopters or less and 90% of eyes had a post-operative uncorrected distance visual acuity, or UDVA, of 20/30 or better.

Our Next-Generation, Integrated Workstation—ALLY

We are designing our second generation system, ALLY, to dramatically advance the ability of surgeons to perform advanced refractive cataract procedures and improve visual outcomes by combining an enhanced version of our laser technology with a phacoemulsification system in a single, compact, mobile workstation. We anticipate submitting an application for 510(k) clearance of ALLY to the FDA by the end of the first quarter of 2022 and beginning commercialization of ALLY in 2022.

We are designing ALLY to seamlessly integrate an enhanced version of our femtosecond laser technology and an advanced phacoemulsification system into one unit that can allow the surgeon to switch seamlessly and quickly between femtosecond laser and phacoemulsification without movement of machines or patients. Importantly, this compact, integrated workstation will be configured with the ergonomics to be used in an operating room or an in-office surgical suite, a trend in current ophthalmology practices. The footprint is significantly smaller than current laser systems and only slightly larger than stand-alone phacoemulsification systems.

We believe several converging marketplace factors will encourage adoption of ALLY, if cleared by the FDA. These include:

 

   

the advent of many new types of advanced IOLs with complex optics, developed to correct near and distance vision with astigmatism, and the ability of ALLY to assist surgeons in optimizing the accurate positioning using any of these lenses to correct astigmatism for better visual outcomes;

 

   

the recent 15% reduction in surgeon reimbursement and continued pressure to lower reimbursement in standard cataract surgery cases coupled with the ability to provide better patient visual outcomes, which we believe will motivate surgeons and patients to seek refractive outcome-based patient-pay procedures;

 

   

the availability of a compact, dual function system with a lower cost of goods that can be placed in the operating room, which we believe will encourage surgeons that currently rely solely on phacoemulsification to adopt and integrate laser-assisted procedures into their practice;

 

   

given the recent COVID 19 pandemic, increased awareness of efficiencies associated with faster patient throughput, less movement from having to use two rooms to complete an advanced cataract procedure, fewer touches of the patient to treat and to complete the advanced cataract procedure, and placing the system in the ASC OR or in-office surgical suite; and

 

   

lower technology acquisition cost and broad base procedure applications across all cataract procedures improve economics for the ASC, and the surgeon.

Our Strategy

Our goal is for our LENSAR Laser System to become the leading solution for the treatment of cataracts and management of astigmatism in cataract surgery. Key elements of our strategy include:

 

   

continue to build our commercial infrastructure in order to further penetrate the cataract surgery market;



 

7


Table of Contents
   

increase awareness of the benefits of our LENSAR Laser System;

 

   

invest in research and development to drive innovation; and

 

   

seek and capitalize on opportunities to enhance our product offering through strategic alliances and acquisitions

Risks Related to Our Business and the Spin-Off

Ownership of LENSAR common stock is subject to a number of risks, including risks relating to the Spin-Off. The following list of risk factors is not exhaustive. Please read the information in the section captioned “Risk Factors” for a more thorough description of these and other risks.

Risks Related to Our Business

 

   

We expect to incur operating losses for the foreseeable future and we cannot assure you that we will be able to generate sufficient revenue to achieve or sustain profitability.

 

   

We principally derive our revenue from the sale or lease of our LENSAR Laser System and the associated procedure licenses and sale of consumables used in each procedure involving our LENSAR Laser System, and the commercial success of our LENSAR Laser System will largely depend upon our ability to maintain and grow significant market acceptance for it.

 

   

Our long-term growth depends in part on our ability to enhance our LENSAR Laser System.

 

   

Patients may not be willing to pay for the price difference between a standard cataract procedure and an advanced cataract procedure in which a laser system such as ours is used, an increment which is typically not covered by Medicare, private insurance or other third-party payors.

 

   

COVID-19 and actions taken to control the spread of COVID-19 have had an adverse impact on our business, and we expect them to continue to do so.

 

   

If we are not able to effectively grow our U.S. sales and marketing organization, or maintain or grow an effective network of international distributors, our business prospects, results of operations and financial condition could be adversely affected.

 

   

Our products and operations are subject to extensive government regulation and oversight both in the United States and abroad, and our failure to comply with applicable requirements could harm our business.

 

   

We may not receive, or may be delayed in receiving, the necessary clearances or approvals for our future products, including ALLY, or modifications to our current products, and failure to timely obtain necessary clearances or approvals for our future products or modifications to our current products would adversely affect our ability to grow our business.

 

   

If we are unable to adequately protect our intellectual property rights, or if we are accused of infringing on the intellectual property rights of others, our competitive position could be harmed or we could be required to incur significant expenses to enforce or defend our rights.

Risks Related to the Spin-Off

 

   

The Spin-Off may not be completed on the terms or timeline currently contemplated, if at all.

 

   

The Spin-Off requires significant time and attention of our management and may distract our employees which could have an adverse effect on us.

 

   

Our ability to meet our capital needs may be harmed by the loss of financial support from PDL.



 

8


Table of Contents

Relationship with PDL

From October 2013 to May 2017, PDL provided us debt financing under various credit agreements. We became a direct subsidiary of PDL as of May 11, 2017 when PDL acquired all of our outstanding equity in exchange for cancellation of PDL’s claims as a secured creditor in Chapter 11 bankruptcy proceedings. At that time, PDL also expanded the debtor-in-possession financing to a broader, secured, first priority $8.6 million term loan facility, or the Credit Agreement, to support our operations post-bankruptcy. The Credit Agreement was amended in April 2019 to increase the size of the term loan facility by an additional $17.0 million dollars, and it was further amended in April 2020 to increase the size of the term loan facility by an additional $7.0 million dollars. In July 2020, we issued PDL a total of 6,221,069 shares of our common stock in exchange for all amounts outstanding under the Credit Agreement and all then-outstanding shares of our mandatorily redeemable, par value $0.01 per share, preferred stock, or the Series A Preferred Stock, including any accrued and unpaid dividends thereon. In July 2020, we issued an additional 740,740 shares of our common stock to PDL in exchange for $8.0 million. In August 2020, we received cash of $29.0 million from PDL. We issued 746,767 shares of common stock to PDL in exchange for $8.3 million. The remaining $20.7 million was a cash contribution from PDL. After giving effect to the Spin-Off, we will be an independent, publicly traded company and PDL will not have continuing stock ownership in us. For more information on our relationship with PDL, see “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions.”

Additionally, in August 2020, we distributed 100% of our ownership interest in our wholly owned subsidiary, PDL Investment Holdings, LLC, or PDLIH, to PDL. PDLIH does not and did not hold any assets relating to our business.

Before the Spin-Off, we will enter into a Separation and Distribution Agreement and several other agreements with PDL and its subsidiaries related to the Spin-Off. In addition, PDL provides us with certain support functions, including information technology, and accounting and other financial and administrative functions. Some of these services will continue to be provided on an interim basis after the Spin-Off pursuant to the terms of a Transition Services Agreement, or the Transition Services Agreement, which is filed as an exhibit to the registration statement on Form 10 of which this information statement forms a part. For a description of the Separation and Distribution Agreement, Transition Services Agreement and other agreements we have entered or intend to enter into with PDL in connection with the Spin-Off, see “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions—Agreements between PDL and LENSAR Relating to the Spin-Off.” These agreements will govern the relationship between PDL and us after the completion of the Spin-Off.

Reasons for the Spin-Off

In September 2019, PDL management recommended to its board of directors that it undertake a strategic review of PDL. Upon completion of that review in December 2019, PDL’s board of directors determined to pursue a process to unlock value within PDL either by sale of PDL or monetization of its assets. Over the subsequent months, PDL’s board of directors and management analyzed, together with outside financial and legal advisors, how to best capture value and provide the best return to stockholders. As part of that process, on September 9, 2020, PDL’s board of directors approved a plan to spin LENSAR off from PDL as a publicly traded company.

PDL’s board of directors believes that spinning us off from PDL will provide us with financial, operational and managerial benefits, including, but not limited to, the following:

 

   

Strategic Focus. We and PDL are distinct, complex enterprises with different opportunities, challenges, strategies and means of doing business. We believe the Spin-Off will allow us to continue to implement corporate strategies that are designed for our ophthalmology business.

 

   

Focused Management. Separating us from PDL will allow our management to continue to allocate and focus resources on the implementation of product development and commercialization strategies that are key to our continued growth.



 

9


Table of Contents
   

Improved Management Incentive Tools. Offering equity of our publicly traded company as compensation tied directly to our performance will assist in attracting and retaining qualified employees, officers and directors.

 

   

Direct Access to Capital and Tailored Capital Structure. As a stand-alone company, we can better attract investors with the opportunity to invest solely in our surgical treatments for cataracts, which will enhance our ability to directly access the equity and debt capital markets to fund our growth strategy and to establish a capital structure tailored to our business needs.

 

   

Ability to Use Equity as Consideration for Acquisitions. The Spin-Off will provide us with enhanced flexibility to use our stock as consideration in pursuing certain financial and strategic objectives, including mergers and acquisitions involving other companies or businesses engaged in ophthalmology. We believe that we will be able to more easily facilitate future strategic transactions with businesses in ophthalmology through the use of our stand-alone stock as consideration.

PDL’s board of directors also considered a number of potentially negative factors in evaluating the Spin-Off, including, in the case of both companies, increased operating costs, disruptions to the businesses as a result of planning for the Spin-Off and the Spin-Off itself, the risk of being unable to achieve expected benefits from the Spin-Off, the risk of being unable to successfully complete operational transfers, the risk that the Spin-Off might not be completed, the initial costs of the Spin-Off and the risk that the common stock of one or both companies may come under initial selling pressure if investors are not interested in holding an investment in one or both businesses following the Spin-Off. Notwithstanding these potentially negative factors, however, PDL’s board of directors determined that the Spin-Off was the best alternative to enhance stockholder value taking into account the factors discussed above. For more information, see the sections entitled “Risk Factors” and “The Spin-Off” included elsewhere in this information statement.

Corporate Information

We were incorporated in the State of Delaware on August 20, 2004 and are a direct, majority-owned subsidiary of PDL. After giving effect to the Spin-Off, we will be an independent, publicly traded company. Our principal executive office is located at 2800 Discovery Drive, Orlando, FL 32826, and our telephone number is (888) 536-7271. Our website is www.lensar.com. Information contained on, or connected to, our website or PDL’s website does not and will not constitute part of this information statement or the registration statement on Form 10 of which this information statement is a part.

Implications of being an Emerging Growth Company and a Smaller Reporting Company

We qualify as an “emerging growth company” as defined in Section 2(a) of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, or the Securities Act, as modified by the Jumpstart Our Business Startups Act of 2012, or the JOBS Act. As an emerging growth company, we may take advantage of specified reduced disclosure and other requirements that are otherwise applicable, in general, to public companies that are not emerging growth companies. These provisions include:

 

   

not being required to comply with the auditor attestation requirements of Section 404(b) of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002;

 

   

an exemption from compliance with the requirements of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board regarding the communication of critical audit matters in the auditor’s report on the financial statements;

 

   

reduced disclosure obligations regarding executive compensation in our periodic reports, proxy statements and registration statements; and



 

10


Table of Contents
   

exemptions from the requirements of holding a nonbinding advisory vote on executive compensation and stockholder approval of any golden parachute payments not previously approved.

We will remain an emerging growth company until the earliest to occur of: (i) the last day of the first fiscal year in which our annual gross revenue exceeds $1.07 billion; (ii) the date that we become a “large accelerated filer” as defined in Rule 12b-2 under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, or the Exchange Act, which would occur if the market value of our common stock that is held by non-affiliates exceeds $700 million as of the last business day of our most recently completed second fiscal quarter; (iii) the date on which we have issued, in any three-year period, more than $1.0 billion in non-convertible debt securities; and (iv) the last day of the fiscal year ending after the fifth anniversary of the completion of the Spin-Off.

We have elected to take advantage of certain of the reduced disclosure obligations in this information statement and may elect to take advantage of other reduced reporting requirements in future filings. As a result, the information that we provide may be different than the information you receive from other public companies in which you hold stock.

Emerging growth companies can also take advantage of the extended transition period for complying with new or revised accounting standards. In other words, an emerging growth company can delay the adoption of certain accounting standards until those standards would otherwise apply to private companies and as a result, may not comply with new or revised accounting standards on the relevant dates on which adoption of such standards is required for non-emerging growth companies. We have elected to take advantage of this extended transition period and, as a result, our operating results and financial statements may not be comparable to the operating results and financial statements of companies who have adopted the new or revised accounting standards.

As a result of these elections, we do not know if some investors will find our common stock less attractive. The result may be a less active trading market for our common stock, and the price of our common stock may become more volatile.

We are also a “smaller reporting company” as defined in the Exchange Act. We may continue to be a smaller reporting company even after we are no longer an emerging growth company. We may take advantage of certain of the scaled disclosures available to smaller reporting companies and will be able to take advantage of these scaled disclosures for so long as our voting and non-voting common stock held by non-affiliates is less than $250.0 million measured on the last business day of our second fiscal quarter, or our annual revenue is less than $100.0 million during the most recently completed fiscal year and our voting and non-voting common stock held by non-affiliates is less than $700.0 million measured on the last business day of our second fiscal quarter.



 

11


Table of Contents

SUMMARY OF THE SPIN-OFF

 

Distributing company

PDL BioPharma, Inc., a Delaware corporation. After the Distribution, PDL will not own, directly or beneficially, any shares of our capital stock and will continue to own and operate its other businesses.

 

Distributed company

LENSAR, Inc., a Delaware corporation and currently a direct, majority-owned subsidiary of PDL.

 

Primary purpose of the Spin-Off

The PDL board of directors believes that separating us from PDL will (i) allow us to continue to implement corporate strategies and initiatives based on our company’s specific business characteristics; (ii) facilitate focus of our management; (iii) enhance our ability to attract, retain, and properly incentivize key employees with equity-based compensation tied directly to our performance of the applicable company; (iv) provide us with direct and more efficient access to equity and debt capital markets; and (v) allow us to use our own public equity as acquisition currency, to make acquisitions.

 

Record Date

The Record Date for the Distribution is 5:00 p.m., Eastern Time, on September 22, 2020.

 

Distribution ratio

Each holder of PDL common stock as of the Record Date will receive a distribution of 0.075879 shares of our common stock for every one share of PDL common stock held on the Record Date. We expect that approximately 8.7 million shares of our common stock will be distributed in the Spin-Off, based on the number of shares of PDL common stock we expect to be outstanding on the Record Date.

 

Securities to be distributed

PDL will be distributing all of the shares of our common stock currently held by PDL, representing approximately 81.5% of our total issued and outstanding common stock. PDL stockholders will not be required to pay for the shares of our common stock to be received by them in the Distribution, or to surrender or exchange shares of PDL common stock in order to receive our common stock, or to take any other action in connection with the Distribution.

 

Fractional shares

Fractional shares of our common stock will not be distributed. Fractional shares of our common stock that would otherwise be distributed to PDL stockholders will be aggregated and sold in the public market by the transfer agent. The aggregate net proceeds of these sales will be distributed ratably as cash payments to the stockholders, who would otherwise have received fractional interests.

 

Treatment of stock-based awards

In connection with the Distribution, we currently expect that, subject to approval by the PDL board of directors, PDL’s outstanding equity-based compensation awards will generally be treated as follows: Each outstanding PDL stock option to purchase shares of PDL common stock on the Distribution Date will remain a stock



 

12


Table of Contents
 

option to purchase shares of PDL common stock, subject to the terms of the original stock option, but the exercise price and the number of shares subject to the stock option will be adjusted using a formula designed to generally preserve the intrinsic value and fair value of the original stock option immediately prior to the Distribution Date. Each adjusted PDL stock option will continue to vest on its existing terms and conditions.

 

Distribution date

The Distribution date is October 1, 2020.

 

The Spin-Off

On the Distribution date, PDL will release all of the shares of our common stock to the transfer agent to distribute to PDL stockholders as of the Record Date. The distribution of shares will be made in book-entry form. It is expected that it will take the transfer agent up to ten days to electronically issue shares of our common stock to you or your bank or brokerage firm on your behalf by way of direct registration in book-entry form. However, your ability to trade the shares of our common stock received in the Distribution will not be affected during this time. You will not be required to make any payment, surrender or exchange your shares of PDL common stock or take any other action to receive your shares of our common stock.

 

Trading market and symbol

There is not currently a public market for our common stock. We have applied to list our common stock on the Nasdaq Capital Market under the ticker symbol “LNSR.” We anticipate that, shortly prior to the Record Date for the Distribution, trading of our common stock will begin on a “when-issued” basis and will continue up to and including the Distribution date. On the first trading day following the Distribution date, when-issued trading in respect of our common stock will end and regular-way trading will begin. See “The Spin-Off—Manner of Effecting the Spin-Off.”

 

Dividend Policy

Holders of shares of our common stock are entitled to receive dividends when, or if, declared by our board of directors out of funds legally available for that purpose. We currently do not anticipate paying any cash dividends in the foreseeable future. See “Dividend Policy.”

 

Tax consequences to PDL stockholders

The Distribution is intended to be treated as part of a liquidating distribution by PDL. In accordance with such treatment, in the case of a U.S. Holder (as defined in “Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences of the Distribution”), an amount equal to the fair market value of our common stock (together with any other property distributed as part of the liquidating distribution) received by you will be treated as received in exchange for your shares of PDL common stock and will first be applied against and reduce your basis in such shares of PDL common stock, but not below zero. Any remaining amount in excess of your basis in such shares of PDL common stock will be treated as capital gain. For a more detailed discussion, see



 

13


Table of Contents
 

“Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences of the Distribution.” You should consult your tax advisor as to the particular tax consequences of the Distribution to you, including the applicability of any U.S. federal, state, local and non-U.S. tax laws.

 

Relationship with PDL after the Spin-Off

Following the Distribution, we will be a public company and PDL will have no continuing stock ownership interest in us. We will enter into the Separation and Distribution Agreement and other agreements with PDL related to the Spin-Off. These agreements will govern the relationship between PDL and us after the completion of the Spin-Off. The Separation and Distribution Agreement will set forth our agreement with PDL regarding the principal transactions necessary to separate us from PDL, as well as other agreements that govern certain aspects of our relationship with PDL after the completion of the Spin-Off. We will enter into the Transition Services Agreement with PDL pursuant to which PDL will provide to us certain functions on an interim basis following the Distribution. Further, we will enter into a Tax Matters Agreement (the “Tax Matters Agreement”) with PDL that will govern the respective rights, responsibilities and obligations of PDL and us after the Spin-Off with respect to taxes, tax attributes, the preparation and filing of tax returns, the control of tax audits and other tax proceedings and assistance and cooperation in respect of tax matters. We describe these arrangements in greater detail under “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions—Agreements between PDL and LENSAR Relating to the Spin-Off” and describe some of the risks of these arrangements under “Risk Factors—Risks Related to the Spin-Off.”

 

Transfer Agent and Registrar

Computershare Trust Company, N.A. will be the transfer agent and registrar for the shares of our common stock.

 

Risk factors

You should carefully consider the matters discussed under the section entitled “Risk Factors” in this information statement.

Unless otherwise indicated, all figures in this information statement reflect a one-for-nine reverse stock split of our common stock, which became effective as of September 10, 2020.



 

14


Table of Contents

SUMMARY HISTORICAL FINANCIAL DATA

The following table sets forth our summary historical financial information for the periods indicated below. The statements of operations data for the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018 and the balance sheet data as of December 31, 2019 is derived from our audited financial statements which are included elsewhere in this information statement. The statements of operations data for the six months ended June 30, 2020 and 2019 and the balance sheet data as of June 30, 2020 is derived from our unaudited condensed interim financial statements which are included elsewhere in this information statement. The unaudited condensed interim financial statements were prepared on a basis consistent with our audited financial statements and include, in management’s opinion, all adjustments, consisting only of normal recurring adjustments that we consider necessary for a fair statement of the financial information set forth in those statements. These financial statements exclude the assets, liabilities, revenue and expenses directly attributable to our wholly owned subsidiary, PDLIH, which was distributed to PDL in August 2020.

Our historical financial statements include certain expenses of PDL that were allocated to us for certain corporate functions, such as administration and organizational oversight, including employee benefits, finance and accounting, treasury and risk management, and professional and legal services, among others. These allocations may not be reflective of the expenses that would have been incurred had we operated as a separate, unaffiliated entity apart from PDL, or future costs we will incur as an independent, publicly traded company. In addition, our historical financial statements do not reflect changes that we expect to experience in the future as a result of the Spin-Off, including changes in our cost structure, personnel needs, tax structure, financing and business operations. Consequently, the historical financial information included here may not necessarily reflect our financial position and results of operations or what our financial position and results of operations would have been had we been an independent, publicly traded company during the periods presented.

The pro forma statement of operations data for the year ended December 31, 2019 and the six months ended June 30, 2020 and the pro forma balance sheet data as of June 30, 2020 have been derived from the unaudited condensed pro forma financial statements included elsewhere in the information statement. The unaudited pro forma statements of operations have been prepared to give effect to the Spin-Off and related transactions as if they had occurred or had become effective as of January 1, 2019. The unaudited pro forma balance sheet has been prepared to give effect to the Spin-Off and related transactions as though the Spin-Off and related transactions had occurred on June 30, 2020.

The unaudited pro forma financial information is not necessarily indicative of our results of operations or financial condition had the distribution and our anticipated post-separation capital structure been completed on the dates assumed. It may not reflect the results of operations or financial condition that would have resulted had we been operating as an independent, publicly traded company during such period.



 

15


Table of Contents

The summary historical and unaudited pro forma financial information should be read in conjunction with the discussion in “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations”, “Unaudited Condensed Pro Forma Financial Information” and the financial statements and corresponding notes included elsewhere in this information statement. The historical and pro forma financial information are not necessarily indicative of the results to be expected in the future and our operating results, actual and pro forma, for the six months ended June 30, 2020 are not necessarily indicative of the results that may be expected for the full year ending December 31, 2020.

 

                            Pro Forma(1)     Pro Forma(1)  
    Year ended
December 31,
    Six Months Ended
June 30,
    Year ended
December 31,
    Six Months Ended
June 30,
 
($ in thousands, except share and per
share data)
  2019     2018     2020     2019     2019     2020  

Total revenue

  $ 30,528     $ 24,388     $ 10,953     $ 14,000     $ 30,528     $ 10,953  

Total cost of revenue

    17,299       13,640       5,439       8,711       17,908       5,541  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Selling, general and administrative expenses

    17,147       16,143       8,820       8,314       26,758       10,269  

Research and development expenses

    7,569       2,784       3,005       1,828       8,692       3,192  

Amortization of intangible assets

    1,227       1,137       631       593       1,227       631  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating loss

    (12,714     (9,316     (6,942     (5,446     (24,057     (8,680

Interest expense

    (2,001     (3,321     (1,275     (953            

Other income, net

    58       64       34       28       58       34  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loss before income taxes

    (14,657     (12,573     (8,183     (6,371     (23,999     (8,646

Income tax expense

          20                          
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loss

  $ (14,657   $ (12,593   $ (8,183   $ (6,371   $ (23,999   $ (8,646
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cumulative dividends in excess of interest expense on Series A Preferred Stock

          (1,451                        
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loss attributable to common stockholders

  $ (14,657     (14,044   $ (8,183   $ (6,371   $ (23,999   $ (8,646
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loss per share attributable to common stockholders, basic and diluted(2)

  $ (13.70     (13.13   $ (7.65   $ (5.95   $ (2.62   $ (0.91
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Weighted-average number of shares outstanding used to compute net loss per share attributable to common stockholders, basic and diluted(2)

    1,070,000       1,070,000       1,070,000       1,070,000       9,143,990       9,509,403  
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

     Year Ended
December 31,
    Six Months Ended
June 30,
 
(in thousands)    2019     2018     2020     2019  

Non-GAAP financial measure(3)

        

EBITDA(4)

   $ (8,848   $ (4,726   $ (5,503   $ (3,358
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 


 

16


Table of Contents
     As of     Pro Forma(1)  
($ in thousands)    December 31,
2019
    June 30,
2020
    as of
June 30, 2020
 

Total current assets

   $ 17,183     $ 20,844     $ 57,844  

Total assets

   $ 34,536     $ 38,021     $ 75,021  

Total liabilities

   $ 65,089     $ 74,296     $ 6,482  

Total stockholders’ equity (deficit)

   $ (30,553   $ (36,275   $ 68,539  

 

(1)

Gives pro forma effect to the Pro Forma Transactions (as defined herein), including the impact of (i) the Recapitalization Transactions (as described in the notes to the unaudited condensed pro forma financial statements included in this information statement), (ii) the contribution of $37.0 million in cash from PDL to us in exchange for an additional number of shares of our common stock, (iii) the new grants under the 2020 Plan (as defined herein) and (iv) the Spin-Off. See the section of this information statement titled “Unaudited Condensed Pro Forma Financial Statements” for pro forma adjustments reflected and related methodologies applied in deriving LENSAR’s unaudited pro forma statements of operations and balance sheet.

(2)

See Note 15 to our audited financial statements and Note 17 to our unaudited condensed interim financial statements included elsewhere in this information statement for an explanation of the calculations of our historical net loss per share attributable to common stockholders, basic and diluted.

(3)

See the definition in “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Non-GAAP Financial Measure.”

(4)

We calculate EBITDA, for a particular period, as net income before interest expense, income tax expense, interest income, depreciation and amortization of intangible assets.

EBITDA is being presented in addition to, and not as a substitute or superior to, measures of financial performance prepared in accordance with GAAP. We believe that presenting EBITDA provides useful supplemental information to investors about us that is useful in understanding and evaluating our operating results, enhancing the overall understanding of our past performance and future prospects, and allowing for greater transparency with respect to key financial metrics used by our management in financial and operational-decision making. In addition, this measure is frequently used by analysts, investors and other interested parties to evaluate and assess performance. This measure has certain limitations in that it does not include the impact of certain expenses that are reflected in our statement of operations that are necessary to run our business. Other companies, including other companies in our industry, may not use such measures or may calculate the measures differently than as presented in this information statement, limiting their usefulness as comparative measures.

The non-GAAP information in this information statement should be read in conjunction with, and not as substitutes for, or in isolation from, our audited financial statements and accompanying notes included elsewhere in this information statement.



 

17


Table of Contents

The following table reconciles EBITDA to the most directly comparable GAAP financial performance measure, which is net loss:

 

     Year Ended
December 31,
     Six Months Ended
June 30,
 
     2019      2018      2020      2019  

(in thousands)

           

Net loss

   $ (14,657    $ (12,593    $ (8,183    $ (6,371

Income tax expense

     —          20        —          —    

Interest income(a)

     (58      (64      (34      (28

Interest expense

     2,001        3,321        1,275        953  

Depreciation

     2,639        3,453        808        1,495  

Amortization of intangible assets

     1,227        1,137        631        593  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

EBITDA

   $ (8,848    $ (4,726    $ (5,503    $ (3,358
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(a)

Presented as “Other income, net” in our audited annual and unaudited condensed interim statements and corresponding notes included elsewhere in this information statement.



 

18


Table of Contents

QUESTIONS AND ANSWERS ABOUT THE SEPARATION AND DISTRIBUTION

Set forth below are commonly asked questions and answers about the Spin-Off and the transactions contemplated thereby. You should read the section entitled “The Spin-Off” elsewhere in this information statement for a more detailed description of the matters described below.

 

Q:

Why am I receiving this document?

 

A:

PDL is delivering this document to you because you were a holder of PDL common stock on the Record Date for the distribution of shares of our common stock. Accordingly, you are entitled to receive 0.075879 shares of our common stock for every one share of PDL common stock that you held on the Record Date.

No action is required for you to participate in the Distribution.

 

Q:

What is LENSAR?

 

A:

We are currently a direct, majority-owned subsidiary of PDL whose shares will be distributed to PDL stockholders if the Spin-Off is completed. We are a commercial-stage medical device company focused on designing, developing and marketing an advanced femtosecond laser system for the treatment of cataracts and the management of pre-existing or surgically induced corneal astigmatism. Upon completion of the Spin-Off, we will be a public company and will own and operate the femtosecond laser assisted cataract surgery business that was formerly part of PDL.

 

Q:

What is the Spin-Off?

 

A:

The Spin-Off is the transaction of separating us from PDL, creating two separate, publicly traded companies, which will be accomplished by distributing our common stock held by PDL pro rata to holders of PDL common stock. If all conditions to the effectiveness of the Spin-Off are met (or waived by the PDL board of directors in its sole discretion), then, on the Distribution date, all of the outstanding shares of our common stock held by PDL will be distributed to the holders of PDL common stock as of the Record Date. A holder of PDL common stock as of the Record Date for the Distribution will be entitled to receive 0.075879 shares of our common stock for every one share of PDL common stock held by such holder. Following the Spin-Off, PDL will no longer hold any of our outstanding capital stock and we will be an independent, publicly traded company with separate management and a separate board of directors. We have applied to list our common stock on the Nasdaq Capital Market under the symbol “LNSR.”

 

Q:

How does my ownership in PDL change as a result of the Distribution?

 

A:

The number of shares of PDL common stock that you own will not change as a direct result of the Distribution.

 

Q:

Why is the Spin-Off structured as a distribution?

 

A:

PDL believes that a distribution of shares of our common stock to the PDL stockholders is a way to separate the femtosecond laser assisted cataract surgery business from its other businesses in a manner that is intended to enhance long-term value for PDL stockholders.

 

Q:

What are the material U.S. federal income tax consequences to me of the Distribution?

 

A:

The Distribution is intended to be treated as part of a liquidating distribution by PDL. In accordance with such treatment, in the case of a U.S. Holder (as defined in “Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences of the Distribution”), an amount equal to the fair market value of our common stock (together with any



 

19


Table of Contents
  other property distributed as part of the liquidating distribution) received by you will be treated as received in exchange for your shares of PDL common stock and will first be applied against and reduce your basis in such shares of PDL common stock, but not below zero. Any remaining amount in excess of your basis in such shares of PDL common stock will be treated as capital gain. For a more detailed discussion, see “Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences of the Distribution.” You should consult your tax advisor as to the particular tax consequences of the Distribution to you, including the applicability of any U.S. federal, state, local and non-U.S. tax laws.

 

Q:

How will the Distribution affect my tax basis and holding period in shares of PDL common stock?

 

A:

Your tax basis in shares of PDL common stock held at the time of the Distribution will be reduced (but not below zero) to the extent of the fair market value of our shares distributed to you by PDL in the Distribution. Your holding period for such shares of PDL common stock will not be affected by the Distribution. See “Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences of the Distribution.” You should consult your tax advisor as to the particular tax consequences of the Distribution to you, including the applicability of any U.S. federal, state, local and non-U.S. tax laws.

 

Q:

What will my tax basis and holding period be for LENSAR common stock that I receive in the Distribution?

 

A:

Your tax basis in our common stock received in the Distribution generally will equal the fair market value of such shares on the Distribution date. Your holding period for such shares will begin the day after the Distribution date. See “Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences of the Distribution.” You should consult your tax advisor as to the particular tax consequences of the Distribution to you, including the applicability of any U.S. federal, state, local and non-U.S. tax laws.

 

Q:

What will I receive in the Spin-Off?

 

A:

A holder of PDL common stock as of the Record Date established for the Distribution will be entitled to receive 0.075879 shares of our common stock for every one share of PDL common stock held by such holder. The person in whose name the shares of PDL common stock are registered at the close of business on the Record Date is the person to whom shares of our common stock will be issued in the Distribution. For a more detailed description, see “The Spin-Off.”

 

Q:

What is being distributed in the Spin-Off?

 

A:

Approximately 8.7 million shares of our common stock will be distributed in the Spin-Off, based on the number of shares of PDL common stock we expect to be outstanding as of the Record Date. The shares of our common stock to be distributed by PDL constitute all of the issued and outstanding shares of our common stock held by PDL immediately prior to the Distribution, representing approximately 81.5% of our total issued and outstanding common stock. For more information on the shares being distributed in the Spin-Off, see “Description of LENSAR Capital Stock—Common Stock.”

 

Q:

Will I receive physical certificates representing shares of LENSAR common stock following the Distribution?

 

A:

No. In the Distribution, stockholders will not receive any physical certificates representing shares of our common stock. Instead, PDL, with the assistance of Computershare Trust Company, N.A., our transfer agent, will electronically distribute shares of our common stock either to you by way of direct registration in book-entry form or on your behalf in street name through your bank or brokerage firm. We expect that it will take the transfer agent, acting on behalf of PDL, up to ten days after the Distribution date to fully



 

20


Table of Contents
  distribute the shares of our common stock to PDL stockholders. Computershare Trust Company, N.A. will mail you a book-entry account statement that reflects your shares of our common stock, or your bank or brokerage firm will credit your account for the shares.

 

Q:

How will fractional shares be treated in the Distribution?

 

A:

We will not distribute fractional shares of our common stock. Fractional shares of our common stock that would otherwise be distributed to PDL stockholders will be aggregated and sold in the public market by the transfer agent. The aggregate net proceeds of these sales will be distributed ratably as cash payments to the stockholders who would otherwise have received fractional interests. See “The Spin-Off—Manner of Effecting the Spin-Off” for an explanation of how the cash payments will be determined and “Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences of the Distribution” for a discussion of the tax consequences of receiving cash in lieu of fractional shares.

 

Q:

What if I want to sell my PDL common stock or my LENSAR common stock?

 

A:

Neither PDL nor LENSAR makes any recommendations on the purchase, retention or sale of shares of PDL common stock or the shares of LENSAR common stock to be distributed. You should consult with your financial advisors, such as your stockbroker, bank or tax advisor.

If you sell your PDL common stock prior to the Record Date or sell your entitlement to receive shares of LENSAR common stock in the Distribution on or prior to the Distribution date, you will not receive any shares of LENSAR common stock in the Distribution. If you decide to sell any shares of PDL common stock after the Record Date, but before the Distribution date, you should make sure your stockbroker, bank or other nominee understands whether you want to sell your PDL common stock, the LENSAR common stock you will be entitled to receive in the Distribution, or both.

 

Q:

On what date did the PDL Board of Directors approve the Spin-Off and declare the Distribution?

 

A:

The PDL board of directors approved the Spin-Off and declared the Distribution on September 9, 2020.

 

Q:

What is the Record Date for the Distribution?

 

A:

Record ownership will be determined as of 5:00 p.m., Eastern Time, on September 22, 2020, which we refer to as the Record Date.

 

Q:

When will the Spin-Off be completed?

 

A:

The date for the Distribution, which is the date on which PDL will distribute shares of our common stock, is expected to be October 1, 2020. The Spin-Off will be completed pursuant to the terms of the Separation and Distribution Agreement between us and PDL. We expect that it will take the transfer agent, acting on behalf of PDL, up to ten days after the Distribution date to fully distribute shares of our common stock to PDL stockholders, which will be accomplished by directly issuing shares in book-entry form or by crediting your account at your bank or brokerage firm. However, your ability to trade our common stock received in the Distribution will not be affected during this time. It is also possible that factors outside of our control, or a decision by PDL to terminate the Separation and Distribution Agreement pursuant to its terms, could require us to complete the Spin-Off at a later time or not at all. See “The Spin-Off.”

 

Q:

What do I have to do to participate in the Distribution?

 

A:

Nothing. No action will be required of PDL stockholders to receive shares of LENSAR common stock, which means that (i) PDL is not asking you for a proxy, and you should not send a proxy; (ii) you will not



 

21


Table of Contents
  be required to pay for the shares of LENSAR common stock that you receive in the Distribution; and (iii) you do not need to surrender or exchange any shares of PDL common stock in order to receive shares of LENSAR common stock, or take any other action in connection with the Spin-Off.

 

Q:

Can PDL decide not to complete the Spin-Off?

 

A:

Yes. PDL’s board of directors reserves the right, in its sole discretion, to amend, modify or abandon the Spin-Off and related transactions at any time prior to the Distribution date. In addition, the Spin-Off is subject to the satisfaction or waiver of certain conditions. See “The Spin-Off—Conditions to the Spin-Off.” If PDL’s board of directors amends, modifies or abandons the Spin-Off, PDL intends to promptly issue a press release and file a Current Report on Form 8-K to report such event.

 

Q:

Is the completion of the Spin-Off subject to any conditions?

 

A:

The Spin-Off is subject to a number of conditions set forth in the Separation and Distribution Agreement, including, among others: (i) approval of the Transactions (as defined in the Separation and Distribution Agreement), including the Spin-Off, and declaration of the Distribution by PDL’s board of directors; (ii) the SEC declaring effective the registration statement on Form 10 of which this information statement forms a part; (iii) us mailing the information statement to the holders of record of PDL common stock at the close of business on the record date; (iv) all other actions and filings necessary and appropriate under applicable federal or state securities laws and state blue sky laws; (v) the approval of our common stock for listing, subject to official notice of issuance; (vi) the execution and delivery of the ancillary agreements; (vii) the receipt of any material governmental authorizations necessary to consummate the Transactions; and (viii) the effectiveness of our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws. Other than the conditions relating to the effectiveness of the registration statement and our mailing of the information statement, PDL’s board of directors may waive any of these conditions, in its sole discretion, prior to the Distribution date. To the extent that the PDL board of directors determines that any modifications by PDL, including any waivers of any conditions to the Spin-Off, materially change the terms of the Distribution, PDL will notify PDL stockholders in a manner reasonably calculated to inform them about the modifications as may be required by law, such as by publishing a press release, filing a current report on Form 8-K or circulating a supplement to this information statement. For a more detailed description, see “The Spin-Off—Conditions to the Spin-Off.”

 

Q:

Will LENSAR have a relationship with PDL following the Spin-Off?

 

A:

In connection with the Spin-Off, we will enter into the Separation and Distribution Agreement and other agreements with PDL that will govern the relationship between PDL and us after the completion of the Spin-Off. The Separation and Distribution Agreement will set forth our agreement with PDL regarding the principal transactions necessary to separate us from PDL and will provide that on the Distribution date, PDL will distribute to its stockholders 0.075879 shares of our common stock for every one share of PDL common stock held by PDL stockholders as of the Record Date. It will also provide, among other things: (i) that each party shall use commercially reasonable efforts to remove the other party and its subsidiaries and affiliates as guarantor or obligor of any of the first party’s obligations or liabilities; (ii) for the settlement or extinguishment of certain liabilities and other obligations between us and our subsidiaries, or the LENSAR Entities, and PDL and its subsidiaries and affiliates (other than us and our subsidiaries), or the PDL Entities; (iii) provisions pursuant to which each of LENSAR and PDL will release and indemnify and hold harmless the other against any claims that arise out of or relate to (x) the management of the releasing party’s respective business and affairs prior to the Distribution date, (y) the releasing party’s breach of the Separation and Distribution Agreement, or with respect to all information contained in this registration statement or the information statement (other than information regarding any PDL entity provided by any PDL entity in writing to us expressly for inclusion in the registration statement or this information statement), any untrue statement or



 

22


Table of Contents
  alleged untrue statement of a material fact or omission or alleged omission to state a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to make the statements therein not misleading.

We will also enter into the Transition Services Agreement with PDL pursuant to which PDL will provide to us certain support functions, primarily with respect to accounting and other financial functions following the Spin-Off.

Prior to consummation of the Spin-Off, we will also enter into the Tax Matters Agreement and other ancillary agreements with PDL.

For a more detailed discussion of each of the agreements we will enter into with PDL in connection with the Spin-Off, see “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions—Agreements between PDL and LENSAR Relating to the Spin-Off.”

 

Q:

How will PDL equity compensation awards be affected as a result of the Spin-Off?

 

A:

In connection with the Distribution, we currently expect that, subject to approval by the PDL board of directors, PDL’s outstanding equity-based compensation awards will generally be treated as follows:

Each outstanding PDL stock option to purchase shares of PDL common stock on the Distribution Date will remain a stock option to purchase shares of PDL common stock, subject to the terms of the original stock option, but the exercise price and the number of shares subject to the stock option will be adjusted using a formula designed to generally preserve the intrinsic value and fair value of the original stock option immediately prior to the Distribution Date. Each adjusted PDL stock option will continue to vest on its existing terms and conditions. For additional information, see “The Spin-Off—Treatment of PDL Equity Awards.”

 

Q:

Will the LENSAR common stock be listed on a stock exchange?

 

A:

Yes. Although there is currently not a public market for our common stock, we have applied to list our common stock on the Nasdaq Capital Market under the symbol “LNSR.” We anticipate that trading of our common stock will commence on a “when-issued” basis shortly prior to the Record Date for the Distribution. “When-issued trading” refers to a sale or purchase made conditionally because the security has been authorized but not yet issued. When-issued trades generally settle within two trading days after the Distribution date. On the first trading day following the Distribution date, when-issued trading with respect to our common stock will end and “regular-way” trading will begin. “Regular-way trading” refers to normal trading transactions, which are settled by delivery of the securities against payment on the second business day after the transaction.

 

Q:

Will the Distribution affect the trading price of my PDL common stock?

 

A:

Yes, the trading price of PDL common stock is expected to change as a result of the Distribution because it will no longer reflect the value of our business. Moreover, the trading price of PDL common stock may fluctuate significantly depending upon a number of factors, some of which may be beyond PDL’s control. PDL’s board of directors believes that the Spin-Off offers its stockholders the greatest long-term value. That said, we cannot provide you with any guarantees as to the price at which the PDL common stock will trade following the Distribution. We also cannot assure you that following the Spin-Off the aggregate value of our common stock and PDL common stock will ever exceed the pre-Spin-Off value of PDL common stock.

 

Q:

What will happen to the listing of PDL common stock?

 

A:

It is expected that, after the Distribution of our common stock, PDL common stock will continue to be traded on the Nasdaq Stock Market under the symbol “PDLI.” The number of shares of PDL common stock you own will not change as a result of the Distribution alone.



 

23


Table of Contents
Q:

What are the anti-takeover effects of the Spin-Off?

 

A:

Some provisions of our amended and restated certificate of incorporation, our amended and restated bylaws and the Delaware General Corporation Law as amended, or the DGCL, may have the effect of making it more difficult for another company to acquire control of us in a transaction not approved by our board of directors. For example, our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws provide for a classified board, that directors can only be removed for cause, plurality voting in the election of directors, require advance notice for stockholder proposals and nominations, place limitations on convening stockholder meetings, authorize our board of directors to issue one or more series of preferred stock, allow our board of directors to fill all vacancies on the board of directors, permit our board of directors to amend the amended and restated bylaws without stockholder consent and require a 66-2/3% vote of stockholders, voting together as a single class, to amend our amended and restated bylaws and certain provisions of our amended and restated certificate of incorporation. See “Risk Factors—Risks Related to Owning Our Common Stock—Certain provisions in our charter documents and Delaware law could discourage takeover attempts and lead to management entrenchment and, therefore, may depress the trading price of our common stock” for more information.

 

Q:

Do I have dissenters’ rights or appraisal rights in connection with the Spin-Off?

 

A:

No. Holders of PDL common stock are not entitled to dissenters’ rights or appraisal rights in connection with the Distribution.

 

Q:

Who is the transfer agent for LENSAR shares?

 

A:

Computershare Trust Company, N.A.

 

Q:

Are there any risks in connection with the Spin-Off that I should consider?

 

A:

Yes. There are certain risks associated with the Spin-Off. These risk factors are discussed in the section titled “Risk Factors.”

 

Q:

Where can I get more information?

 

A:

If you have any questions relating to the mechanics of the Distribution, you should contact the transfer agent at:

Computershare Trust Company, N.A.

P.O. Box 30170

College Station, TX 77842

Tel: 877-422-4271

Before the Spin-Off, if you have any questions relating to the Distribution, you should contact PDL at:

932 Southwood Boulevard

Incline Village, NV 89451

Attention: Investor Relations

Tel: 775-832-8500

After the Spin-Off, if you have any questions relating to LENSAR, you should contact us at:

2800 Discovery Drive

Orlando, FL 32826

Attention: Investor Relations

Tel: 888-536-7271



 

24


Table of Contents

RISK FACTORS

You should consider carefully the risks and uncertainties described below, together with all of the other information in this information statement, including our financial statements and related notes, in evaluating our common stock. If any of the following risks are realized, our business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects, as well as the price of our common stock could be materially and adversely affected.

Risks Related to Our Business

We expect to incur operating losses for the foreseeable future and we cannot assure you that we will be able to generate sufficient revenue to achieve or sustain profitability.

For the years ended December 31, 2018 and 2019, we had net losses of $12.6 million and $14.7 million, respectively, and for the six months ended June 30, 2019 and 2020, we had net losses of $6.4 million and $8.2 million, respectively. As of June 30, 2020, we had an accumulated deficit of $46.4 million. We expect to continue to incur losses for the foreseeable future as we continue to build our commercial and clinical infrastructure, pursue development and FDA clearance of our proprietary, next-generation, integrated workstation, known as ALLY, and invest in research and development. In addition, as a public company, we will incur significant legal, accounting and other expenses that we did not incur as a private company. We cannot assure you that we will ever generate sufficient revenue from our operations to achieve profitability, and even if we achieve profitability, we cannot be sure that we will remain profitable for any substantial period of time. Our failure to achieve or maintain profitability could negatively affect the value of our securities and our ability to raise capital and continue operations.

We principally derive our revenue from the sale or lease and use of our LENSAR Laser System, the associated procedure licenses and consumables used in each procedure and the commercial success of our LENSAR Laser System will largely depend upon our ability to maintain and grow significant market acceptance for it.

We principally derive our revenue from the sale or lease of our LENSAR Laser System and the associated procedure licenses and consumables used in each procedure involving our LENSAR Laser System, and expect that this will account for all of our revenue in the foreseeable future. Accordingly, our ability to increase revenue is highly dependent on our ability to market and sell or lease our LENSAR Laser System and market the associated consumables.

Our ability to maintain our market share, execute our growth strategy, achieve commercial success and become profitable will depend upon the adoption and continued acceptance of our LENSAR Laser System by surgeons, hospital outpatient surgical facilities, in-office surgical suites and ambulatory surgery centers, or ASCs. Our system is currently used in advanced cataract procedures for which surgeon reimbursement continues to decline and patients pay a significant portion of the cost of the procedure. We cannot predict the extent to which patients will continue to seek out these types of procedures. Further, we cannot predict if cataract surgeons will continue to use our LENSAR Laser System or how quickly cataract surgeons will accept any planned or future products we introduce and, if accepted, how frequently any such products will be used. Our current products may not maintain, and ALLY or other planned or future products we may develop or market may never gain, broad market acceptance among cataract surgeons and the medical community for the procedures in which they are designed to be used. Our ability to maintain and increase market acceptance of our products depends on a number of factors, including:

 

   

our ability to provide visual outcomes and economic data that show the safety, efficacy and cost effectiveness, including other patient benefits from, the use of our LENSAR Laser System or other future products;

 

   

acceptance by cataract surgeons and others in the medical community of our LENSAR Laser System;

 

25


Table of Contents
   

the potential and perceived advantages and disadvantages of our LENSAR Laser System as compared to competing products;

 

   

the willingness of patients to pay out-of-pocket for procedures in which our LENSAR Laser System or other future products is used but for which limited reimbursement by third-party payors, including government authorities, is available;

 

   

the effectiveness of our sales and marketing efforts, and of those of our international distributors;

 

   

the prevalence and severity of any complications associated with using our LENSAR Laser System;

 

   

the ease of use, reliability and convenience of our LENSAR Laser System relative to competing products;

 

   

competitive response and negative selling efforts from providers of competing products;

 

   

quality of outcomes for patients in procedures in which surgeons use our LENSAR Laser System;

 

   

the results of clinical trials and post-market clinical studies relating to the use of our LENSAR Laser System;

 

   

the technical leadership of our research and development teams;

 

   

the absence of third party blocking intellectual property;

 

   

our ability to introduce our products to the market with speed and on time with our projected timelines;

 

   

pricing pressure, including from larger, well-capitalized and product-diverse competitors, corporate-owned ASCs, group purchasing organizations, and government payors; and

 

   

the availability of coverage and adequate reimbursement for procedures using our LENSAR Laser System or other future products from third-party payors, including government authorities.

Failure to maintain or increase market acceptance would limit our ability to generate revenue and would have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Our long-term growth depends in part on our ability to enhance our LENSAR Laser System.

We are currently focused on developing ALLY. ALLY will take considerable time and resources to develop, and we may not be able to complete development, obtain FDA clearance to market and ultimately commercialize ALLY on a timely basis, or at all. Moreover, we are developing ALLY as a dual-function device that can perform both phacoemulsification and laser-assisted surgery, and if approved, its commercial success will depend significantly on physicians’ perception of the benefits of such a device and the extent to which government and other third-party payors cover and reimburse surgeons and other health care providers for procedures using ALLY. We are relying on a third party to develop and manufacture the phacoemulsification component of ALLY, and do not currently possess the internal resources or know-how to do so. Any adverse developments with that third-party supplier could in turn negatively impact our development of ALLY.

While we have engaged in market research to evaluate the interest in a dual-function device, the results of that research are based on a small population of cataract surgeons and may not be indicative of actual market interest. In addition, the success of ALLY or any other new product offering or product enhancements we pursue will depend on several factors, including our ability to:

 

   

properly identify and anticipate cataract surgeon and patient needs;

 

   

develop and introduce new products and product enhancements in a timely manner;

 

   

our ability to exclude competition based on our intellectual property rights;

 

   

avoid infringing upon the intellectual property rights of third-parties;

 

26


Table of Contents
   

demonstrate, if required, the safety and efficacy of new products with data from preclinical studies and clinical trials;

 

   

obtain the necessary regulatory clearances or approvals for expanded indications, new products or product modifications;

 

   

be fully FDA-compliant with manufacturing and marketing of new devices or modified products;

 

   

provide adequate training to potential users of these products;

 

   

receive adequate coverage and reimbursement for procedures performed with ALLY or any other products we may develop in the future; and

 

   

develop an effective and dedicated sales and marketing team.

If we are not successful in expanding our product offering, our ability to increase our revenue may be impaired, which could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

COVID-19 and actions taken to control the spread of COVID-19 have had an adverse impact on our business, and we expect them to continue to do so.

The outbreak of a novel coronavirus, or COVID-19, has severely impacted global economic activity and caused significant volatility and negative pressure in financial markets. COVID-19 and actions taken to control the spread of COVID-19 have significantly impacted our business, and we expect them to continue to do so. For example, many jurisdictions have imposed, or in the future may impose, “shelter-in-place” orders, quarantines or similar orders or restrictions to control the spread of COVID-19 by restricting non-essential activities, including the suspension of elective surgeries and various business operations. These types of orders and restrictions have resulted in a significant decrease in the number of and demand for non-essential or elective medical procedures, including cataract surgeries, since the outbreak of the pandemic. Additionally, we have implemented remote working arrangements where possible for our employees and restricted business-related travel. The respective commercial teams of certain of the third parties that act as our distributors in international markets have chosen or have been forced to take similar action, and those or other distributors may choose or be forced to take similar action in the future. Neither we, nor our distributors have significant experience operating with the majority of our respective work forces working from home, and this may disrupt standard operations for us or them, the magnitude of which will depend, in part, on the length and severity of the restrictions and other limitations on our respective abilities to conduct business in the ordinary course. In addition, this may increase our cybersecurity risk, create data accessibility concerns and make us more susceptible to communication disruptions, any of which could adversely impact our business operations or delay necessary interactions with local and federal regulators, ethics committees, manufacturing sites, research or clinical trial sites and other important agencies and contractors. While the implementation of these measures has not required material expenditures to date, the suspension of non-essential medical services has significantly impacted our revenues and cash flows and has significantly impacted our ability to operate our commercial operations. Furthermore, these developments, including their long-term impact on our suppliers, may adversely affect our development of ALLY or, if such conditions persist, the commercial success of ALLY. For example, the COVID-19 pandemic has resulted in, and may continue to result in, historically high unemployment rates, which typically result in lower rates of private health insurance. Even if procedures in which our LENSAR Laser Systems are used are covered or reimbursable by third-party payors, patients may not have adequate insurance coverage or other discretionary income to pay for a procedure in which one of our LENSAR Laser Systems is used, which would in turn adversely impact our future revenue and results of operations.

The continued spread of COVID-19 has also led to extreme disruption and volatility in the global capital markets, which increases the cost of, and adversely impacts access to, capital and increases economic uncertainty. While we expect COVID-19 to continue to negatively impact our business, operations and revenue

 

27


Table of Contents

growth, given the rapid and evolving nature of the virus and the uncertainty about its impact on society and the global economy, we cannot predict with certainty the extent to which it will affect our operations, particularly if these impacts persist or worsen over an extended period of time. Furthermore, any similar pandemic, epidemic or outbreak of an infectious disease in the markets in which we operate or in which we sell or lease our LENSAR Laser Systems may adversely affect our business.

In addition to the COVID-19 disruptions adversely impacting our business and financial results, they may also have the effect of heightening many of the other risks described in “Risk Factors,” including risks relating to changes in consumer demand; our ability to maintain and grow significant market acceptance; our ability to enhance our LENSAR Laser System; our ability to grow our marketing team; patients’ and surgeons’ willingness and ability to pay for an advanced cataract procedure over a standard cataract procedure; our future capital needs; disruption in the long-term supply and manufacturing of our products by suppliers; increased credit risks associated with our customers; and regulatory restrictions.

Patients may not be willing to pay for the price difference between a standard cataract procedure and an advanced cataract procedure in which a laser system such as ours is used, an increment which is typically not covered by Medicare, private insurance or other third-party payors.

Payment for a standard cataract procedure is typically covered by Medicare, private insurance or other third-party payors. However, a cataract patient seeking a greater and more versatile visual outcome may desire an advanced cataract procedure involving a laser system such as ours. The patient is typically responsible for the additional costs associated with the use of these premium technologies in the physician’s practice, hospital outpatient surgical facilities, in-office surgical suites and ambulatory surgery centers. Due to this additional cost, patients may not elect to have such a procedure and our business may not grow as anticipated. Our future success depends in part upon patients achieving better visual outcomes from procedures using our LENSAR Laser System, or procedures involving similar laser systems that meets their expectations. If patients are not adequately satisfied with the results of such procedures, they or their surgeons may be less willing to recommend these procedures to other patients.

Additionally, weak or uncertain economic conditions, such as those that have resulted from the COVID-19 pandemic, may cause individuals to be less willing to pay for advanced cataract procedures. Although we anticipate use of ALLY in certain aspects of the standard cataract procedure will be covered by or reimbursable through government or other third-party payors, our current LENSAR Laser System procedures are not covered by or reimbursable through government or other third-party payors. A decline in economic conditions in the United States or in international markets could result in a decline in demand for the procedures in which our LENSAR Laser System is used and could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

If we are not able to effectively grow our U.S. sales and marketing organization, or maintain or grow an effective network of international distributors, our business prospects, results of operations and financial condition could be adversely affected.

In order to generate future sales growth within the United States, we will need to expand the size and geographic scope of our U.S. direct sales organization. Accordingly, our future success will depend largely on our ability to train, retain and motivate skilled regional sales managers and direct sales representatives with significant technical knowledge of our LENSAR Laser System. Because of the competition for their services, we may not be able to retain such representatives on favorable or commercially reasonable terms, if at all. If we are unable to grow our global sales and marketing organization within the United States, we may not be able to increase our revenue, which would adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Additionally, we rely exclusively on a network of independent distributors to generate sales and leases of our LENSAR Laser System as well as purchases of our consumables and licensed applications outside of the

 

28


Table of Contents

United States. For the year ended December 31, 2019, two customers accounted for 26% and 11% of our revenue. For the year ended December 31, 2018, two customers accounted for 12% each of our revenue. As of December 31, 2019 and 2018 one customer accounted for 25% and 15% of our accounts receivable, net, respectively. This customer concentration exposes us to a material adverse effect if either of these significant distributors were to significantly reduce purchases for any reason or favor competitors or new market participants. If a dispute arises with a distributor or if a distributor is terminated by us or goes out of business, it may take time to locate an alternative distributor, to seek appropriate regulatory approvals and to train new personnel to market our LENSAR Laser System, and our ability to sell those systems in the region formerly serviced by such terminated distributor could be harmed. In addition, our international distributors may be unable to successfully market and sell our products and may not devote sufficient time and resources to support the marketing, sales, education and training efforts that we believe are necessary to enable the products to develop, achieve or sustain market acceptance. Any of these factors could reduce our revenues from affected markets, increase our costs in those markets or damage our reputation. In addition, if an independent distributor were to depart and be retained by one of our competitors, we may be unable to prevent that distributor from helping competitors solicit business from our existing customers, which could further adversely affect us. As a result of our reliance on third-party distributors, we may be subject to disruptions and increased costs due to factors beyond our control, including labor strikes, third-party error and other issues. If the services of any of these third-party distributors become unsatisfactory, we may experience delays in meeting our customers’ demands and we may be unable to find a suitable replacement on a timely basis or on commercially reasonable terms. Any failure to deliver products in a timely manner may damage our reputation and could cause us to lose potential customers.

Our future capital needs are uncertain and we may need to raise additional funds in the future, and such funds may not be available on acceptable terms or at all.

Subject to the duration and extent of the impact of the ongoing COVID-19 pandemic, we expect our revenues and expenses to increase in connection with our on-going activities, particularly as we continue to execute on our growth strategy, including expansion of our sales and customer support teams. We also expect to incur additional costs as a stand-alone public company. The primary factors determining our cash needs are the funding of operations, which we expect to continue to expand as the business grows, and enhancing our product offerings through the research and development of our second generation laser system. Our future liquidity needs, and ability to address those needs, will largely be determined by the success of our commercial efforts and those of our distributors; the timing, scope and magnitude of our commercial and development activities; and the timing of regulatory clearance of ALLY. We also expect the impact of the ongoing COVID-19 pandemic will negatively affect our capital requirements and the availability of funds to finance those requirements outside of cash provided by PDL.

As of September 14, 2020, we expect our cash, together with cash generated from the sale of our products, to be sufficient to operate our business for at least the next 12 months. However, if these amounts are insufficient to satisfy our liquidity requirements, we may seek additional funds from public and private stock offerings, borrowings under credit facilities or other sources which we may not be able to maintain or obtain on acceptable or commercially reasonable terms, if at all. Our capital requirements will depend on many factors, including, but not limited to:

 

   

the revenue generated by the sale, lease or use of our LENSAR Laser Systems;

 

   

the costs associated with expanding our sales and marketing efforts;

 

   

the expenses we incur in procuring, manufacturing and selling our LENSAR Laser Systems;

 

   

the costs of researching, developing and commercializing ALLY or other new products or technologies;

 

   

the scope, rate of progress and cost of our clinical studies that we are currently conducting or may conduct in the future;

 

29


Table of Contents
   

the cost and timing of obtaining and maintaining regulatory approval or clearance of our products and planned or future products;

 

   

costs associated with any product recall that may occur;

 

   

the costs associated with complying with state, federal and international laws and regulations;

 

   

the cost of filing and prosecuting patent applications and defending and enforcing our patent and other intellectual property rights;

 

   

the cost of defending, in litigation or otherwise, any claims that we infringe third-party patent or other intellectual property rights;

 

   

the cost of enforcing or defending against non-competition claims;

 

   

the number and timing of acquisitions and other strategic transactions;

 

   

the costs associated with increased capital expenditures; and

 

   

anticipated and unanticipated general and administrative expenses, including expenses related to operating as a public company and insurance expenses.

Such capital may not be available on favorable terms, or at all. Furthermore, if we issue equity securities to raise additional capital, our existing stockholders may experience dilution, and the new equity securities may have rights, preferences and privileges senior to those of our existing stockholders. Debt financing, if available, may involve covenants restricting our operations or our ability to incur additional debt. Any debt financing or additional equity that we raise may contain terms that are not favorable to us or our stockholders. In addition, if we raise additional capital through collaboration, licensing or other similar arrangements, it may be necessary to relinquish valuable rights to our products, potential products or proprietary technologies, or grant licenses on terms that are not favorable to us. If we cannot raise capital on acceptable terms, we may not be able to develop or enhance our products, execute our business plan, take advantage of future opportunities or respond to competitive pressures, changes in our supplier relationships or unanticipated customer requirements. Any of these events could adversely affect our ability to achieve our business and financial goals or to achieve or maintain profitability, and could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

If the supply or manufacture of our LENSAR Laser System or other products is materially disrupted, it may adversely affect our ability to manufacture products and could negatively affect our operating results.

We manufacture both our LENSAR Laser System and provide the electronic license applications at our corporate headquarters in Orlando, Florida. This is also the location where we currently conduct substantially all of our research and development activities, customer and technical support, and management and administrative functions. If our facility suffers a crippling event, or a force majeure event such as an earthquake, fire, flood or temporary shutdown due to a pandemic, epidemic or infectious disease, this could materially impact our ability to operate.

We purchase custom and off-the-shelf components from a number of suppliers and subject them to stringent quality specifications and processes. Some of the components necessary for the assembly of our LENSAR Laser System and associated consumables are currently provided by single-sourced suppliers (the only approved supply source for us among other sources). We are also relying on a third party to develop and manufacture the phacoemulsification component of ALLY. If one or more of our suppliers cease to provide us with sufficient quantities of materials in a timely manner or on terms acceptable to us, we would have to seek alternative sources of supply. Because of factors such as the proprietary nature of our products, our quality control standards and regulatory requirements, we may experience delay in engaging additional or replacement suppliers for certain components. Despite our efforts to maintain an adequate supply of inventory, the long-term loss of these suppliers, or their long-term inability to provide us with an adequate supply of components or products, could

 

30


Table of Contents

potentially cause delay in the manufacture of our products, thereby impairing our ability to meet the demand of our customers and causing significant harm to our business. If it becomes necessary to identify and qualify a suitable second source to replace one of our key suppliers, that replacement supplier would not have access to our previous supplier’s proprietary processes and would therefore be required to develop its own, which could also result in delay. Any disruption of this nature or increased expense could harm our commercialization efforts and could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

We and some of our suppliers and contract facilities are required to comply with regulatory requirements of the U.S. Food and Drug Administration, or FDA. In particular, the FDA’s Quality System Regulation, or QSR, which includes FDA’s current Good Manufacturing Practice requirements, or cGMPs, covers the procedures and documentation of the design, testing, production, control, quality assurance, inspection, complaint handling, recordkeeping, management review, labeling, packaging, sterilization, storage and shipping of our device products. The FDA audits compliance with these regulatory requirements through periodic announced and unannounced inspections of manufacturing and other facilities. If our manufacturing facilities or those of any of our suppliers or contract facilities are found to be in violation of applicable laws and regulations, the FDA could take enforcement action. Additionally, in the event we must obtain a replacement supplier or contract facility, it may be difficult for us to identify and qualify a supplier or contract facility that complies with QSR and cGMPs, which would adversely impact our operations.

We compete and may compete in the future against other companies, some of which have longer operating histories, more established products or greater resources than we do.

Our industry is global, highly competitive and subject to rapid and profound technological, market and product-related changes. We face significant competition from large multinational medical device companies, as well as smaller, emerging players focused on product innovation.

Our primary competitors in providing surgical solutions for cataract patients are Alcon Inc.; Bausch + Lomb, a division of Bausch Health Companies Inc.; Johnson & Johnson; Carl Zeiss AG; and Zeimer. These competitors are focused on bringing new technologies to market and acquiring products and technologies that directly compete with our products or have potential product advantages that could render our products obsolete or noncompetitive.

Many of our current and potential competitors are large publicly traded companies or divisions of publicly-traded companies and have several competitive advantages, including:

 

   

greater financial and human resources for product development and sales and marketing;

 

   

significantly greater name recognition;

 

   

longer operating histories; and

 

   

more established sales and marketing programs and distribution networks.

In addition, many of our competitors have their own intraocular lens, or IOLs, while we do not, which could put us at a competitive disadvantage. If we are unable to compete effectively in this environment, it could adversely affect our business.

To successfully market, sell and lease our products in markets outside of the United States, we must address many international business risks with which we have limited experience.

We have historically sold and leased a significant portion of our LENSAR Laser Systems outside of the United States through a network of independent distributors and intend to increase our international presence in

 

31


Table of Contents

Germany, China and South Korea, as well as other international markets. Our international business operations are subject to a number of risks, including:

 

   

difficulties in staffing and managing our international operations;

 

   

increased competition as a result of more products and procedures receiving regulatory approval or otherwise free to market in international markets;

 

   

longer accounts receivable payment cycles and difficulties in collecting accounts receivable;

 

   

reduced or varied protection for intellectual property rights in some countries;

 

   

export restrictions, trade regulations, and foreign tax laws;

 

   

fluctuations in currency exchange rates;

 

   

foreign certification and regulatory clearance or approval requirements;

 

   

difficulties in developing effective marketing campaigns in unfamiliar foreign countries;

 

   

customs clearance and shipping delays;

 

   

political, social, and economic instability abroad, terrorist attacks, and security concerns in general;

 

   

preference for locally produced products;

 

   

potentially adverse tax consequences, including the complexities of foreign value-added tax systems, tax inefficiencies related to our corporate structure, and restrictions on the repatriation of earnings;

 

   

the burdens of complying with a wide variety of foreign laws and different legal standards; and

 

   

increased financial accounting and reporting burdens and complexities.

If one or more of these risks are realized, this could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

We are exposed to the credit risk of some of our customers, which could result in material losses.

Customers may lease our LENSAR Laser System or finance the laser through the product utilization, and we believe there has been an increase in demand for these types of customer leasing in recent years. We may experience loss from a customer’s failure to make payments according to the contractual lease terms or some other material decrease in the practice revenues and surgical procedure volume. Our exposure to the credit risks relating to our lease financing arrangements may increase if our customers are adversely affected by changes in healthcare laws, economic pressures or uncertainty, or other customer-specific factors. In addition, our credit risk may be highly concentrated, as we rely exclusively on a network of independent distributors to generate sales outside of the United States. Further, ongoing consolidation among distributors, retailers and healthcare provider organizations could increase the concentration of credit risk. The factors affecting our customers’ ability to make timely payments according to the contractual lease terms are out of our control, and as a result, exposes us to additional risks that may materially and adversely affect our business and results of operations. The occurrence of any such factors affecting our customers may cause delays in payments or, in some cases, defaults on payment obligations, which could result in material losses.

Although we have programs in place that are designed to monitor and mitigate the associated risk, there can be no assurance that such programs will be effective in reducing credit risks relating to these lease financing arrangements. If the level of credit losses we experience in the future exceed our expectations, such losses could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations or adversely affect our ability to sell such assets as part of our monetization strategy.

 

32


Table of Contents

We may be unable to accurately forecast customer demand and our inventory levels.

We generally do not maintain large volumes of finished goods and anticipating demand for our products may be challenging as cataract surgeon demand and adoption rates can be unpredictable. In addition, as use of our LENSAR Laser System is adopted by more cataract surgeons, we anticipate greater fluctuations in demand for our products, which makes demand forecasting more difficult. Our forecasts are based on management’s judgment and assumptions, each of which may introduce error into our estimates. if we underestimate customer demand or if insufficient manufacturing capacity is available, we would miss revenue opportunities and potentially lose market share and damage our customer relationships. Conversely, if we overestimate customer demand, our excess or obsolete inventory may increase significantly, which would reduce our gross margin and adversely affect our financial results.

Failure to secure adequate coverage or reimbursement by government or other third-party payors for procedures using ALLY or our other future products, or changes in current coverage or reimbursement, could materially impact our revenue and future growth.

Adequate coverage and reimbursement from third-party payors, including government programs such as Medicare and Medicaid, private insurance plans and managed care programs, for procedures using ALLY or other products we may develop in the future, if approved, is central to the acceptance and adoption of these products. Hospitals, healthcare facilities, physicians and other healthcare providers that may purchase and use ALLY generally rely on third-party payors to pay for all or part of the costs and fees associated with the procedures using ALLY. If third-party payors reduce their levels of payment, if our costs of production increase faster than increases in reimbursement levels or if third-party payors deny reimbursement for procedures using ALLY, ALLY may not be adopted or accepted by hospitals, healthcare facilities, physicians or other healthcare providers and the prices paid for a procedure using ALLY may decline, which could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations.

Physicians are reimbursed separately for their professional time and effort to perform a cataract procedure that is covered by third-party payors. Such party payors regularly update reimbursement amounts and also from time to time revise the methodologies used to determine reimbursement amounts. This includes routine updates to payments to physicians, hospitals and ambulatory surgery centers for procedures during which ALLY would be used. These updates could directly impact the demand for our future products. For example, the Medicare Access and CHIP Reauthorization Act of 2015, or MACRA, provided for a 0.5% annual increase in payment rates under the Medicare Physician Fee Schedule, or PFS, through 2019, but no annual update from 2020 through 2025. MACRA also introduced a Quality Payment Program for Medicare physicians, nurses and other “eligible clinicians” (as defined in MACRA) that adjusts overall reimbursement under the PFS based on certain performance categories. While MACRA applies only to Medicare reimbursement, Medicaid and private payors often follow Medicare payment limitations in setting their own reimbursement rates, and any reduction in Medicare reimbursement may result in a similar reduction in payments from private payors, which may result in reduced demand for ALLY or any other products we may develop in the future. However, there is no uniform policy of coverage and reimbursement among payors in the United States. Therefore, coverage and reimbursement for procedures can differ significantly from payor to payor. Many private payors require extensive documentation of a multi-step diagnosis before authorizing procedures using our products. Some private payors may apply their own coverage policies and criteria inconsistently, and physicians and other healthcare providers may not be able to receive approval and reimbursement for certain procedures using ALLY consistently. Any perception by physicians and other healthcare providers that the reimbursement for procedures using ALLY or other future products is inadequate to compensate them for the work required, including diagnosis, documentation, obtaining third-party payor approval for the procedure and other burdens on their office staff or that they may not be reimbursed at all for the procedures using ALLY or other future products, may negatively affect the adoption and use of ALLY or other future products and technologies, and the prices paid for such products may decline.

 

33


Table of Contents

The healthcare industry in the United States has experienced a trend toward cost containment as government and private insurers seek to control healthcare costs. Third-party payors are imposing lower payment rates and negotiating reduced contract rates with hospitals, other healthcare facilities, surgeons and other healthcare providers and being increasingly selective about the products, technologies and procedures they chose to cover and provide reimbursement for. Third-party payors may adopt policies in the future restricting access to products and technologies like ours or the procedures performed using such products. Therefore, we cannot be certain that any procedures performed with ALLY or other future products will be covered and reimbursed. There can be no guarantee that should we introduce new products and technologies, third-party payors will provide adequate coverage and reimbursement for those products or the procedures in which they are used. If third-party payors do not provide adequate coverage or reimbursement for such products, then our sales may be limited to circumstances where our products and procedures using our products are being largely or entirely self-paid by patients, as is currently the case with procedures using our current LENSAR Laser System.

Additionally, market acceptance of our products and technologies in foreign markets may depend, in part, upon the availability of coverage and reimbursement within prevailing healthcare payment systems. Reimbursement and healthcare payment systems in international markets vary significantly by country and include both government-sponsored healthcare and private insurance. We may not obtain additional international coverage and reimbursement approvals in a timely manner, if at all. Our failure to receive such approvals would negatively impact future market acceptance of ALLY or any of other products we may develop in the future in the international markets in which those approvals are sought.

We provide a limited warranty for our products.

We provide a limited warranty that our products are free of material defects and conform to specifications, and offer to repair, replace or refund the purchase price of defective products. As a result, we bear the risk of potential warranty claims on our products. In the event that we attempt to recover some or all of the expenses associated with a warranty claim against us from our suppliers or vendors, we may not be successful in claiming recovery under any warranty or indemnity provided to us by such suppliers or vendors and any recovery from such vendor or supplier may not be adequate. In addition, warranty claims brought by our customers related to third-party components may arise after our ability to bring corresponding warranty claims against such suppliers expires, which could result in costs to us.

Product liability suits brought against us could cause us to incur substantial liabilities, limit the selling or leasing of our existing products and interfere with commercialization of any products that we may develop.

If our product offerings are defectively designed or manufactured, contain defective materials, or are used or deployed improperly, or if someone alleges any of the foregoing, whether or not such claims are meritorious, we may become subject to substantial and costly litigation. Any product liability claims brought against us, with or without merit, could divert management’s attention from our business, be expensive to defend, result in sizable damage awards against us, damage our reputation, increase our product liability insurance rates, prevent us from securing continuing coverage, or prevent or interfere with commercialization of our products. In addition, we may not have sufficient insurance coverage for all future claims. Product liability claims brought against us in excess of our insurance coverage would likely be paid out of cash reserves, harming our financial condition and results of operations.

Our insurance policies are expensive and protect us only from some business risks, which leaves us exposed to significant uninsured liabilities.

We do not carry insurance for all categories of risk that our business may encounter. Although we carry product liability insurance in the United States, we can give no assurance that such coverage will be available or adequate to satisfy any claims. Product liability insurance is expensive, subject to significant deductibles and exclusions, and may not be available on acceptable terms, if at all. If we are unable to obtain or maintain

 

34


Table of Contents

insurance at an acceptable cost or on acceptable terms with adequate coverage or otherwise protect against potential product liability claims, we could be exposed to significant liabilities. A product liability claim, recall or other claim with respect to uninsured liabilities or for amounts in excess of insured liabilities could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations. Defending a suit, regardless of its merit or eventual outcome, could be costly, could divert management’s attention from our business and might result in adverse publicity, which could result in reduced acceptance of our products in the market, product recalls or market withdrawals.

We do not carry specific hazardous waste insurance coverage, and our insurance policies generally exclude coverage for damages and fines arising from hazardous waste exposure or contamination. Accordingly, in the event of contamination or injury, we could be held liable for damages or be penalized with fines in an amount exceeding our resources, and our clinical trials or regulatory approvals could be suspended.

We also expect that operating as a public company will make it more difficult and more expensive for us to obtain director and officer liability insurance, and we may be required to accept reduced policy limits and coverage or incur substantially higher costs to obtain the same or similar coverage. As a result, it may be more difficult for us to attract and retain qualified people to serve on our board of directors, our board committees or as executive officers. We do not know, however, if we will be able to maintain existing insurance with adequate levels of coverage. Any significant uninsured liability may require us to pay substantial amounts, which would negatively affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Our financial results may fluctuate significantly and may not fully reflect the underlying performance of our business.

Our quarterly and annual results of operations may vary significantly in the future, and period-to-period comparisons of our operating results may not be meaningful. Accordingly, the results of any one quarter or period should not be relied upon as an indication of future performance. Our quarterly and annual financial results may fluctuate as a result of a variety of factors, many of which are outside our control and, as a result, may not fully reflect the underlying performance of our business. For example, we have historically experienced seasonal variations in the selling or leasing of our products and procedures involving our products, with our fourth quarter typically being the strongest and the third quarter being the slowest. We believe these seasonal changes are consistent across our industry. Other factors that may cause fluctuations in our quarterly and annual results include:

 

   

fluctuations in the demand for the more advanced, patient-pay procedures in which our LENSAR Laser System is used;

 

   

adoption of our LENSAR Laser Systems;

 

   

our ability to establish and maintain an effective and dedicated sales organization in the United States and network of independent distributors outside the United States;

 

   

pricing pressure applicable to our products competitor pricing;

 

   

results of clinical research and trials on our products or competitive products;

 

   

the mix of sales and leases of our LENSAR Laser Systems;

 

   

timing of delivery of LENSAR Laser Systems, new product offerings, acquisitions, licenses or other significant events by us or our competitors;

 

   

decisions by surgeons, hospitals and ASCs to defer acquisitions of LENSAR Laser Systems in anticipation of the introduction of new products or product enhancements by us or our competitors;

 

   

sampling by and additional training requirements for cataract surgeons upon the commercialization of a new product by us or one of our competitors;

 

35


Table of Contents
   

regulatory approvals and legislative changes affecting the products we may offer or those of our competitors;

 

   

interruption in the manufacturing or distribution of our LENSAR Laser System;

 

   

delays in, or failure of, component and raw material deliveries by our suppliers;

 

   

the ability of our suppliers to timely provide us with an adequate supply of components;

 

   

the effect of competing technological, industry and market developments; and

 

   

changes in our ability to obtain regulatory clearance or approval for our LENSAR Laser System.

As a result, you should not rely on our results in any past period as an indication of future results and you should anticipate that fluctuations in our quarterly and annual operating results may continue and could generate volatility in the price of our common stock. Quarterly comparisons of our financial results should not be relied upon as an indication of our future performance.

If we fail to manage our anticipated growth effectively, or are unable to increase or maintain our manufacturing capacity, we may not be able to meet customer demand for our products and our business could suffer.

We have experienced significant period-to-period growth in our business, and we must continue to grow in order to meet our business and financial objectives. However, continued growth may create numerous challenges, including:

 

   

new and increased responsibilities for our management team;

 

   

increased pressure on our operating, financial and reporting systems;

 

   

increased pressure to anticipate and satisfy market demand;

 

   

additional manufacturing capacity requirements;

 

   

strain on our ability to source a larger supply of components that meet our required specifications on a timely basis;

 

   

management of an increasing number of relationships with our customers, suppliers and other third parties;

 

   

entry into new international territories with unfamiliar regulations and business approaches; and

 

   

the need to hire, train and manage additional qualified personnel.

Although we believe we have adequate capacity to meet our current business plans, there are uncertainties inherent in expanding our manufacturing capabilities, and we may not be able to sufficiently increase our capacity in a timely manner. For example, manufacturing and product quality issues may arise as we increase production rates at our manufacturing facility or launch new products. Also, we may not manufacture the right product mix to meet customer demand as we introduce new products. As a result, we may experience difficulties in meeting customer demand, in which case we could lose customers or be required to delay new product introductions, and demand for our products could decline. If we fail to manage any of the above challenges effectively, our business may be harmed.

If we choose to acquire new and complementary businesses, products or technologies, we may be unable to complete these acquisitions or to successfully integrate them in a cost-effective and non-disruptive manner.

Our success depends, in part, on our ability to continually enhance and broaden our product offerings in response to changing customer demands, competitive pressures and advances in technologies. Accordingly,

 

36


Table of Contents

although we have no current commitments with respect to any acquisition or investment, we may in the future pursue the acquisition of, or joint ventures relating to, complementary businesses, products or technologies instead of developing them ourselves. We do not know if we will be able to successfully complete any future acquisitions or joint ventures, or whether we will be able to successfully integrate any acquired business, product or technology or retain any key employees related thereto. Integrating any business, product or technology we acquire could be expensive and time-consuming, disrupt our ongoing business and distract our management. If we are unable to integrate any acquired businesses, products or technologies effectively, our business will be adversely affected. In addition, any amortization or charges resulting from the costs of acquisitions could increase our expenses.

Our future growth depends on our ability to retain members of our senior management and other key employees. If we are unable to retain or recruit qualified personnel for growth, our business results could suffer.

We have benefited substantially from the leadership and performance of our senior management as well as certain key employees. Our success will depend on our ability to retain our current management and key employees, and to attract and retain qualified personnel in the future. Competition for senior management and key employees in our industry is intense, and we cannot guarantee that we will be able to retain our personnel or attract new, qualified personnel. The loss of services of certain members of our senior management or key employees could prevent or delay the implementation and completion of our strategic objectives, or divert management’s attention to seeking qualified replacements. Each member of senior management as well as our key employees may terminate employment without notice and without cause or good reason. The members of our senior management are not subject to non-competition agreements. Accordingly, the adverse effect resulting from the loss of certain members of senior management could be compounded by our inability to prevent them from competing with us.

In addition to competing for market share for our products, we also compete against our competitors for personnel, including qualified sales representatives that are necessary to grow our business. Universities and research institutions also compete with us for scientific and clinical personnel that are important to our R&D efforts. We also rely on consultants and advisors in our research, operations, clinical and commercial efforts to implement our business strategies. Our consultants and advisors may be employed by employers other than us and may have commitments under consulting or advisory contracts with other entities that may limit their availability to us. Our strategic plan requires us to continue growing our sales, marketing, clinical and operational infrastructure in order to generate, and meet, the demand for our products. If we fail to retain or attract these key personnel, we could fail to take advantage of the market for our products, adversely affecting our business, financial condition and results of operation.

Failure to protect our information technology infrastructure against cyber-based attacks, network security breaches, service interruptions or data corruption could materially disrupt our operations and adversely affect our business and operating results.

The efficient operation of our business depends on our information technology systems. We rely on our information technology systems to effectively manage sales and marketing data, accounting and financial functions, inventory management, product development tasks, clinical data, customer service and technical support functions. Our information technology systems are vulnerable to damage or interruption from earthquakes, fires, floods and other natural disasters, terrorist attacks, power losses, computer system or data network failures, security breaches, data corruption and cyber-based attacks, including malicious software programs or other attacks, which have been attempted against us in the past. In addition, a variety of our software systems are cloud-based data management applications, hosted by third-party service providers whose security and information technology systems are subject to similar risks.

The failure to protect either our or our service providers’ information technology infrastructure could disrupt our entire operation or result in decreased sales and leases of our products, increased overhead costs, product

 

37


Table of Contents

shortages, loss or misuse of proprietary or confidential information, intellectual property or sensitive or personal information, all of which could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Failure to comply with data privacy and security laws could have a material adverse effect on our business.

Our business processes personal data, including some data related to health. When conducting clinical trials, we face risks associated with collecting trial participants’ data, especially health data, in a manner consistent with applicable laws and regulations. We also face risks inherent in handling large volumes of data and in protecting the security of such data. We could be subject to attacks on our systems by outside parties or fraudulent or inappropriate behavior by our service providers or employees. Third parties may also gain access to users’ accounts using stolen or inferred credentials, computer malware, viruses, spamming, phishing attacks or other means, and may use such access to obtain users’ personal data or prevent use of their accounts. Data breaches could result in a violation of applicable U.S. and international privacy, data protection and other laws, and subject us to individual or consumer class action litigation and governmental investigations and proceedings by federal, state and local regulatory entities in the United States and by international regulatory entities, resulting in exposure to material civil or criminal liability, or both. Further, our general liability insurance and corporate risk program may not cover all potential claims to which we are exposed and may not be adequate to indemnify us for all liability that may be imposed.

We may be subject to state, federal and foreign laws relating to data privacy and security in the conduct of our business, including state breach notification laws, the Health Insurance Portability and Accountability Act, or HIPAA, as amended by the Health Information Technology for Economic and Clinical Health Act of 2009, or HITECH, the European Union, or EU’s, General Data Protection Regulation, or GDPR, and the California Consumer Privacy Act, or CCPA. These laws affect how we collect and use data of our employees, consultants, customers and other parties. Additionally, we are subject to laws and regulations regarding cross-border transfers of personal data, including laws relating to transfer of personal data outside of the EEA. We rely on transfer mechanisms permitted under these laws, including EU Standard Contract Clauses. If we cannot rely on existing mechanisms for transferring personal data from the EEA, the United Kingdom, or UK, or other jurisdictions, we could be prevented from transferring personal data of users or employees in those regions. This could adversely affect the manner in which we provide our services and thus materially affect our operations and financial results.

Furthermore, these laws impose substantial requirements that require the expenditure of significant funds and employee time to comply, and additional states and countries are enacting new data privacy and security laws, which will require future expansion of our compliance efforts. We also rely on third parties to host or otherwise process some of this data. In some instances, these third parties have experienced immaterial failures to protect data privacy. Any failure by a third party to prevent security breaches could have adverse consequences for us. We will need to expend additional resources and make significant investments to comply with data privacy and security laws. Our failure to comply with these laws or prevent security breaches of such data could result in significant liability under applicable laws, cause disruption to our business, harm our reputation and have a material adverse effect on our business.

We cannot be certain that our net operating loss tax carryforwards or other tax attributes will be available to offset future taxable income.

For periods since PDL acquired us, a consolidated Federal tax return, and when permitted, consolidated state tax returns, are filed with PDL. Within our financial statements we record and present our income tax provision and disclosures on a “separate return” basis, as if we were a taxpayer separate from PDL. As of December 31, 2019, on a “separate return” basis we had approximately $158.3 million, $131.7 million and $0 of net operating loss, or NOL, carryforwards for federal, state and foreign purposes, respectively, available to offset future taxable income. The federal NOL carryforwards incurred prior to 2018 begin to expire in 2024. The state NOL carryforwards will begin to expire in 2023. As of December 31, 2019, on a “separate return” basis we had

 

38


Table of Contents

federal and state research and development, or R&D, credit carryforwards of approximately $2.2 million and $0, respectively. Federal credits begin to expire in 2025. We continue to provide a full valuation allowance against these tax attributes because we believe that uncertainty exists with respect to their future realization. To the extent available, we intend to use these tax attributes to offset future taxable income associated with our operations. There can be no assurance we will generate sufficient taxable income in the carryforward period to utilize any NOL and R&D credit carryforwards before they expire.

We expect that a portion of these tax attributes that we report on a “separate return” basis will not be available to us upon the Spin-Off as a portion of the tax attributes generated by us in the past have been utilized by PDL in its consolidated tax return and because of other limitations. Such limitations on our tax attributes could include change of ownership limitations set out under the U.S. Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, or the Code, Section 382 and Section 383, and other net operating loss limitations under Code Section 1502, which may apply to us following our separation from the PDL tax return group. The amounts of tax attributes currently attributable to us on PDL’s consolidated U.S. federal income tax return and various state returns, as filed, are $70.6 million and $57.5 million, respectively, as of December 31, 2019. As such, we expect that a portion of these carryforwards could be limited at the time the Spin-Off is executed.

Furthermore, in future periods we expect to record adjustments to certain deferred tax assets reflecting the impact of separation related activities. Our results of operations could be materially affected in future periods as a result of any such adjustments.

Our business is subject to the risk of natural disasters, adverse weather events and other catastrophic events, and to interruption by manmade problems such as terrorism.

Our business is vulnerable to damage or interruption from earthquakes, fires, floods, power losses, telecommunications failures, terrorist attacks, acts of war, human errors and similar events. The third-party systems and operations on which we rely are subject to similar risks. For example, a significant natural disaster, such as an earthquake, fire or flood, could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition and operating results, and our insurance coverage may be insufficient to compensate us for losses that may occur. Acts of terrorism could also cause disruptions in our businesses, consumer demand or the economy as a whole. We may not have sufficient protection or recovery plans in some circumstances, such as if a natural disaster affects locations that store a significant amount of our inventory vehicles. Any such damage or interruptions could negatively affect our ability to run our business, which could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition, and operating results.

Performance issues, service interruptions or price increases by our shipping carriers could adversely affect our business and harm our reputation and ability to provide our products on a timely basis.

Reliable shipping is essential to our operations. We rely on providers of transport services for reliable and secure point-to-point transport of our products to our customers and for tracking of these shipments. Should a carrier encounter delivery performance issues such as loss, damage or destruction of any of our products, it would be costly to replace such products in a timely manner and such occurrences may damage our reputation and lead to decreased demand for our products and increased cost and expense to our business. In addition, any significant increase in shipping rates could adversely affect our operating margins and results of operations. Similarly, strikes, severe weather, natural disasters or other service interruptions affecting delivery services we use would adversely affect our ability to deliver our products (or any other products we commercialize in the future) on a timely basis.

Intangible assets on our books may lead to significant impairment charges.

We carry a significant amount of intangible assets on our balance sheet, partially due to the value of the LENSAR brand name, but also intangible assets associated with our technologies, acquired research and

 

39


Table of Contents

development, currently marketed products, and marketing know-how. As a result, we may incur significant impairment charges if the fair value of the intangible assets would be less than their carrying value on our balance sheet at any point in time.

We regularly review our long-lived intangible and tangible assets, including identifiable intangible assets, for impairment. Intangible assets with an indefinite useful life (such as the LENSAR brand name), acquired research projects not ready for use, and acquired development projects not yet ready for use are subject to impairment review. We review other long-lived assets for impairment when there is an indication that an impairment may have occurred.

Risks Related to Government Regulation

Our products and operations are subject to extensive government regulation and oversight both in the United States and abroad, and our failure to comply with applicable requirements could harm our business.

Our products are regulated as medical devices. We and our products are subject to extensive regulation in the United States and elsewhere, including by the FDA and its foreign counterparts. The FDA and foreign regulatory agencies regulate, among other things, with respect to medical devices: design, development and manufacturing; testing, labeling, content and language of instructions for use and storage; clinical trials; product safety; establishment registration and device listing; marketing, sales and distribution; pre-market clearance and approval; record keeping procedures; advertising and promotion; recalls and field safety corrective actions; post-market surveillance, including reporting of deaths or serious injuries and malfunctions that, if they were to recur, could lead to death or serious injury; post-market approval studies; and product import and export.

The regulations to which we are subject are complex and have tended to become more stringent over time. Regulatory changes could result in restrictions on our ability to carry on or expand our operations, higher than anticipated costs or lower than anticipated sales. The FDA enforces these regulatory requirements through, among other means, periodic unannounced inspections. We do not know whether we will be found compliant in connection with any future FDA inspections. Failure to comply with applicable regulations could jeopardize our ability to sell our products and result in enforcement actions such as: warning letters; fines; injunctions; civil penalties; termination of distribution; recalls or seizures of products; delays in the introduction of products into the market; total or partial suspension of production; refusal to grant future clearances or approvals; withdrawals or suspensions of current approvals, resulting in prohibitions on sales of our products; and in the most serious cases, criminal penalties.

We may not receive, or may be delayed in receiving, the necessary clearances or approvals for our future products, including ALLY, or modifications to our current products, and failure to timely obtain necessary clearances or approvals for our future products or modifications to our current products would adversely affect our ability to grow our business.

In the United States, before we can market a new medical device, or a new use of, new claim for or significant modification to an existing product, we must first receive either clearance under Section 510(k) of the Federal Food, Drug, and Cosmetic Act, or the FDCA, or approval of a pre-market approval application, or PMA, from the FDA, unless an exemption applies. In the 510(k) clearance process, before a device may be marketed, the FDA must determine that a proposed device is “substantially equivalent” to a legally-marketed “predicate” device, which includes a device that has been previously cleared through the 510(k) process, a device that was legally marketed prior to May 28, 1976 (pre-amendments device), a device that was originally on the U.S. market pursuant to an approved PMA and later down-classified, or a 510(k)-exempt device. To be “substantially equivalent,” the proposed device must have the same intended use as the predicate device, and either have the same technological characteristics as the predicate device or have different technological characteristics and not raise different questions of safety or effectiveness than the predicate device. Clinical data are sometimes required to support substantial equivalence. In the process of obtaining PMA approval, the FDA must determine that a

 

40


Table of Contents

proposed device is safe and effective for its intended use based, in part, on extensive data, including, but not limited to, technical, pre-clinical, clinical trial, manufacturing and labeling data. The PMA process is typically required for devices that are deemed to pose the greatest risk, such as life-sustaining, life-supporting or implantable devices. To date, our products have received marketing authorization pursuant to the 510(k) clearance process. We also have one device in development that we plan to submit for clearance through the 510(k) process.

Modifications to products that are approved through a PMA application generally require FDA approval. Similarly, certain modifications made to products cleared through a 510(k) may require a new 510(k) clearance. Both the PMA approval and the 510(k) clearance process can be expensive, lengthy and uncertain. The FDA’s 510(k) clearance process usually takes from three to 12 months, but can last longer. The process of obtaining a PMA is much more costly and uncertain than the 510(k) clearance process and generally takes from one to three years, or even longer, from the time the application is filed with the FDA. In addition, a PMA generally requires the performance of one or more clinical trials. Despite the time, effort and cost, a device may not be approved or cleared by the FDA. Any delay or failure to obtain necessary regulatory clearances or approvals could harm our business. Furthermore, even if we are granted regulatory clearances or approvals, they may include significant limitations on the indicated uses for the device, which may limit the market for the device.

In the United States, we have obtained clearance of our LENSAR Laser System through the 510(k) clearance process. Any modification to these systems that has not been previously cleared may require us to submit a new 510(k) premarket notification and obtain clearance, or submit a PMA and obtain FDA approval prior to implementing the change. Specifically, any modification to a 510(k)-cleared device that could significantly affect its safety or effectiveness, or that would constitute a major change in its intended use, design or manufacture, requires a new 510(k) clearance or, possibly, approval of a PMA. The FDA requires every manufacturer to make this determination in the first instance, but the FDA may review any manufacturer’s decision. The FDA may not agree with our decisions regarding whether new clearances or approvals are necessary. We have made modifications to 510(k)-cleared products in the past and have determined based on our review of the applicable FDA regulations and guidance that in certain instances new 510(k) clearances or PMA approvals were not required. We may make modifications or add additional features in the future that we believe do not require a new 510(k) clearance or approval of a PMA. If the FDA disagrees with our determination and requires us to submit new 510(k) notifications or PMA applications for modifications to our previously cleared products for which we have concluded that new clearances or approvals are unnecessary, we may be required to cease marketing or to recall the modified product until we obtain clearance or approval, and we may be subject to significant regulatory fines or penalties. If the FDA requires us to go through a lengthier, more rigorous examination for future products or modifications to existing products than we had expected, product introductions or modifications could be delayed or canceled, which could adversely affect our ability to grow our business.

The FDA can delay, limit or deny clearance or approval of a device for many reasons, including:

 

   

our inability to demonstrate to the satisfaction of the FDA or the applicable regulatory entity or notified body that our products are safe or effective for their intended uses;

 

   

the disagreement of the FDA or the applicable foreign regulatory body with the design or implementation of our clinical trials or the interpretation of data from pre-clinical studies or clinical trials;

 

   

serious and unexpected adverse device effects experienced by participants in our clinical trials;

 

   

the data from our pre-clinical studies and clinical trials may be insufficient to support clearance or approval, where required;

 

   

our inability to demonstrate that the clinical and other benefits of the device outweigh the risks;

 

   

the manufacturing process or facilities we use may not meet applicable requirements; and

 

41


Table of Contents
   

the potential for approval policies or regulations of the FDA or applicable foreign regulatory bodies to change significantly in a manner rendering our clinical data or regulatory filings insufficient for clearance or approval.

In order to sell our products in member countries of the EEA our products must comply with the essential requirements of the EU Medical Devices Directive (Council Directive 93/42/EEC) and the Active Implantable Medical Devices Directive (Council Directive 90/385/EEC). Compliance with these requirements is a prerequisite to be able to affix the Conformité Européene mark, or CE Mark, to our products, without which they cannot be sold or marketed in the EEA. To demonstrate compliance with the essential requirements we must undergo a conformity assessment procedure, which varies according to the type of medical device and its classification. Except for low-risk medical devices (Class I non-sterile, non-measuring devices), where the manufacturer can issue an EC Declaration of Conformity based on a self-assessment of the conformity of its products with the essential requirements of the EU Medical Devices Directive, a conformity assessment procedure requires the intervention of an organization accredited by a member state of the EEA to conduct conformity assessments, or a Notified Body. Depending on the relevant conformity assessment procedure, the Notified Body would typically audit and examine the technical file and the quality system for the manufacture, design and final inspection of our devices. The Notified Body issues a certificate of conformity following successful completion of a conformity assessment procedure conducted in relation to the medical device and its manufacturer and their conformity with the essential requirements. This certificate entitles the manufacturer to affix the CE Mark to its medical devices after having prepared and signed a related EC Declaration of Conformity.

As a general rule, demonstration of conformity of medical devices and their manufacturers with the essential requirements must be based, among other things, on the evaluation of clinical data supporting the safety and performance of the products during normal conditions of use. Specifically, a manufacturer must demonstrate that the device achieves its intended performance during normal conditions of use, that the known and foreseeable risks, and any adverse events, are minimized and acceptable when weighed against the benefits of its intended performance, and that any claims made about the performance and safety of the device are supported by suitable evidence. If we fail to remain in compliance with applicable European laws and directives, we would be unable to continue to affix the CE Mark to our products, which would prevent us from selling them within the EEA.

Failure to comply with post-marketing regulatory requirements could subject us to enforcement actions, including substantial penalties, and might require us to recall or withdraw a product from the market.

We are subject to ongoing and pervasive regulatory requirements governing, among other things, the manufacture, marketing, advertising, medical device reporting, sale, promotion, import, export, registration, and listing of devices. The regulations to which we are subject are complex and have become more stringent over time. Regulatory changes could result in restrictions on our ability to continue or expand our operations, higher than anticipated costs, or lower than anticipated sales. Even after we have obtained the proper regulatory approval to market a device, we have ongoing responsibilities under FDA regulations and applicable foreign laws and regulations. The FDA, state and foreign regulatory authorities have broad enforcement powers. Our failure to comply with applicable regulatory requirements could result in enforcement action by the FDA, state or foreign regulatory authorities, which may include any of the following sanctions:

 

   

untitled letters or warning letters;

 

   

fines, injunctions, consent decrees and civil penalties;

 

   

recalls, termination of distribution, administrative detention, or seizure of our products;

 

   

customer notifications or repair, replacement or refunds;

 

   

operating restrictions or partial suspension or total shutdown of production;

 

   

delays in or refusal to grant our requests for future clearances or approvals or foreign regulatory approvals of new products, new intended uses, or modifications to existing products;

 

42


Table of Contents
   

withdrawals or suspensions of our current 510(k) clearances, resulting in prohibitions on sales of our products;

 

   

FDA refusal to issue certificates to foreign governments needed to export products for sale in other countries; and

 

   

criminal prosecution.

Any of these sanctions could result in higher than anticipated costs or lower than anticipated sales and have a material adverse effect on our reputation, business, financial condition and results of operations.

In addition, the FDA may change its clearance policies, adopt additional regulations or revise existing regulations, or take other actions, which may prevent or delay clearance or approval of our future products under development or impact our ability to modify our currently cleared products on a timely basis. Such policy or regulatory changes could impose additional requirements upon us that could delay our ability to obtain new clearances or approvals, increase the costs of compliance or restrict our ability to maintain our clearances of our current products. For example, the FDA recently announced forthcoming steps that the FDA intends to take to modernize the premarket notification pathway under Section 510(k) of the FDCA. For more information, see “—Legislative or regulatory reforms in the United States or the EU may make it more difficult and costly for us to obtain regulatory clearances or approvals for our products or to manufacture, market or distribute our products after clearance or approval is obtained.

Our products must be manufactured in accordance with federal and state regulations, and we or any of our suppliers could be forced to recall products or terminate production if we fail to comply with these regulations.

The methods used in, and the facilities used for, the manufacture of our products must comply with the FDA’s QSR, which is a complex regulatory scheme that covers the procedures and documentation of the design, testing, production, process controls, quality assurance, labeling, packaging, handling, storage, distribution, installation, servicing and shipping of medical devices. Furthermore, we are required to verify that our suppliers maintain facilities, procedures and operations that comply with our quality standards and applicable regulatory requirements. The FDA enforces the QSR through periodic announced or unannounced inspections of medical device manufacturing facilities, which may include the facilities of subcontractors. Our products are also subject to similar state regulations and various laws and regulations of foreign countries governing manufacturing.

Our third-party manufacturers may not take the necessary steps to comply with applicable regulations, which could cause delays in the delivery of our products. In addition, failure to comply with applicable FDA requirements or later discovery of previously unknown problems with our products or manufacturing processes could result in, among other things: warning letters or untitled letters; fines, injunctions or civil penalties; suspension or withdrawal of approvals; seizures or recalls of our products; total or partial suspension of production or distribution; administrative or judicially imposed sanctions; the FDA’s refusal to grant pending or future clearances or approvals for our products; clinical holds; refusal to permit the import or export of our products; and criminal prosecution of us or our employees.

Any of these actions could significantly and negatively affect supply of our products. If any of these events occurs, our reputation could be harmed, we could be exposed to product liability claims and we could lose customers and experience reduced sales and increased costs.

The misuse or off-label use of our LENSAR Laser System may harm our reputation in the marketplace, result in injuries that lead to product liability suits or result in costly investigations, fines or sanctions by regulatory bodies if we are deemed to have engaged in the promotion of these uses, any of which could be costly to our business.

Our LENSAR Laser System is an ophthalmic surgical laser indicated for, among other things, the creation of anterior capsulotomies, use in patients undergoing surgery requiring laser-assisted fragmentation of the

 

43


Table of Contents

cataractous lens, and for creating cuts/incisions in the cornea. We train our marketing personnel and direct sales force to not promote our devices for uses outside of the FDA-approved indications for use, known as “off-label uses.” We cannot, however, prevent a physician from using our devices off-label, when in the physician’s independent professional medical judgment he or she deems it appropriate. There may be increased risk of injury to patients if physicians attempt to use our devices off-label. Furthermore, the use of our devices for indications other than those approved by the FDA or approved by any foreign regulatory body may not effectively treat such conditions, which could harm our reputation in the marketplace among physicians and patients.

If the FDA or any foreign regulatory body determines that our promotional materials or training constitute promotion of an off-label use, it could request that we modify our training or promotional materials or subject us to regulatory or enforcement actions, including the issuance or imposition of an untitled letter, which is used for violators that do not necessitate a warning letter, injunction, seizure, civil fine or criminal penalties. It is also possible that other federal, state or foreign enforcement authorities might take action under other regulatory authority, such as false claims laws, if they consider our business activities to constitute promotion of an off-label use, which could result in significant penalties, including, but not limited to, criminal, civil and administrative penalties, damages, fines, disgorgement, exclusion from participation in government healthcare programs and the curtailment of our operations.

In addition, physicians may misuse our products or use improper techniques if they are not adequately trained, potentially leading to injury and an increased risk of product liability. If our devices are misused or used with improper technique, we may become subject to costly litigation by our customers or their patients. Product liability claims could divert management’s attention from our core business, be expensive to defend and result in sizeable damage awards against us that may not be covered by insurance.

Our products may cause or contribute to adverse medical events or be subject to failures or malfunctions that we are required to report to the FDA, and if we fail to do so, we would be subject to sanctions that could harm our reputation, business, financial condition and results of operations. The discovery of serious safety issues with our products, or a recall of our products either voluntarily or at the direction of the FDA or another governmental authority, could have a negative impact on us.

We are subject to the FDA’s medical device reporting regulations and similar foreign regulations, which require us to report to the FDA when we receive or become aware of information that reasonably suggests that one or more of our products may have caused or contributed to a death or serious injury or malfunctioned in a way that, if the malfunction were to recur, it could cause or contribute to a death or serious injury. The timing of our obligation to report is triggered by the date we become aware of the adverse event as well as the nature of the event. We may fail to report adverse events of which we become aware within the prescribed timeframe. We may also fail to recognize that we have become aware of a reportable adverse event, especially if it is not reported to us as an adverse event or if it is an adverse event that is unexpected or removed in time from the use of the product. If we fail to comply with our reporting obligations, the FDA could take action, including warning letters, untitled letters, administrative actions, criminal prosecution, imposition of civil monetary penalties, revocation of our device clearance or approval, seizure of our products or delay in clearance or approval of future products.

The FDA and foreign regulatory bodies have the authority to require the recall of commercialized products in the event of material deficiencies or defects in design or manufacture of a product or in the event that a product poses an unacceptable risk to health. The FDA’s authority to require a recall must be based on a finding that there is reasonable probability that the device could cause serious injury or death. We may also choose to voluntarily recall a product if any material deficiency is found. A government-mandated or voluntary recall by us could occur as a result of an unacceptable risk to health, component failures, malfunctions, manufacturing defects, labeling or design deficiencies, packaging defects or other deficiencies or failures to comply with applicable regulations. Product defects or other errors may occur in the future.

Depending on the corrective action we take to redress a product’s deficiencies or defects, the FDA may require, or we may decide, that we will need to obtain new clearances or approvals for the device before we may

 

44


Table of Contents

market or distribute the corrected device. Seeking such clearances or approvals may delay our ability to replace the recalled devices in a timely manner. Moreover, if we do not adequately address problems associated with our devices, we may face additional regulatory enforcement action, including FDA warning letters, product seizure, injunctions, administrative penalties or civil or criminal fines.

Companies are required to maintain certain records of recalls and corrections, even if they are not reportable to the FDA. We may initiate voluntary withdrawals or corrections for our products in the future that we determine do not require notification of the FDA. If the FDA disagrees with our determinations, it could require us to report those actions as recalls and we may be subject to enforcement action. A future recall announcement could harm our reputation with customers, potentially lead to product liability claims against us and negatively affect our sales. Any corrective action, whether voluntary or involuntary, as well as defending ourselves in a lawsuit, will require the dedication of our time and capital, distract management from operating our business and may harm our reputation and financial results.

If we do not obtain and maintain international regulatory registrations, clearances or approvals for our products, we will be unable to market and sell our products outside of the United States.

Sales of our products outside of the United States are subject to foreign regulatory requirements that vary widely from country to country. In addition, the FDA regulates exports of medical devices from the United States. While the regulations of some countries may not impose barriers to marketing and selling our products or only require notification, others require that we obtain the clearance or approval of a specified regulatory body. Complying with foreign regulatory requirements, including obtaining registrations, clearances or approvals, can be expensive and time-consuming, and we may not receive regulatory clearances or approvals in each country in which we plan to market our products or we may be unable to do so on a timely basis. The time required to obtain registrations, clearances or approvals, if required by other countries, may be longer than that required for FDA clearance or approval, and requirements for such registrations, clearances or approvals may significantly differ from FDA requirements. If we modify our products, we may need to apply for additional regulatory clearances or approvals before we are permitted to sell the modified product. In addition, we may not continue to meet the quality and safety standards required to maintain the authorizations that we have received. If we are unable to maintain our authorizations in a particular country, we will no longer be able to sell the applicable product in that country.

Regulatory clearance or approval by the FDA does not ensure registration, clearance or approval by regulatory authorities in other countries, and registration, clearance or approval by one or more foreign regulatory authorities does not ensure registration, clearance or approval by regulatory authorities in other foreign countries or by the FDA. However, a failure or delay in obtaining registration or regulatory clearance or approval in one country may have a negative effect on the regulatory process in others.

The clinical trial process is lengthy and expensive with uncertain outcomes. Results of earlier studies may not be predictive of future clinical trial results, or the safety or efficacy profile for such products.

Clinical testing is difficult to design and implement, can take many years, can be expensive and carries uncertain outcomes. We intend to conduct additional clinical trials and to generate clinical data that will help us demonstrate the benefits of our system compared to manual cataract surgery conducted without a laser system, or with competing laser systems.

The results of preclinical studies and clinical trials of our products conducted to date and ongoing or future studies and trials of our current, planned or future products may not be predictive of the results of later clinical trials, and interim results of a clinical trial do not necessarily predict final results. Our interpretation of data and results from our clinical trials do not ensure that we will achieve similar results in future clinical trials. In addition, preclinical and clinical data are often susceptible to various interpretations and analyses, and many companies that have believed their products performed satisfactorily in preclinical studies and earlier clinical

 

45


Table of Contents

trials have nonetheless failed to replicate results in later clinical trials. Products in later stages of clinical trials may fail to show the desired safety and efficacy despite having progressed through nonclinical studies and earlier clinical trials. Failure can occur at any stage of clinical testing. Our clinical studies may produce negative or inconclusive results, and we may decide, or regulators may require us, to conduct additional clinical and non-clinical testing in addition to those we have planned.

The initiation and completion of any of clinical studies may be prevented, delayed, or halted for numerous reasons. We may experience delays in our ongoing clinical trials for a number of reasons, which could adversely affect the costs, timing or successful completion of our clinical trials, including related to the following:

 

   

we may be required to submit an IDE application to FDA, which must become effective prior to commencing certain human clinical trials of medical devices, and FDA may reject our IDE application and notify us that we may not begin clinical trials;

 

   

regulators and other comparable foreign regulatory authorities may disagree as to the design or implementation of our clinical trials;

 

   

regulators, Institutional Review Boards, or IRBs, or other reviewing bodies may not authorize us or our investigators to commence a clinical trial, or to conduct or continue a clinical trial at a prospective or specific trial site;

 

   

we may not reach agreement on acceptable terms with prospective contract research organizations, or CROs, and clinical trial sites, the terms of which can be subject to extensive negotiation and may vary significantly among different CROs and trial sites;

 

   

clinical trials may produce negative or inconclusive results, and we may decide, or regulators may require us, to conduct additional clinical trials or abandon product development programs;

 

   

the number of subjects or patients required for clinical trials may be larger than we anticipate, enrollment in these clinical trials may be insufficient or slower than we anticipate, and the number of clinical trials being conducted at any given time may be high and result in fewer available patients for any given clinical trial, or patients may drop out of these clinical trials at a higher rate than we anticipate;

 

   

our third-party contractors, including those manufacturing products or conducting clinical trials on our behalf, may fail to comply with regulatory requirements or meet their contractual obligations to us in a timely manner, or at all;

 

   

we might have to suspend or terminate clinical trials for various reasons, including a finding that the subjects are being exposed to unacceptable health risks;

 

   

we may have to amend clinical trial protocols or conduct additional studies to reflect changes in regulatory requirements or guidance, which we may be required to submit to an IRB, regulatory authorities, or both, for re-examination;

 

   

regulators, IRBs, or other parties may require or recommend that we or our investigators suspend or terminate clinical research for various reasons, including safety signals or noncompliance with regulatory requirements;

 

   

the cost of clinical trials may be greater than we anticipate;

 

   

clinical sites may not adhere to the clinical protocol or may drop out of a clinical trial;

 

   

we may be unable to recruit a sufficient number of clinical trial sites;

 

   

regulators, IRBs, or other reviewing bodies may fail to approve or subsequently find fault with our manufacturing processes or facilities of third-party manufacturers with which we enter into agreement for clinical and commercial supplies, the supply of devices or other materials necessary to conduct clinical trials may be insufficient, inadequate or not available at an acceptable cost, or we may experience interruptions in supply;

 

46


Table of Contents
   

approval policies or regulations of FDA or applicable foreign regulatory agencies may change in a manner rendering our clinical data insufficient for approval; and

 

   

our current or future products may have undesirable side effects or other unexpected characteristics.

Any of these occurrences may significantly harm our business, financial condition and prospects. In addition, disruptions caused by the COVID-19 pandemic may increase the likelihood that we encounter such difficulties or delays in initiating, enrolling, conducting or completing our planned and ongoing clinical trials. Many of the factors that cause, or lead to, a delay in the commencement or completion of clinical trials may also ultimately lead to the denial of regulatory approval of our product candidates.

Patient enrollment in clinical trials and completion of patient follow-up depend on many factors, including the size of the patient population, the nature of the trial protocol, the proximity of patients to clinical sites, the eligibility criteria for the clinical trial, patient compliance, competing clinical trials and clinicians’ and patients’ perceptions as to the potential advantages of the product being studied in relation to other available therapies, including any new treatments that may be approved for the indications we are investigating. For example, patients may be discouraged from enrolling in our clinical trials if the trial protocol requires them to undergo extensive post-treatment procedures or follow-up to assess the safety and efficacy of a product candidate, or they may be persuaded to participate in contemporaneous clinical trials of a competitor’s product candidate. In addition, patients participating in our clinical trials may drop out before completion of the trial or experience adverse medical events unrelated to our products. Delays in patient enrollment or failure of patients to continue to participate in a clinical trial may delay commencement or completion of the clinical trial, cause an increase in the costs of the clinical trial and delays, or result in the failure of the clinical trial.

Clinical trials must be conducted in accordance with the laws and regulations of the FDA and other applicable regulatory authorities’ legal requirements, regulations or guidelines, and are subject to oversight by these governmental agencies and IRBs at the medical institutions where the clinical trials are conducted. In addition, clinical trials must be conducted with supplies of our devices produced under cGMP, requirements and other regulations. Furthermore, we rely on CROs, and clinical trial sites to ensure the proper and timely conduct of our clinical trials and while we have agreements governing their committed activities, we have limited influence over their actual performance. We depend on our collaborators and on medical institutions and CROs to conduct our clinical trials in compliance with good clinical practice, or GCP, requirements. To the extent our collaborators or the CROs fail to enroll participants for our clinical trials, fail to conduct the study to GCP standards or are delayed for a significant time in the execution of trials, including achieving full enrollment, we may be affected by increased costs, program delays or both. In addition, clinical trials that are conducted in countries outside the United States may subject us to further delays and expenses as a result of increased shipment costs, additional regulatory requirements and the engagement of non-U.S. CROs, as well as expose us to risks associated with clinical investigators who are unknown to the FDA, and different standards of diagnosis, screening and medical care.

Even if our future products are cleared or approved in the United States, commercialization of our products in foreign countries would require clearance or approval by regulatory authorities in those countries. Clearance or approval procedures vary among jurisdictions and can involve requirements and administrative review periods different from, and greater than, those in the United States, including additional preclinical studies or clinical trials. Any of these occurrences could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Legislative or regulatory reforms in the United States or the EU may make it more difficult and costly for us to obtain regulatory clearances or approvals for our products or to manufacture, market or distribute our products after clearance or approval is obtained.

From time to time, legislation is drafted and introduced in Congress that could significantly change the statutory provisions governing the regulation of medical devices. The FDA may change its clearance and

 

47


Table of Contents

approval policies, adopt additional regulations or revise existing regulations, or take other actions, which may prevent or delay approval or clearance of our future products under development or impact our ability to modify our currently cleared products on a timely basis. For example, in November 2018, FDA officials announced forthcoming steps that the FDA intends to take to modernize the premarket notification pathway under Section 510(k) of the Federal Food, Drug, and Cosmetic Act. Among other things, the FDA announced that it plans to develop proposals to drive manufacturers utilizing the 510(k) pathway toward the use of newer predicates. These proposals include plans to potentially sunset certain older devices that were used as predicates under the 510(k) clearance pathway, and to potentially publish a list of devices that have been cleared on the basis of demonstrated substantial equivalence to predicate devices that are more than 10 years old. In May 2019, the FDA solicited public feedback on these proposals. These proposals have not yet been finalized or adopted, and the FDA may work with Congress to implement such proposals through legislation. Accordingly, it is unclear the extent to which any proposals, if adopted, could impose additional regulatory requirements on us that could delay our ability to obtain new 510(k) clearances, increase the costs of compliance, or restrict our ability to maintain our current clearances, or otherwise create competition that may negatively affect our business.

More recently, in September 2019, the FDA finalized guidance describing an optional “safety and performance based” premarket review pathway for manufacturers of “certain, well-understood device types” to demonstrate substantial equivalence under the 510(k) clearance pathway by showing that such device meets objective safety and performance criteria established by the FDA, thereby obviating the need for manufacturers to compare the safety and performance of their medical devices to specific predicate devices in the clearance process. The FDA intends to develop and maintain a list device types appropriate for the “safety and performance based” pathway and will continue to develop product-specific guidance documents that identify the performance criteria for each such device type, as well as the testing methods recommended in the guidance documents, where feasible. The FDA may establish performance criteria for classes of devices for which we or our competitors seek or currently have received clearance, and it is unclear the extent to which such performance standards, if established, could impact our ability to obtain new 510(k) clearances or otherwise create competition that may negatively affect our business.

In addition, FDA regulations and guidance are often revised or reinterpreted by the FDA in ways that may significantly affect our business and our products. Any new statutes, regulations or revisions or reinterpretations of existing regulations may impose additional costs or lengthen review times of any future products or make it more difficult to obtain approval for, manufacture, market or distribute our products. We cannot determine what effect changes in regulations, statutes, legal interpretation or policies, when and if promulgated, enacted or adopted may have on our business in the future. Such changes could, among other things, require: additional testing prior to obtaining clearance or approval; changes to manufacturing methods; recall, replacement or discontinuance of our products; or additional record keeping. The FDA’s and other regulatory authorities’ policies may change and additional government regulations may be enacted that could prevent, limit or delay regulatory clearance or approval of our product candidates. We cannot predict the likelihood, nature or extent of government regulation that may arise from future legislation or administrative action, either in the United States or abroad. For example, certain policies of the Trump administration may impact our business and industry. Namely, the Trump administration has taken several executive actions, including the issuance of a number of Executive Orders, that could impose significant burdens on, or otherwise materially delay, FDA’s ability to engage in routine oversight activities such as implementing statutes through rulemaking, issuance of guidance, and review and approval of marketing applications. It is difficult to predict how these executive actions will be implemented, and the extent to which they will impact the FDA’s ability to exercise its regulatory authority. If these executive actions impose restrictions on FDA’s ability to engage in oversight and implementation activities in the normal course, our business may be negatively impacted. If we are slow or unable to adapt to changes in existing requirements or the adoption of new requirements or policies, or if we are not able to maintain regulatory compliance, we may lose any marketing approval that we may have obtained and we may not achieve or sustain profitability.

 

48


Table of Contents

In the EU, in April 2017, the European Parliament passed the Medical Devices Regulation (Regulation 2017/745), which repeals and replaces the EU Medical Devices Directive and the Active Implantable Medical Devices Directive. Unlike directives, which must be implemented into the national laws of the EEA Member States, the regulations would be directly applicable, i.e., without the need for adoption of EEA member State laws implementing them, in all EEA Member States and are intended to eliminate current differences in the regulation of medical devices among EEA Member States. The Medical Devices Regulation, among other things, is intended to establish a uniform, transparent, predictable and sustainable regulatory framework across the EEA for medical devices and ensure a high level of safety and health while supporting innovation. The Medical Devices Regulation was meant to become applicable three years after publication (in May 2020). However, on April 23, 2020, to take the pressure off EEA national authorities, notified bodies, manufacturers and other actors so they can focus fully on urgent priorities related to the COVID 19 pandemic, the European Council and Parliament adopted Regulation 2020/561, postponing the date of application of the Medical Devices Regulation by one year (to May 2021). Once applicable, the Medical Devices Regulation will among other things:

 

   

strengthen the rules on placing devices on the market and reinforce surveillance once they are available;

 

   

establish explicit provisions on manufacturers’ responsibilities for the follow-up of the quality, performance and safety of devices placed on the market;

 

   

improve the traceability of medical devices throughout the supply chain to the end-user or patient through a unique identification number;

 

   

set up a central database to provide patients, healthcare professionals and the public with comprehensive information on products available in the EU; and

 

   

strengthen rules for the assessment of certain high-risk devices, such as implants, which may have to undergo an additional check by experts before they are placed on the market.

Once applicable, the Medical Devices Regulation may impose increased compliance obligations for us to access the EU market. These modifications may have an effect on the way we conduct our business in the EEA.

Disruptions at the FDA and other government agencies caused by funding shortages or global health concerns could hinder their ability to hire, retain or deploy key leadership and other personnel, or otherwise prevent new or modified products from being developed, cleared or approved or commercialized in a timely manner or at all, which could negatively impact our business.

The ability of the FDA to review and clear or approve new products can be affected by a variety of factors, including government budget and funding levels, statutory, regulatory, and policy changes, the FDA’s ability to hire and retain key personnel and accept the payment of user fees, and other events that may otherwise affect the FDA’s ability to perform routine functions. Average review times at the agency have fluctuated in recent years as a result. In addition, government funding of other government agencies that fund research and development activities is subject to the political process, which is inherently fluid and unpredictable. Disruptions at the FDA and other agencies may also slow the time necessary for new medical devices or modifications to cleared or approved medical devices to be reviewed and cleared or approved by necessary government agencies, which would adversely affect our business. For example, over the last several years, including for 35 days beginning on December 22, 2018, the U.S. government has shut down several times and certain regulatory agencies, such as the FDA, have had to furlough critical FDA employees and stop critical activities.

Separately, in response to the global pandemic of COVID-19, on March 10, 2020 the FDA announced its intention to postpone most foreign inspections of manufacturing facilities, and subsequently, on March 18, 2020, the FDA announced its intention to temporarily postpone routine surveillance inspections of domestic manufacturing facilities. Regulatory authorities outside the United States may adopt similar restrictions or other policy measures in response to the COVID-19 pandemic. If a prolonged government shutdown occurs, or if

 

49


Table of Contents

global health concerns continue to prevent the FDA or other regulatory authorities from conducting their regular inspections, reviews, or other regulatory activities, it could significantly impact the ability of the FDA or other regulatory authorities to timely review and process our regulatory submissions, which could have a material adverse effect on our business.

Enacted and future healthcare legislation may increase the difficulty and cost for us to commercialize ALLY or other products we may develop in the future and may affect the prices we may set.

In the United States, the European Union and other jurisdictions, there have been and continue to be a number of legislative initiatives and judicial challenges to contain healthcare costs. For example, in March 2010, the Patient Protection and Affordable Care Act, as amended by the Health Care and Education Reconciliation Act, or collectively the ACA, was passed, which substantially changed the way healthcare is financed by both governmental and private insurers, and significantly impacted the United States medical device industry. Among other things, the ACA established a 2.3% excise tax on sales of medical devices with respect to any entity that manufactures or imports specified medical devices offered for sale in the United States, which, through a series of legislative amendments, was suspended, effective January 1, 2016, and subsequently repealed altogether on December 20, 2019. Since its enactment, there have been judicial and Congressional challenges to certain aspects of the ACA, as well as other efforts to challenge, repeal or replace the ACA that may impact our business or financial condition.

Moreover, other legislative changes have been proposed and adopted since the ACA was enacted. For example, the Budget Control Act of 2011, among other things, included reductions to Medicare payments to providers of 2% per fiscal year, which went into effect on April 1, 2013 and, due to subsequent legislative amendments to the statute, will remain in effect through 2029 unless additional Congressional action is taken. These reductions will be suspended from May 1, 2020 through December 31, 2020 due to the COVID-19 pandemic. Additionally, the American Taxpayer Relief Act of 2012, among other things, reduced Medicare payments to several providers, including hospitals, and increased the statute of limitations period for the government to recover overpayments to providers from three to five years.

We cannot predict the likelihood, nature or extent of government regulation that may arise from future legislation or administrative action in the United States, the European Union or any other jurisdiction. If we or any third parties we may engage are slow or unable to adapt to changes in existing requirements or the adoption of new requirements or policies, or if we or such third parties are not able to maintain regulatory compliance, we may not be able to achieve or sustain profitability or successfully market ALLY or any other products we may develop and obtain clearance for in the future.

We may be subject to certain federal and state laws pertaining to healthcare fraud and abuse, including anti-kickback, self-referral, false claims and fraud laws, and any violations by us of such laws could result in fines or other penalties.

Although none of the procedures using our products are currently covered by any state or federal government healthcare programs or other third-party payors, applicable agencies and regulators may interpret that our commercial, research and other financial relationships with healthcare providers and institutions are nonetheless subject to various federal and state laws intended to prevent healthcare fraud and abuse, including the following:

 

   

the federal Anti-Kickback Statute, which prohibits, among other things, any person from knowingly and willfully offering, soliciting, receiving or providing remuneration, directly or indirectly, to induce either the referral of an individual for an item or service or the purchasing or ordering of a good or service, for which payment may be made under federal healthcare programs such as the Medicare and Medicaid programs. Remuneration has been broadly defined to include anything of value, including cash, improper discounts and free or reduced price items and services. In addition, a person or entity does not need to have actual knowledge of the statute or specific intent to violate it in order to have committed a violation;

 

50


Table of Contents
   

the federal False Claims Act, which prohibits, among other things, individuals or entities from knowingly presenting, or causing to be presented, false claims, or knowingly using false statements, to obtain payment from the federal government, and which may apply to entities that provide coding and billing advice to customers. The federal False Claims Act has been used to prosecute persons submitting claims for payment that are inaccurate or fraudulent, that are for services not provided as claimed or for services that are not medically necessary. In addition, the government may assert that a claim including items and services resulting from a violation of the federal Anti-Kickback Statute constitutes a false or fraudulent claim for purposes of the False Claims Act. The federal False Claims Act also includes a whistleblower provision that allows individuals to bring actions on behalf of the federal government and share a portion of the recovery of successful claims;

 

   

the federal Health Insurance Portability and Accountability Act of 1996, as amended, also created federal criminal laws that prohibit executing a scheme to defraud any healthcare benefit program or making false statements relating to healthcare matters. Similar to the federal Anti-Kickback Statute, a person or entity does not need to have actual knowledge of the statute or specific intent to violate it in order to have committed a violation;

 

   

the Physician Payments Sunshine Act and its implementing regulations, which require certain manufacturers of drugs, devices, biologics and medical supplies that are reimbursable under Medicare, Medicaid, or the Children’s Health Insurance Program to report annually to the government information related to certain payments and other transfers of value to physicians (defined to include doctors, dentists, optometrists, podiatrists and chiropractors), certain other healthcare providers starting in 2022, and teaching hospitals, as well as ownership and investment interests held by the physicians described above and their immediate family members; and

 

   

analogous state and foreign laws and regulations, including state anti-kickback and false claims laws, which apply to items and services reimbursed by any third-party payor, including private insurers and self-pay patients; state laws that require device manufacturers to comply with the industry’s voluntary compliance guidelines and the relevant compliance guidance promulgated by the U.S. federal government, or otherwise restrict payments that may be made to healthcare providers and other potential referral sources; and state laws and regulations that require manufacturers to track gifts and other remuneration and items of value provided to healthcare professionals and entities.

If our operations are found to be in violation of any of the laws described above or any other governmental laws and regulations that may apply to us, we may be subject to significant penalties, including civil, criminal and administrative penalties, damages, fines, exclusion from government-funded healthcare programs, such as Medicare and Medicaid or similar programs in other countries or jurisdictions, disgorgement, individual imprisonment, contractual damages, reputational harm, diminished profits and the curtailment or restructuring of our operations. Further, defending against any such actions can be costly, time-consuming and may require significant personnel resources. Therefore, even if we are successful in defending against any such actions that may be brought against us, our business may be impaired.

We are subject to anti-corruption, anti-bribery and similar laws and any violations by us of such laws could result in fines or other penalties.

A majority of our revenue is derived from operations outside of the United States and is subject to requirements under the U.S. Treasury Department’s Office of Foreign Assets Control, anti-corruption, anti-bribery and similar laws, such as the Foreign Corrupt Practices Act, or FCPA, the U.K. Bribery Act 2010, and other anti-corruption, anti-bribery and anti-money laundering laws in countries in which we conduct activities. The FCPA prohibits, among other things, improper payments or offers of payments to foreign governments and their officials for the purpose of obtaining or retaining business. Recently, the U.S. Department of Justice has increased its enforcement activities with respect to the FCPA.

 

51


Table of Contents

While we have safeguards in place to discourage improper payments or offers of payments by our employees, consultants, sales agents or distributors, these safeguards may be ineffective. Any violations of the FCPA and similar laws may result in severe criminal or civil sanctions, or other liabilities or proceedings against us, and would likely harm our reputation, business, financial condition and result of operations.

Our employees, independent contractors, principal investigators, consultants, vendors, distributors and contract research organizations may engage in misconduct or other improper activities, including noncompliance with regulatory standards and requirements.

We are exposed to the risk that our employees, independent contractors, principal investigators, consultants, vendors, distributors and contractor research organizations, or CROs, may engage in fraudulent or other illegal activity. While we have policies and procedures in place prohibiting such activity, misconduct by these parties could include among other infractions or violations intentional, reckless or negligent conduct or unauthorized activity that violates: (i) FDA regulations, including those laws that require the reporting of true, complete and accurate information to the FDA; (ii) manufacturing standards; (iii) federal and state healthcare fraud and abuse laws and regulations; (iv) laws that require the true, complete and accurate reporting of financial information or data; or (v) other commercial or regulatory laws or requirements. Specifically, sales, marketing and business arrangements in the healthcare industry are subject to extensive laws and regulations intended to prevent fraud, kickbacks, self-dealing and other abusive practices. These laws and regulations may restrict or prohibit a wide range of pricing, discounting, marketing and promotion, sales commission, customer incentive programs and other business arrangements. Activities subject to these laws also involve the improper use of information obtained in the course of clinical trials, which could result in regulatory sanctions and serious harm to our reputation. It is not always possible to identify and deter misconduct by our employees and other third parties, and the precautions we take to detect and prevent this activity may not be effective in controlling unknown or unmanaged risks or losses or in protecting us from governmental investigations or other actions or lawsuits stemming from a failure to be in compliance with such laws or regulations. If any such actions are instituted against us, and we are not successful in defending ourselves or asserting our rights, those actions could have a significant impact on our business, including the imposition of civil, criminal and administrative penalties, damages, monetary fines, contractual damages, reputational harm, diminished profits and future earnings, and curtailment of our operations, any of which could adversely affect our ability to operate our business and our results of operations.

Risks Related to Intellectual Property Matters

Our success will depend on our ability to obtain, maintain and protect our intellectual property rights.

Our commercial success will depend in part on our success in obtaining and maintaining issued patents, trademarks and other intellectual property rights in the United States and elsewhere and protecting our proprietary technology. If we do not adequately protect our intellectual property and proprietary technology, competitors may be able to use our technologies we have acquired in the marketplace and erode or negate any competitive advantage we may have, which could harm our business and ability to achieve profitability.

Our intellectual property coverage includes protection provided by patents licensed through third parties, including patents that relate to combining a femtosecond laser and phacoemulsification system into a single device. Our licensors may not successfully prosecute the intellectual property applications, including patent applications, that we have licensed, may fail to maintain these patents, or may determine not to pursue litigation, or assist us in the pursuit of litigation against other companies that are infringing this intellectual property, or may pursue such litigation less aggressively than we would. If, in the future, we no longer have rights to one or more of these licensed patents or other licensed intellectual property, our intellectual property coverage may be compromised, which, in turn, could affect our ability to sell our products, or to protect our products and defend them against competitors. Without protection for the intellectual property we license, other companies might be able to offer similar products for sale, which could adversely affect our competitive business position and harm our business prospects.

 

52


Table of Contents

We rely on a combination of contractual provisions, confidentiality procedures and patent, copyright, trademark, trade secret and other intellectual property laws to protect the proprietary aspects of our products, brands, technologies and data. These legal measures afford only limited protection, and competitors or others may gain access to or use our intellectual property and proprietary information. Our success will depend, in part, on preserving our trade secrets, maintaining the security of our data and know-how and obtaining and maintaining other intellectual property rights. We may not be able to obtain or maintain intellectual property or other proprietary rights necessary to our business or in a form that provides us with a competitive advantage.

In addition, despite our efforts to enter into confidentiality agreements with our employees, consultants, clients and other vendors who have access to such information, our trade secrets, data and know-how could be subject to unauthorized use, misappropriation, or disclosure to unauthorized parties, and could otherwise become known or be independently discovered by third parties. Our intellectual property, including trademarks, could be challenged, invalidated, infringed, and circumvented by third parties, and our trademarks could also be diluted, declared generic or found to be infringing on other marks. If any of the foregoing occurs, we could be forced to re-brand our products, resulting in loss of brand recognition and requiring us to devote resources to advertising and marketing new brands, and suffer other competitive harm. Third parties may also adopt trademarks similar to ours, which could harm our brand identity and lead to market confusion.

Failure to obtain and maintain intellectual property rights necessary to our business and failure to protect, monitor and control the use of our intellectual property rights could negatively impact our ability to compete and cause us to incur significant expenses. The intellectual property laws and other statutory and contractual arrangements in the United States and other jurisdictions may not provide sufficient protection in the future to prevent the infringement, use, violation or misappropriation of our trademarks, data, technology and other intellectual property and services, and may not provide an adequate remedy if our intellectual property rights are infringed, misappropriated or otherwise violated.

We rely, in part, on our ability to obtain, maintain, expand, enforce, and defend the scope of our intellectual property portfolio or other proprietary rights, including the amount and timing of any payments we may be required to make in connection with the licensing, filing, defense and enforcement of any patents or other intellectual property rights. The process of applying for and obtaining a patent is expensive, time-consuming and complex, and we may not be able to file, prosecute, maintain, enforce or license all necessary or desirable patent applications at a reasonable cost, in a timely manner, or in all jurisdictions where protection may be commercially advantageous, or we may not be able to protect our proprietary rights at all. Despite our efforts to protect our proprietary rights, unauthorized parties may be able to obtain and use information that we regard as proprietary.

We own numerous issued patents and pending patent applications. As of June 16, 2020, we held 29 U.S. patents, 26 pending U.S. patent applications, 69 issued foreign patents, 30 pending foreign patent applications and one pending Patent Cooperation Treaty application, and we also exclusively licensed two U.S. patents, four pending U.S. patent applications and one pending Patent Cooperation Treaty application. The patent positions of medical device companies, including our patent position, may involve complex legal and factual questions, and therefore, the scope, validity and enforceability of any patent claims that we may obtain cannot be predicted with certainty.

Though an issued patent is presumed valid and enforceable, its issuance is not conclusive as to its validity or its enforceability and it may not provide us with adequate proprietary protection or competitive advantages against competitors with similar products. Patents, if issued, may be challenged, deemed unenforceable, invalidated or circumvented. Proceedings challenging our patents could result in either loss of the patent, or denial or the patent application or loss or reduction in the scope of one or more of the claims of the patent or patent application. In addition, such proceedings may be costly. Thus, any patents that we may own may not provide any protection against competitors. Furthermore, an adverse decision may result in a third party receiving a patent right sought by us, which in turn could affect our ability to commercialize our products.

 

53


Table of Contents

Competitors could purchase our products and attempt to replicate or reverse engineer some or all of the competitive advantages we derive from our development efforts, willfully infringe our intellectual property rights, design around our patents, or develop and obtain patent protection for more effective technologies, designs or methods. We may be unable to prevent the unauthorized disclosure or use of our technical knowledge or trade secrets by consultants, suppliers, vendors, former employees and current employees. Further, the laws of some foreign countries do not protect our proprietary rights to the same extent as the laws of the United States, including the protection of surgical and medical methods, and we may encounter significant problems in protecting our proprietary rights in these countries.

In addition, proceedings to enforce or defend our patents could put our patents at risk of being invalidated, held unenforceable or interpreted narrowly. Such proceedings could also provoke third parties to assert claims against us, including that some or all of the claims in one or more of our patents are invalid or otherwise unenforceable. If any of our patents covering our products are invalidated or found unenforceable, or if a court found that valid, enforceable patents held by third parties covered one or more of our products, our competitive position could be harmed or we could be required to incur significant expenses to enforce or defend our rights.

The degree of future protection for our proprietary rights is uncertain, and we cannot ensure that:

 

   

any of our patents, or any of our pending patent applications, if issued, will include claims having a scope sufficient to protect our products;

 

   

any of our pending patent applications will issue as patents;

 

   

we will be able to successfully commercialize our products on a substantial scale, if approved, before our relevant patents we may have expire;

 

   

we were the first to make the inventions covered by each of our patents and pending patent applications;

 

   

we were the first to file patent applications for these inventions;

 

   

others will not develop similar or alternative technologies that do not infringe our patents;

 

   

any of our patents will be found to ultimately be valid and enforceable;

 

   

any patents issued to us will provide a basis for an exclusive market for our commercially viable products, will provide us with any competitive advantages or will not be challenged by third parties;

 

   

we will develop additional proprietary technologies or products that are separately patentable; or

 

   

our commercial activities or products will not infringe upon the patents of others.

Even if we are able to obtain patent protection, such patent protection may be of insufficient scope to achieve our business objectives. Issued patents may be challenged, narrowed, invalidated or circumvented. Decisions by courts and governmental patent agencies may introduce uncertainty in the enforceability or scope of patents owned by or licensed to us. Furthermore, the issuance of a patent does not give us the right to practice the patented invention. Third parties may have blocking patents that could prevent us from marketing our own products and practicing our own technology. Alternatively, third parties may seek approval to market their own products similar to or otherwise competitive with our products. In these circumstances, we may need to defend or assert our patents, including by filing lawsuits alleging patent infringement. In any of these types of proceedings, a court or agency with jurisdiction may find our patents invalid, unenforceable or not infringed; competitors may then be able to market products and use manufacturing and analytical processes that are substantially similar to ours. Even if we have valid and enforceable patents, these patents still may not provide protection against competing products or processes sufficient to achieve our business objectives.

 

54


Table of Contents

Obtaining and maintaining patent protection depends on compliance with various procedural, document submission, fee payment and other requirements imposed by governmental patent agencies, and our patent protection could be reduced or eliminated for non-compliance with these requirements.

The U.S. Patent and Trademark Office, or USPTO, and various foreign governmental patent agencies require compliance with a number of procedural, documentary, fee payment and other similar provisions during the patent application process. In addition, periodic maintenance fees on issued patents often must be paid to the USPTO and foreign patent agencies over the lifetime of the patent. While an unintentional lapse can in many cases be cured by payment of a late fee or by other means in accordance with the applicable rules, there are situations in which noncompliance can result in abandonment or lapse of the patent or patent application, resulting in partial or complete loss of patent rights in the relevant jurisdiction. Even if a lapse is cured, reviving the patent or application, there is a risk that the revival can be challenged by third parties in proceeding and litigation, and that the revival can be overruled. Non-compliance events that could result in abandonment or lapse of a patent or patent application include failure to respond to official actions within prescribed time limits, non-payment of fees and failure to properly legalize and submit formal documents. If we fail to maintain the patents and patent applications covering our products, we may not be able to stop a competitor from marketing products that are the same as or similar to our products, which would have a material adverse effect on our business.

Changes in patent law could diminish the value of patents in general, thereby impairing our ability to protect our existing and future products.

Recent patent reform legislation could increase the uncertainties and costs surrounding the prosecution of patent applications and the enforcement or defense of issued patents. In 2011, the Leahy-Smith America Invents Act, or the Leahy-Smith Act, was signed into law. The Leahy-Smith Act includes a number of significant changes to U.S. patent law. These include provisions that affect the way patent applications are prosecuted and also may affect patent litigation. These also include provisions that switched the United States from a “first-to-invent” system to a “first-to-file” system, allow third-party submission of prior art to the USPTO during patent prosecution and set forth additional procedures to attack the validity of a patent by the USPTO administered post grant proceedings. Under a first-to-file system, assuming the other requirements for patentability are met, the first inventor to file a patent application generally will be entitled to the patent on an invention regardless of whether another inventor had made the invention earlier. The USPTO recently developed new regulations and procedures to govern administration of the Leahy-Smith Act, and many of the substantive changes to patent law associated with the Leahy-Smith Act, and in particular, the first to file provisions, only became effective in 2013. Accordingly, it is not clear what, if any, impact the Leahy-Smith Act will have on the operation of our business. The Leahy-Smith Act and its implementation could increase the uncertainties and costs surrounding the prosecution of our patent applications and the enforcement or defense of our issued patents, all of which could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

In addition, patent reform legislation may pass in the future that could lead to additional uncertainties and increased costs surrounding the prosecution, enforcement and defense of our patents and applications. Furthermore, the U.S. Supreme Court and the U.S. Court of Appeals for the Federal Circuit have made, and will likely continue to make, changes in how the patent laws of the United States are interpreted. Similarly, foreign courts have made, and will likely continue to make, changes in how the patent laws in their respective jurisdictions are interpreted. We cannot predict future changes in the interpretation of patent laws and regulations or changes to patent laws and regulations that might be enacted into law by U.S. and foreign legislative bodies and patent offices. Those changes may materially affect our patents or patent applications and our ability to obtain additional patent protection in the future.

 

55


Table of Contents

If we cannot license and maintain rights to use third-party technology on reasonable terms, we may not be able to successfully commercialize our products. Our licensed or acquired technology may lose value or utility or over time.

We have licensed technology from third parties and may choose or need to do so in the future, including to develop or commercialize new products or services. We may also need to negotiate licenses to patents or patent applications before or after introducing a commercial product, and we may not be able to obtain necessary licenses to such patents or patent applications. If we are unable to enter into the necessary licenses on acceptable terms or at all, if any necessary licenses are subsequently terminated, if the licensors fail to abide by the terms of the licenses or fail to prevent infringement by third parties, or if the licensed patents or other rights are found to be invalid or unenforceable, our business may suffer. In addition, any technology licensed or acquired by us may lose value or utility, including as a result of a change of in the industry, in our business objectives, others’ technology, our dispute with the licensor, and other circumstances outside our control. In return for the use of a third party’s technology, we may agree to pay the licensor royalties based on sales of our products or services. If we are unable to negotiate reasonable royalties or if we have to pay royalties on technology that becomes less useful for us or ceases to provide value to us, our profit margin will be reduced and we may suffer losses.

We may become a party to intellectual property litigation or administrative proceedings that could be costly and could interfere with our ability to sell and market our products.

The medical device industry has been characterized by extensive litigation regarding patents, trademarks, trade secrets, and other intellectual property rights, and companies in the industry have used intellectual property litigation to gain a competitive advantage. It is possible that U.S. and foreign patents and pending patent applications or trademarks controlled by third parties may be alleged to cover our products, or that we may be accused of misappropriating third parties’ trade secrets. Additionally, our products include components that we purchase from vendors, and may include design components that are outside of our direct control. Our competitors, many of which have substantially greater resources and have made substantial investments in patent portfolios, trade secrets, trademarks, and competing technologies, may have applied for or obtained, or may in the future apply for or obtain, patents or trademarks that will prevent, limit or otherwise interfere with our ability to make, use, sell or export our products or to use our technologies or product names. Moreover, in recent years, individuals and groups that are non-practicing entities, commonly referred to as “patent trolls,” have purchased patents and other intellectual property assets for the purpose of making claims of infringement in order to extract settlements. From time to time, we may receive threatening letters, notices or “invitations to license,” or may be the subject of claims that our products and business operations infringe or violate the intellectual property rights of others. The defense of these matters can be time consuming, costly to defend in litigation, divert management’s attention and resources, damage our reputation and brand and cause us to incur significant expenses or make substantial payments. Vendors from whom we purchase hardware or software may not indemnify us in the event that such hardware or software is accused of infringing a third-party’s patent or trademark or of misappropriating a third-party’s trade secret.

Since patent applications are confidential for a period of time after filing, we cannot be certain that we were the first to file any patent application related to our products. Because of the confidential nature of patent applications, we do not know at any given time what patent applications are pending that may later issue as a patent and be asserted by a third party against us. Competitors may also contest our patents, if issued, by showing the patent examiner that the invention was not original, was not novel, or was invalid or unenforceable for other reasons. In litigation or administrative proceedings, a competitor could claim that our patents, if issued, are not valid for a number of reasons. If a court agrees, we would lose our rights to those challenged patents or have the scope of those rights narrowed.

In addition, we may in the future be subject to claims by our former employees or consultants asserting an ownership right in our patents, patent applications or other intellectual property, as a result of the work they performed on our behalf. Although we generally require all of our employees and consultants and any other

 

56


Table of Contents

partners or collaborators who have access to our proprietary know-how, information or technology to assign or grant similar rights to their inventions to us, we cannot be certain that we have executed such agreements with all parties who may have contributed to our intellectual property, nor can we be certain that our agreements with such parties will be upheld in the face of a potential challenge, that such agreements will adequately protect us, or that they will not be breached, for which we may not have an adequate remedy.

Any lawsuits relating to intellectual property rights could subject us to significant liability for damages and invalidate our proprietary rights. Any potential intellectual property litigation also could force us to do one or more of the following:

 

   

stop making, selling or using products or technologies that allegedly infringe the asserted intellectual property;

 

   

lose the opportunity to license our intellectual property to others or to collect royalty payments based upon successful protection and assertion of our intellectual property rights against others; incur significant legal expenses;

 

   

pay substantial damages or royalties to the party whose intellectual property rights we may be found to be infringing;

 

   

pay the attorney’s fees and costs of litigation to the party whose intellectual property rights we may be found to be infringing;

 

   

redesign those products or technologies that contain the allegedly infringing intellectual property, which could be costly and disruptive, and may be infeasible; and

 

   

attempt to obtain a license to the relevant intellectual property from third parties, which may not be available on reasonable terms or at all, or from third parties who may attempt to license rights that they do not have.

Any litigation or claim against us, even those without merit and even those where we prevail, may cause us to incur substantial costs, and could place a significant strain on our financial resources, divert the attention of management from our core business and harm our reputation. If we are found to infringe the intellectual property rights of third parties, we could be required to pay substantial damages, including the third party’s lost profits, the disgorgement of our profits, or substantial royalties (all of which may be increased, including three times the awarded damages, if we are found to willfully infringe third-party patents or trademarks or to have misappropriated trade secrets) and could be prevented from selling our products unless we obtain a license or are able to redesign our products to avoid infringement. Any such license may not be available on reasonable terms, if at all, and there can be no assurance that we would be able to redesign our products in a way that would not infringe the intellectual property rights of others. Although patent, trademark, trade secret, and other intellectual property disputes in the medical device area are often settled through licensing or similar arrangements, costs associated with such arrangements may be substantial and could include ongoing royalties. If we do not obtain necessary licenses, we may not be able to redesign our products to avoid infringement. We could encounter delays in product introductions while we attempt to develop alternative methods or products, and these alternative methods or products may be less competitive, which could adversely affect our competitive business position. If we fail to obtain any required licenses or make any necessary changes to our products or technologies, we may have to withdraw existing products from the market or may be unable to commercialize one or more of our products.

In addition, we generally indemnify our customers with respect to infringement by our products of the proprietary rights of third parties. However, third parties may assert infringement claims against our customers. These claims may require us to initiate or defend protracted and costly litigation on behalf of our customers, regardless of the merits of these claims. If any of these claims succeed or settle, we may be forced to pay damages or settlement payments on behalf of our customers or may be required to obtain licenses for the products they use. If we cannot obtain all necessary licenses on commercially reasonable terms, our customers may be forced to stop using our products.

 

57


Table of Contents

Similarly, interference or derivation proceedings provoked by third parties or brought by the USPTO may be necessary to determine priority with respect to our patents, patent applications, trademarks or trademark applications. We may also become involved in other proceedings, such as reexamination, inter parties review, post grant review, derivation or opposition proceedings before the USPTO or other jurisdictional body relating to our intellectual property rights or the intellectual property rights of others. Adverse determinations in a judicial or administrative proceeding or failure to obtain necessary licenses could prevent us from manufacturing our products or using product names, which would have a significant adverse impact on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Additionally, we may file lawsuits or initiate other proceedings to protect or enforce our patents or other intellectual property rights, which could be expensive, time consuming and unsuccessful. Competitors may infringe our issued patents or other intellectual property. To counter infringement or unauthorized use, we may be required to file infringement claims, which can be expensive and time-consuming. Any claims we assert against perceived infringers could provoke these parties to assert counterclaims against us alleging that we infringe their intellectual property. In addition, in a patent or other intellectual property infringement proceeding, a court may decide that a patent or other intellectual property of ours is invalid or unenforceable, in whole or in part, construe the patent’s claims or other intellectual property narrowly or refuse to stop the other party from using the technology at issue on the grounds that our patents or other intellectual property do not cover the technology in question. Furthermore, even if our patents or other intellectual property are found to be valid and infringed, a court may refuse to grant injunctive relief against the infringer and instead grant us monetary damages or ongoing royalties. Such monetary compensation may be insufficient to adequately offset the damage to our business caused by the infringer’s competition in the market. An adverse result in any litigation proceeding could put one or more of our patents or other intellectual property at risk of being invalidated or interpreted narrowly, which could adversely affect our competitive business position, financial condition and results of operations.

If we are unable to protect the confidentiality of our other proprietary information, our business and competitive position may be harmed.

In addition to patent protection, we also rely on protection of trade secrets, know-how and other proprietary information that is not patentable or that we elect not to patent. However, trade secrets can be difficult to protect and some courts are less willing or unwilling to protect trade secrets. To maintain the confidentiality of our trade secrets and proprietary information, we rely heavily on confidentiality provisions that we have in contracts with our employees, consultants, collaborators and others upon the commencement of their relationship with us. We cannot guarantee that we have entered into such agreements with each party that may have or have had access to our trade secrets or proprietary technology and processes. We may not be able to prevent the unauthorized disclosure or use of our technical knowledge or other trade secrets by such third parties, despite the existence generally of these confidentiality restrictions. These contracts may not provide meaningful protection for our trade secrets, know-how, or other proprietary information in the event the unwanted use is outside the scope of the provisions of the contracts or in the event of any unauthorized use, misappropriation, or disclosure of such trade secrets, know-how, or other proprietary information. There can be no assurance that such third parties will not breach their agreements with us, that we will have adequate remedies for any breach, or that our trade secrets will not otherwise become known or independently developed by competitors. Despite the protections we do place on our intellectual property or other proprietary rights, monitoring unauthorized use and disclosure of our intellectual property is difficult, and we do not know whether the steps we have taken to protect our intellectual property or other proprietary rights will be adequate. In addition, the laws of many foreign countries will not protect our intellectual property or other proprietary rights to the same extent as the laws of the United States. Consequently, we may be unable to prevent our proprietary technology from being exploited abroad, which could affect our ability to expand to international markets or require costly efforts to protect our technology. To the extent our intellectual property or other proprietary information protection is incomplete, we are exposed to a greater risk of direct competition. A third party could, without authorization, copy or otherwise obtain and use our products or technology, or develop similar technology. Our competitors could purchase our products and

 

58


Table of Contents

attempt to replicate some or all of the competitive advantages we derive from our development efforts or design around our protected technology. Our failure to secure, protect and enforce our intellectual property rights could substantially harm the value of our products, brand and business. The theft or unauthorized use or publication of our trade secrets and other confidential business information could reduce the differentiation of our products and harm our business, the value of our investment in development or business acquisitions could be reduced and third parties might make claims against us related to losses of their confidential or proprietary information. Any of the foregoing could materially and adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Further, it is possible that others will independently develop the same or similar technology or products or otherwise obtain access to our unpatented technology, and in such cases we could not assert any trade secret rights against such parties. Costly and time-consuming litigation could be necessary to enforce and determine the scope of our trade secret rights and related confidentiality and nondisclosure provisions. If we fail to obtain or maintain trade secret protection, or if our competitors obtain our trade secrets or independently develop technology or products similar to ours or competing technologies or products, our competitive market position could be materially and adversely affected.

We also seek to preserve the integrity and confidentiality of our data and other confidential information by maintaining physical security of our premises and physical and electronic security of our information technology systems. While we have confidence in these individuals, organizations and systems, agreements or security measures may be breached and detecting the disclosure or misappropriation of confidential information and enforcing a claim that a party illegally disclosed or misappropriated confidential information is difficult, expensive and time-consuming, and the outcome is unpredictable. Further, we may not be able to obtain adequate remedies for any breach.

We may not be able to protect our intellectual property rights throughout the world.

A company may attempt to commercialize competing products utilizing our proprietary design, trademarks or tradenames in foreign countries where we do not have any patents or patent applications and where legal recourse may be limited. This may have a significant commercial impact on our foreign business operations.

Filing, prosecuting and defending patents or trademarks on our current and future products in all countries throughout the world would be prohibitively expensive. The requirements for patentability and trademarking may differ in certain countries, particularly developing countries. The laws of some foreign countries do not protect intellectual property rights including the protection of surgical and medical methods, to the same extent as laws in the United States. Consequently, we may not be able to prevent third parties from utilizing our inventions and trademarks in all countries outside the United States. Competitors may use our technologies or trademarks in jurisdictions where we have not obtained patent or trademark protection to develop or market their own products and further, may export otherwise infringing products to territories where we have patent and trademark protection, but enforcement on infringing activities is inadequate. These products or trademarks may compete with our products or trademarks, and our patents, trademarks or other intellectual property rights may not be effective or sufficient to prevent them from competing.

Many companies have encountered significant problems in protecting and defending intellectual property rights in foreign jurisdictions. The legal systems of certain countries, particularly certain developing countries, do not favor the enforcement of patents, trademarks and other intellectual property protection, which could make it difficult for us to stop the infringement of our patents and trademarks or marketing of competing products in violation of our proprietary rights generally. Proceedings to enforce our patent and trademarks rights in foreign jurisdictions could result in substantial costs and divert our efforts and attention from other aspects of our business, could put our patents and trademarks in those jurisdictions, as well as elsewhere at risk of being invalidated or interpreted narrowly and our patent or trademark applications at risk, and could provoke third parties to assert claims against us. We may not prevail in any lawsuits that we initiate and the damages or other remedies awarded, if any, may not be commercially meaningful. Certain countries in Europe and certain

 

59


Table of Contents

developing countries, including India and China, have compulsory licensing laws under which a patent owner may be compelled to grant licenses to third parties. In those countries, we may have limited remedies if our patents are infringed or if we are compelled to grant a license to our patents to a third party, which could materially diminish the value of those patents. This could limit our potential revenue opportunities. Accordingly, our efforts to enforce our intellectual property rights around the world may be inadequate to obtain a significant commercial advantage from the intellectual property that we own or license. Finally, our ability to protect and enforce our intellectual property rights may be adversely affected by unforeseen changes in foreign intellectual property laws.

We may be subject to claims that we or our employees have misappropriated the intellectual property of a third party, including trade secrets or know-how, or are in breach of non-competition or non-solicitation agreements with our competitors.

Many of our employees and consultants were previously employed at or engaged by other medical device or other biotechnology companies, including our competitors or potential competitors. Some of these employees, consultants and contractors, may have executed proprietary rights, non-disclosure and non-competition agreements in connection with such previous employment. Although we try to ensure that our employees and consultants do not use the intellectual property, proprietary information, know-how or trade secrets of others in their work for us, we may be subject to claims that we or these individuals have, inadvertently or otherwise, misappropriated the intellectual property or disclosed the alleged trade secrets or other proprietary information, of these former employers or competitors.

Additionally, we may be subject to claims from third parties challenging our ownership interest in intellectual property we regard as our own, based on claims that our employees or consultants have breached an obligation to assign inventions to another employer, to a former employer, or to another person or entity. Litigation may be necessary to defend against any other claims, and it may be necessary or we may desire to enter into a license to settle any such claim; however, there can be no assurance that we would be able to obtain a license on commercially reasonable terms, if at all. If our defense to those claims fails, in addition to paying monetary damages, a court could prohibit us from using technologies or features that are essential to our products, if such technologies or features are found to incorporate or be derived from the trade secrets or other proprietary information of the former employers. An inability to incorporate technologies or features that are important or essential to our products could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations, and may prevent us from selling our products. In addition, we may lose valuable intellectual property rights or personnel. Even if we are successful in defending against these claims, litigation could result in substantial costs and could be a distraction to management. Any litigation or the threat thereof may adversely affect our ability to hire employees or contract with independent sales representatives. A loss of key personnel or their work product could hamper or prevent our ability to commercialize our products, which could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

The failure of third parties to meet their contractual, regulatory, and other obligations could adversely affect our business.

We rely on suppliers, vendors, outsourcing partners, consultants, alliance partners and other third parties to research, develop, manufacture and commercialize our products and manage certain parts of our business. Using these third parties poses a number of risks, such as:

 

   

they may not perform to our standards or legal requirements;

 

   

they may not produce reliable results;

 

   

they may not perform in a timely manner;

 

   

they may not maintain confidentiality of our proprietary information;

 

60


Table of Contents
   

disputes may arise with respect to ownership of rights to technology developed with our partners, and those dispute may be resolved against us; and

 

   

disagreements could cause delays in, or termination of, the research, development or commercialization of our products or result in litigation or arbitration.

Moreover, some third parties are located in markets subject to political and social risk, corruption, infrastructure problems and natural disasters, in addition to country-specific privacy and data security risk given current legal and regulatory environments. Failure of third parties to meet their contractual, regulatory, and other obligations may materially affect our business.

We are jointly developing certain technologies with Oertli Instrumente AG, or Oertli, and our agreement with Oertli may restrict our freedom to practice and may not protect us against potential competition with respect to jointly-developed intellectual property.

We have entered into a development agreement with Oertli pursuant to which we are collaborating in the development of a key component in our ALLY system. Under this agreement, intellectual property invented individually by either party is owned exclusively by such party and intellectual property jointly developed by us and Oertli will be jointly and severally owned by us and Oertli, and by the terms of our agreement, we and Oertli are entitled to practice such jointly owned intellectual property in our respective sole discretion. Our agreement with Oertli does not restrict how individually or jointly developed intellectual property may be used, exploited, or enforced. With respect to jointly developed intellectual property, both parties will be subject to default rules under the laws of various countries pertaining to joint ownership. Some countries require the consent of all joint owners to exploit, license or assign jointly owned patents, and if either party is unable to obtain that consent from the other party, the party requesting consent may be unable to exploit the invention or to license or assign its rights under these patents and patent applications in those countries. Additionally, in the United States, the other party may be required to be joined as a party to any claim or action a party may wish to bring to enforce these patent rights, which may limit its ability to pursue third party infringement claims. In some countries, Oertli will have a right to develop and commercialize products and technology invented during the course of our agreement, and to license to third parties the right to do so. This may lead to the development and commercialization of products and technology by others that are based on technology similar to our ALLY system platform, which may impair our competitive position in the marketplace and have an adverse impact on our business. If we cannot obtain distribution rights for such jointly-owned intellectual property or Oertli-owned intellectual property, our future product development and commercialization plans and competitive position in our industry may be adversely affected, which may have a material adverse impact on our business, financial condition and results of operation.

If our trademarks and tradenames are not adequately protected, then we may not be able to build name recognition in our markets and our business may be adversely affected.

We rely on trademarks, service marks, tradenames and brand names to distinguish our products from the products of our competitors, and have registered or applied to register many of these trademarks. We cannot assure you that our trademark applications will be approved. During trademark registration proceedings, we may receive rejections. Although we are given an opportunity to respond to those rejections, we may be unable to overcome such rejections. In addition, in proceedings before the USPTO and comparable agencies in many foreign jurisdictions, third parties are given an opportunity to oppose pending trademark applications and to seek to cancel registered trademarks. Opposition or cancellation proceedings may be filed against our trademarks, and our trademarks may not survive such proceedings. In the event that our trademarks are successfully challenged, we could be forced to rebrand our products, which could result in loss of brand recognition and could require us to devote resources towards advertising and marketing new brands. At times, competitors may adopt trade names or trademarks similar to ours, thereby impeding our ability to build brand identity and possibly leading to market confusion. Certain of our current or future trademarks may become so well known by the public that their use

 

61


Table of Contents

becomes generic and they lose trademark protection. Over the long term, if we are unable to establish name recognition based on our trademarks and trade names, then we may not be able to compete effectively and our business, financial condition and results of operations may be adversely affected.

Risks Related to the Spin-Off

The Spin-Off may not be completed on the terms or timeline currently contemplated, if at all.

We are actively engaged in planning for the Spin-Off. Unanticipated developments could delay or negatively affect the Spin-Off, including delays related to the filing and effectiveness of appropriate filings with the SEC, acceptance of our common stock for listing by the Nasdaq Capital Market, completing further due diligence as appropriate, and changes in market conditions, among other things. PDL’s board of directors may also, in its absolute and sole discretion, decide at any time prior to the consummation of the Distribution not to proceed with the Spin-Off or change the terms of the Spin-Off, including the establishment of the record date and Distribution date or waiving certain conditions to the Spin-Off under the Separation and Distribution Agreement, such as the requirement that our common stock be accepted for listing on Nasdaq Capital Market, subject to official notice of issuance. Therefore, the Spin-Off may not be completed on the terms or in accordance with the timeline currently contemplated, if at all. Any delays in the anticipated completion of the Spin-Off may also increase the expenses we or PDL incur in connection with the transaction.

The Spin-Off require significant time and attention of our management and may distract our employees which could have an adverse effect on us.

Execution of the Spin-Off will require significant time and attention from management, which may distract management from the operation of our business and the execution of our other initiatives. Employees may also be distracted because of uncertainty about their future roles with us or PDL, as applicable, pending the completion of the Distribution. Any such difficulties could have a material and adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Our ability to meet our capital needs may be harmed by the loss of financial support from PDL.

The loss of financial support from PDL could harm our ability to meet our capital needs. After the Spin-Off, we expect to obtain any funds needed in excess of our cash on hand and the amounts generated by our operating activities through the equity and debt capital markets or bank financing, and not from PDL. However, given the smaller relative size of us after the Spin-Off as compared to PDL, we may incur higher debt servicing and other costs than we would have otherwise incurred as a part of PDL. Further, there can be no assurances that we will be able to obtain capital market financing or additional credit on favorable terms, or at all, in the future. If we are unable to generate sufficient cash from operations or obtain adequate additional financing on commercially reasonable terms, on a timely basis or at all, our ability to invest in our business or fund our business strategy may be limited and may materially and adversely affect our ability to compete effectively in our markets.

We may be unable to achieve some or all of the benefits that we expect to achieve as an independent, publicly traded company.

By separating from PDL, we may be more susceptible to securities market fluctuations and other adverse events than we would have otherwise encountered as part of PDL. In addition, we may not be able to achieve some or all of the benefits that we expect to achieve as an independent, publicly traded company in the time in which we expect to do so, if at all. For example, the process of operating as a newly independent, public company may distract our management team from focusing on our business and strategic priorities. If we do not realize the anticipated benefits from the Spin-Off for any reason, our business may be adversely affected.

 

62


Table of Contents

We may have difficulty operating as an independent, publicly traded company.

As an independent, publicly traded company, we believe that our business will benefit from, among other things, providing direct access to equity capital and a tailored capital structure, allowing us to better focus our financial and operational resources on our specific business, allowing our management to design and implement corporate strategies and policies that are based primarily on the business characteristics and strategic decisions of our business, allowing us to more effectively respond to industry dynamics and allowing the creation of effective incentives for our management and employees that are more closely tied to our business performance. However, we may not be able to achieve some or all of the benefits that we believe we can achieve as an independent company in the time we currently expect, if at all. Because our business has previously operated as part of the larger PDL organization, we may not be able to successfully implement the changes necessary to operate independently and may incur additional costs that could adversely affect our business.

We may incur material costs, including information technology costs, and expenses as a result of our Spin-Off from PDL, which could adversely affect our profitability.

As a result of our Spin-Off from PDL, we may incur costs and expenses greater than those we currently incur. These increased costs and expenses may arise from various factors, including financial reporting, accounting and audit services, insurance, costs associated with information technology systems, complying with federal securities laws (including compliance with the Sarbanes-Oxley Act) and legal and human resources-related functions. Although PDL will continue to provide certain of these services to us under the Transition Services Agreement, this arrangement may not capture all the benefits our business has enjoyed as a result of being integrated with PDL. In addition, such services are for a limited period of time, and we will be required to establish the necessary infrastructure and systems to supply these services on an ongoing basis. We cannot assure you that these costs will not be material to our business.

The combined post-Distribution value of our common stock and PDL common stock following completion of the Distribution may not equal or exceed the pre-Distribution value of PDL common stock.

After the Distribution, we expect that our common stock will be listed and traded on the Nasdaq Capital Market under the symbol “LNSR.” PDL common stock will continue to be listed and traded on the Nasdaq Global Select Market. The combined trading price of our common stock and PDL common stock after the Distribution, as adjusted for any changes in our capitalization or in the capitalization of PDL, could be lower than the trading price of PDL common stock prior to the Distribution. The prices at which our common stock and PDL common stock trade may fluctuate significantly, depending upon a number of factors, many of which may be beyond our and PDL’s control. These changes may not meet some stockholders’ investment strategies or requirements, which could cause investors to sell their shares of our common stock or PDL common stock. Excessive selling could cause the relative market price of our common stock or PDL common stock to decrease following completion of the Distribution.

Our historical financial information may not be representative of the results we would have achieved as a stand-alone public company during the periods presented and may not be a reliable indicator of our future results.

The historical financial data that we have included in this information statement may not necessarily reflect what our financial position, results of operations or cash flows would have been had we been an independent entity during the periods presented or those that we will achieve in the future. The costs and expenses reflected in our historical financial data include an allocation for certain corporate functions historically provided by PDL, including shared services and infrastructure provided by PDL to us, such as costs of information technology, accounting, tax and legal services, and other corporate and infrastructure services that may be different from the comparable expenses that we would have incurred had we operated as a stand-alone company. Our historical financial data does not reflect changes that will occur in our cost structure and operations as a result of our

 

63


Table of Contents

transition to becoming a stand-alone public company, including changes in our employee base, potential increased costs associated with reduced economies of scale and increased costs associated with SEC reporting and requirements. Accordingly, the historical financial data presented in this information statement should not be assumed to be indicative of what our financial condition or results of operations actually would have been as an independent, publicly traded company or to be a reliable indicator of what our financial condition or results of operations actually could be in the future.

Similarly, our unaudited pro forma financial information in this information statement is presented for illustrative purposes only. Accordingly, such unaudited pro forma financial information may not be indicative of our future operating or financial performance and our actual financial condition and results of operations may vary materially from our unaudited pro forma statement of operations and balance sheet contained elsewhere in this information statement.

If the Spin-Off is completed, our operational and financial profile will change and we will be a smaller, less diversified company than PDL was prior to the Distribution and we may not enjoy the same benefits that we did as part of PDL.

If the Spin-Off is completed, we will be a smaller, less diversified company focused on the design, development and commercialization of advanced technology for the treatment of cataracts and management of astigmatism, which represents a narrower business focus than PDL currently has. By separating from PDL, we may become more susceptible to market fluctuations and other adverse events than we would have been if we were still a part of the current PDL organizational structure, which could materially and adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations. As part of PDL, we have been able to enjoy certain benefits from PDL’s operating diversity and more readily available capital to fund investments, as well as opportunities to pursue integrated strategies with PDL’s other businesses. As an independent, publicly traded company, we will not have similar diversity, available capital or integration opportunities and may not have similar access to equity and debt capital markets. In addition, we currently share economies of scope and scale with PDL with respect to certain costs and supplier relationships, and take advantage of PDL’s size and purchasing power in procuring certain products and services, such as insurance and healthcare benefits, and technology, such as computer software licenses. After the Spin-Off, as a separate, independent entity, we may be unable to obtain these products, services and technologies at prices or on terms as favorable to us as those we obtained prior to the Spin-Off.

Following the Spin-Off, we will rely on PDL’s performance under various agreements and we and PDL will continue to be dependent on each other for certain support services for each respective business.

We expect to enter into or have entered into various agreements with PDL in connection with the Spin-Off, including the Separation and Distribution Agreement, Transition Services Agreement and Tax Matters Agreement. These agreements will govern our relationship with PDL subsequent to the Spin-Off. If PDL were to fail to fulfill its obligations under these agreements, we could suffer operational difficulties or significant losses. For example, as part of PDL’s previously announced process to unlock value within PDL either by sale of PDL or monetization of its assets, PDL’s stockholders approved the liquidation and dissolution of PDL, and PDL has announced that it is currently targeting the end of 2020 to file a certificate of dissolution with the Secretary of State of the State of Delaware, although it acknowledges that such filing may be delayed given the uncertainties related to the COVID-19 pandemic. Pursuant to Delaware law, PDL’s corporate existence would continue for a period of at least three years for certain limited purposes after any such filing of a certificate of dissolution, which we expect would include fulfillment of its obligations under these agreements, but we cannot assure we will receive the expected benefit from these agreements.

If we are required to indemnify PDL for certain liabilities and related losses arising in connection with any of these agreements, or if PDL is required to indemnify us for certain liabilities and related losses arising in connection with any of these agreements and PDL does not fulfill its obligations to us, we may be subject to substantial liabilities, which could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

64


Table of Contents

Additionally, although PDL will be contractually obligated to provide us with certain services during the term of the Transition Services Agreement, we cannot assure you that these services will be performed as efficiently or proficiently as they were prior to the Spin-Off. The Transition Services Agreement also contains provisions that may be more favorable than terms and provisions we might have obtained in arm’s length negotiations with unaffiliated third parties. When PDL ceases to provide services pursuant to the Transition Services Agreement, our costs of procuring those services from third parties may increase. In addition, we may not be able to replace these services in a timely manner or enter into appropriate third-party agreements on terms and conditions, including cost, comparable to those under the Transition Services Agreement. To the extent that we require additional support from PDL not addressed in the Transition Services Agreement, we would need to negotiate the terms of receiving such support in future agreements. See “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions—Agreements between PDL and LENSAR Relating to the Spin-Off.”

Our ability to operate our business may suffer if we do not, quickly and effectively, establish our own financial, administrative, accounting and other support functions in order to operate as a separate, stand-alone company, and we cannot assure you that the support services PDL has agreed to provide us will be sufficient for our needs.

Historically, we have relied on financial, administrative, accounting, tax and other resources of PDL to support the operation of our business. In conjunction with our Spin-Off from PDL, we will need to expand our financial, administrative, accounting, tax and other support systems or contract with third parties to replace certain systems that were previously provided by PDL. We will also need to maintain our own credit and banking relationships and perform our own financial and operational functions. We cannot assure you that we will be able to successfully put in place the financial, operational and managerial resources necessary to operate as a public company or that we will be able to be profitable doing so. Any failure or significant downtime in our financial or administrative systems could affect our results or prevent us from performing other administrative services and financial reporting on a timely basis and could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

We will be subject to continuing contingent liabilities of PDL following the Spin-Off.

After the Spin-Off, there will be several significant areas where the liabilities of PDL may become our obligations. For example, under the Code and the related rules and regulations, each corporation that was a member of the PDL consolidated U.S. federal income tax reporting group during any taxable period or portion of any taxable period ending on or before the effective time of the Distribution is jointly and severally liable for the U.S. federal income tax liability of the entire PDL consolidated tax reporting group for that taxable period. In addition, in connection with the Spin-Off, we intend to enter into the Tax Matters Agreement with PDL that will allocate the responsibility for taxes between PDL and us. Pursuant to this allocation, we may be responsible for taxes that we would not have otherwise incurred, or that we would have incurred but in different amounts or at different times, on a standalone basis outside of the PDL consolidated group, and the amount of such taxes could be significant. See “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions—Agreements between PDL and LENSAR Relating to the Spin-Off” included elsewhere in this information statement for more detail. However, if PDL is unable to pay any prior period taxes for which it is responsible, we could be required to pay the entire amount of such taxes.

We have overlapping board membership with PDL, which may lead to conflicting interests, and one of our directors continues to own a substantial amount of PDL common stock and equity awards covering PDL common stock.

As a result of the Spin-Off, some of our board members will also serve as board members of PDL. Neither we nor PDL will have any ownership interest in the other; however, our directors who are members of the PDL board of directors have fiduciary duties to PDL stockholders, as well as fiduciary duties to our stockholders. Therefore, such persons may have conflicts of interest or the appearance of conflicts of interest with respect to matters involving or affecting more than one of the companies to which they owe fiduciary duties. In addition, a

 

65


Table of Contents

number of our directors and officers will continue to own PDL common stock, as well as, in some cases, equity awards covering PDL common stock. The direct interests of our directors and officers in common stock of PDL could create, or appear to create, potential conflicts of interest with respect to matters involving both PDL and us that could have different implications for PDL than they do for us.

As a result of the foregoing, there may be the potential for a conflict of interest when we or PDL consider acquisitions and other corporate opportunities. In addition, potential conflicts of interest could arise in connection with the resolution of any dispute that may arise between PDL and us regarding the terms of the agreements governing the internal reorganization, the Spin-Off and the relationship thereafter between the companies, including with respect to the indemnification of certain matters. From time to time, we may enter into transactions with PDL, its subsidiaries and other affiliates. There can be no assurance that the terms of any such transactions will be as favorable to us, PDL or any of our or their subsidiaries or affiliates as would be the case where there is no overlapping officer or director or ownership of both companies. See “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions—Policies and Procedures for Related Party Transactions” below for a discussion of certain procedures we will institute to address any such potential conflicts that may arise.

Potential indemnification obligations to PDL pursuant to the Separation and Distribution Agreement could materially and adversely affect us.

Among other things, the Separation and Distribution Agreement provides for indemnification obligations designed to make us financially responsible for substantially all of the liabilities that may exist relating to our business activities, whether incurred prior to or after the Spin-Off. If we are required to indemnify PDL under the circumstances set forth in the Separation and Distribution Agreement, we may be subject to substantial liabilities.

The Spin-Off may expose us to potential liabilities arising out of state and federal fraudulent conveyance laws and legal dividend requirements.

The Spin-Off is subject to review under various state and federal fraudulent conveyance laws. Fraudulent conveyance laws generally provide that an entity engages in a constructive fraudulent conveyance when (i) the entity transfers assets and does not receive fair consideration or reasonably equivalent value in return; and (ii) the entity: (a) is insolvent at the time of the transfer or is rendered insolvent by the transfer; (b) has unreasonably small capital with which to carry on its business; or (c) intends to incur or believes it will incur debts beyond its ability to repay its debts as they mature. An unpaid creditor or an entity acting on behalf of a creditor (including without limitation a trustee or debtor-in-possession in a bankruptcy by us or PDL or any of our respective subsidiaries) may bring an action alleging that the Distribution or any of the related transactions constituted a constructive fraudulent conveyance. If a court accepts these allegations, it could impose a number of remedies, including without limitation, voiding our claims against PDL, requiring our stockholders to return to PDL some or all of the shares of our common stock issued in the Distribution, or providing PDL with a claim for money damages against us in an amount equal to the difference between the consideration received by PDL and our fair market value at the time of the Spin-Off.

The measure of insolvency for purposes of the fraudulent conveyance laws will vary depending on which jurisdiction’s law is applied. Generally, an entity would be considered insolvent if (i) the present fair saleable value of its assets is less than the amount of its liabilities (including contingent liabilities); (ii) the present fair saleable value of its assets is less than its probable liabilities on its debts as such debts become absolute and matured; (iii) it cannot pay its debts and other liabilities (including contingent liabilities and other commitments) as they mature; or (iv) it has unreasonably small capital for the business in which it is engaged. We cannot assure you what standard a court would apply to determine insolvency or that a court would determine that we, PDL or any of our respective subsidiaries were solvent at the time of or after giving effect to the Distribution.

The Spin-Off of our common stock is also subject to review under state corporate distribution statutes. Under the DGCL, a corporation may only pay dividends to its stockholders either (i) out of its surplus (net assets

 

66


Table of Contents

minus capital) or (ii) if there is no such surplus, out of its net profits for the fiscal year in which the dividend is declared or the preceding fiscal year. Although PDL intends to make the distribution of our common stock entirely from surplus, we cannot assure you that a court will not later determine that some or all of the Spin-Off to PDL stockholders was unlawful.

The Distribution will not qualify for tax-free treatment.

The Distribution will not qualify for tax-free treatment, but rather is intended to be treated as part of a liquidating distribution by PDL. In accordance with such treatment, if you are a U.S. Holder (as defined in “Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences of the Distribution”), an amount equal to the fair market value of our common stock (together with any other property distributed as part of the liquidating distribution) received by you will be treated as received in exchange for your shares of PDL common stock and will first be applied against and reduce your basis in such shares of PDL common stock, but not below zero. Any remaining amount in excess of your basis in such shares of PDL common stock will be treated as capital gain. As cash will be paid in the Distribution only in lieu of fractional shares, you may need alternative sources from which to pay your resulting U.S. federal income tax liability.

Although PDL will ascribe a value to our common stock distributed in the Distribution, this valuation is not binding on the Internal Revenue Services, or IRS, or any other tax authority. These taxing authorities could ascribe a higher valuation to our distributed common stock, particularly if, following the Distribution, our common stock trades at prices significantly above the value ascribed to those shares by PDL. Such a higher valuation may affect the tax consequences of the Distribution to holders of PDL common stock.

Notwithstanding PDL’s position that the Distribution will be treated as part of a series of distributions in complete liquidation of PDL, it is possible that the IRS or a court could determine that the Distribution is a current distribution. In addition, if PDL’s liquidation is abandoned or revoked, the Distribution would be treated as a current distribution. A current distribution would be treated as a dividend for U.S. federal income tax purposes to the extent of PDL’s current and accumulated earnings and profits. Under this treatment, amounts not treated as dividends for U.S. federal income tax purposes would constitute a return of capital and first be applied against and reduce a holder’s adjusted tax basis in its PDL common stock, but not below zero. Any excess would be treated as capital gain.

For a more detailed discussion, see “Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences of the Distribution.” You should consult your tax advisor as to the particular tax consequences of the Distribution to you, including the applicability of any U.S. federal, state, local and non-U.S. tax laws.

Risks Related to Owning Our Common Stock

An active, liquid and orderly market for our common stock may not develop or be sustained, and the trading price of our common stock is likely to be volatile.

Prior to the Spin-Off, there has been no public market for shares of our common stock. It is anticipated that shortly prior to the record date for the distribution of our common stock, trading of shares of our common stock would begin on a “when-issued” basis and such trading would continue up to and including the Distribution date. However, an active trading market for our common stock may not develop or be sustained, which could depress the market price of our common stock and could affect your ability to sell your shares. The trading price of our common stock following the Distribution is likely to be highly volatile and could be subject to wide fluctuations in response to various factors, some of which are beyond our control. In addition to the factors discussed in this “Risk Factors” section and elsewhere in this information statement, these factors include:

 

   

a shift in our investor base;

 

   

actual or anticipated fluctuations in our quarterly financial condition and operating performance;

 

67


Table of Contents
   

the operating and stock price performance of similar companies;

 

   

introduction of new products by us or our competitors;

 

   

success or failure of our business strategy;

 

   

our ability to obtain financing as needed;

 

   

changes in accounting standards, policies, guidance, interpretations or principles;

 

   

the overall performance of the equity markets;

 

   

the number of shares of our common stock publicly owned and available for trading;

 

   

threatened or actual litigation or governmental investigations;

 

   

changes in laws or regulations affecting our business, including tax legislation;

 

   

announcements by us or our competitors of significant acquisitions or dispositions;

 

   

any major change in our board of directors or management;

 

   

changes in earnings estimates by securities analysts or our ability to meet earnings guidance;

 

   

publication of research reports about us or our industry or changes in recommendations or withdrawal of research coverage by securities analysts;

 

   

large volumes of sales of our shares of common stock by existing stockholders;

 

   

investor perception of us and our industry; and

 

   

general political and economic conditions, and other external factors, including the global impact of the COVID-19 pandemic.

In addition, the stock market in general, and the market for medical device companies in particular, have experienced extreme price and volume fluctuations that have often been unrelated or disproportionate to the operating performance of those companies. These fluctuations could be even more pronounced in the trading market for our stock shortly following the Distribution. This could limit or prevent investors from readily selling their shares of common stock and may otherwise negatively affect the liquidity of our common stock. Securities class action litigation has often been instituted against companies following periods of volatility in the overall market and in the market price of a company’s securities. This litigation, if instituted against us, could result in very substantial costs, divert our management’s attention and resources, and could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Your percentage of ownership in us may be diluted in the future.

As with any publicly traded company, your percentage ownership in us may be diluted in the future because of equity issuances for acquisitions, financing transactions or otherwise, including equity awards that we expect will be granted to our directors, officers and employees.

The large number of shares eligible for public sale could depress the market price of our common stock.

The shares of our common stock that PDL will distribute to its stockholders in the Distribution generally may be sold immediately in the public market. PDL stockholders could sell our common stock received in the Distribution if we do not fit their investment objectives, such as minimum market capitalization requirements or specific business sector focus. The market price of our common stock could decline as a result of sales of a large number of shares of our common stock in the market after the Distribution, and the perception that these sales could occur may also depress the market price of our common stock. A decline in the price of shares of our common stock might impede our ability to raise capital through the issuance of additional shares of our common stock or other equity securities.

 

68


Table of Contents

We also may issue our shares of common stock from time to time as consideration for future acquisitions and investments. If any such acquisition or investment is significant, the number of shares that we may issue may in turn be significant. In addition, we may also grant registration rights covering those shares in connection with any such acquisitions and investments.

We are an “emerging growth company” and a “smaller reporting company” and we cannot be certain if the reduced disclosure requirements applicable to us will make our common stock less attractive to investors.

We are an “emerging growth company,” as defined in the JOBS Act, and we may take advantage of certain exemptions and relief from various reporting requirements that are applicable to other public companies that are not “emerging growth companies.” In particular, while we are an “emerging growth company” (1) we will not be required to comply with the auditor attestation requirements of Section 404(b) of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, (2) we will be exempt from any rules that may be adopted by the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board requiring mandatory audit firm rotations or a supplement to the auditor’s report on financial statements, (3) we will be subject to reduced disclosure obligations regarding executive compensation in our periodic reports and proxy statements and (4) we will not be required to hold nonbinding advisory votes on executive compensation or stockholder approval of any golden parachute payments not previously approved.

In addition, we are eligible to delay the adoption of new or revised accounting standards applicable to public companies until those standards apply to private companies, and as a result, we may not comply with new or revised accounting standards on the relevant dates on which adoption of such standards is required for non-emerging growth companies. As a result of this election, our financial statements may not be comparable to the financial statements of other public companies.

We also currently intend to take advantage of the reduced disclosure requirements regarding executive compensation. If we remain an “emerging growth company” after 2020, we may take advantage of other exemptions, including the exemptions from the advisory vote requirements and executive compensation disclosures under the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Customer Protection Act, and the exemption from the provisions of Section 404(b) of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act. We may remain an “emerging growth company” until as late as December 31, 2025 (the fiscal year-end following the fifth anniversary of the completion of the Spin-Off), though we may cease to be an “emerging growth company” earlier under certain circumstances, including (1) if the market value of our common stock that is held by non-affiliates exceeds $700.0 million as of any June 30, in which case we would cease to be an “emerging growth company” as of the following December 31, (2) if our gross revenue exceeds $1.07 billion in any fiscal year or (3) if we issue more than $1.0 billion in nonconvertible notes in any three-year period.

We are also a “smaller reporting company” as defined in the Exchange Act. We may continue to be a smaller reporting company even after we are no longer an emerging growth company. We may take advantage of certain of the scaled disclosures available to smaller reporting companies and will be able to take advantage of these scaled disclosures for so long as our voting and non-voting common stock held by non-affiliates is less than $250.0 million measured on the last business day of our second fiscal quarter, or our annual revenue is less than $100.0 million during the most recently completed fiscal year and our voting and non-voting common stock held by non-affiliates is less than $700.0 million measured on the last business day of our second fiscal quarter.

If some investors find our common stock less attractive as a result, there may be a less active trading market for our common stock and our stock price may decline or become more volatile.

As a result of becoming a public company, we will be obligated to develop and maintain proper and effective internal control over financial reporting and will be subject to other requirements that will be burdensome and costly.

We have historically operated our business as part of a larger public company. Following consummation of the Spin-Off, we will be required to file with the SEC annual, quarterly and current reports that are specified in

 

69


Table of Contents

Section 13 of the Exchange Act. We will also be required to ensure that we have the ability to prepare financial statements that are fully compliant with all SEC reporting requirements on a timely basis. In addition, we will become subject to other reporting and corporate governance requirements, including the requirements of the Nasdaq Capital Market, and certain provisions of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act and the regulations promulgated thereunder, which will impose significant compliance obligations upon us. As a public company, we will be required to:

 

   

prepare and distribute periodic public reports and other stockholder communications in compliance with our obligations under the federal securities laws and the listing rules of the Nasdaq Stock Market;

 

   

create or expand the roles and duties of our board of directors and committees of the board of directors;

 

   

institute more comprehensive financial reporting and disclosure compliance functions;

 

   

supplement our internal accounting and auditing function, including hiring additional staff with expertise in accounting and financial reporting for a public company;

 

   

establish formal closing procedures at the end of our accounting periods;

 

   

develop our investor relations function;

 

   

establish new internal policies, including those relating to disclosure controls and procedures; and

 

   

involve and retain to a greater degree outside counsel and accountants in the activities listed above.

We expect to devote significant resources and time to comply with the internal control over financial reporting requirements of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, including costs associated with auditing and legal fees and accounting and administrative staff. In addition, Section 404(a) under the Sarbanes-Oxley Act requires that we assess the effectiveness of our controls over financial reporting. Our future compliance with the annual internal control report requirement will depend on the effectiveness of our financial reporting and data systems and controls across our operating subsidiaries. We cannot be certain that these measures will ensure that we design, implement and maintain adequate controls over our financial processes and reporting in the future. Any failure to implement required new or improved controls, or difficulties encountered in their implementation or operation, could harm our operating results, cause us to fail to meet our financial reporting obligations, or cause us to suffer adverse regulatory consequences or violate applicable stock exchange listing rules. Inadequate internal controls could also cause investors to lose confidence in our reported financial information, which could have a negative effect on the trading price of our stock and our access to capital.

For as long as we are an “emerging growth company” under the JOBS Act, we will not be required to comply with Section 404(b) of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, which would require our independent auditors to issue an opinion on their audit of our internal control over financial reporting, until the later of the year following our first annual report required to be filed with the SEC and the date we are no longer an “emerging growth company.” If, once we are no longer an “emerging growth company,” our independent registered public accounting firm cannot provide an unqualified attestation report on the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting, investor confidence and, in turn, the market price of our common stock, could decline.

Our disclosure controls and procedures may not prevent or detect all errors or acts of fraud.

Upon consummation of the Spin-Off, we will become subject to the periodic reporting requirements of the Exchange Act. We designed our disclosure controls and procedures to provide reasonable assurance that information we must disclose in reports we file or submit under the Exchange Act is accumulated and communicated to management, and recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time periods specified in the rules and forms of the SEC. We believe that any disclosure controls and procedures, no matter how well-conceived and operated, can provide only reasonable, not absolute, assurance that the objectives of the control system are met.

These inherent limitations include the realities that judgments in decision-making can be faulty, and that breakdowns can occur because of simple error or mistake. Additionally, controls can be circumvented by the individual

 

70


Table of Contents

acts of some persons, by collusion of two or more people or by an unauthorized override of the controls. Accordingly, because of the inherent limitations in our control system, misstatements due to error or fraud may occur and not be detected.

We may issue preferred stock with terms that could dilute the voting power or reduce the value of our common stock.

While we have no specific plan to issue preferred stock, our amended and restated certificate of incorporation authorizes us to issue, without the approval of our stockholders, one or more series of preferred stock having such designation, powers, privileges, preferences, including preferences over our common stock respecting dividends and distributions, terms of redemption and relative participation, optional, or other rights, if any, of the shares of each such series of preferred stock and any qualifications, limitations or restrictions thereof, as our board of directors may determine. The terms of one or more series of preferred stock could dilute the voting power or reduce the value of our common stock. For example, the repurchase or redemption rights or liquidation preferences we could assign to holders of preferred stock could affect the residual value of the common stock. For a more detailed description, see “Description of LENSAR Capital Stock—Preferred Stock.”

If securities or industry analysts do not publish research or publish inaccurate or unfavorable research about our business, our stock price and trading volume could decline.

The trading market for our common stock will depend in part on the research and reports that securities or industry analysts publish about us or our business. Securities and industry analysts do not currently, and may never, publish research on us. If no securities or industry analysts commence coverage of us, the trading price for our stock would likely be negatively affected. If securities or industry analysts were to initiate coverage, if one or more of the analysts who cover us were to downgrade our stock or publish inaccurate or unfavorable research about our business, our stock price would likely decline. If one or more of these analysts were to cease coverage of us or fail to publish reports on us regularly, demand for our stock could decrease, which might cause our stock price and trading volume to decline.

We do not anticipate paying cash dividends, and accordingly, stockholders must rely on stock appreciation for any return on their investment.

We do not anticipate paying cash dividends in the foreseeable future. As a result, only appreciation of the price of our common stock, which may never occur, will provide a return to stockholders. Investors seeking cash dividends should not invest in our common stock.

Certain provisions in our charter documents and Delaware law could discourage takeover attempts and lead to management entrenchment and, therefore, may depress the trading price of our common stock.

Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws contain provisions that could have the effect of delaying or preventing changes in control or changes in our management without the consent of our board of directors, including, among other things:

 

   

a classified board of directors with three-year staggered terms, which may delay the ability of stockholders to change the membership of a majority of our board of directors;

 

   

no cumulative voting in the election of directors, which limits the ability of minority stockholders to elect director candidates;

 

   

the ability of our board of directors to determine to issue shares of preferred stock and to determine the price and other terms of those shares, including preferences and voting rights, without stockholder approval, which could be used to significantly dilute the ownership of a hostile acquirer;

 

71


Table of Contents
   

the exclusive right of our board of directors to elect a director to fill a vacancy created by the expansion of our board of directors or the resignation, death or removal of a director, which prevents stockholders from being able to fill vacancies on our board of directors;

 

   

limitations on the removal of directors;

 

   

a prohibition on stockholder action by written consent, which forces stockholder action to be taken at an annual or special meeting of our stockholders;

 

   

the requirement that a special meeting of stockholders may be called only by the chairperson of our board of directors, the chief executive officer, the president (in absence of a chief executive officer) or our board of directors, which may delay the ability of our stockholders to force consideration of a proposal or to take action, including the removal of directors;

 

   

the approval of the holders of at least two-thirds of the shares entitled to vote at an election of directors is required to adopt, amend or repeal our bylaws or repeal the provisions of our amended and restated certificate of incorporation regarding the election and removal of directors;

 

   

the ability of our board of directors, by majority vote, to amend the amended and restated bylaws, which may allow our board of directors to take additional actions to prevent a hostile acquisition and inhibit the ability of an acquirer from amending the amended and restated bylaws to facilitate a hostile acquisition; and

 

   

advance notice procedures that stockholders must comply with in order to nominate candidates to our board of directors or to propose matters to be acted upon at a stockholders’ meeting, which may discourage or deter a potential acquirer from conducting a solicitation of proxies to elect the acquirer’s own slate of directors or otherwise attempting to obtain control of us.

We believe that these provisions should protect our stockholders from coercive or harmful takeover tactics by requiring potential acquirers to negotiate with our board of directors and by providing our board of directors with adequate time to assess any acquisition proposal, and are not intended to make us immune from takeovers. These provisions in our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws may discourage, delay or prevent a transaction involving a change in control that is in the best interest of our stockholders. Even in the absence of a takeover attempt, the existence of these provisions may adversely affect the prevailing market price of our common stock if they are viewed as discouraging future takeover attempts.

We are also subject to certain anti-takeover provisions under the DGCL. Under the DGCL, a corporation may not, in general, engage in a business combination with any holder of 15% or more of its capital stock unless the holder has held the stock for three years or, among other things, our board of directors has approved the transaction.

Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation designates certain courts as the sole and exclusive forums for certain litigation that may be initiated by our stockholders, which could limit our stockholders’ ability to obtain a favorable judicial forum for disputes with us.

Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation provides that, unless we consent in writing to the selection of an alternative forum, the Court of Chancery of the State of Delaware shall be the sole and exclusive forum for (i) any derivative action or proceeding brought on our behalf; (ii) any action asserting a claim of breach of fiduciary duty owed by any of our directors, officers or other employees or our stockholders; (iii) any action asserting a claim arising pursuant to any provision of the DGCL or our amended and restated certificate of incorporation or amended and restated bylaws; or (iv) any action asserting a claim governed by the internal affairs doctrine. Additionally, our amended and restated certificate of incorporation provides that the federal district courts of the United States of America will be the exclusive forum for the resolution of any complaint asserting a cause of action against us or any of our directors, officers, employees or agents and arising under the Securities Act. Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation further provides that any person or entity

 

72


Table of Contents

purchasing or acquiring any interest in shares of our capital stock shall be deemed to have notice of and to have consented to the provisions described above. This forum selection provision in our amended and restated certificate of incorporation may limit our stockholders’ ability to obtain a favorable judicial forum for disputes with us. This exclusive forum provision will not apply to suits brought to enforce a duty or liability created by the Exchange Act or any other claim for which the federal courts have exclusive jurisdiction.

 

73


Table of Contents

SPECIAL NOTE REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

We have made statements in this information statement under the captions “Information Statement Summary,” “Risk Factors,” “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations,” “The Spin-Off,” “Business” and in other sections of this information statement that are forward-looking statements. In some cases, you can identify these statements by forward-looking words such as “may,” “might,” “will,” “should,” “expects,” “plans,” “anticipates,” “believes,” “estimates,” “predicts,” “potential” or “continue,” the negative of these terms and other comparable terminology. These forward-looking statements, which are subject to risks, uncertainties and assumptions about us, may include projections of our future financial performance, our anticipated growth strategies and anticipated trends in our business. Any estimates and forward-looking statements contained in this information statement speak only as of the date of this information statement and are only predictions based on our current expectations and projections about future events. There are important factors that could cause our actual results, level of activity, performance or achievements to differ materially from the results, level of activity, performance or achievements expressed or implied by the forward-looking statements, including those factors discussed under the caption entitled “Risk Factors.” You should specifically consider the numerous risks outlined under “Risk Factors.”

The forward-looking statements made in this information statement relate only to events as of the date on which the statements are made. Although we believe the expectations reflected in the forward-looking statements are reasonable, we cannot guarantee future results, level of activity, performance or achievements. Moreover, neither we nor any other person assumes responsibility for the accuracy and completeness of any of these forward-looking statements. We are under no duty to update any of these forward-looking statements after the date of this information statement to conform our prior statements to actual results or revised expectations.

 

74


Table of Contents

THE SPIN-OFF

General

The board of directors of PDL, our parent company, has authorized the announcement of a plan to spin off our company as an independent, publicly traded company, to be accomplished by means of a pro rata distribution of all of our common stock held by PDL, representing approximately 81.5% of our total issued and outstanding common stock, to PDL’s stockholders as of the Record Date. Following the Spin-Off, PDL will no longer own any equity interest in us, and we will operate as an independent, publicly traded company. We have applied to list our common stock on the Nasdaq Capital Market under the symbol “LNSR.”

We were incorporated as a Delaware corporation on August 20, 2004. We currently have one class of authorized common stock. As of the date of this information statement, approximately 81.5% of the outstanding shares of our common stock are beneficially owned by PDL, with the remainder being beneficially owned by certain of our directors, executive officers and other employees All shares of our common stock currently outstanding are fully paid and non-assessable, not subject to redemption and without preemptive or other rights to subscribe for or purchase any proportionate part of any new or additional issues of stock or securities. We expect approximately 8.7 million shares of our common stock will be distributed in the Spin-Off based on the number of shares of PDL common stock we expect to be outstanding on the Record Date. We will not have any shares of preferred stock outstanding immediately following the Spin-Off.

On October 1, 2020, the Distribution date, each stockholder holding shares of PDL common stock that were outstanding as of 5:00 p.m., Eastern Time, on September 22, 2020, the Record Date, will be entitled to receive, in respect of one share of PDL common stock, 0.075879 shares of our common stock, as described below. Immediately following the Distribution, PDL’s stockholders will own 81.5% of our outstanding common stock, and PDL will not hold any of our outstanding capital stock. You will not be required to make any payment, surrender or exchange your common stock of PDL or take any other action to receive your shares of our common stock.

Holders of PDL common stock will continue to hold their shares in PDL. We do not require and are not seeking a vote of PDL’s stockholders in connection with the Spin-Off, and PDL’s stockholders will not have any dissenters’ rights or appraisal rights in connection with the Spin-Off.

Before the Distribution, we will enter into the Separation and Distribution Agreement and other agreements with PDL to effect the Distribution and provide a framework for our relationship with PDL after the Distribution. These agreements will govern the relationship between PDL and us up to and subsequent to the completion of the Distribution. We describe these arrangements in greater detail under “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions—Agreements between PDL and LENSAR Relating to the Spin-Off” and describe some of the risks of these arrangements under “Risk Factors—Risks Related to the Separation and Distribution.”

The distribution of shares of our common stock as described in this information statement is subject to the satisfaction or waiver of certain conditions. In addition, PDL has the right not to complete the Spin-Off if, at any time prior to the Distribution, its board of directors determines, in its sole discretion, that the Spin-Off is not in the best interests of PDL or its stockholders, or that it is not advisable for us to separate from PDL. For a more detailed description of these conditions, see “—Conditions to the Spin-Off” below.

Reasons for the Spin-Off

In September 2019, PDL management recommended to its board of directors that it undertake a strategic review of PDL. Upon completion of that review in December 2019, PDL’s board of directors determined to pursue a process to unlock value within PDL either by sale of PDL or monetization of its assets. Over the subsequent months, PDL’s board of directors and management analyzed, together with outside financial and

 

75


Table of Contents

legal advisors, how to best capture value and provide the best return to stockholders. As part of that process, on September 9, 2020, PDL’s board of directors approved a plan to spin us off from PDL as a publicly traded company.

PDL’s board of directors believes that spinning us off from PDL will provide us with financial, operational and managerial benefits, including, but not limited to, the following:

 

   

Strategic Focus. We and PDL are distinct, complex enterprises with different opportunities, challenges, strategies and means of doing business. We believe the Spin-Off will allow us to continue to implement corporate strategies that are designed for our ophthalmology business.

 

   

Focused Management. Separating us from PDL will allow our management to continue to allocate and focus resources on the implementation of product development and commercialization strategies that are key to our continued growth.

 

   

Improved Management Incentive Tools. Offering equity of our publicly traded company as compensation tied directly to our performance will assist in attracting and retaining qualified employees, officers and directors.

 

   

Direct Access to Capital and Tailored Capital Structure. As a stand-alone company, we can better attract investors with the opportunity to invest solely in our surgical treatments for cataracts, which will enhance our ability to directly access the equity and debt capital markets to fund our growth strategy and to establish a capital structure tailored to our business needs.

 

   

Ability to Use Equity as Consideration for Acquisitions. The Spin-Off will provide us with enhanced flexibility to use our stock as consideration in pursuing certain financial and strategic objectives, including mergers and acquisitions involving other companies or businesses engaged in ophthalmology. We believe that we will be able to more easily facilitate future strategic transactions with businesses in ophthalmology through the use of our stand-alone stock as acquisition currency.

PDL’s board of directors also considered a number of potentially risk factors in evaluating the Spin-Off, including, in the case of both companies, increased operating costs, disruptions to the businesses as a result of planning for the Spin-Off and the Spin-Off itself, the risk of being unable to achieve expected benefits from the Spin-Off, the risk of being unable to successfully complete operational transfers, the risk that the Spin-Off might not be completed, the initial costs of the Spin-Off and the risk that the common stock of one or both companies may come under initial selling pressure if investors are not interested in holding an investment in one or both businesses following the Spin-Off. Notwithstanding these potentially negative factors, however, the board of directors of PDL determined that the Spin-Off was the best alternative to enhance stockholder value taking into account the factors discussed above. For more information, see the sections entitled “Risk Factors” and “The Spin-Off” included elsewhere in this information statement.

Manner of Effecting the Spin-Off

The Distribution will be effective as of 5:00 p.m., Eastern Time, on October 1, 2020, the Distribution date. As a result of the Spin-Off, on the Distribution date, each PDL stockholder will receive 0.075879 shares of our common stock for every one share of PDL common stock owned by such holder and outstanding as of the Record Date. In order to receive shares of our common stock in the Spin-Off, a PDL stockholder must be a stockholder at 5:00 p.m., Eastern Time, on September 22, 2020. The Distribution will be pro rata to stockholders holding shares of PDL common stock that are outstanding as of the Record Date.

PDL STOCKHOLDERS WILL NOT BE REQUIRED TO PAY FOR SHARES OF OUR COMMON STOCK RECEIVED IN THE DISTRIBUTION, OR TO SURRENDER OR EXCHANGE SHARES OF PDL COMMON STOCK IN ORDER TO RECEIVE OUR COMMON STOCK, OR TO TAKE ANY OTHER ACTION IN CONNECTION WITH THE DISTRIBUTION. NO VOTE OF PDL STOCKHOLDERS IS REQUIRED OR SOUGHT IN CONNECTION WITH THE DISTRIBUTION, AND PDL STOCKHOLDERS HAVE NO DISSENTERS’ RIGHTS OR APPRAISAL RIGHTS IN CONNECTION WITH THE DISTRIBUTION.

 

76


Table of Contents

See “Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences of the Distribution” for an explanation of the material U.S. federal income tax consequences of the Distribution.

Fractional shares of our common stock will not be issued to PDL stockholders as part of the Distribution or credited to book-entry accounts. In lieu of receiving fractional shares, each holder of PDL common stock who would otherwise be entitled to receive a fractional share of our common stock will receive cash for the fractional interest. Each stockholder should have a maximum of less than one fractional share pursuant to this transaction. The transfer agent will, as soon as practicable after the Distribution date, aggregate fractional shares of our common stock into whole shares and sell them in the open market at the prevailing market prices and distribute the aggregate proceeds, net of brokerage fees, ratably to PDL stockholders otherwise entitled to fractional interests in our common stock. The amount of such payments will depend on the prices at which the aggregated fractional shares are sold by the transfer agent in the open market shortly after the Distribution date. None of PDL, us or the transfer agent will guarantee any minimum sale price for the fractional shares of our common stock. Neither we nor PDL will pay any interest on the proceeds from the sale of fractional shares.

If you own shares of PDL common stock as of the close of business on the Record Date, the shares of our common stock that you are entitled to receive will be issued electronically, as of the Distribution date, to you or to your bank or brokerage firm on your behalf by way of direct registration in book-entry form. Registration in book-entry form refers to a method of recording share ownership when no physical share certificates are issued to stockholders, as is the case in the Distribution. If you sell shares of PDL common stock in the market up to and including the Distribution date, however, you may be selling your right to receive shares of our common stock in the Distribution.

Commencing on or shortly after the Distribution date, if you hold physical share certificates that represent your shares of PDL common stock and you are the registered holder of the PDL shares represented by those certificates, the transfer agent will mail to you an account statement that indicates the number of shares of our common stock that have been registered in book-entry form in your name. See “—Results of the Separation; Listing of LENSAR Common Stock and Trading of PDL Common Stock.”

Most PDL stockholders hold their shares of PDL common stock through a bank or brokerage firm. In such cases, the bank or brokerage firm would be said to hold the shares in “street name” and ownership would be recorded on the bank or brokerage firm’s books. If you hold your shares of PDL common stock through a bank or brokerage firm, your bank or brokerage firm will credit your account for the shares of our common stock that you are entitled to receive in the Distribution. If you have any questions concerning the mechanics of having shares held in “street name,” we encourage you to contact your bank or brokerage firm at any time following the approval of the Spin-Off.

Assuming approximately 114.1 million shares of PDL common stock are outstanding as of the Record Date, the number of shares of our common stock to be distributed will be approximately 8.7 million, and the number of shares of our common stock which will be outstanding immediately following the Spin-Off will be approximately 10.6 million. The Spin-Off will not affect the number of outstanding shares of PDL common stock or any rights of PDL’s stockholders.

Conditions to the Spin-Off

The Distribution is subject to the satisfaction or waiver of a number of conditions, including the following:

 

   

the PDL board of directors shall have approved the Spin-Off, including the declaration of the Distribution and other related transactions, which approval may be given or withheld at its sole and absolute discretion;

 

   

the SEC has declared effective the registration statement, with no stop order in effect with respect thereto, and with no proceedings for such purpose pending or threatened by the SEC;

 

77


Table of Contents
   

we shall have mailed this information statement (and such other information concerning us, our business, operations and management, the Distribution and such other matters as we and PDL shall determine and as may otherwise be required by law) to the holders of record of PDL common stock at the close of business on the record date for the Distribution;

 

   

all other actions and filings necessary or appropriate under applicable federal or state securities laws and state blue sky laws in connection with the Transactions shall have been taken;

 

   

our common stock shall have been accepted for listing on the Nasdaq Capital Market, subject to official notice of issuance;

 

   

the ancillary agreements shall have been executed and delivered by each of PDL and us, as applicable, and no party to any of the ancillary agreements will be in material breach of any such agreement;

 

   

any material governmental authorizations necessary to consummate the Spin-Off and other related transactions, or any portion thereof, shall have been obtained and be in full force and effect;

 

   

our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws, each in substantially the form filed as exhibits to the registration statement, are in effect;

 

   

no preliminary or permanent injunction or other order, decree, or ruling issued by a governmental authority, and no statute (as interpreted through orders or rules of any governmental authority duly authorized to effectuate the statute), rule, regulation or executive order promulgated or enacted by any governmental authority shall be in effect preventing the consummation of, or materially limiting the benefits of, the Spin-Off and related transactions; and

 

   

no other event or development shall have occurred or failed to occur that, in the judgment of the PDL board of directors, in its sole discretion, prevents the consummation of the Spin-Off and related transactions or any portion thereof or makes the consummation of the same inadvisable.

Other than the conditions relating to the effectiveness of the registration statement and our mailing of the information statement, PDL’s board of directors may waive any of these conditions, in its sole discretion, prior to the Distribution date. A waiver by PDL’s Board of Directors of one or more of these conditions in connection with the Distribution may adversely impact our business, the trading price of our common stock, or the ability of our stockholders to sell their shares after the Distribution. For example, consummating the Distribution despite an injunction or decree as described above could result in time-consuming and costly proceedings that would adversely affect our business and result in expenditure of our resources. Consummating the Distribution without having our common stock accepted for listing on the Nasdaq Capital Market or another national stock exchange could result in a less liquid market for our stock and adversely affect the stock price or a holder’s ability to sell our stock.

PDL only intends to notify PDL stockholders of any modifications to the terms of the Spin-Off or Distribution that, in the judgment of its board of directors, are material. For example, the PDL board of directors might consider material such matters as significant changes to the Distribution ratio, significant changes to the assets to be contributed or the liabilities to be assumed following the Spin-Off. To the extent that the PDL board of directors determines that any modifications by PDL, including any waivers of any conditions to the Distribution, materially change the terms of the Distribution, PDL will notify PDL stockholders in a manner reasonably calculated to inform them about the modification as may be required by law, such as by publishing a press release, filing a current report on Form 8-K or circulating a supplement to this information statement.

The fulfillment of the foregoing conditions will not create any obligation on PDL’s part to effect the Spin-Off. Except as described in the foregoing conditions, we are not aware of any material federal or state regulatory requirements that must be complied with or any material approvals that must be obtained. PDL has the right not to complete the Spin-Off if, at any time prior to the Distribution, the board of directors of PDL determines, in its sole discretion, that the Spin-Off is not in the best interests of PDL or its stockholders, or that it is not advisable for us to separate from PDL.

 

78


Table of Contents

Results of the Spin-Off; Listing of LENSAR Common Stock and Trading of PDL Common Stock

There is not currently a public market for our common stock. We have applied to list LENSAR’s common stock on the Nasdaq Capital Market under the symbol “LNSR.” We expect that a “when-issued” market in LENSAR common stock could develop shortly prior to the Record Date, and we will announce the when-issued trading symbol of LENSAR when and if it becomes available. “When-issued trading” refers to a sale or purchase made conditionally because the security has been authorized but not yet issued. The when-issued trading market will be a market for the LENSAR common stock that will be distributed to PDL stockholders on the Distribution date. If you own shares of PDL common stock at the close of business on the Record Date, you will be entitled to shares of LENSAR common stock distributed pursuant to the Spin-Off. You may trade this entitlement to shares of LENSAR common stock, without the shares of PDL common stock you own, on the when-issued market. On the first trading day following the Distribution date, we expect that when-issued trading with respect to LENSAR common stock will end and regular-way trading will begin.

It is also anticipated that, shortly prior to the Record Date and continuing up to and including the Distribution date, there will be two markets for PDL common stock: a “regular-way” market and an “ex-distribution” market. Shares of PDL common stock that trade on the regular-way market will trade with an entitlement to shares of our common stock distributed pursuant to the Distribution. Shares that trade on the ex-distribution market will trade without an entitlement to shares of our common stock distributed pursuant to the Distribution. Therefore, if you sell shares of PDL common stock in the regular-way market up to and including the Distribution date, you will be selling your right to receive shares of our common stock in the Distribution. However, if you own PDL common stock at the close of business on the Record Date and sell those shares on the ex-distribution market up to and including the Distribution date, you will still receive the shares of our common stock that you would otherwise be entitled to receive pursuant to the Distribution. If, for any reason, the Distribution does not occur, “when-issued” and “ex-distribution” trades will be cancelled and, therefore, will not be settled.

We cannot assure you as to the price at which our common stock will trade before, on or after the Distribution date and, depending upon a number of factors, some of which may be beyond our control, the price at which our common stock trades may fluctuate significantly. In addition, the combined trading prices of our common stock and PDL common stock held by stockholders after the Distribution may be less than, equal to or greater than the pre-Spin-Off trading price of PDL common stock prior to the Distribution.

The shares of our common stock distributed to PDL stockholders will be freely transferable, except for shares received by people who may have a special relationship or affiliation with us or shares subject to contractual restrictions. People who may be considered our affiliates after the Distribution generally include individuals or entities that control, are controlled by, or are under common control with us and may include certain of our officers, directors and significant stockholders. Persons who are our affiliates will be permitted to sell their shares only pursuant to an effective registration statement under the Securities Act, or an exemption from the registration requirements of the Securities Act.

Reasons for Furnishing the Information Statement

This information statement is being furnished solely to provide information to PDL stockholders who will receive shares of our common stock in the Distribution. It is not, and is not to be construed as, an inducement or encouragement to buy or sell any of our securities or any securities of PDL, nor is it to be construed as a solicitation of proxies in respect of the proposed Distribution or any other matter. We believe that the information contained in this information statement is accurate as of the date set forth on the cover. Changes to the information contained in this information statement may occur after that date, and neither we nor PDL undertakes any obligation to update the information except in the normal course of our respective public disclosure obligations and practices.

 

79


Table of Contents

MATERIAL U.S. FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES OF THE DISTRIBUTION

The following discussion is a summary of the material U.S. federal income tax consequences of the Distribution to U.S. Holders and Non-U.S. Holders (each as defined below) and a summary of the material U.S. federal income tax consequences of the ownership and disposition of LENSAR common stock for U.S. Holders and Non-U.S. Holders, but does not purport to be a complete analysis of all potential tax effects. The effects of other U.S. federal tax laws, such as estate and gift tax laws, and any applicable state, local or non-U.S. tax laws are not discussed. This discussion is based on the Code, U.S. Treasury regulations promulgated thereunder, or Treasury Regulations, judicial decisions, and published rulings and administrative pronouncements of the IRS, in each case in effect as of the date hereof. These authorities may change or be subject to differing interpretations. Any such change or differing interpretation may be applied retroactively in a manner that could adversely affect a U.S. Holder or Non-U.S. Holder of PDL common stock or LENSAR common stock. We have not sought and will not seek any rulings from the IRS regarding the matters discussed below. There can be no assurance the IRS or a court will not take a contrary position to that discussed below.

This discussion is limited to U.S. Holders and Non-U.S. Holders that hold PDL common stock and will hold LENSAR common stock as a “capital asset” within the meaning of Section 1221 of the Code (generally, property held for investment). This discussion does not address all U.S. federal income tax consequences relevant to a holder’s particular circumstances, including the impact of the Medicare contribution tax on net investment income or the alternative minimum tax. In addition, it does not address consequences relevant to holders subject to special rules, including, without limitation:

 

   

U.S. expatriates and former citizens or long-term residents of the United States;

 

   

U.S. Holders whose functional currency is not the U.S. dollar;

 

   

persons who hold PDL common stock or will hold LENSAR common stock as part of a hedge, straddle or other risk reduction strategy or as part of a conversion transaction or other integrated investment;

 

   

banks, insurance companies, and other financial institutions;

 

   

real estate investment trusts or regulated investment companies;

 

   

brokers, dealers or traders in securities;

 

   

“controlled foreign corporations,” “passive foreign investment companies,” and corporations that accumulate earnings to avoid U.S. federal income tax;

 

   

S corporations, partnerships or other entities or arrangements treated as partnerships for U.S. federal income tax purposes (and investors therein);

 

   

tax-exempt organizations or governmental organizations;

 

   

persons deemed to sell PDL common stock or LENSAR common stock under the constructive sale provisions of the Code;

 

   

persons who hold or receive PDL common stock or will receive LENSAR common stock pursuant to the exercise of any employee stock option or otherwise as compensation;

 

   

tax-qualified retirement plans;

 

   

“qualified foreign pension funds” as defined in Section 897(l)(2) of the Code and entities all of the interests of which are held by qualified foreign pension funds; and

 

   

persons subject to special tax accounting rules as a result of any item of gross income with respect to PDL common stock and LENSAR common stock being taken into account in an applicable financial statement.

 

80


Table of Contents

If an entity treated as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes holds PDL common stock or LENSAR common stock, the tax treatment of a partner in the partnership will depend on the status of the partner, the activities of the partnership and certain determinations made at the partner level. Accordingly, partnerships holding PDL common stock or LENSAR common stock and the partners in such partnerships should consult their tax advisors regarding the U.S. federal income tax consequences to them.

THIS DISCUSSION IS FOR INFORMATION PURPOSES ONLY AND IS NOT TAX ADVICE. HOLDERS SHOULD CONSULT THEIR TAX ADVISORS WITH RESPECT TO THE APPLICATION OF THE U.S. FEDERAL INCOME TAX LAWS TO THEIR PARTICULAR SITUATIONS AS WELL AS ANY TAX CONSEQUENCES OF THE DISTRIBUTION AND THE OWNERSHIP AND DISPOSITION OF LENSAR COMMON STOCK ARISING UNDER THE U.S. FEDERAL ESTATE OR GIFT TAX LAWS OR UNDER THE LAWS OF ANY STATE, LOCAL OR NON-U.S. TAXING JURISDICTION OR UNDER ANY APPLICABLE INCOME TAX TREATY.

Definitions of U.S. Holder and Non-U.S. Holder

For purposes of this discussion, a “U.S. Holder” is a beneficial owner of PDL common stock or LENSAR common stock that, for U.S. federal income tax purposes, is or is treated as:

 

   

an individual who is a citizen or resident of the United States;

 

   

a corporation created or organized under the laws of the United States, any state thereof, or the District of Columbia;

 

   

an estate, the income of which is subject to U.S. federal income tax regardless of its source; or

 

   

a trust that (1) is subject to the primary supervision of a U.S. court and the control of one or more “United States persons” (within the meaning of Section 7701(a)(30) of the Code), or (2) has a valid election in effect to be treated as a United States person for U.S. federal income tax purposes.

For purposes of this discussion, a “Non-U.S. Holder” is any beneficial owner of PDL common stock or LENSAR common stock that is neither a U.S. Holder nor an entity treated as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes.

U.S. Federal Income Tax Treatment of the Distribution

The Distribution is intended to be treated as part of a series of distributions in complete liquidation of PDL, and this discussion assumes this treatment will be respected. In accordance with such treatment, each PDL stockholder will be treated as receiving an amount equal to the fair market value of the LENSAR common stock received by such holder (including any fractional shares deemed received by the holder, as described below), determined as of the date of the Distribution. We refer to such amount as the “Distribution Amount.” Each PDL stockholder will be treated as receiving such Distribution Amount, together with any other property distributed to such holder as part of the liquidating distribution, in exchange for its PDL common stock. If a PDL stockholder holds different blocks of shares of PDL common stock (generally, shares of PDL common stock purchased or acquired on different dates or at different prices), the Distribution Amount must be allocated among the several blocks of shares in the proportion that the number of shares in a particular block bears to the total number of shares owned by the holder.

The Distribution will also be a taxable transaction for PDL in which PDL will recognize gain or loss based on the difference between the fair market value of the LENSAR common stock as of the date of the Distribution and PDL’s tax basis in such stock.

Although PDL will ascribe a value to the LENSAR common stock distributed in the Distribution, this valuation is not binding on the IRS or any other tax authority. These taxing authorities could ascribe a higher

 

81


Table of Contents

valuation to the distributed LENSAR common stock, particularly if, following the Distribution, the LENSAR common stock trades at prices significantly above the value ascribed to those shares by PDL. Such a higher valuation may affect the Distribution Amount and thus the tax consequences of the Distribution to holders of PDL common stock.

Any cash received by a holder of PDL common stock in lieu of a fractional share of LENSAR common stock will be treated as if such fractional share had been (i) received by the holder as part of the Distribution and then (ii) sold by such holder, via the transfer agent, for the amount of cash received. As described below, the basis of the fractional share deemed received by a holder of PDL common stock generally will equal the fair market value of such share on the date of the Distribution, and the amount paid in lieu of a fractional share will be net of the transfer agent’s brokerage fees.

The tax consequences of the Distribution will be affected by a number of facts that are yet to be determined, including the fair market value of LENSAR common stock on the date of the Distribution. PDL will provide its stockholders with tax information on an IRS Form 1099-DIV, informing them of the amount and character of distributions made during the taxable year, including the Distribution.

Notwithstanding PDL’s position that the Distribution will be treated as part of a series of distributions in complete liquidation of PDL, it is possible that the IRS or a court could determine that the Distribution is a current distribution. In addition, if PDL’s liquidation is abandoned or revoked, the Distribution would be treated as a current distribution. A current distribution would be treated as a dividend for U.S. federal income tax purposes to the extent of PDL’s current and accumulated earnings and profits. Under this treatment, amounts not treated as dividends for U.S. federal income tax purposes would constitute a return of capital and first be applied against and reduce a holder’s adjusted tax basis in its PDL common stock, but not below zero. Any excess would be treated as capital gain. Please consult your tax advisor with respect to the proper characterization of the Distribution.

Tax Basis and Holding Period of LENSAR Common Stock Received by Holders of PDL Common Stock

A PDL stockholder’s tax basis in LENSAR common stock received in the Distribution generally will equal the fair market value of such stock on the date of the Distribution, and the holding period for such shares will begin the day after the date of the Distribution.

U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences of the Distribution and of the Ownership and Disposition of LENSAR Common Stock to U.S. Holders

Treatment of the Distribution

The Distribution Amount will be treated as received by a U.S. Holder (together with any other property distributed to the U.S. Holder as part of the liquidating distribution) in exchange for the U.S. Holder’s PDL common stock. The Distribution Amount allocable to a block of shares of PDL common stock owned by the U.S. Holder will reduce the U.S. Holder’s tax basis in such shares, but not below zero. Any excess Distribution Amount allocable to such shares will be treated as capital gain. Such gain generally will be taxable as long-term capital gain if the shares have been held for more than one year. Any tax basis remaining in a share of PDL common stock following the final liquidating distribution by PDL will be treated as a capital loss. The deductibility of capital losses is subject to limitations.

Distributions on LENSAR Common Stock

As described in the section entitled “Dividend Policy,” we do not anticipate declaring or paying cash dividends to holders of LENSAR common stock in the foreseeable future. However, if we do make distributions of cash or property on our common stock, such distributions will constitute dividends for U.S. federal income tax

 

82


Table of Contents

purposes to the extent paid from our current or accumulated earnings and profits, as determined under U.S. federal income tax principles. Dividends received by certain non-corporate U.S. Holders (including individuals) may be taxed at preferential rates applicable to qualified dividend income, provided certain holding period requirements are met. Corporate U.S. Holders that meet certain holding period and other requirements may be eligible for a dividends-received deduction for a portion of the dividend received. Amounts not treated as dividends for U.S. federal income tax purposes will constitute a return of capital and first be applied against and reduce a U.S. Holder’s adjusted tax basis in its LENSAR common stock, but not below zero. Any excess will be treated as capital gain. Such gain generally will be taxable as long-term capital gain if the shares have been held for more than one year.

Sale or Other Taxable Disposition of LENSAR Common Stock

Upon a subsequent sale or other taxable disposition of a share of LENSAR common stock, a U.S. Holder will recognize taxable gain or loss equal to the difference between the amount realized on the disposition of the share and the U.S. Holder’s tax basis in the share. The gain or loss will be capital gain or loss. A non-corporate U.S. Holder, including an individual, who has held the share for more than one year generally will be eligible for reduced tax rates for such long-term capital gains. The deductibility of capital losses is subject to limitations.

U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences of the Distribution and of the Ownership and Disposition of LENSAR Common Stock to Non-U.S. Holders

Treatment of the Distribution

The Distribution Amount will be treated as received by a Non-U.S. Holder (together with any other property distributed to the Non-U.S. Holder as part of the liquidating distribution) in exchange for the Non-U.S. Holder’s PDL common stock. The Distribution Amount allocable to a block of shares of PDL common stock owned by the Non-U.S. Holder will reduce the Non-U.S. Holder’s tax basis in such shares, but not below zero. Any excess Distribution Amount allocable to such shares will be treated as capital gain and will be treated as described below under “—Sale or Other Taxable Disposition.”

Distributions on LENSAR Common Stock

As described in the section entitled “Dividend Policy,” we do not anticipate declaring or paying cash dividends to holders of LENSAR common stock in the foreseeable future. However, if we do make distributions of cash or property on our common stock, such distributions will constitute dividends for U.S. federal income tax purposes to the extent paid from our current or accumulated earnings and profits, as determined under U.S. federal income tax principles. Amounts not treated as dividends for U.S. federal income tax purposes will constitute a return of capital and first be applied against and reduce a Non-U.S. Holder’s adjusted tax basis in its LENSAR common stock, but not below zero. Any excess will be treated as capital gain and will be treated as described below under “—Sale or Other Taxable Disposition.”

Subject to the discussion below on effectively connected income, dividends paid to a Non-U.S. Holder of LENSAR common stock will be subject to U.S. federal withholding tax at a rate of 30% of the gross amount of the dividends (or such lower rate specified by an applicable income tax treaty, provided the Non-U.S. Holder furnishes a valid IRS Form W-8BEN or W-8BEN-E, as applicable (or other applicable documentation), certifying qualification for the lower treaty rate). A Non-U.S. Holder that does not timely furnish the required documentation, but that qualifies for a reduced treaty rate, may obtain a refund of any excess amounts withheld by timely filing an appropriate claim for refund with the IRS. Non-U.S. Holders should consult their tax advisors regarding their entitlement to benefits under any applicable income tax treaty.

If dividends paid to a Non-U.S. Holder are effectively connected with the Non-U.S. Holder’s conduct of a trade or business within the United States (and, if required by an applicable income tax treaty, the Non-U.S.

 

83


Table of Contents

Holder maintains a permanent establishment in the United States to which such dividends are attributable), the Non-U.S. Holder will be exempt from the U.S. federal withholding tax described above. To claim the exemption, the Non-U.S. Holder must furnish to the applicable withholding agent a valid IRS Form W-8ECI, certifying that the dividends are effectively connected with the Non-U.S. Holder’s conduct of a trade or business within the United States.

Any such effectively connected dividends will be subject to U.S. federal income tax on a net income basis at the regular graduated rates. A Non-U.S. Holder that is a corporation also may be subject to a branch profits tax at a rate of 30% (or such lower rate specified by an applicable income tax treaty) on such effectively connected dividends, as adjusted for certain items. Non-U.S. Holders should consult their tax advisors regarding any applicable tax treaties that may provide for different rules.

Sale or Other Taxable Disposition

A Non-U.S. Holder will not be subject to U.S. federal income tax on any gain realized upon the Distribution or the sale or other taxable disposition of LENSAR common stock (including with respect to any cash received in lieu of a fractional share of LENSAR common stock) unless:

 

   

the gain is effectively connected with the Non-U.S. Holder’s conduct of a trade or business within the United States (and, if required by an applicable income tax treaty, the Non-U.S. Holder maintains a permanent establishment in the United States to which such gain is attributable);

 

   

the Non-U.S. Holder is a nonresident alien individual present in the United States for 183 days or more during the taxable year of the disposition and certain other requirements are met;

 

   

in the case of the Distribution, PDL common stock constitutes a U.S. real property interest, or USRPI, by reason of PDL’s status as a U.S. real property holding corporation, or USRPHC, for U.S. federal income tax purposes; or

 

   

in the case of a sale or other taxable disposition of LENSAR common stock, LENSAR common stock constitutes a USRPI by reason of LENSAR’s status as a USRPHC for U.S. federal income tax purposes.

Gain described in the first bullet point above generally will be subject to U.S. federal income tax on a net income basis at the regular graduated rates. A Non-U.S. Holder that is a corporation also may be subject to a branch profits tax at a rate of 30% (or such lower rate specified by an applicable income tax treaty) on such effectively connected gain, as adjusted for certain items.

Gain described in the second bullet point above will be subject to U.S. federal income tax at a rate of 30% (or such lower rate specified by an applicable income tax treaty), which may be offset by U.S. source capital losses of the Non-U.S. Holder (even though the individual is not considered a resident of the United States), provided the Non-U.S. Holder has timely filed U.S. federal income tax returns with respect to such losses.

With respect to the third and fourth bullet points above, each of PDL and LENSAR believes it is currently not, and does not anticipate becoming, a USRPHC. Because the determination of whether PDL or LENSAR, as applicable, is a USRPHC depends, however, on the fair market value of such company’s USRPIs relative to the fair market value of its non-U.S. real property interests and its other business assets, there can be no assurance PDL or LENSAR currently is not a USRPHC or will not become one in the future. Even if PDL or LENSAR is or were to become a USRPHC, gain arising from the sale or other taxable disposition by a Non-U.S. Holder of PDL common stock or LENSAR common stock, as applicable, will not be subject to U.S. federal income tax if such stock is “regularly traded,” as defined by applicable Treasury Regulations, on an established securities market, and such Non-U.S. Holder owned, actually and constructively, 5% or less of such stock throughout the shorter of the five-year period ending on the date of the sale or other taxable disposition or the Non-U.S. Holder’s holding period, or if another exception from these rules under the Code applies.

 

84


Table of Contents

Non-U.S. Holders should consult their tax advisors regarding potentially applicable income tax treaties that may provide for different rules.

Information Reporting and Backup Withholding

U.S. Holders

A U.S. Holder may be subject to information reporting and backup withholding when such holder receives the Distribution, receives cash in lieu of a fractional share of LENSAR common stock in the Distribution or receives payments on shares of LENSAR common stock or proceeds from the sale or other taxable disposition of such shares. Certain U.S. Holders are exempt from backup withholding, including corporations and certain tax-exempt organizations. A U.S. Holder will be subject to backup withholding if such holder is not otherwise exempt and:

 

   

the holder fails to furnish the holder’s taxpayer identification number, which for an individual is ordinarily his or her social security number;

 

   

the holder furnishes an incorrect taxpayer identification number;

 

   

the applicable withholding agent is notified by the IRS that the holder previously failed to properly report payments of interest or dividends; or

 

   

the holder fails to certify under penalties of perjury that the holder has furnished a correct taxpayer identification number and that the IRS has not notified the holder that the holder is subject to backup withholding.

Backup withholding is not an additional tax. Any amounts withheld under the backup withholding rules may be allowed as a refund or a credit against a U.S. Holder’s U.S. federal income tax liability, provided the required information is timely furnished to the IRS. U.S. Holders should consult their tax advisors regarding their qualification for an exemption from backup withholding and the procedures for obtaining such an exemption.

Non-U.S. Holders

The payments of dividends on LENSAR common stock will not be subject to backup withholding, provided the applicable withholding agent does not have actual knowledge or reason to know the holder is a United States person and the holder either certifies its non-U.S. status, such as by furnishing a valid IRS Form W-8BEN, W-8BEN-E or W-8ECI, as applicable, or otherwise establishes an exemption. However, information returns are required to be filed with the IRS in connection with any distributions on LENSAR common stock paid to the Non-U.S. Holder, regardless of whether such distributions constitute dividends or any tax was actually withheld. In addition, the Distribution and proceeds from the sale or other taxable disposition of LENSAR common stock (including with respect to any cash received in lieu of a fractional share of LENSAR common stock) within the United States or conducted through certain U.S.-related brokers generally will not be subject to backup withholding or information reporting, if the applicable withholding agent receives the certification described above and does not have actual knowledge or reason to know that such holder is a United States person, or the holder otherwise establishes an exemption. Proceeds from the Distribution or a sale or other taxable disposition of LENSAR common stock (including with respect to any cash received in lieu of a fractional share of LENSAR common stock) conducted through a non-U.S. office of a non-U.S. broker generally will not be subject to backup withholding or information reporting.

Copies of information returns that are filed with the IRS may also be made available under the provisions of an applicable treaty or agreement to the tax authorities of the country in which the Non-U.S. Holder resides or is established.

Backup withholding is not an additional tax. Any amounts withheld under the backup withholding rules may be allowed as a refund or a credit against a Non-U.S. Holder’s U.S. federal income tax liability, provided the required information is timely furnished to the IRS.

 

85


Table of Contents

Additional Withholding Tax on Payments Made to Foreign Accounts

Withholding taxes may be imposed under Sections 1471 to 1474 of the Code (such Sections commonly referred to as the Foreign Account Tax Compliance Act, or FATCA) on certain types of payments made to non-U.S. financial institutions and certain other non-U.S. entities. Specifically, a 30% withholding tax may be imposed on dividends on LENSAR common stock, or (subject to the proposed Treasury Regulations discussed below) the Distribution or gross proceeds from the sale or other disposition of LENSAR common stock (including with respect to any cash received in lieu of a fractional share of LENSAR common stock), in each case paid to a “foreign financial institution” or a “non-financial foreign entity” (each as defined in the Code), unless (1) the foreign financial institution undertakes certain diligence and reporting obligations, (2) the non-financial foreign entity either certifies it does not have any “substantial United States owners” (as defined in the Code) or furnishes identifying information regarding each substantial United States owner, or (3) the foreign financial institution or non-financial foreign entity otherwise qualifies for an exemption from these rules. If the payee is a foreign financial institution and is subject to the diligence and reporting requirements in (1) above, it must enter into an agreement with the U.S. Department of the Treasury requiring, among other things, that it undertake to identify accounts held by certain “specified United States persons” or “United States owned foreign entities” (each as defined in the Code), annually report certain information about such accounts, and withhold 30% on certain payments to non-compliant foreign financial institutions and certain other account holders. Foreign financial institutions located in jurisdictions that have an intergovernmental agreement with the United States governing FATCA may be subject to different rules.

Under the applicable Treasury Regulations and administrative guidance, withholding under FATCA generally applies to payments of dividends on stock. While withholding under FATCA would have applied also to payments of gross proceeds from the sale or other disposition of stock on or after January 1, 2019, proposed Treasury Regulations eliminate FATCA withholding on payments of gross proceeds entirely. Taxpayers generally may rely on these proposed Treasury Regulations until final Treasury Regulations are issued.

Holders should consult their tax advisors regarding the potential application of withholding under FATCA to the Distribution and the ownership and disposition of LENSAR common stock.

 

86


Table of Contents

DIVIDEND POLICY

We currently do not anticipate paying any cash dividends in the foreseeable future. Instead, we anticipate that all of our earnings will be used to provide working capital, to support our operations and to finance the growth and development of our business. Any future determination to declare cash dividends will be made at the discretion of our board of directors and will depend on our financial condition, results of operations, capital requirements, general business conditions and other factors that our board of directors may deem relevant. In addition, if we were to enter into a credit facility in the future, we anticipate that the terms of such facility could limit or prohibit our ability to pay dividends.

 

87


Table of Contents

UNAUDITED CONDENSED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

The following unaudited condensed pro forma financial statements consist of the unaudited pro forma balance sheet as of June 30, 2020 and the unaudited pro forma statements of operations for the six months ended June 30, 2020 and for the year ended December 31, 2019. These unaudited condensed pro forma financial statements were derived from our historical audited annual financial statements and unaudited condensed interim financial statements included elsewhere in this information statement.

The unaudited pro forma statements of operations have been prepared to give effect to the Spin-Off and the related Pro Forma Transactions (as defined below) as if the Pro Forma Transactions had occurred or had become effective as of January 1, 2019. The unaudited pro forma balance sheet has been prepared to give effect to the Pro Forma Transactions as though the Pro Forma Transactions had occurred on June 30, 2020.

In management’s opinion, the unaudited condensed pro forma financial statements reflect certain adjustments that are necessary to present fairly our unaudited pro forma results of operations and unaudited pro forma balance sheet as of and for the periods indicated. The pro forma adjustments give effect to events that are (i) directly attributable to the Spin-Off, (ii) factually supportable and, (iii) with respect to the statements of operations, expected to have a continuing impact on us.

The unaudited condensed pro forma financial statements have been adjusted to give effect to the following (the “Pro Forma Transactions”):

 

   

the effect of our post-separation capital structure, including the impact of the Recapitalization Transactions (as described in the accompanying notes to the unaudited condensed pro forma financial statements) and the contributions of $37.0 million in cash from PDL to us in exchange for an additional number of shares of our common stock;

 

   

the impact of the new grants under the LENSAR, Inc. 2020 Incentive Award Plan (“the 2020 Plan”) in connection with the Spin-Off; and

 

   

the impact of the separation and distribution agreement, the transition services agreement and other agreements among us and PDL and the provisions contained therein.

The unaudited condensed pro forma financial statements have been prepared based on available information, assumptions, and estimates that management believes are reasonable. The unaudited condensed pro forma financial statements are for illustrative and informational purposes only, and are not intended to represent what our financial position and results of operations would have been had we operated as an independent, stand-alone company during the periods presented or if the Pro Forma Transactions had occurred as of the dates indicated. The unaudited condensed pro forma financial statements also should not be considered indicative of our future financial position or future results of operations as an independent, publicly traded company.

The unaudited condensed pro forma financial statements reported below should be read in conjunction with our historical audited financial statements, unaudited interim condensed financial statements, and the accompanying notes in the “Index to Financial Statements” and “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” included elsewhere in this information statement.

The unaudited condensed pro forma financial information is subject to change based on the finalization of the terms of the Spin-Off and related agreements. If the actual facts are different than these assumptions, then the unaudited condensed pro forma financial information will be different, and those changes could be material.

 

88


Table of Contents

LENSAR, Inc.

UNAUDITED PRO FORMA STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS

FOR THE SIX MONTHS ENDED JUNE 30, 2020

(In thousands, except share and per share amounts)

 

     Historical
As reported
    Pro Forma
Adjustments
   

Notes

   Pro Forma  

Revenue

         

Product

   $ 8,096     $ —          $ 8,096  

Lease

     1,446       —            1,446  

Service

     1,411       —            1,411  
  

 

 

   

 

 

      

 

 

 

Total revenues

     10,953       —            10,953  
  

 

 

   

 

 

      

 

 

 

Cost of revenue (exclusive of amortization)

         

Product

     3,468       66     (E)      3,534  

Lease

     696       —            696  

Service

     1,275       36     (E)      1,311  
  

 

 

   

 

 

      

 

 

 

Total cost of revenue

     5,439       102          5,541  
  

 

 

   

 

 

      

 

 

 

Operating expenses

         

Selling, general and administrative expenses

     8,820       1,449     (A),(E)      10,269  

Research and development expenses

     3,005       187     (E)      3,192  

Amortization of intangible assets

     631       —            631  
  

 

 

   

 

 

      

 

 

 

Operating loss

     (6,942     (1,738        (8,680
  

 

 

   

 

 

      

 

 

 

Other income (expense)

         

Interest expense

     (1,275     1,275     (D)      —    

Other income, net

     34       —            34  
  

 

 

   

 

 

      

 

 

 

Loss before income taxes

     (8,183     (463        (8,646

Income tax expense

     —         —            —    
  

 

 

   

 

 

      

 

 

 

Net loss

   $ (8,183   $ (463      $ (8,646
  

 

 

   

 

 

      

 

 

 

Cumulative dividends in excess of interest expense on mandatorily redeemable preferred stock

     —         —            —    
  

 

 

   

 

 

      

 

 

 

Net loss attributable to common stockholders

   $ (8,183   $ (463      $ (8,646
  

 

 

   

 

 

      

 

 

 

Net loss per share attributable to common stockholders

         

Basic and diluted

   $ (7.65        $ (0.91

Weighted-average number of shares used in calculation of loss per share:

         

Basic and diluted

     1,070,000       8,439,403     (B)      9,509,403  

See accompanying Notes to Unaudited Condensed Pro Forma Financial Statements

 

89


Table of Contents

LENSAR, Inc.

UNAUDITED PRO FORMA STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS

FOR THE YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2019

(In thousands, except share and per share amounts)

 

     Historical
As reported
    Pro Forma
Adjustments
   

Notes

   Pro Forma  

Revenue

         

Product

   $ 23,254     $ —          $ 23,254  

Lease

     4,181       —            4,181  

Service

     3,093       —            3,093  
  

 

 

   

 

 

      

 

 

 

Total revenues

     30,528       —            30,528  
  

 

 

   

 

 

      

 

 

 

Cost of revenue (exclusive of amortization)

         

Product

     12,030       395     (E)      12,425  

Lease

     2,264       —            2,264  

Service

     3,005       214     (E)      3,219  
  

 

 

   

 

 

      

 

 

 

Total cost of revenue

     17,299       609          17,908  
  

 

 

   

 

 

      

 

 

 

Operating expenses

         

Selling, general and administrative expenses

     17,147       9,611     (A),(E)      26,758  

Research and development expenses

     7,569       1,123     (E)      8,692  

Amortization of intangible assets

     1,227       —            1,227  
  

 

 

   

 

 

      

 

 

 

Operating loss

     (12,714     (11,343        (24,057
  

 

 

   

 

 

      

 

 

 

Other income (expense)

         

Interest expense

     (2,001     2,001     (D)      —    

Other income, net

     58       —            58  
  

 

 

   

 

 

      

 

 

 

Loss before income taxes

     (14,657     (9,342        (23,999

Income tax expense

     —         —            —    
  

 

 

   

 

 

      

 

 

 

Net loss

   $ (14,657   $ (9,342      $ (23,999
  

 

 

   

 

 

      

 

 

 

Cumulative dividends in excess of interest expense on mandatorily redeemable preferred stock

     —         —            —    
  

 

 

   

 

 

      

 

 

 

Net loss attributable to common stockholders

   $ (14,657   $ (9,342      $ (23,999
  

 

 

   

 

 

      

 

 

 

Net loss per share attributable to common stockholders

         

Basic and diluted

   $ (13.70        $ (2.62

Weighted-average number of shares used in calculation of loss per share:

         

Basic and diluted

     1,070,000       8,073,990     (B)      9,143,990  

See accompanying Notes to Unaudited Condensed Pro Forma Financial Statements

 

90


Table of Contents

LENSAR, Inc.

UNAUDITED PRO FORMA BALANCE SHEET

AS OF JUNE 30, 2020

(In thousands, except share and per share amounts)

 

     Historical
As reported
    Pro Forma
Adjustments
   

Notes

   Pro Forma  

Assets

         

Current assets:

         

Cash

   $ 4,715     $ 37,000     (C)    $ 41,715  

Accounts receivable, net of allowance for doubtful accounts of $24

     2,565       —            2,565  

Notes receivable, net of allowance for doubtful accounts of $11

     516       —            516  

Inventories

     12,633       —            12,633  

Prepaid and other current assets

     415       —            415  
  

 

 

   

 

 

      

 

 

 

Total current assets

     20,844       37,000          57,844  

Property and equipment, net

     843       —            843  

Equipment under lease, net

     2,147       —            2,147  

Notes and other receivable, long term, net of allowance for doubtful accounts of $13

     636       —            636  

Intangible assets, net

     12,735       —            12,735  

Other assets

     816       —            816  
  

 

 

   

 

 

      

 

 

 

Total assets

   $ 38,021     $ 37,000        $ 75,021  
  

 

 

   

 

 

      

 

 

 

Liabilities and stockholders’ (deficit) equity

         

Current liabilities:

         

Accounts payable

   $ 1,515     $ —          $ 1,515  

Accrued liabilities

     3,255       —            3,255  

Deferred revenue

     864       —            864  

Other current liabilities

     565       —            565  
  

 

 

   

 

 

      

 

 

 

Total current liabilities

     6,199       —            6,199  

Long-term operating lease liabilities

     48       —            48  

Note payable due to related party

     30,600       (30,600   (D)      —    

Mandatorily redeemable preferred stock

     37,214       (37,214   (D)      —    

Other long-term liabilities

     235       —            235  
  

 

 

   

 

 

      

 

 

 

Total liabilities

     74,296       (67,814        6,482  
  

 

 

   

 

 

      

 

 

 

Commitments and contingencies

         

Stockholders’ (deficit) equity:

         

Common stock, par value $0.01 per share, 150,000,000 shares authorized; 10,605,644 shares issued and outstanding on a pro forma basis

     11       95     (C),(D),(E)      106  

Additional paid-in capital

     10,116       104,719     (C),(D),(E)      114,835  

Accumulated deficit

     (46,402     —            (46,402
  

 

 

   

 

 

      

 

 

 

Total stockholders’ (deficit) equity

     (36,275     104,814          68,539  
  

 

 

   

 

 

      

 

 

 

Total liabilities and stockholders’ (deficit) equity

   $ 38,021     $ 37,000        $ 75,021  
  

 

 

   

 

 

      

 

 

 

See accompanying Notes to Unaudited Condensed Pro Forma Financial Statements

 

91


Table of Contents

LENSAR, Inc.

Notes to Unaudited Condensed Pro Forma Financial Statements

Note 1. Basis of Presentation

The accompanying unaudited condensed pro forma financial information was prepared in accordance with Article 11 of Regulation S-X of the SEC and presents the unaudited pro forma statements of operations and unaudited pro forma balance sheet based on the audited historical financial statements and unaudited interim condensed financial statements included in this information statement, after giving effect to the Pro Forma Transactions. The audited historical financial statements and unaudited interim condensed financial statements of LENSAR have been adjusted in the accompanying unaudited condensed pro forma financial information to give effect to pro forma events that are: (1) directly attributable to the Spin-Off and the related Pro Forma Transactions (2) factually supportable, and (3) with respect to the statements of operations, expected to have a continuing impact on us.

The accompanying unaudited condensed pro forma financial information is presented for illustrative purposes only and does not purport to be indicative of the actual results that would have been achieved by LENSAR if the Pro Forma Transactions had been consummated for the period presented or that will be achieved in the future.

Our historical statements of operations include allocations of certain expenses relating to support functions historically provided by PDL. These functions include, but are not limited to administration and organizational oversight, including employee benefits, finance and accounting, treasury and risk management, professional and legal services, among others. These historical allocations may not be indicative of our future cost structure. To operate as an independent public company, we expect to incur costs to replace those services previously provided by PDL in addition to incremental standalone costs. Due to the scope and complexity of these activities, the amount and timing of these incremental costs could vary and, consequently, are not included in the unaudited condensed pro forma financial statements.

The income tax effects of pro forma adjustments within the unaudited condensed pro forma financial information continue to be offset by our full valuation allowance.

All common share and per share amounts in the unaudited condensed pro forma financial information and notes thereto have been retroactively adjusted for all periods presented to give effect to a one-for-nine reverse stock split. See Note 17 to our audited financial statements and Note 15 to our unaudited condensed interim financial statements included elsewhere in this information statement for further information on this reverse stock split.

Note 2. Description of the Recapitalization Transactions, Capital Contributions and 2020 Plan

On July 10, 2020, we amended and restated our certificate of incorporation (the “Restated Charter”) to, among other things, (a) increase the number of shares of common stock ($0.01 par value per share) we are authorized to issue to 150,000,000 shares and (b) we issued to PDL a total of 3,414,825 shares of our common stock in exchange for the extinguishment of all 30,000 shares of our Series A Preferred Stock, including any accrued and unpaid dividends thereon (the “Series A Preferred Stock Recapitalization”). We currently do not have any shares of Series A Preferred Stock outstanding.

On July 13, 2020, we entered into a contribution and exchange agreement with PDL whereby we issued to PDL a total of 2,806,244 shares of our common stock in exchange for the extinguishment of the $32.6 million outstanding, including accrued interest, we owed to PDL under the Credit Agreement (the “Note Payable Recapitalization”).

 

92


Table of Contents

The Series A Preferred Stock Recapitalization, together with the Note Payable Recapitalization, is defined as the “Recapitalization Transactions”. The Recapitalization Transactions were accounted for under GAAP as an extinguishment of debt.

On July 9, 2020, our board of directors approved the 2020 Plan. Under the 2020 Plan, we may grant stock options, restricted stock, restricted stock unit awards and other stock-based awards.

On July 21, 2020 we issued an additional 740,740 shares of common stock to PDL in exchange for $8.0 million in cash (the “Capital Contribution”).

On July 22, 2020, our board of directors approved the grant of 1,847,298 shares of restricted stock in connection with the Spin-Off to certain individuals under the 2020 Plan in consideration of future services to be rendered to the Company. The vesting schedule of the restricted stock awards is (i) 40% vest on the later of three months following the closing of the Spin-Off or six months following the grant date (provided the Spin-Off has occurred prior to such date), (ii) 30% vest 18 months following grant date, and (iii) 30% vest 36 months following grant date. Additionally, the shares of restricted stock are subject to an excess share forfeiture restriction, whereby, as of the date of the Spin-Off, the number of shares issued to a participant pursuant to the grant notice plus all other shares of common stock held by such participant shall not exceed the target percentage stated in the participant’s restricted stock agreement multiplied by LENSAR’s fully diluted capitalization as of the date of the Spin-Off. Following the application of the excess share forfeiture restriction, the remaining shares shall be eligible to vest based on the aforementioned vesting schedule.

On August 24, 2020, we received cash of $29.0 million from PDL (the “Additional Capital Contribution”). We issued 746,767 shares of common stock to PDL in exchange for $8.3 million. The remaining $20.7 million was a cash contribution from PDL.

On September 10, 2020, we amended our amended and restated certificate of incorporation to effectuate a one-for-nine reverse stock split of our common stock.

Note 3. Pro Forma Adjustments

 

(A)

Reflects the removal of approximately $0.2 million and $0.5 million for the six months ended June 30, 2020 and for the year ended December 31, 2019, respectively, of separation costs directly related to the Pro Forma Transactions that were incurred during the historical periods and are not expected to have a continuing impact on our results of operations following the consummation of the Spin-Off.

 

(B)

Represents the basic and diluted weighted average number of shares of common stock outstanding as a result of pro forma adjustments. Refer to the table below for the reconciliation of the pro forma adjustments for the weighted average number of shares of common stock outstanding.

 

93


Table of Contents
     Shares  

Weighted average number of shares of common stock for the year ended December 31, 2019— Historical as reported

     1,070,000  

Reclassification of all shares of Series A Preferred stock

     3,414,825  

Conversion of note payable due to related party

     2,806,244  

Capital Contribution from PDL in exchange for common stock

     740,740  

Additional Capital Contribution from PDL in exchange for common stock (the Additional Capital Contribution)

     746,767  

Vested restricted stock awards under the 2020 Plan

     365,414  
  

 

 

 

Weighted average number of shares of common stock for the year ended December 31, 2019—Pro Forma

     9,143,990  
  

 

 

 

Increase in weighted average number of shares for vested restricted stock awards under the 2020 Plan

     365,414  
  

 

 

 

Weighted average number of shares of common stock for the six months ended June 30, 2020—Pro Forma

     9,509,403  
  

 

 

 

 

(C)

Represents the increase to cash of $37.0 million and the increase to common stock and additional paid-in capital of less than $0.1 million and $37.0 million, respectively, to reflect the Capital Contribution and the Additional Capital Contribution by PDL to us in exchange for the issuance of 1,487,507 shares of our common stock.

 

(D)

Represents the effect of the Recapitalization Transactions which resulted in the extinguishment of our note payable due to related party and our Series A Preferred stock of $30.6 million and of $37.2 million, respectively, and the increase to common stock and additional paid-in capital of $0.1 million and $67.1 million, respectively, in connection with the issuance of 6,221,069 shares of our common stock to extinguish our note payable and Series A Preferred stock. The Recapitalization Transactions with PDL resulted in an adjustment to equity for an aggregate gain on extinguishment of $0.6 million. An adjustment was also recorded in the unaudited pro forma statements of operations to decrease interest expense by $1.3 million and $2.0 million for the six months ended June 30, 2020 and for the year ended December 31, 2019, respectively, to reflect the elimination of interest expense associated with the Recapitalization Transactions.

The unaudited pro forma statement of operations does not include an adjustment to reflect a loss on extinguishment, which would have been incurred if the Recapitalization Transactions had been effective on January 1, 2019, as such event is one-time in nature and not expected to have a continuing impact on our results of operations.

Due to the change in the carrying values of our note payable due to related party and our Series A Preferred Stock as of the actual extinguishment date in July 2020, we expect to recognize an approximate $2.7 million gain on extinguishment which will be accounted for as a capital transaction between PDL and us and, accordingly, recorded directly within equity during the three months ended September 30, 2020.

 

(E)

Represents the estimated stock-based compensation expense under the 2020 Plan for the remaining shares of restricted stock following the application of the excess share forfeiture restriction, which resulted in 20,230 restricted stock awards not considered probable of vesting as of the assumed Spin-Off date used in the unaudited condensed pro forma financial information. The fair value of awards granted under the 2020 Plan will be recognized using a straight-line attribution method over the service period, except for portions of the award subject to performance conditions which will be recognized ratably over the service period for each separate performance vesting tranche. The grant date fair values of the restricted stock awards were determined based on the fair value of our underlying common stock as of the date of the grant using preliminary valuation techniques with the most reliable information available. Actual results may differ from these estimates and such differences may be material.

 

94


Table of Contents

MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

The following discussion and analysis presented below refer to and should be read in conjunction with the audited financial statements, unaudited condensed interim financial statements and the corresponding notes, each included elsewhere in this information statement. This Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations contain forward-looking statements. The matters discussed in these forward-looking statements are subject to risk, uncertainties and other factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from those made, projected or implied in the forward-looking statements. Please see the “Risk Factors” section for a discussion of the uncertainties, risks and assumptions associated with these statements.

Spin-Off from PDL BioPharma, Inc.

PDL is considering spinning off its medical device business. The Spin-Off will create a separate, independent, publicly traded global medical device company focused on designing, developing and marketing an advanced femtosecond laser system for the treatment of cataracts and the management of pre-existing or surgically induced corneal astigmatism. Following the Spin-Off, we will become a stand-alone company and our business will consist of the assets, liabilities and operations of PDL’s medical device business.

Our historical financial statements have been prepared on a stand-alone basis and are derived from PDL’s consolidated financial statements and accounting records. Our financial statements reflect, in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States, our financial position, results of operations, and cash flows as the business was historically operated as part of PDL prior to the Spin-Off. The statements of operations include direct expenses for cost of revenue; research and development; selling, general and administrative expenses; and amortization, as well as allocated expenses for certain corporate support functions that are provided by PDL, such as administration and organizational oversight, including employee benefits, finance and accounting, treasury and risk management, professional and legal services, among others. These expenses have been allocated to us on the basis of direct usage when identifiable, with the remainder allocated on a proportional basis of our expenses and expenses of PDL. Our management and PDL’s management considered the basis on which the expenses have been allocated to be a reasonable reflection of utilization of services provided to or to the benefit received by us during the periods presented. These allocations may not be reflective of the expenses that would have been incurred had we operated as a separate, unaffiliated entity apart from PDL. Actual costs that would have been incurred if we had been a stand-alone, public company would depend on multiple factors, including the chosen organizational structure and strategic decisions made in various areas, including information technology and infrastructure.

Transactions with PDL that are expected to be settled for cash are reflected as outstanding in our balance sheets. These transactions primarily include payables to PDL related to certain historical cross charge cost allocations, the loan payable to PDL, and the Series A Preferred Stock held by PDL. The cash flows related to payables due to PDL for these certain historical cross charge cost allocations are reflected in our statements of cash flows as operating activities. The cash flows related to the loan payable due to PDL and our Series A Preferred Stock are reflected in our statements of cash flows as financing activities since these balances represent amounts financed by PDL. Transactions with PDL that have not been historically settled in cash or are not expected to be settled in cash have been included in the balance sheets as a component of equity and are reflected in our statements of cash flows as financing activities. In July 2020, we entered into a contribution and exchange agreement with PDL, whereby we issued to PDL a total of 2,806,244 shares of our common stock in exchange for the extinguishment of the $32.6 million outstanding, including accrued interest, we owed to PDL under the Credit Agreement. In July 2020, we issued to PDL a total of 3,414,825 shares of our common stock in exchange for the extinguishment of all 30,000 shares of our Series A Preferred Stock, including any accrued and unpaid dividends thereon. We currently do not have any shares of Series A Preferred Stock outstanding.

 

95


Table of Contents

Following the Spin-Off, we expect to perform the functions described above using our own resources or purchased services. For an interim period, however, some of these functions may continue to be provided by PDL and we expect to enter into one or more transition service agreements with PDL in connection with the Spin-Off.

Overview

We are a commercial-stage medical device company focused on designing, developing and marketing an advanced femtosecond laser system for the treatment of cataracts and the management of pre-existing or surgically induced corneal astigmatism. Our LENSAR Laser System incorporates a range of proprietary technologies designed to assist the surgeon in obtaining better visual outcomes, efficiency and reproducibility by providing advanced imaging, simplified procedure planning, efficient design and precision. We believe the cumulative effect of these technologies results in a laser system that can be quickly and efficiently integrated into a surgeon’s existing practice, is easy to use and provides surgeons the ability to deliver improved visual outcomes. As we continue to innovate, we are designing a next-generation, integrated workstation, ALLY, which combines an enhanced femtosecond laser with a phacoemulsification system in a compact, mobile workstation that is designed to allow surgeons to perform a femtosecond laser assisted cataract procedure in a single operating room using a single device. We expect this combination product would be a meaningful advancement and will provide significant administrative and financial benefit to a surgeon’s practice at a cost less than the cost of our current system.

Our current product portfolio consists of the Streamline IV LENSAR Laser System and its associated consumable components. The consumable portion of the system consists of a disposable patient interface device, or PID, kit and a procedure license. Each procedure on each system requires the use of a PID kit. The PID kit includes a suction ring, vacuum filter and fluidic connection that are designed to facilitate placement of the laser while minimizing a patient’s discomfort, intraocular pressure and trauma to the retina and maintaining corneal integrity. The procedure license is downloaded onto the system as required or as purchased by the customer. The system will not perform a procedure without an active license. We offer licenses in a subscription package with minimum monthly obligations and the ability to increase procedure numbers as the practice grows to address occasional increases in demand. We believe this structure allows the surgeon to implement a budget while also providing us with a predictable revenue stream.

We are focused on continuous innovation and are currently developing our proprietary, next-generation, integrated workstation, ALLY. ALLY is designed to combine our existing femtosecond laser technology with enhanced capabilities and a phacoemulsification system into a single unit and allow surgeons to perform each of the critical steps in a cataract procedure in a single operating room using this device. We anticipate submitting an application for 510(k) clearance to the FDA by the end of the first quarter of 2022 and to begin commercialization of ALLY by the end of 2022. If ALLY is cleared by the FDA, we believe its lower cost of goods and combined functions will help drive broader penetration for us into the overall cataract surgery market and could create a paradigm shift in the treatment of cataracts and management of astigmatism in cataract surgery.

We have built and are continuing to grow our commercial organization, which includes a direct sales force in the United States and distributors in Germany, China, South Korea and other targeted international geographies. We believe there is significant opportunity for us to expand our presence in these countries and other markets and regions. In the United States, we sell our products through a direct sales organization that, as of June 30, 2020, consisted of 30 commercial team professionals, including regional sales managers, clinical applications and outcomes specialists, field service, technology and customer support personnel. We currently manufacture our LENSAR Laser System at a facility in Orlando, Florida. We purchase custom and off-the-shelf components from a number of suppliers, including some single-source suppliers. We purchase the majority of our components and major assemblies through purchase orders with limited long-term supply agreements and generally do not maintain large volumes of finished goods. We strive to maintain enough inventory of our various component parts to avoid the impact of a potential short-term disruption in the supply.

 

96


Table of Contents

Our revenue decreased from $14.0 million for the six months ended June 30, 2019 to $11.0 million for the six months ended June 30, 2020, representing a decline of 22%, primarily on account of the impact of COVID-19 as discussed below. Our revenue increased from $24.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2018 to $30.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2019, representing growth of 25%. Our net losses were $6.4 million, $8.2 million, $12.6 million and $14.7 million for the six months ended June 30, 2019 and June 30, 2020 and for the years ended December 31, 2018 and December 31, 2019, respectively. Additionally, our installed base of LENSAR Laser Systems has increased from 193 as of June 30, 2019 to 211 as of June 30, 2020. Although our installed base of LENSAR Laser Systems increased, the decrease in revenue was primarily driven by the impact of the COVID-19 pandemic and the associated decline in elective surgical procedures.

Factors to Consider

We operate in a highly competitive environment that involves a number of risks, some of which are beyond our control. We are subject to risks common to medical device companies, including risks inherent in:

 

   

our laser system development and commercialization efforts;

 

   

clinical trials;

 

   

uncertainty of regulatory actions and marketing approvals;

 

   

reliance on a network of international distributors;

 

   

levels of coverage and reimbursement by government or other third-party payors for procedures using our products;

 

   

patients’ willingness and ability to pay for procedures with significant costs not covered by or reimbursable through government or other third-party payors;

 

   

enforcement of patent and proprietary rights;

 

   

the need for future capital; and

 

   

competition associated with our products.

We cannot provide assurance that we will generate significant revenues or achieve and sustain profitability in the future. In addition, we can provide no assurance that we will have sufficient funding to meet our future capital requirements.

Our revenues and operating expenses are also difficult to predict and depend on several factors, including the level of ongoing research and development requirements necessary to complete development of our ALLY laser system, the number of laser systems we manufacture, sell, and lease on an annual basis, and the availability of capital and direction from regulatory agencies, which are difficult to predict. We may be able to control the timing and level of research and development and selling, general and administrative expenses, but many of these expenditures will occur irrespective of our actions due to contractually committed activities and payments.

Additionally, we have historically experienced seasonal variations in the sales and leases of our products, with our fourth quarter typically being the strongest and the third quarter being the slowest. We believe these seasonal variations are consistent across our industry.

On March 11, 2020, the World Health Organization declared a global pandemic, as the outbreak of a novel strain of coronavirus spread throughout the world. The outbreak of COVID-19 has significantly disrupted our business operations and adversely impacted our business, as non-essential medical procedures, including cataract surgeries, were suspended or significantly decreased in many geographic areas. Actions taken to mitigate coronavirus have had and are expected to continue to have an adverse impact on the geographical areas in which we operate, and we are making adjustments intended to assist in protecting the safety of our employees and

 

97


Table of Contents

communities while continuing our business activities where possible and legally permitted. To date, implementation of these measures has not required material expenditures, but the suspension of non-essential medical services has significantly impacted our revenues and cash flows and continues to disrupt our commercial operations. During the second quarter of 2020, we made lease concessions to several customers related to the effects of COVID-19 pandemic, which adversely impacted revenue recognized during the period. In return for these concessions, the related contracts were extended by the same number of months waived. We have also experienced minor supply chain disruptions as a result of COVID-19. We are continuing to monitor developments with respect to the outbreak and its potential impacts on our operations and those of our employees, distributors, partners, suppliers, and regulators.

As a result of these and other factors, our historical results are not necessarily indicative of future performance, and any interim results we present are not indicative of the results that may be expected for the full fiscal year.

Components of Our Results of Operations

Revenue

Total revenue comprises product revenue, service revenue and lease revenue. We derive product revenue from the sale of our laser systems and sales of our PID and procedure licenses to our surgeon customers and to our distributors outside the United States. A PID and procedure license, which may also be referred to as an application license, is required to perform each procedure using our laser system. A procedure license represents a one-time right to utilize the LENSAR Laser System surgical application in connection with a surgery procedure. Service revenue is derived from the sale of extended warranties for our laser systems that provide additional maintenance and service beyond our standard limited warranty. In some situations, we lease our laser systems to surgeons, primarily through non-cancellable leases with a fixed lease payment.

Cost of Revenue

Total cost of revenue comprises cost of product revenue, cost of lease revenue and cost of service revenue.

Cost of product revenue primarily consists of the raw materials used in the manufacture of our products, plant and equipment overhead, labor and stock-based compensation costs, packaging costs, depreciation expense, freight and other related costs, which include shipping, inspection and excess and obsolete inventory charges. Cost of lease revenue primarily consists of depreciation expense associated with leased equipment and shipping costs associated with delivery of these systems. Cost of service revenue primarily consists of costs associated with providing maintenance services under the extended warranty contracts.

Selling, General and Administrative Expense

Our selling, general and administrative expenses consist primarily of personnel costs, such as salaries and wages, including stock-based compensation, and benefits, professional and legal fees, marketing, insurance, travel and other expenses.

We are continuing to grow our sales efforts in the United States. We expect our selling, general and administrative expenses to continue to increase in association with our planned growth. Additionally, if we receive regulatory clearance for ALLY, we anticipate additional increases in selling, general and administrative expenses as we prepare for and launch commercialization of ALLY. We also expect to incur additional expenses as a result of operating as a public company, including expenses necessary to comply with the rules and regulations applicable to companies listed on a national securities exchange and those of the SEC, as well as increased expenses for director and officer insurance, investor relations and professional services.

 

98


Table of Contents

Research and Development Expense

Our research and development expenses consist primarily of engineering, product development, clinical studies to develop and support our products, personnel costs, such as salaries and wages, including stock-based compensation, regulatory expenses, and other costs associated with products and technologies that are in development. Currently, our research and development expense primarily consists of costs associated with the continued development of our next-generation laser system, ALLY, which is designed to combine our existing femtosecond laser technology with a phacoemulsification system into a single unit.

As we continue to advance the development of ALLY, we expect our research and development expenditures to increase from current levels, as we anticipate that the planned development of ALLY will consume significant capital resources.

Amortization of Intangible Assets

Intangible assets with finite useful lives consist primarily of acquired trademarks, acquired technology, and customer relationships. Acquired trademarks and acquired technology are amortized on a straight-line basis over their estimated useful lives, of 15 to 20 years. Customer relationships are amortized on a straight-line basis or a double declining basis over their estimated useful lives up to 20 years, based on the method that better represents the economic benefits to be obtained.

Interest Expense

Interest expense primarily consists of interest expense associated with the Series A Preferred Stock and a loan payable to PDL. The Series A Preferred Stock is classified as a liability on our balance sheet and related dividends are recorded as interest expense using the effective interest method. In July 2020, we entered into a contribution and exchange agreement with PDL, whereby we issued to PDL a total of 2,806,244 shares of our common stock in exchange for the extinguishment of the $32.6 million, including accrued interest, we owed to PDL under the Credit Agreement. In July 2020, we issued to PDL a total of 3,414,825 shares of our common stock in exchange for the extinguishment of all 30,000 shares of our Series A Preferred Stock, including any accrued and unpaid dividends thereon. We currently do not have any shares of Series A Preferred Stock outstanding.

Results of Operations

Comparison of Six Months Ended June 30, 2020 and 2019

 

(Dollars in thousands)

   Six Months Ended June 30,      Change from
Prior Year %
 
   2020      2019  

Revenue:

        

Product

   $ 8,096      $ 10,433        (22.4 )% 

Lease

     1,446        2,060        (29.8 )% 

Service

     1,411        1,507        (6.4 )% 
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

Total revenue

   $ 10,953      $ 14,000        (21.8 )% 

Cost of revenue (excluding intangible amortization):

        

Product

   $ 3,468      $ 5,806        (40.3 )% 

Lease

     696        1,267        (45.1 )% 

Service

     1,275        1,638        (22.2 )% 
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

Total cost of revenue

   $ 5,439      $ 8,711        (37.6 )% 

 

99


Table of Contents

Revenue

Total revenue for the six months ended June 30, 2020 compared to the six months ended June 30, 2019 decreased by $3.0 million, or 22%. The decrease was primarily driven by the impact of the COVID-19 pandemic and the associated decline in elective surgical procedures.

Product revenue for the six months ended June 30, 2020 compared to the six months ended June 30, 2019 decreased by $2.3 million, or 22.4%. The decrease was primarily attributable to a decrease of $1.5 million related to a net decrease in sales of new and refurbished LENSAR Laser Systems. The number of procedures performed decreased by 18.4% in the six months ended June 30, 2020 as compared to the six months ended June 30, 2019, primarily due to the impact of the COVID-19 pandemic.

Service revenue for the six months ended June 30, 2020 compared to the six months ended June 30, 2019 decreased by $0.1 million primarily due to decreased sales of our extended warranty services.

Geographically, the decrease in product and service revenue was primarily attributable to lower international net revenue due to decreased LENSAR Laser System sales. Our international sales represented 53.5% and 61.0% of product and service revenue for the six months ended June 30, 2020 and 2019, respectively. The decline was primarily driven by a decrease in LENSAR Laser System sales, PIDs and procedure licenses, comprised of a $2.4 million decrease in sales in South Korea, a $0.2 million decrease in Europe and a $0.2 million decrease in the United States, partially offset by $0.4 million increase in other countries.

Lease revenue for the six months ended June 30, 2020 compared to the six months ended June 30, 2019 decreased by $0.6 million primarily related to the impact of the COVID-19 pandemic, including $0.3 million of lease concessions made in the period ended June 30, 2020.

Cost of Revenue

Total cost of revenue for the six months ended June 30, 2020 was $5.4 million, a decrease of 37.6% when compared to total cost of revenue of $8.7 million for the six months ended June 30, 2019.

Cost of product revenue for the six months ended June 30, 2020 compared to the six months ended June 30, 2019 decreased by $2.3 million, or 40.3%. The decrease was primarily attributable to a decrease in the number of new and refurbished LENSAR Laser Systems that were sold in the six months ended June 30, 2020 as compared to the six months ended June 30, 2019. In addition, there was a decrease in the number of PIDs and procedure licenses sold in the six months ended June 30, 2020 as compared to the six months ended June 30, 2019.

Cost of service revenue for the six months ended June 30, 2020 compared to the six months ended June 30, 2019 decreased by $0.4 million, or 22.2%. This decrease was primarily attributable to a decrease in service, maintenance and warranty costs associated with lower sales volume. Although more systems were covered under service contracts, fewer service requests were made due to the COVID-19 pandemic.

Cost of lease revenue for the six months ended June 30, 2020 compared to the six months ended June 30, 2019 decreased by $0.6 million, or 45.1%. This decrease was primarily attributable to a decrease in rental depreciation as LENSAR Laser Systems reach the end of their depreciable life.

Operating Expenses

Selling, General, and Administrative. Selling, general, and administrative expenses for the six months ended June 30, 2020 were $8.8 million, an increase of $0.5 million, or 6.1%, compared to $8.3 million for the six months ended June 30, 2019. The increase was due to a $0.5 million increase in expenses allocated from PDL for corporate support functions, a $0.3 million increase in professional service fees, and a $0.3 million increase in

 

100


Table of Contents

personnel expense as headcount increases to support our continued growth. The increase was partially offset by a decrease of $0.3 million in trade show expenses due to cancellations related to COVID-19 and a $0.3 million decrease in travel expenses as a result of travel restrictions related to COVID-19. Selling, general and administrative expenses include $2.8 million and $2.3 million of expenses allocated from PDL for corporate support functions for the six months ended June 30, 2020 and 2019, respectively.

Research and Development. Research and development expenses for the six months ended June 30, 2020 were $3.0 million, an increase of $1.2 million, or 64.3%, compared to $1.8 million for the six months ended June 30, 2019. The increase was primarily attributable to a $0.7 million increase in research and development consulting services, as well as increased project costs of $0.4 million related to developing ALLY.

Amortization of Intangible Assets. Amortization of intangible assets is $0.6 million for the six months ended June 30, 2020 and 2019.

Other Income (Expense)

Interest expense increased by $0.3 million, or 33.7%, to $1.3 million for the six months ended June 30, 2020 from $1.0 million for the six months ended June 30, 2019. The increase was attributable to a $0.3 million increase of interest expense related to the loan payable to PDL in which the loan principal increased from December 31, 2019 to June 30, 2020.

Income Taxes

Prior to the Spin-Off, we are included in the consolidated federal tax return of PDL. The provision for income taxes is calculated by using a “separate return” method. Under this method, we are assumed to file a separate return with the applicable tax authority(ies). The current provision is the amount of tax payable or refundable on the basis of a hypothetical, current-year separate return. Deferred taxes are provided on temporary differences and on any attributes being carried forward that could be claimed on the hypothetical return. The need for a valuation allowance is assessed on a separate company basis and on projected separate return assets.

We maintain a full valuation allowance against our deferred tax assets.

Comparison of the Years Ended December 31, 2019 and 2018

 

(Dollars in thousands)    2019      2018      Change from
Prior Year %
 

Revenue:

        

Product

   $ 23,254      $ 17,239        34.9

Lease

     4,181        4,567        (8.5 )% 

Service

     3,093        2,582        19.8
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

Total revenue

   $ 30,528      $ 24,388        25.2

Cost of revenue (excluding intangible amortization):

        

Product

   $ 12,030      $ 8,315        44.7

Lease

     2,264        2,854        (20.7 )% 

Service

     3,005        2,471        21.6
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

Total cost of revenue

   $ 17,299      $ 13,640        26.8

Revenue

Total revenue for the year ended December 31, 2019 was $30.5 million, an increase of 25.2% when compared to total revenue of $24.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2018.

 

101


Table of Contents

Product revenue for the year ended December 31, 2019 compared to the year ended December 31, 2018 increased by $6.0 million, or 34.9%. The increase was primarily attributable to an increase of $4.4 million in sales of PIDs and procedure licenses and an increase of $1.6 million relating to sales of an increased number of new and refurbished LENSAR Laser Systems. During the year ended December 31, 2019 we experienced a net increase of 23 laser systems in the field, which contributed to a 33% increase in the number of procedures performed with our laser systems in the year ended December 31, 2019.

Service revenue for the year ended December 31, 2019 compared to the year ended December 31, 2018 increased by $0.5 million primarily due to increased sales of our extended warranty services.

Geographically, the increase in product and service revenue is primarily attributable to higher international net revenues due to increased sales volume. Changes in price did not have a material impact. Our international sales represented 59% and 49% of product and service revenues for the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018, respectively. The growth is primarily driven by an increase in product sales, specifically systems, PID and procedure licenses, comprised of a $5.0 million increase in sales in South Korea, a $1.1 million increase in Europe and a $0.9 million increase in the United States, partially offset by $0.5 million decrease in other countries.

Lease revenue for the year ended December 31, 2019 compared to the year ended December 31, 2018 decreased by $0.4 million primarily due to the conversion of three rental systems to sold systems and the timing of rental systems being placed in service within 2018 as compared to 2019.

Cost of Revenue

Total cost of revenue for the year ended December 31, 2019 was $17.3 million, an increase of 26.8% when compared to total cost of revenue of $13.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2018.

Cost of product revenue for the year ended December 31, 2019 compared to the year ended December 31, 2018 increased by $3.7 million or 44.7%. The increase was primarily attributable to a $2.7 million increase in cost of materials and production for systems sold and a $0.9 million increase in cost of materials associated with the increase in PID sales, both of which were directly related to an increased number of LENSAR Laser Systems that were sold. We expect our cost of product revenue to continue to increase in absolute dollars as we increase our sales volume.

Cost of service revenue for the year ended December 31, 2019 compared to the year ended December 31, 2018 increased by $0.5 million or 21.6%. This increase was primarily attributable to service, maintenance and warranty costs associated with increased sales volume and is also a function of a higher amount of systems under service agreements in the year ended December 31, 2019.

Cost of lease revenue for the year ended December 31, 2019 compared to the year ended December 31, 2018 decreased by $0.6 million, or 20.7%. This decrease was primarily attributable to a decrease in rental depreciation, as we had fewer leased systems in the field due to the conversion of three rental systems to sold systems, and shipping costs related to leased systems.

Operating Expenses

Selling, General, and Administrative. Selling, general, and administrative expenses for the year ended December 31, 2019 were $17.1 million, an increase of $1.0 million, or 6.2%, compared to $16.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2018. The increase was primarily due to a $0.9 million increase in personnel costs as a result of larger incentive bonuses associated with increased revenues as well as additions in headcount to support our continued growth. Selling, general and administrative expenses include $4.4 million and $5.0 million of expenses allocated from PDL for corporate support functions for the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018, respectively.

 

102


Table of Contents

We are continuing to grow our sales efforts in the United States. We expect our selling general and administrative expenses to continue to increase in association with our planned growth of our direct commercial organization in the United States. Additionally, if we receive regulatory clearance for ALLY, we anticipate additional increases in selling, general and administrative expense as we prepare for and launch commercialization of ALLY. We also expect to incur additional expenses as a result of operating as a public company, including expenses necessary to comply with the rules and regulations applicable to companies listed on a national securities exchange and those of the SEC, as well as increased expenses for director and officer insurance, investor relations and professional services.

Research and Development. Research and development expenses for the year ended December 31, 2019 were $7.6 million, an increase of $4.8 million, or 171.8%, compared to $2.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2018. The increase was primarily attributable to a $4.2 million increase in project costs, including the exclusive licensing of intellectual property from Doug Patton and Ophthalmic Synergies, LLC for $3.5 million, for use in developing ALLY and higher lab and laser supply costs. Research and development personnel costs also increased by $0.6 million due to the continued development of ALLY.

As we continue to advance the development of ALLY, we expect our research and development expenditures to increase from 2019 levels, as we anticipate that the planned development of ALLY will consume significant capital resources.

Amortization of Intangible Assets. Amortization of intangible assets increased by $0.1 million, or 7.9%, to $1.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2019 from $1.1 million the year ended December 31, 2018. The increase is primarily due to the acquisition of certain intellectual property in 2019.

Other Income (Expense)

Interest expense decreased by $1.3 million, or 39.8%, to $2.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2019 from $3.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2018. The decrease of $1.3 million was due to a reduction in the dividend rate of our Series A Preferred Stock from 15% to 5% effective January 1, 2019. The decrease was offset by an increase of $0.2 million of interest expense related to the note payable to PDL in which the loan principal increased from December 31, 2018 to December 31, 2019.

Income Taxes

In general, our income tax returns are subject to examination by U.S. federal, state and local tax authorities for tax years 2009 forward. There was no interest and penalties associated with unrecognized tax benefits accrued on the balance sheet as of December 31, 2019 and 2018, respectively. We do not anticipate any material change to the amount of our unrecognized tax benefit over the next 12 months.

Non-GAAP Financial Measure

We prepare and analyze operating and financial data and non-GAAP measures to assess the performance of our business, make strategic and offering decisions and build our financial projections. The key non-GAAP measure we use is set forth below for the six months ended June 30, 2020 and 2019 and the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018.

 

     Year Ended
December 31,
     Six Months Ended
June 30,
 
(in thousands)    2019      2018      2020      2019  

EBITDA

   $ (8,848    $ (4,726    $ (5,503    $ (3,358

 

103


Table of Contents

EBITDA is defined as net loss before interest expense, income tax expense, interest income, depreciation and amortization of intangible assets. EBITDA is a non-GAAP financial measure. For more information about how we use this non-GAAP financial measure in our business, the limitations of this measure, and a reconciliation of EBITDA to net loss, the most directly comparable GAAP measure, please see the section titled “Information Statement Summary—Summary Historical Financial Data.”

Liquidity and Capital Resources

Overview

For the six months ended June 30, 2020 and 2019, we had net losses of $8.2 million and $6.4 million, respectively, and as of June 30, 2020, we had an accumulated deficit of $46.4 million. For the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018, we had net losses of $14.7 million and $12.6 million, respectively, and as of December 31, 2019, we had an accumulated deficit of $38.2 million. We expect to continue to incur losses and operating cash outflows for the foreseeable future as we continue to build our commercial and clinical infrastructure, pursue development and FDA clearance of our proprietary, next-generation, integrated workstation, known as ALLY, and invest in research and development. In addition, as a stand-alone public company, we will incur significant legal, accounting and other expenses that we did not incur as a subsidiary of PDL.

As discussed above, we also expect the ongoing COVID-19 pandemic will negatively affect our capital requirements and the availability of funds to finance those requirements outside of cash provided by PDL.

In May 2017, we entered into a credit agreement with PDL whereby, as of July 2020, we borrowed $32.6 million from PDL at an interest rate of 4% per annum. The credit agreement is included in note payable due to related party on our balance sheets and the aggregate principal balance outstanding as of June 30, 2020 and December 31, 2019 was $30.6 million and $20.2 million, respectively. In July 2020, we entered into a contribution and exchange agreement with PDL, whereby we issued to PDL a total of 2,806,244 shares of our common stock in exchange for the extinguishment of the $32.6 million outstanding, including accrued interest, we owed to PDL under the credit agreement.

We issued 30,000 shares of Series A Preferred Stock to PDL in May 2017. The Series A Preferred Stock has an aggregate liquidation preference of $30.0 million, plus all accrued and unpaid dividends, whether or not declared. Dividends on each share of the Series A Preferred Stock accrued on an annual basis at an initial rate of 15.00% per annum of the liquidation preference, and decreased to 5.00% per annum of the liquidation preference effective January 1, 2019. In July 2020, we also exchanged all 30,000 shares of our Series A Preferred Stock, including any accrued and unpaid dividends thereon, for a total of 3,414,825 shares of our common stock. We currently do not have any shares of Series A Preferred Stock outstanding. See Note 17 to our audited annual financial statements and Note 15 to our unaudited condensed interim financial statements included elsewhere in this information statement for more detail.

In July 2020, we issued an additional 740,740 shares of our common stock to PDL in exchange for $8.0 million.

On August 4, 2020, PDL committed that through August 5, 2021 it will provide financial support to us of up to $20.0 million to fund our operating, financing and investing activities. This obligation was fulfilled on August 24, 2020 in connection with the receipt of a capital contribution of $29.0 million from PDL. We issued 746,767 shares of common stock to PDL in exchange for $8.3 million. The remaining $20.7 million was a cash contribution from PDL.

Historically, PDL, as our parent, has provided us cash management and other treasury services. Following the Spin-Off, PDL will no longer provide such services, and we expect our primary sources of liquidity will be our cash on hand, cash from the sale and lease of our systems and the sale of our consumables, and funds from additional financing activities. As of September 14, 2020, we expect our cash, together with cash generated from the sale of our products, to be sufficient to operate our business for at least the next 12 months.

 

104


Table of Contents

However, if these sources are insufficient to satisfy our liquidity requirements, we may seek additional funds from public and private stock offerings, borrowings under credit facilities or other sources. Such capital may not be available on favorable terms, or at all. Furthermore, if we issue equity securities to raise additional capital, our existing stockholders may experience dilution, and the new equity securities may have rights, preferences and privileges senior to those of our existing stockholders. Debt financing, if available, may involve covenants restricting our operations or our ability to incur additional debt. Any debt financing or additional equity that we raise may contain terms that are not favorable to us or our stockholders. In addition, if we raise additional capital through collaboration, licensing or other similar arrangements, it may be necessary to relinquish valuable rights to our products, potential products or proprietary technologies, or grant licenses on terms that are not favorable to us. If we cannot raise capital on acceptable terms, we may not be able to develop or enhance our products, execute our business plan, take advantage of future opportunities or respond to competitive pressures, changes in our supplier relationships or unanticipated customer requirements. Any of these events could adversely affect our ability to achieve our business and financial goals or to achieve or maintain profitability and could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations. Additionally, the extent and duration of the impact the COVID-19 pandemic may have on our stock price and on those of other companies in our industry is highly uncertain and may make us look less attractive to investors and, as a result, there may be a less active trading market for our common stock, our stock price may be more volatile, and our ability to raise capital could be impaired, which could in the future negatively affect our liquidity and financial position.

We expect our revenue and expenses to increase in connection with our on-going activities, particularly as we continue to execute on our growth strategy, including expansion of our sales and customer support teams. We also expect to incur additional costs as a stand-alone public company. The primary factors determining our cash needs are the funding of operations, which we expect to continue to expand as the business grows, and enhancing our product offerings through the research and development of ALLY, our next-generation laser system. Our future liquidity needs, and ability to address those needs, will largely be determined by the success of our commercial efforts and those of our distributors; the ongoing impact of COVID-19 on our business; the timing, scope and magnitude of our commercial and development activities; and the timing of regulatory clearance of ALLY.

Cash Flows

The following table summarizes, for the periods indicated, selected items in our statements of cash flows (in thousands):

 

     Six Months Ended June 30,      Year Ended December 31,  
     2020      2019      2019      2018  

Net cash used in operating activities

   $ (11,739    $ (3,273    $ (12,589    $ (1,885

Net cash used in investing activities

     (235      (1,735      (2,089      (3,892

Net cash provided by financing activities

     12,074        4,923        15,949        6,955  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net increase (decrease) in cash and restricted cash

   $ 100      $ (85    $ 1,271      $ 1,178  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Operating Activities

Net cash used in operating activities for the six months ended June 30, 2020 was $11.7 million, consisting primarily of a net loss of $8.2 million and an increase in net operating assets of $5.3 million, partially offset by non-cash charges of $1.8 million. The increase in net operating assets was primarily due to purchases of inventory of $6.0 million partially offset by a decrease in account receivable, net of $0.7 million. Non-cash charges consisted of depreciation, amortization, loss on disposal of property and equipment and stock-based compensation.

 

105


Table of Contents

Net cash used in operating activities for the six months ended June 30, 2019 was $3.3 million, consisting primarily of a net loss of $6.4 million, partially offset by a decrease in net operating assets of $0.7 million and non-cash charges of $2.4 million. The decrease in net operating assets was primarily due to changes in current and long-term accrued liabilities. Non-cash charges consisted of depreciation, amortization, and stock-based compensation.

Net cash used in operating activities for 2019 was $12.6 million, consisting primarily of a net loss of $14.7 million and an increase in net operating assets of $2.4 million, partially offset by non-cash charges of $4.4 million. The increase in net operating assets was primarily due to purchases of inventory of $4.8 million offset by accrued liabilities of $1.9 million. Non-cash charges consisted of depreciation, amortization, and stock-based compensation.

Net cash used in operating activities for 2018 was $1.9 million, consisting primarily of a net loss of $12.6 million partially offset by non-cash charges of $4.8 million and a decrease in net operating assets of $5.9 million. The decrease in net operating assets was primarily due to changes in current and long-term accrued liabilities. Non-cash charges consisted of depreciation, amortization, and stock-based compensation.

Investing Activities

Net cash used in investing activities for the six months ended June 30, 2020 was $0.2 million, which consisted of capital expenditures of $0.2 million for property and equipment.

Net cash used in investing activities for the six months ended June 30, 2019 was $1.7 million, which consisted of $1.7 million costs to acquire intangible assets.

Net cash used in investing activities for 2019 was $2.1 million, which consisted of $1.7 million costs to acquire intangible assets and capital expenditures of $0.4 million for property and equipment.

Net cash used in investing activities for 2018 was $3.9 million, which consisted of $2.1 million costs to acquire intangible assets, capital expenditures of $1.2 million for property and equipment, and $0.6 million related to payments of contingent consideration.

Financing Activities

Net cash provided by financing activities for the six months ended June 30, 2020 was $12.1 million, primarily due to the proceeds of $10.4 million from the loan with PDL and a $1.8 million contribution from PDL partially offset by a $0.1 million distribution to PDL.

Net cash provided by financing activities for the six months ended June 30, 2019 was $4.9 million, primarily due to the proceeds of $4.2 million from the loan with PDL and a $1.8 million contribution from PDL partially offset by a $1.1 million payment of contingent consideration.

Net cash provided by financing activities for 2019 was $15.9 million, primarily due to the proceeds of $13.2 million from the loan with PDL and a $3.8 million contribution from PDL, partially offset by a $1.1 million payment of contingent consideration.

Net cash provided by financing activities for 2018 was $7.0 million, primarily due to the proceeds of $3.5 million from the loan with PDL and a $3.8 million contribution from PDL, partially offset by a $0.2 million payment of contingent consideration.

Off Balance Sheet Arrangements

As of December 31, 2019, we did not have any off-balance sheet arrangements, as defined under SEC Regulation S-K Item 303(a)(4)(ii).

 

106


Table of Contents

Contractual Obligations

The following table summarizes our contractual obligations and commercial commitments as of December 31, 2019:

 

     Payments Due by Period  
(in thousands)    Less than 1 year      1-3 years      3-5 years      Thereafter      Total  

Operating leases(1)

   $ 592      $ 353      $ —        $ —        $ 945  

Purchase obligations(2)

     9,600        800        —          —          10,400  

Loan payable to Parent(3)

     —          —          20,200        —          20,200  

Series A Preferred Stock(3)(4)

     —          —          —          49,923        49,923  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total contractual obligations

   $ 10,192      $ 1,153      $ 20,200      $ 49,923      $ 81,468  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1)

Amounts represent the lease for the LENSAR office and manufacturing facility in Orlando, Florida and operating leases for office equipment.

(2)

Consists of a $10.4 million minimum purchase obligation for inventory components for the manufacture and supply of certain components, $1.0 million of which are guaranteed by PDL. LENSAR expects to meet these requirements.

(3)

In July 2020, we entered into a contribution and exchange agreement with PDL, whereby we issued to PDL a total of 2,806,244 shares of our common stock in exchange for the $32.6 million outstanding under the Credit Agreement. We currently do not have any loans outstanding with PDL. In July 2020, we also exchanged all 30,000 shares of our Series A Preferred Stock, including any accrued and unpaid dividends thereon, for a total of 3,414,825 shares of our common stock. We currently do not have any shares of Series A Preferred Stock outstanding.

(4)

Consists of the aggregate liquidation preference of our Series A Preferred Stock of $30 million, plus cumulative dividends accrued and accruing through the redemption date of May 11, 2027.

Some of the amounts included in this table are based on management’s estimates and assumptions about these obligations, including their duration, timing, anticipated actions by third parties and other factors. Because these estimates and assumptions are necessarily subjective, the obligations we will actually pay in future periods may vary from those reflected in the table.

Royalty and Milestone Payments

In connection with the acquisition of certain intellectual property in September 2019, we could be required to make milestone payments in the amount of $2.4 million, which are contingent upon the regulatory approval and commercialization of ALLY. In addition, we acquired certain intellectual property, which if used in the development of ALLY could result in additional royalty payments.

Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk

Our cash is held in deposit demand accounts at a large financial institution in amounts in excess of the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation, or FDIC, insurance coverage limit of $250,000 per depositor, per FDIC-insured bank, per ownership category. Management has reviewed the financial statements of this institution and believe it has sufficient assets and liquidity to conduct its operations in the ordinary course of business with little or no credit risk to us.

Financial instruments that potentially subject us to concentrations of credit risk principally consist of accounts receivable and notes receivable. We limit our credit risk with respect to accounts receivable and notes receivable by performing credit evaluations when deemed necessary, but we do not require collateral to secure amounts owed to us by our customers. We do have the ability to disable the LENSAR Laser System’s ability to operate for lack of payment and, in the case of notes receivable, repossess the LENSAR Laser System if scheduled payments lapse.

Inflationary factors, such as increases in our costs of revenues and operating expenses, may adversely affect our operating results. Although we do not believe inflation has had a material impact on its financial condition,

 

107


Table of Contents

results of operations or cash flows to date, a high rate of inflation in the future may have an adverse effect on its ability to maintain and increase its gross margin or decrease its operating expenses as a percentage of its revenues if its selling prices of its products do not increase as much or more than its increase in costs.

We currently have very infrequent and limited exposure to foreign currency fluctuations and do not engage in any hedging activities as part of our normal course of business.

Critical Accounting Policies and Significant Estimates

The preparation of financial statements and related disclosures in conformity with U.S. Generally Accepted Accounting Principles, or GAAP, and the discussion and analysis of our financial condition and operating results require our management to make judgments, assumptions and estimates that affect the amounts reported in its Financial Statements and accompanying notes. Note 2, Summary of Significant Accounting Policies, to our financial statements included in this information statement describes the significant accounting policies and methods used in the preparation of our financial statements. Management bases its estimates on historical experience and on various other assumptions it believes to be reasonable under the circumstances, the results of which form the basis for making judgments about the carrying values of assets and liabilities. The impact on accounting estimates and judgments on our financial condition and results of operations due to COVID-19 has introduced additional uncertainties. Actual results may differ from these estimates and such differences may be material.

Our significant accounting policies are more fully described and discussed in the notes to our financial statements. We believe that the following accounting policies described below are critical because they are both important to the portrayal of our financial condition and operating results, and they require management to make judgments and estimates about inherently uncertain matters. We evaluate our estimates and assumptions on an ongoing basis.

Product and Service Revenue Recognition

Revenue is recognized from the sale of products and services when we transfer control of such promised products and services. The amount of revenue recognized reflects the consideration we expect to be entitled to receive in exchange for these products and services. A five-step model is utilized to achieve the core principle and includes the following steps: (1) identify the customer contract; (2) identify the contract’s performance obligations; (3) determine the transaction price; (4) allocate the transaction price to the performance obligations; and (5) recognize revenue when the distinct performance obligations are satisfied.

We principally derive our revenue from the sale and lease of the LENSAR Laser System and the sale of other related products and services, including PIDs, procedure licenses, and extended warranty service agreements. A procedure license represents a one-time right to utilize the LENSAR Laser System surgical application in connection with a surgery procedure. Without separately procuring procedure licenses granted by us, either together with the purchase of the LENSAR Laser System or under separate subsequent contracts, the customer does not have the right to use the surgical software application to perform surgical procedures. Typically, returns are not allowed.

Our contracts with customers often include promises to transfer multiple products and services to a customer. Determining whether products and services are considered distinct performance obligations that should be accounted for separately versus together may require significant judgment. Judgment is required to determine the level of interdependency between the LENSAR Laser System and the sale of other related products and services. We evaluate each product or service promised in a contract to determine whether it represents a distinct performance obligation. A performance obligation is distinct if (1) the customer can benefit from the product or service on its own or with other resources that are readily available to the customer and (2) the products or service is separately identifiable from other promises in the contract.

 

108


Table of Contents

For contracts involving the sale or lease of the LENSAR Laser System, our performance obligations generally include the LENSAR Laser System, PID, procedure license, and extended warranty service agreements. In addition, our customer contracts contain provisions for installation and training services, which are not assessed as performance obligations as they are determined to be immaterial promises in the context of the contract and are required for a customer to use the LENSAR Laser System.

We have determined that the LENSAR Laser System, PID and procedure license are each capable of being distinct because they are each sold separately and the customer can benefit from these products with the other readily available resources that are sold by us. In addition, we have determined each are separately identifiable because the LENSAR Laser System, PID and procedure license (1) are not highly interdependent or interrelated; (2) do not modify or customize one another; and (3) we do not provide a significant service of integrating the promised goods into a bundled output. This is because we are able to fulfill each promise in the contract independently of the others. That is, we would be able to fulfill our promise to transfer the LENSAR Laser System even if the customer did not purchase a PID or procedure license and we would be able to fulfill our promise to provide the PID or the procedure license even if the customer acquired the LENSAR Laser System separately.

The extended warranty, unlike our standard product warranty, is a performance obligation because it provides an incremental service that is beyond ensuring the product delivered will be consistent with stated contractual specifications.

When a contract contains multiple performance obligations, revenue is allocated to each performance obligation based on its relative standalone selling price.

We recognize revenue as the performance obligations are satisfied by transferring control of the product or service to a customer as described below. We record a contract liability, or deferred revenue, when we have an obligation to provide a product or service to the customer and payment is received or due in advance of our performance.

Product revenue. We recognize revenue for the sale of the products at a point in time when control is transferred to customers.

Equipment. LENSAR Laser System sales are recognized as Product revenue when the Company transfers control of the system. This usually occurs after the customer signs a contract, we install the system, and we perform the requisite training for use of the system for direct customers. LENSAR Laser System sales to distributors are recognized as revenue upon shipment.

PID and procedure licenses. The LENSAR Laser System requires both a PID and a procedure license to perform each procedure. We recognize Product revenue for PIDs when we transfer control of the PID. We recognize Product revenue for procedure licenses, which represent a one-time right to utilize the LENSAR Laser System surgical software application, at the point in time when control of the procedure license is transferred to the customer. Control transfers at the time a customer receives the license key. For the sale of PIDs and procedure licenses, we may offer volume discounts to certain customers. To determine the amount of revenue that should be recognized at the time control over these products transfers to the customer, we estimate the average per unit price, net of discounts.

Service revenue. We offer an extended warranty that provides additional maintenance services beyond the standard limited warranty. We recognize Service revenue from the sale of extended warranties over the warranty period on a ratable basis. Customers have the option of renewing the warranty period, which is considered a new and separate contract.

 

109


Table of Contents

Lease Revenue

We lease equipment to customers under operating lease arrangements. At contract inception we perform an evaluation to determine if a lease arrangement conveys the right to control the use of an identified asset. To the extent such rights of control are conveyed, we further make an assessment as to the applicable lease classification. The identification of specified assets and determination of appropriate lease classification may require the use of management judgement.

Some of our operating leases include a purchase option for the customer to purchase the leased asset at the end of the lease arrangement, subject to a new contract. We do not believe the purchase price qualifies as a bargain purchase option.

For lease arrangements with lease and non-lease components where we are the lessor, we allocate the contract’s transaction price (including discounts) to the lease and non-lease components on a relative standalone selling price which requires judgments. For those leases with variable lease payments, the variable lease payment is typically based upon use of the leased equipment or the purchase of procedure licenses and PIDs used with the leased equipment.

For operating leases, rental income is recognized on a straight-line basis over the lease term as lease revenue. Depreciation expense associated with the leased equipment under operating lease arrangements is reflected in cost of lease in the statements of operations.

Lessee leases

Lessee operating leases are included in other current liabilities and long-term operating lease liabilities in our balance sheets. We do not have lessee finance leases.

Operating lease ROU assets represent our right to use an underlying asset for the lease term and lease liabilities represent our obligation to make lease payments arising from the lease. Operating lease ROU assets and liabilities are recognized at commencement date based on the present value of lease payments over the lease term. Lease payments are discounted using our incremental borrowing rate as of the commencement date of each lease. Our remaining lease terms may include options to extend or terminate the lease when it is reasonably certain that we will exercise that option. Lease expense for lease payments is recognized on a straight-line basis as operating expense in our statements of operations over the lease term.

Inventory

Inventory, which consists of raw materials, work-in-process and finished goods, is stated at the lower of cost or net realizable value. Inventory levels are analyzed periodically on a first-in, first-out basis and written down to their net realizable value if they have become obsolete, have a cost basis in excess of its expected net realizable value or are in excess of expected requirements. We analyze current and future product demand relative to the remaining product shelf life to identify potential excess inventory. We build demand forecasts by considering factors such as, but not limited to, overall market potential, market share, market acceptance and patient usage.

Intangible Assets

Intangible assets with finite useful lives consist primarily of acquired product rights, acquired technology, and customer relationships. Acquired product rights and acquired technology are amortized on a straight-line basis over their estimated useful lives, over 15 to 20 years. Customer relationships are amortized on a straight-line basis or a double declining basis over their estimated useful lives up to 20 years, based on the method that better represents the economic benefits to be obtained. The estimated useful lives associated with finite-lived intangible assets are consistent with the estimated lives of the associated products and may be modified when circumstances warrant.

 

110


Table of Contents

Such assets are reviewed for impairment when events or circumstances indicate that the carrying value of an asset may not be recoverable. An impairment loss would be recognized when estimated undiscounted future cash flows expected to result from the use of an asset and its eventual disposition are less than its carrying amount. The impairment reviews require significant estimates about fair value, including estimation of future cash flows, selection of an appropriate discount rate, and estimates of long-term growth rates. We have not recorded any impairment to our intangible assets for the six months ended June 30, 2020 and 2019 and the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018.

Stock-based compensation

We have an equity incentive plan under which we grant phantom stock units, or PSUs, to LENSAR directors and employees. PSUs are awards in the form of phantom shares, denominated in a hypothetical equivalent number of shares of LENSAR common stock and with the value of each PSU equal to the fair value of LENSAR common stock at the date of grant.

Stock-based compensation is measured at the grant date based on the fair value of the award and is expensed over the requisite service period. The holders of the phantom stock units have the right to receive cash upon settlement. Awards of phantom stock are accounted for as a liability under ASC Topic 718 and changes in the fair value of the Company’s liability are recognized as compensation cost over the remaining requisite service period. Changes in the fair value of the liability that occur after the requisite service period are recognized as compensation cost during the period in which the changes occur. We remeasure the liability for the outstanding awards at the end of each reporting period and the compensation cost is based on the change for each reporting period. Forfeitures are accounted for as they occur.

Common stock valuation

The estimated fair value of our common stock is determined by our board of directors, with input from management. In the absence of a public trading market for the common stock, we develop an estimate of the fair value of the common stock based on the information known on the reporting date, upon a review of any recent events and their potential impact on the estimated fair value, and valuations from an independent third-party valuation firm.

In determining the fair value of our common stock, as used for purposes of determining the fair value of the PSUs, we establish the enterprise value of our company using generally accepted valuation methodologies including discounted cash flow analysis, comparable public company analysis and comparable acquisitions analysis. We then allocate the equity value among the securities that comprise the capital structure of LENSAR using the Black Scholes Option-Pricing model after deducting the liquidation preference of the Series A Preferred Stock. Under the Option-Pricing model, the common stock is modeled as a call option that gives its owner the right but not the obligation to buy the underlying enterprise value at a predetermined or exercise price. Common stock is considered to be a call option with a claim on the enterprise at an exercise price equal to the remaining value immediately after the preferred stock is liquidated.

The Black-Scholes Option-Pricing model requires the use of highly subjective and complex assumptions which impact the fair value of the common stock, including the option’s expected term and the implied volatility of the underlying stock. Because we have not operated as a stand-alone public company, there is a lack of company-specific historical and implied volatility data, and therefore we have estimated stock price volatility based upon an index of the historical volatilities of a group of comparable publicly-traded medical device peer companies. We have estimated the expected term using our expected time to a liquidity event. We also considered the fact that the stockholders could not freely trade the common stock in the public markets. Accordingly, the estimated fair value reflects a non-marketability discount partially based on the anticipated likelihood and timing of a future liquidity event.

 

111


Table of Contents

The assumptions used in calculating the fair value of stock-based awards represent our best estimates, however the estimates involve inherent uncertainties and judgment and the use of different values could produce materially different results.

Following the completion of the Spin-Off, our board of directors will determine the fair value of our common stock based on its closing price as reported on the date of grant on the primary stock exchange on which our common stock is traded.

Income Taxes

We are subject to U.S. federal, state, and local corporate income taxes at the entity level. Prior to the Spin-Off, our losses were included with PDL’s consolidated U.S. federal and state income tax returns. Income taxes as presented in our financial statements have been prepared on the separate return method as if we were a taxpayer separate from PDL.

The provision for income taxes is determined using the asset and liability approach. Under this method, we recognize deferred tax assets and liabilities for the temporary differences between the financial reporting and tax basis of assets and liabilities. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured using the enacted tax rates that apply to taxable income for the years in which those tax assets and liabilities are expected to be realized or settled. Valuation allowances are recorded to reduce deferred tax assets when it is more likely than not that a tax benefit will not be realized.

We recognize tax benefits from uncertain tax positions only if it is more likely than not that the tax position will be sustained on examination by the taxing authorities, based on the technical merits of the position. The tax benefits recognized in the financial statements from such positions are then measured based on the largest benefit that has a greater than 50% likelihood of being realized upon ultimate settlement. We adjust the level of the liability to reflect any subsequent changes in the relevant facts surrounding the uncertain positions. Any interest and penalties on uncertain tax positions are included within the tax provision.

JOBS Act Accounting Election

Section 107 of the JOBS Act provides that an “emerging growth company” may take advantage of the extended transition period provided in Section 7(a)(2)(B) of the Securities Act for complying with new or revised accounting standards. Therefore, an emerging growth company can delay the adoption of certain accounting standards until those standards would otherwise apply to private companies. We have elected to use this extended transition period for complying with new or revised accounting standards that have different effective dates for public and private companies until the earlier of the date we (i) are no longer an emerging growth company or (ii) affirmatively and irrevocably opt out of the extended transition period provided in the JOBS Act. As a result, our financial statements may not be comparable to companies that comply with new or revised accounting pronouncements as of public company effective dates.

We intend to rely on other exemptions provided by the JOBS Act, including without limitation, not being required to comply with the auditor attestation requirements of Section 404(b) of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act.

We will remain an emerging growth company until the earliest to occur of: (1) the last day of our first fiscal year in which we have total annual revenues of more than $1.07 billion; (2) the date we qualify as a “large accelerated filer,” with at least $700.0 million of equity securities held by non-affiliates; (3) the date on which we have issued more than $1.0 billion in non-convertible debt securities during the prior three-year period; and (4) the last day of the fiscal year ending after the fifth anniversary of our initial public offering.

Recently Issued Accounting Standards

See Note 2, Summary of Significant Accounting Policies, to our audited financial statements and the unaudited condensed interim financial statements included in this information statement for a discussion of recently adopted accounting pronouncements and recently issued accounting pronouncements not yet adopted as of December 31, 2019 and June 30, 2020, respectively.

 

112


Table of Contents

BUSINESS

Overview

We are a commercial-stage medical device company focused on designing, developing and marketing an advanced femtosecond laser system for the treatment of cataracts and the management of pre-existing or surgically induced corneal astigmatism. Our LENSAR Laser System incorporates a range of proprietary technologies designed to assist the surgeon in obtaining better visual outcomes, efficiency and reproducibility by providing advanced imaging, simplified procedure planning, efficient design and precision. We believe the cumulative effect of these technologies results in a laser system that can be quickly and efficiently integrated into a surgeon’s existing practice, is easy to use and provides surgeons the ability to deliver improved visual outcomes. Surgeons have used our laser system to perform more than 430,000 cataract procedures, including 108,030 during the year ended December 31, 2019 and 41,490 during the six months ended June 30, 2020. As we continue to innovate, we are designing a next-generation, integrated workstation, ALLY, which combines an enhanced femtosecond laser with a phacoemulsification system in a compact, mobile workstation that is designed to allow surgeons to perform a femtosecond laser assisted cataract procedure in a single operating room using a single device. We expect this combination product could be a considerable advancement and will provide significant administrative and financial benefit to a surgeon’s practice at a cost less than the cost of our current system. We anticipate submitting an application for 510(k) clearance of ALLY to the U.S. Food and Drug Administration, or FDA, by the end of the first quarter of 2022 and to begin commercialization of ALLY in 2022.

A cataract occurs when the normally clear lens of the eye becomes cloudy or opaque, causing a decrease in vision. The majority of patients suffering from cataracts also present with visually significant astigmatism, which is an imperfection in the symmetry of the cornea that results in decreased visual acuity. In 2019, Market Scope estimated that approximately 70% to 90% of cataract patients present with addressable astigmatism prior to cataract surgery. Currently, the only way to treat cataracts is to surgically remove the natural lens of the eye. The principal steps in the procedure include a corneal incision, called an anterior capsulotomy; cataract phacoemulsification including the fragmentation, aspiration and removal of the cataract; and implantation of an artificial intraocular lens, or IOL. IOLs contain corrective power to replace the optical power of the natural lens. A variety of IOLs exist, including a standard monofocal IOL, or premium IOLs, such as multifocal, accommodating or toric IOLs.

Traditional cataract surgeries are performed by a surgeon using a metal or diamond blade to perform the anterior capsulotomy to enter the eye, and a bent needle to perform the anterior capsulotomy to provide the surgeon access to the nucleus of the cataract for fragmentation and subsequent removal. More recently, laser systems have been developed to assist surgeons in performing or facilitating these aspects of the cataract procedure, including assessing and fragmenting the cataract. In either case, cataract fragmentation and removal is achieved using a process called phacoemulsification. Currently, Medicare and most commercial third-party payors only cover the cost of traditional cataract surgery and the placement of a monofocal IOL, which may not produce the targeted visual outcome. To achieve their targeted visual outcome, patients may elect to have an advanced procedure that involves use of a laser system and implantation of a premium IOL, in which case the patient is responsible for the cost differential between the amount reimbursed by a third-party payor and the cost of the advanced procedure. However, based on management’s calculations derived from the 2019 Cataract Surgical Equipment Report, even when patients pay for and receive an advanced procedure that involves implantation of a premium IOL, approximately 43% still do not achieve the targeted visual outcome, typically characterized as a result within 0.5 diopters.

We believe the inability to achieve the targeted visual outcome is largely due to a failure to appropriately address corneal astigmatism even when using competing laser systems. We believe this lack of precision can be attributed to several limitations of competing laser devices, including imaging systems that require manual inputs, inaccuracies that result from reliance on manually transposing data and marking the eye for treatment, and

 

113


Table of Contents

the inability to use iris registration to integrate with preoperative devices. These devices also lack a cataract density imaging system, which allows the surgeon to customize the fragmentation and energy settings based on each individual patient’s cataract.

We developed our LENSAR Laser System to provide an alternative laser cataract treatment tool that allows the surgeon to better address astigmatism and improve visual outcomes. Our system incorporates a range of proprietary technology features that are designed to provide surgeons the following key benefits:

 

   

Advanced imaging. Our Augmented Reality imaging and processing technology collects a broad spectrum of biometric data and then reconstructs and presents a precise, three-dimensional model of each individual patient’s eye that is used to develop and implement the surgeon’s procedure plan.

 

   

Simplified procedures. Our system is designed to automate and perform various critical steps in the cataract procedure with the goal of providing surgeons with the confidence to perform these advanced procedures that include implantation of a premium IOL. For example, our IntelliAxis IV technology allows for the precise placement of arcuate corneal incisions, as well as the proprietary refractive capsulorhexis that creates tabs on the exact axis of astigmatism 180 degrees apart to help produce proper toric IOL placement. These tabs can even be visualized by the surgeon postoperatively to help further ensure proper placement without rotation, which can diminish the effectiveness of the toric IOL.

 

   

Efficient design. We designed the ergonomics of the system and its wireless capabilities to enable the system to integrate seamlessly into a surgeon’s existing surgical environment.

 

   

Precision and reproducibility. The system has multiple features specifically designed to enable precise placement and centration of the IOL in patients in a consistent and reproducible manner that is not possible in manual cataract surgery or using competing laser systems.

We believe the cumulative effect of these technologies is an advanced laser system that can be quickly integrated into a surgeon’s existing practice, is easy to use and provides surgeons the ability to deliver improved outcomes when addressing astigmatism in connection with cataract removal. In the Arcuate Keratotomy Study, of 189 eyes that underwent arcuate keratotomy with our laser system, 95.8% demonstrated post-operative refractive astigmatism of 0.5 diopters or less and 90% of eyes had a post-operative uncorrected distance visual acuity, or UDVA, of 20/30 or better.

We are focused on continuous innovation and are currently developing our proprietary, next-generation, integrated workstation, ALLY. ALLY is designed to combine our existing femtosecond laser technology with enhanced capabilities and a phacoemulsification system into a single unit and allow surgeons to perform a femtosecond laser assisted cataract procedure in a single operating room using this device. We anticipate submitting an application for 510(k) clearance to the FDA by the end of the first quarter of 2022 and to begin commercialization of ALLY in 2022. If ALLY is cleared by the FDA, we believe its lower operating costs and combined functions will help drive broader penetration for us into the overall cataract surgery market and could create a paradigm shift in the treatment of cataracts and management of astigmatism in cataract surgery.

We have built and are continuing to grow our commercial organization, which includes a direct sales force in the United States and distributors in Germany, China, South Korea and other targeted international geographies. We believe there is significant opportunity for us to expand our presence in these countries and other markets and regions. In the United States, we sell our products through a direct sales organization that, as of December 31, 2019, consisted of 30 commercial team professionals, including regional sales managers, clinical applications and outcomes specialists, field service, technology and customer support personnel.

 

114


Table of Contents

We have experienced considerable growth since we began commercializing our products in the United States in 2012. Our revenue increased from $24.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2018 to $30.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2019, representing annual revenue growth of 25%. Our revenue for the six months ended June 30, 2020 was $11.0 million, compared to revenue of $14.0 million for the six months ended June 30, 2019 representing a decline of 22%, primarily on account of the impact of COVID-19. Our net losses were $8.2 million, $12.6 million and $14.7 million for the six months ended June 30, 2020 and the years ended December 31, 2018 and December 31, 2019, respectively. Additionally, our installed base of LENSAR Laser Systems has increased from 207 as of December 31, 2019 to 211 as of June 30, 2020.

Our Strengths

We attribute our current and anticipated future success to the following factors:

 

   

Established large and growing market for cataract surgery. According to the 2019 Cataract Surgical Equipment Market Report, an estimated 29 million cataract/refractive lens surgical procedures were performed globally in 2019, with 4.3 million performed in the United States. We believe that growth in the cataract market generally will continue to be driven by an aging population. Moreover, as IOL technology and advanced laser techniques demonstrate improved vision correction, we expect to see a greater portion of cataract surgeries transition to these advanced refractive cataract procedures. According to the 2019 Premium Cataract Surgery Market Report, global cataract surgeries are projected to grow at a 3.1% compound annual growth rate, or CAGR, from 2019 to 2024, while the CAGR of advanced refractive cataract surgical procedures for the same period is projected to be 7.7%.

 

   

Disruptive technology platform providing improved visual outcomes. Our LENSAR Laser System was built specifically for laser refractive cataract surgery. Central to our LENSAR Laser System is our Augmented Reality technology, which begins by using scheimpflug imaging to scan the anterior segment of the eye, collecting a broad spectrum of biometric data. The system then uses a process called wave-tracing to take a series of two dimensional images derived from the imaging and scanning and, through precision processing of this biometric data, reconstruct a three-dimensional model of each individual patient’s eye. Using this model, surgeons can identify relevant anatomy and specific measurements within the eye, enabling them to plan and precisely place the laser pulses necessary to accomplish the desired treatment. Data presented in 2019 at the American Society of Cataract and Refractive Surgery, or ASCRS, demonstrated that 93% of patients receiving a toric IOL using the LENSAR Laser System achieved refractive correction within 0.5 diopter of the targeted outcome. In addition to improving visual outcomes, our system is designed to improve the efficiency and simplify the procedure for surgeons by including pre-programmable surgeon preferences, wireless integration with pre-operative diagnostic data, cataract density imaging, and accurate laser incision planning. We believe these features enable surgeons an unprecedented reproducibility and ability to optimize their treatments to achieve LASIK-like vision correction while also improving overall efficiency for the surgeon’s practice.

 

   

Demonstrated and growing commercial success. We believe our disruptive technology platform has enabled LENSAR to rapidly take market share in a highly competitive market. Based on the 2019 Cataract Surgical Equipment Market Report, it was estimated that we would achieve 13% worldwide market share in femtosecond laser assisted cataract surgery in 2019. Additionally, when looking at the average procedures per installed device, each of our LENSAR Laser Systems averaged 522 procedures in 2019 compared to the estimated industry average of 285 procedures per year per installed device, based on a 2019 Cataract Surgical Equipment Market Report. Since commercial launch, we have continued to grow our annual number of procedures and revenue, with procedures increasing most recently from 63,175 in 2017 to 108,030 in 2019, representing a CAGR of 30.8%, and revenue increasing from $20.6 million in 2017 to $30.5 million in 2019, representing a CAGR of 21.6%. We believe that our improved patient outcomes, along with increased surgeon efficiencies

 

115


Table of Contents
 

and growing commercial presence, will enable us to continue to drive our commercial success. The following chart shows the number of procedures performed per year from 2015 to 2019:

LENSAR Procedures per Year

LOGO

Source: Management.

 

   

Improved visual outcomes that drive more advanced, patient-pay procedures. Standard cataract procedures are generally covered by Medicare and other third-party payors, including commercial health plans. However, based on management’s calculations derived from the 2019 Cataract Surgical Equipment Report, approximately 43% of patients receiving a standard cataract procedure fail to achieve their targeted visual outcome and must rely on glasses for distance or near vision or to correct visually significant astigmatism. Moreover, surgeon reimbursement for these standard procedures continues to decline. More advanced procedures, such as laser-assisted cataract surgery and the use of toric and multifocal premium IOLs, can address these additional vison challenges but are generally not covered by Medicare or other third-party payors. Accordingly, patients are required to pay the additional cost associated with the use of these advanced technologies in the physicians’ practice. Historically, some patients may have been reluctant to incur the additional cost of a more advanced procedure that includes implantation of a premium IOL, and some surgeons may have been reluctant to recommend these procedures, because of concerns that the targeted visual outcome might not be achieved. We believe the clinical data supporting the effectiveness of our laser system in assisting surgeons to achieve desired outcomes will motivate additional patients to seek, and additional surgeons to offer, these more advanced procedures that include implantation of a premium IOL.

 

   

Focus on innovation to facilitate surgeon adoption. Our current Streamline IV laser system encompasses improved innovations such as wireless capability, advanced imaging, iris registration, and other features to improve its effectiveness and enhance efficiency. We are currently focused on developing a proprietary, next-generation, integrated workstation, known as ALLY, that is intended to further enhance the capabilities of our current femtosecond laser technology and combine it with an advanced phacoemulsification system. We are designing this compact, integrated workstation to operate anywhere in an operating room or in-office surgical suite and allow the surgeon to switch seamlessly and quickly between femtosecond laser and phacoemulsification without moving machines or patients. We believe this significant improvement in patient flow and efficiency will allow surgeons to offer this technology and its benefits to a broader base of patients. Moreover, by combining a

 

116


Table of Contents
 

femtosecond laser and phacoemulsification into a single system, we believe we can educate surgeons who currently rely solely on phacoemulsification on the benefits of adopting and integrating laser-assisted procedures into their practice.

 

   

Innovative intellectual property protected by a comprehensive patent portfolio. As of June 16, 2020, we owned approximately 98 issued patents and 56 pending patent applications globally. This portfolio covers key aspects of our technology, including the augmented reality imaging and processing, iris registration and patient interface features of our system. We have also licensed or acquired patent rights relating to our next-generation, integrated workstation. With regard to our next generation dual function system development project, we have licensed or acquired significant patent rights. For example, we have exclusively licensed two issued U.S. patents, four pending U.S. applications, one international patent application and one foreign patent application. In addition, we have acquired through assignment one issued U.S. patent, one pending U.S. application which has received a Notice of Allowance, three pending U.S. patent applications and five foreign patent applications.

 

   

Proven management team and board of directors. Our senior management team and board of directors consists of seasoned medical device professionals with deep industry experience. Our team has successfully led and managed dynamic growth phases in organizations and commercialized several products specifically in the cataract and refractive surgery field. Members of our team have worked with well-regarded, ophthalmology-focused medical technology companies such as Chiron Corporation, Alcon Inc., Advanced Medical Optics, Inc., Bausch + Lomb and STAAR Surgical.

While we believe these factors will contribute to further growth and success, we cannot assure you that the market for cataract surgery will continue to grow as we anticipate or that new disruptive technologies will not be introduced to displace our laser systems. Moreover, we must maintain and grow market acceptance for our laser system and convince physicians and patients that the out of pocket costs associated with procedures that use our laser systems will produce their targeted results. If we are unable to accomplish those goals, our business could suffer.

Market Overview

Current Cataract Treatment Alternatives

A cataract occurs when the normally clear lens of the eye becomes cloudy or opaque, causing a decrease in vision. The natural lens of the eye focuses light onto the back of the eye, or the retina. The clouding of this lens caused by a cataract can cause blurring and distortion of vision, colors that seem faded, glare or halos from lights at night, diminished vision and double vision. Cataracts typically affect both eyes, but it is not uncommon for a cataract in one eye to advance more rapidly. In most cases, the cataract is a naturally occurring process that is age-related, although it can also be caused by heredity, an injury to the eye or after surgery for another eye problem, such as glaucoma.

The majority of patients suffering from cataracts also present with visually significant astigmatism. Astigmatism is an imperfection in the symmetry of the cornea, creating a different, additional focal plane in a specific axis within the cornea. This causes a distortion of the light as it converges on the retina and causes blurry vision. In a Market Scope review of 6,000 patients in 2019, approximately 70% to 90% of patients had astigmatism prior to cataract surgery that was visually significant. To reduce the need for prescription distance or reading glasses following cataract surgery, it is important that little or no astigmatism remain. Conventionally, residual post-operative astigmatism has been targeted at less than or equal to 0.5 diopters, the unit measure of the refractive power of a lens. Surgeons may attempt to address low to moderate magnitudes of astigmatism using a procedure called limbal relaxing incisions, or LRI. LRI is performed by making two small incisions on the cornea, usually 180 degrees apart that are intended to return the cornea to a rounder, symmetrical shape. LRIs that are performed with a laser are referred to as arcuate corneal incisions, or AIs. More recently, and where the magnitude of astigmatism is higher, toric IOLs might be used to both correct the patient’s near or far vision and address any pre-existing astigmatism.

 

117


Table of Contents

Currently, the only way to treat cataracts is to surgically remove the natural lens of the eye. The standard cataract surgical procedure is typically performed in a hospital or in an outpatient ambulatory surgery center, or ASC. The patient receives drops topically, or an injection to numb the eye during the procedure and is usually released from the facility on the same day. The principal steps in the procedure include a corneal incision called an anterior capsulotomy, cataract fragmentation and removal of the cataract, and implantation of an IOL. IOLs contain corrective power to replace the optical power from the natural lens, and can also be used to correct the pre-existing visual errors in the natural lens removed in cataract surgery. Without an IOL, patients would need very thick eyeglasses or special contact lenses to see at all after cataract surgery. A variety of IOLs with different features exist. Some of the basic types include:

 

   

Monofocal IOLs. This type of lens has a single focus strength primarily used for distance vision. Most patients receiving this type of lens will typically require the use of reading glasses for near vision. More contemporary uses of these lenses are to correct one eye for distance and use a different power to correct one eye for reading. This is referred to as monovision and is not suitable for a large part of the population due to many patients being unable to adapt to the vision imbalance.

 

   

Accommodating IOLs. Similar to monofocal IOLs, these lenses have a single focus strength; however, they are designed to respond to eye muscle movements and shift focus from near to far. There are accommodating IOLs in development that have an optical fluid or multi-piece designs that are designed to move and shift focus but work on different principles.

 

   

Extended depth-of-focus or Multifocal IOLs. These IOLs are similar to glasses with bifocal or progressive trifocal lenses. Different areas of the lens have different focusing strengths that allow for near, far and medium vision.

 

   

Astigmatism correction, or toric IOLs. Toric IOLs are designed to correct astigmatism, as well as near or far vision. Some IOL technology may blend these features and include the toric or astigmatism-correcting aspect with the multi-focality or accommodating.

Traditional cataract surgeries are performed by a surgeon using a metal or diamond blade to create the incision necessary to perform the procedure. More recently, special laser systems have been developed to assist surgeons in performing or facilitating the various aspects of the cataract procedures.

Traditional Cataract Surgery. In a traditional cataract surgery, the surgeon performs the corneal incision by hand using a disposable metal- or reusable diamond-tipped scalpel. This incision allows the surgeon to gain access to the interior of the eye. Next, the surgeon performs an anterior capsulotomy, which involves removing the front membrane portion of the lens capsule that surrounds the natural crystalline lens. This is accomplished by inserting a small bent needle through the corneal incision and into the capsule where the surgeon will tear the membrane to create a round opening in the capsule. After the capsulotomy, the surgeon has access to the nucleus of the cataract to remove it. The surgeon then inserts a pen-shaped probe into the capsule. The probe applies ultrasonic sound waves to break up the cloudy lens and then suctions out the pieces. This process is referred to as phacoemulsification. After the surgeon has aspirated all of the remaining fragments and nuclear debris of the lens, the surgeon will replace the lens with an IOL and close the incision. Once the incision is closed, the surgeon may perform an LRI to address any identified astigmatism. The incision usually will self-seal or the surgeon injects a balanced salt solution to assist in sealing the cataract incision. Sutures are typically not needed.

Laser-Assisted Cataract Surgery. Laser-assisted cataract surgery involves the same steps as traditional surgery but uses advanced imaging techniques to design a precise surgical plan and a femtosecond laser, the same type of laser engine used to cut the flaps in LASIK corrective procedures, to make the AIs and perform the capsulotomy. The intent is to create an incision with a specific location, depth and length that can be performed exactly without the variable of surgeon experience. The laser can also be used to soften and fragment the nucleus of the cataract before phacoemulsification, which can reduce the amount of phacoemulsification energy required to break up and remove the cataract and reduce the chance of certain complications. After phacoemulsification, the surgeon replaces the natural lens with an IOL and the incision is closed without the need for suture.

 

118


Table of Contents

The Transition to Advanced Refractive Cataract Procedures

Currently, Medicare and most commercial third-party payors only cover the cost of treating the medical condition of the cataract, which can be accomplished with traditional cataract surgery and the placement of a monofocal IOL. Standard or traditional cataract surgery does not specifically address the outcomes associated with astigmatism and presbyopia, which may be addressed in an advanced refractive procedure involving laser-assisted cataract removal and implantation of a premium IOL. However, since the advantages of these advanced refractive cataract procedures are not deemed medically necessary, patients seeking either or both of these alternatives must pay the difference between the reimbursed amount and the cost of the advanced procedure that includes implantation of a premium IOL.

We believe that these advanced procedures that include implantation of a premium IOL offer physicians and patients additional benefits and improved outcomes that justify the additional cost. For example, some of the benefits of laser-assisted cataract surgery include:

 

   

Improved accuracy. Most laser systems cleared for the treatment of cataracts contain imaging tools that assist the surgeon in modeling the eye and developing a surgical plan for the procedure, including the precise placement and location of the capsulorhexis and identifying the axis of astigmatism in each patient. After the surgeon has developed and chosen the plan to proceed, the system itself can make the appropriate capsulotomy, including the incisions prescribed in the plan, without reliance on the surgeon’s manual capabilities to size, shape and locate the capsulorhexis, and appropriately place the AIs to minimize any further inducement of astigmatism. This is intended to optimize reproducibility and precision in the optimal placement of the capsulorhexis or location of the AIs, customized to each patient and IOL selection.

 

   

Reproducibility. Studies have shown that laser capsulotomies are consistently more round and more precise in sizing to enable better centering and capsulorhexis overlap of the IOL and that IOL positioning is an important factor in determining visual outcomes minimizing the variances associated with manual techniques.

 

   

Reduced complications and quicker visual recovery. By using a laser to soften and fragment the cataract before phacoemulsification, less phacoemulsification energy is required to emulsify and remove the cataract. This may make the procedure safer to the inner eye and reduce the chance of complications, such as cystoid macular edema, or swelling of the eye. Use of the laser also creates less endothelial cell loss than phacoemulsification alone, contributing to clearer corneas and quicker visual recovery after surgery.

Typically, patients undergoing an advanced refractive cataract procedure are paying a significant portion of the cost of the surgery out of pocket. As a result, they have heightened expectations for their visual outcomes, normally targeting vision correction within 0.5 diopters of their predicted refractive outcome, sometimes referred to as best uncorrected visual acuity. However, based on management’s calculations derived from the 2019 Cataract Surgical Equipment Report, even when patients pay for and receive an advanced procedure that involves implantation of a premium IOL, approximately 43% still do not achieve the targeted visual outcome, typically characterized as a result within 0.5 diopters. We believe this is largely attributable to an inability to appropriately address and manage the correction of the patient’s pre-existing astigmatism. This astigmatism is frequently not even being addressed in the preoperative surgical planning and even more frequently is not part of the treatment. In many cases, we believe the failure to manage the astigmatism in such a large percentage of patients is due to the lack of useful technology in surgery. For example, research indicates that for each 1 degree that a toric IOL is off-axis, its ability to reduce astigmatism is decreased by approximately 3.3%. To that end, very small errors in the measurements, calculations and treatments used in the cataract procedure can significantly decrease its effectiveness in achieving the targeted visual outcome. We believe this lack of precision can be attributed to one or more of the following limitations of procedures performed with competing laser systems:

 

   

Imaging that requires manual inputs. Prior to performing a cataract surgery with most existing laser systems, the surgeon must manually identify and locate the pupil and anterior capsule in order to place

 

119


Table of Contents
 

the cursors necessary to perform the capsulotomy. The result is more likely to be a capsulotomy that likely is marginally better than a manual surgery by being more concentric and round, but still reduces the accuracy and reproducibility of the laser to provide useful treatment for a surgeon. In addition, several competing laser systems do not measure automatically for lens tilt and adjust the laser treatment accordingly when fragmenting the natural lens.

 

   

Inaccuracies that appear when managing astigmatism. Once the surgeon performs the appropriate calculations to determine the surgical plan, he or she will mark the eye with an ink marker to identify the proper steep axis of astigmatism used to accurately align the toric, trifocal or toric multifocal IOL. The reliability of these manual marks can be impacted by events as minor as manually transposing data from the office to the surgical record, the thickness of the marker or bleeding of the ink used when mixed with fluids. The accuracy is also impacted by the natural rotation of the patient’s eye when they move from the seated position when the measurements are taken, to a supine position for surgery. This rotation varies per patient, and the manual marking to orient the eye has to be started when the patient is seated and requires other markers before the ink marker. This can increase the cumulative effect of “stackable error,” contributing to a lack of precision in aligning the IOL.

 

   

Inability to integrate with preoperative devices to guide surgical treatment. Surgeons use a variety of different devices such as corneal topographers and imaging to obtain the preoperative measurements and data needed to develop the treatment plan. Many competing laser systems are unable to integrate with many of these devices, leaving surgeons to manually input, set up, and develop the laser treatment plan.

 

   

Deficient cataract density imaging system. Cataracts come in varying densities and lens compositions. These can range from soft, which are more easily removed with less energy, to very hard, which require much more energy, care and time during the phacoemulsification procedure. Many competing laser systems’ imaging does not provide useful data and cataract grading systems designed to assist the surgeon in choosing the optimal tissue specific treatments utilizing only the energies and fragmentation necessary to reduce the amount of phacoemulsification required, contributing to less cell loss and quicker visual recoveries.

As a result, we believe a significant opportunity exists for a laser system that can improve surgeon precision and assist in achieving targeted visual outcomes in patients with astigmatism.

Market Opportunity

The global market for the treatment of cataracts is characterized by large patient populations with increases driven by the aging population and the availability of new technologies, such as laser-assisted systems and an influx of new, innovative IOLs, which can improve visual outcomes post-operatively. Cataract surgery is one of the highest volume surgical procedures in the world, and according to the American Academy of Ophthalmology, the most common procedure performed by the ophthalmic surgeon. According to the 2019 Cataract Surgical Equipment Market Report, global estimated cataract/refractive lens exchange surgical procedures are expected to grow from 29 million in 2019 to 34 million in 2024. In the United States, cataract surgery is expected to increase from almost 4.3 million procedures in 2019 to approximately 4.9 million in 2023. By contrast, worldwide laser-assisted cataract surgery is expected to grow from an estimated 815,000 procedures in 2019 to an estimated one million procedures in 2024. In 2019, Market Scope estimated that approximately 70% to 90% of cataract patients present with a treatable astigmatism prior to cataract surgery.

Care for cataract patients in the United States is administered by many of the approximately 20,000 ophthalmologists who diagnose the disease and provide medical management according to Market Scope. There are approximately 8,400 ophthalmic surgeons in the United States focused on performing cataract procedures.

 

120


Table of Contents

Our Solution

We developed our LENSAR Laser System to provide an alternative laser cataract treatment that allows the surgeon to better address astigmatism and improve visual outcomes.

Benefits of the LENSAR Laser System

Our system incorporates a range of proprietary technology features that are designed to provide surgeons the following key benefits:

 

   

Advanced imaging. Our proprietary Augmented Reality imaging and processing technology collects a broad spectrum of biometric data while taking a series of scans from multiple positions and different angles to capture the radius of corneal curvature, corneal thickness, anterior chamber depth, anterior and posterior lens apex and lens thickness, as well as various anterior segment measurements and location. Once collected, the system takes these two dimensional images and reconstructs them into a precise, three-dimensional model of each individual patient’s eye that is then used to develop and implement the surgeon’s procedure plan.

 

   

Simplified procedures. Our system is designed to automate and perform various critical steps in the cataract procedure with the goal of providing surgeons with the confidence to perform advanced refractive procedures. For example, using patient-specific biometric data, the system is designed to provide the surgeon a concise view and choice of treatment parameters and algorithms based on cumulative treatment data or surgeon selectable preferences. Additionally, the system’s technology, including cataract density imaging, has the ability to detect and compensate for lens tilt, and to identify and treat tissue specific densities in the patients’ natural lens. These capabilities combine to enable the system to provide precise laser delivery; to produce easy to remove, free-floating capsulotomies; and to perform efficient lens fragmentation, while reducing the laser and phacoemulsification energy required to remove the cataract. The IntelliAxis IV technology allows for the precise placement of arcuate corneal incisions, as well as the proprietary refractive capsulorhexis that creates tabs on the exact axis of astigmatism 180 degrees apart to help produce proper toric IOL placement. These tabs can also be visualized by the surgeon postoperatively to help further ensure proper placement without rotation, which can diminish the effectiveness of the toric IOL. With these automated features, we believe surgeons can feel confident their treatment and execution will lead to better and more predictable outcomes

 

   

Efficient design. We designed the ergonomics of the system to integrate seamlessly into a surgeon’s existing surgical environment and to enable preferred patient positioning during treatment. In addition, the system has wireless capabilities that allow it to collect and transmit data quickly between itself and multiple pre-operative diagnostic devices, such as corneal topographers, for the surgeons use while examining their patients in the office. The system uses this data, together with proprietary measurement and imaging technology, called iris registration, to automatically adjust to compensate for rotation of the eye and to place the AIs and capsulotomy in the desired locations, based on pre-programmable surgeon preferences. We believe this significantly improves the accuracy of the incisions, as the surgeon does not need to manually calculate and transpose data or manually mark the eye prior to treatment, and reduces treatment times. The system also includes expanded remote diagnostics that allows us to view and check various software and hardware performance metrics, which helps us increase system reliability and encourages surgeon confidence.

 

   

Precision and reproducibility. The system has multiple features specifically designed to enhance a surgeon’s operating precision. The cloud-based or thumb-drive communication with pre-operative diagnostics, use of iris registration, and integrated surgeon’s tables enhance procedure planning and treatments by storing surgeon specific treatment algorithms and eliminating the need to manually mark the eye with an ink pen. Additionally, our system has automated surface identification and utilizes Augmented Reality and wave tracing capability to accurately and efficiently provide the choice to the

 

121


Table of Contents
 

surgeon to automatically center the capsulotomy on the pupil center or the patient’s optical axis. This is designed to result in precise placement and centration of the IOL in patients in a consistent and reproducible manner that is not possible in manual cataract surgery or using competing laser systems.

Despite these benefits, many surgeons continue to rely on traditional cataract surgery procedures for a variety of reasons, including comfort with the process and the established reimbursement. Moreover, the use of our laser system requires a capital investment by the surgeon that may not be needed for traditional cataract surgery. In order to maintain and grow our market share, we must establish the ability to deliver improved visual outcomes relative to traditional cataract surgery and provide economic data that demonstrate the safety, efficacy and cost-effectiveness of our laser systems. We will also need to convince surgeons of the ease of use, reliability, precision and reproducibility afforded by our laser systems.

Improved Outcomes

We believe the cumulative effect of these technologies is an advanced laser system that can be quickly integrated into a surgeon’s existing practice, is easy to use and provides surgeons the ability to deliver improved outcomes when addressing astigmatism in connection with cataract removal. Several recent studies support the ability to achieve targeted visual outcomes using our laser system. Key findings in these studies include:

 

   

In a retrospective study presented at the 2019 Annual ASCRS Meeting, of 60 eyes that underwent treatment with our laser system, we observed a reduction in mean corneal astigmatism from a mean of 2.11 diopters preoperatively to a mean of 0.15 diopters postoperatively, and 98% of eyes achieved postoperative astigmatism of 0.5 diopters or less.

 

   

In a retrospective study presented at the AAO 2019 Meeting, of 54 eyes that underwent treatment with our laser system, we observed a reduction in mean corneal astigmatism from a mean of 1.01 diopters preoperatively to a mean of 0.11 diopters postoperatively, and 95% of eyes achieved postoperative astigmatism of 0.5 diopters or less.

 

   

In another retrospective study presented at the AAO 2019 Meeting, of 115 eyes that underwent treatment with our laser system and implantation of a toric IOL, we observed a reduction in mean corneal astigmatism from 1.55 diopters preoperatively to 0.47 diopters postoperatively.

 

   

In the Arcuate Keratotomy Study of 189 eyes that underwent arcuate keratotomy with our laser system, 95.8% demonstrated post-operative refractive astigmatism of 0.5 diopters or less and 90% of eyes had a post-operative uncorrected distance visual acuity, or UDVA, of 20/30 or better.

Our Next-Generation, Integrated Workstation—ALLY

We are designing our second generation system, ALLY, to dramatically advance the ability of surgeons to perform advanced refractive cataract procedures and improve visual outcomes by combining an enhanced version of our laser technology with a phacoemulsification system in a single, compact, mobile workstation. We anticipate submitting an application for 510(k) clearance of ALLY to the FDA by the end of the first quarter of 2022 and beginning commercialization of ALLY in 2022.

Currently, almost all cataract procedures, whether manual or laser-assisted, involve the use of a phacoemulsification system to fracture and remove the cataract. For surgeons that also use a laser-assisted system, the laser system is stationed in a separate room from the phacoemulsification system, as the size of most operating rooms will not accommodate placement of all the other necessary equipment and these two critical pieces of equipment operating independently. This configuration results in significant interruption in the patient flow, by requiring the patient to be moved from one room to the next during the course of the procedure.

We are designing ALLY to seamlessly integrate an enhanced version of our femtosecond laser technology and an advanced phacoemulsification system into one unit that can allow the surgeon to switch seamlessly and

 

122


Table of Contents

quickly between femtosecond laser and phacoemulsification without movement of machines or patients. Importantly, this compact, integrated workstation will be configured with the ergonomics to be used in an operating room or an in-office surgical suite, a trend in current ophthalmology practices. The footprint is significantly smaller than current laser systems and only slightly larger than stand-alone phacoemulsification systems. The additional enhancements to our existing laser technology that we intend to incorporate into ALLY include, a more versatile laser that uses pulse characteristics designed for tissue specific targeting with significantly faster speeds in different applications. We expect this combination product could be a considerable advancement and will provide significant administrative and financial benefit to a surgeon’s practice at a cost less than the cost of our current system.

We believe several converging marketplace factors will encourage adoption of ALLY, if cleared by the FDA. These include:

 

   

the advent of many new types of advanced IOLs with complex optics, developed to correct near and distance vision with astigmatism, and the ability of ALLY to assist surgeons in optimizing the accurate positioning using any of these lenses to correct astigmatism for better visual outcomes;

 

   

the recent 15% reduction in surgeon reimbursement and continued pressure to lower reimbursement in standard cataract surgery cases coupled with the ability to provide better patient visual outcomes, which we believe will motivate surgeons and patients to seek refractive outcome-based patient-pay procedures;

 

   

the availability of a compact, dual function system with a lower cost of goods that can be placed in the operating room, which we believe will encourage surgeons that currently rely solely on phacoemulsification to adopt and integrate laser-assisted procedures into their practice;

 

   

given the recent COVID-19 pandemic increased awareness of efficiencies associated with faster patient throughput, less movement from having to use two rooms to complete an advanced cataract procedure, fewer touches of the patient to treat and to complete the advanced cataract procedure, placing the system in the ASC OR or in-office surgical suite; and

 

   

lower technology acquisition cost and broad base procedure applications across all cataract procedures improve economics for the ASC, and the surgeon.

Our Strategy

Our goal is for our LENSAR Laser System to become the leading solution for the treatment of cataracts and management of astigmatism in cataract surgery. Key elements of our strategy include:

 

   

Continue to build commercial infrastructure to further penetrate the cataract surgery market. We have been able to achieve our success to date with a limited number of regional sales managers in the United States and independent distributors in more limited geographic international markets, growing our business substantially year-over-year in terms of both revenues and number of procedures. We believe that increasing the size and geographic breadth of our sales and marketing management team and number of regional sales managers in the United States and expanding our network of independent distributors in additional international markets will allow further penetration in the cataract surgery market. To support these commercial efforts, we intend to expand our marketing support and commitment to physician and staff training programs, including our clinical outcome specialists, to optimize results and communicate the strengths of our cataract surgery solutions.

 

   

Increase awareness of the benefits of our LENSAR Laser System. We intend to continue to educate surgeons about the advantages of cataract surgery conducted with our LENSAR Laser System. In order to do so, we intend to conduct additional clinical trials and continue to generate clinical data that will help us demonstrate the benefits of our system when compared to manual cataract surgery conducted without a laser system, or with competing laser systems. In addition, we believe our planned

 

123


Table of Contents
 

deployment of clinical outcomes specialists that will work with individual surgeons interested in continuing to refine and optimize the visual outcomes performance in their practice will greatly support the initiatives in growing the utilization of the LENSAR Laser System.

 

   

Invest in research and development to drive innovation. We have succeeded in continuous improvement of our LENSAR Laser System. We are committed to new product development and to our ongoing research and development initiatives, and we are investing in our business to further evolve our LENSAR Laser System. Our current focus is on developing our proprietary, next-generation, integrated workstation, known as ALLY, that is intended to further enhance the capabilities of our current femtosecond laser technology and combine it with an advanced phacoemulsification system. We believe this integrated platform design will facilitate the ability of surgeons that currently rely solely on phacoemulsification to adopt and integrate laser-assisted procedures into their practice, as well as facilitate greater utilization of the system with current femtosecond laser users due to improving efficiencies and cost benefits with standard cataracts. We have secured, and will continue to maintain, patent protection for our innovations.

 

   

Seek and capitalize on opportunities to enhance our product offering through strategic alliances and acquisitions. We have worked, and will continue to work, with other companies to make our cataract surgery solutions meet the needs of surgeons and their patients. For example, we modified our Streamline platform to accept data input from a wide variety of commonly used diagnostic devices in physicians’ offices that collect the preoperative data that is required in making up the front end plan for a surgeon’s parameters in a cataract procedure. These diagnostic tools are provided by third parties. We also intend to continue to pursue alliances that would provide us access to technologies and opportunities to strengthen our market position and help grow our business. We are especially interested in synergistic acquisitions that may enhance and grow our market presence and breadth in the market. We believe these may include other types of IOLs, viscoelastics, which are viscous fluids of varying molecular weights designed to coat the inner tissues of the eye to protect from damage during the procedure, and other disposable components used in these procedures.

Our Products and Technology

LENSAR Laser System

Our current product portfolio consists of the Streamline IV LENSAR Laser System and its associated consumable components. The system itself is designed as a standalone console and consists of the following key components:

 

LOGO   

1. Interactive graphic user interface. Allows the physician to easily plan, customize and view custom surgery for each individual patient. Further allows easy adjustment of patient treatment moments before surgery.

 

2. Deployable head. Allows the patient to be presented to the system in multiple orientations in a multitude of different laser or operating room configurations.

 

3. Scanning camera. Allows the doctor to find all of the relevant unique eye surfaces automatically, with no manual, time-consuming or cumbersome adjustments.

 

124


Table of Contents

4. Seamless docking technology. Allows for easy docking with force feedback technology to the patient’s eye with minimal discomfort.

5. Easy to use joystick. Provides physician intuitive, simple control when docking the system to the patients eye from multiple patient orientation to the system.

The consumable portion of the system consists of a disposable patient interface device, or PID, kit and a procedure license. Each procedure on each system requires the use of a PID kit. The PID kit includes a suction ring, vacuum filter and fluidic connection that are designed to facilitate placement of the laser while minimizing patients discomfort, intraocular pressure and trauma to the retina and maintaining corneal integrity. The following diagram depicts the PID kit:

 

LOGO

The procedure license is downloaded onto the system as required or as purchased by the customer. The system will not perform a procedure without an active license. We offer licenses in a subscription package with minimum monthly obligations and the ability to increase procedure numbers as the practice grows to address occasional increases in demand. We believe this structure allows the surgeon to implement a budget while also providing us with a predictable revenue stream.

 

125


Table of Contents

ALLY

We are currently developing our proprietary, next-generation, integrated workstation, which we refer to as ALLY. ALLY is designed to combine our existing femtosecond laser technology with enhanced capabilities and a phacoemulsification system that together will allow surgeons to perform each of the critical steps in a cataract procedure in a single operating room using this device. The following diagram depicts our current rendering of the ALLY system. We anticipate submitting an application for 510(k) clearance to the FDA by the end of the first quarter of 2022 and beginning commercialization of ALLY in 2022.

 

 

LOGO

Our market research supports the importance of this compact, dual function system. In February 2020, we engaged EyeQ Research, an independent third party research firm, to conduct a survey to help evaluate and assess surgeon perceptions regarding a dual function system. EyeQ Research contacted over 250 surgeons in the United States in connection with the survey and excluded the results of those surgeons that did not meet certain eligibility criteria, which included, among other things, having performed less than 30 cataract procedures per month. This was a blind survey such that the surgeons contacted were unaware of our association and commissioning of the survey. The results from 122 surgeons, approximately 25% of which were not current users of femtosecond laser-assisted cataract surgery, are reflected in the survey, with those surgeons possessing an average of 20 years in practice and an average monthly cataract surgery procedure volume of 55. Key findings from the survey are summarized below:

 

   

40% indicated that use of a dual function system would increase the number of femtosecond laser-assisted cataract surgery procedures they perform;

 

   

93% indicated that a dual function system would improve femtosecond laser assisted cataract surgery workflow;

 

   

89% indicated a preference to have the femtosecond laser in the same room as the phacoemulsification system;

 

   

83% would consider acquiring a dual function system when it is time to replace a femtosecond laser or phacoemulsification system;

 

   

83% would consider acquiring a dual function system as a new/additional femtosecond laser; and

 

   

42% indicated that it would be a barrier to acquiring a dual function system if the system was manufactured by a different supplier than their current femtosecond laser, and 55% indicated it would be a barrier if the dual function system was manufactured by a different supplier than their current phacoemulsification system.

 

126


Table of Contents

We estimate that there are currently approximately 56,000 phacoemulsification systems installed globally, with an estimated 8,300 new phacoemulsification systems installed in 2019 growing to an anticipated 9,600 new units in 2024. According to the 2019 Cataract Surgical Equipment Market Report, there were an estimated 2,863 new femtosecond laser systems installed in 2019, of which 2,576 are in markets that we service. The number of total femtosecond laser systems installed is expected to grow to over 3,600 devices by 2024. We believe the expected growth in the phacoemulsification market, combined with the results from our blinded survey, suggest a significant market opportunity as surgeons replace, or add to, their phacoemulsification or femtosecond laser systems.

To help encourage and facilitate this transition to a dual function system, and to our ALLY system in particular, we are focused on reducing the total the cost of the system, as compared to two separate systems, without compromising the capabilities or performance of either of the dual functions. With that in mind, we are designing ALLY to offer more functionality and better performance than the combined use of currently available separate systems but at a substantially lower cost of goods. If ALLY is cleared by the FDA, we believe its lower cost of goods and combined functions could help drive broader penetration into the overall cataract surgery market and could potentially create a paradigm shift in the treatment of cataracts and management of astigmatism in cataract surgery.

Technology

Our LENSAR Laser System has been built specifically for treating refractive cataract surgery, and at the core of our commitment to continuous technological innovation is our focus on providing cataract surgeons the tools to deliver their patients improved outcomes. The key technological features of our system include:

 

   

IntelliAxis Refractive Capsulorhexis: Designed to improve precision and accuracy in outcome-based astigmatic cataract procedures, this proprietary technology enables a surgeon to precisely mark by producing small tabs in the capsulorhexis on the steep axis through the use of advanced iris registration to guide toric IOL placement and alignment, both during and after the surgical procedure.

 

   

Augmented Reality: Our patented augmented reality technology provides a surgeon with a sophisticated, three-dimensional view of a patient’s eye. This enhanced view, which reflects each patient’s own unique eye size and shape, allows surgeons to identify relevant anatomy and specific biometric measurements within the patient’s eye, enabling them to precisely place the laser pulses necessary to accomplish the desired treatment. Surgeons are then able to develop better-informed approaches and subsequent treatment for refractive cataract surgical procedures. This technology also simplifies the procedure for surgeons by including pre-programmable surgeon preferences, wireless integration with pre-operative diagnostic data, cataract density imaging for using the lowest energy needed to treat, and accurate laser incision planning. We believe this improves the efficiency and reproducibility of the procedure for surgeons.

 

   

Wireless Transfer of Pre-Operative Data: Pre-operative diagnostic data can be transferred wirelessly from many preoperative corneal topographers and diagnostic devices to our system, which can guide more precise astigmatism planning and reduce or eliminate risks associated with transcription errors and manually marking the eye.

 

   

Pre-Operative Data Analysis: With the assistance of our clinical applications and clinical outcomes groups, practices’ individualized astigmatism treatment protocols can be refined and customized based on site specific pre-, intra-, and post-operative data, with the objective to help surgeons to deliver incrementally better patient outcomes over time as compared to earlier generations.

 

   

Cataract Density Imaging: Another unique aspect of our Augmented Reality imaging system is the ability of the system to grade and compare the cataract density and tissue specific areas to treat within the lens nucleus. The benefit of this is the surgeon can customize the treatment and deliver only the energy and fragmentation patterns necessary to optimally treat the cataract. This not only increases

 

127


Table of Contents
 

efficiency in removal of the cataract when the surgeon gets to the phacoemulsification, but also provides the surgeon choices in pre-programmed treatment algorithms or their own customized preferences in the energy and fragmentation parameters based on their surgical technique. These can be stored and used each time the system identifies a cataract with similar characteristics.

 

   

Corneal Incision-Only Mode: By allowing a surgeon to perform laser corneal incisions independent of capsulorhexis and fragmentation, the surgeon has greater flexibility to treat a patient who may benefit from post-operative arcuate incisions, and may achieve greater efficiency with abbreviated scanning that omits lens boundaries.

Key Clinical Studies

The following description summarizes some the key clinical studies supporting our laser system’s ability to achieve targeted visual outcomes:

 

   

At the 2019 Annual Meeting of the ASCRS, results were presented from a retrospective study designed to evaluate visual and refractive outcomes following toric IOL implantation guided by iris-registration guided femtosecond laser-assisted capsular marks. The study evaluated 60 eyes that had undergone femtosecond laser-assisted cataract surgery using the LENSAR Laser System and its IntelliAxis Refractive Capsulorhexis to guide toric IOL placement. The study demonstrated a reduction in mean corneal astigmatism from a mean of 2.11 diopters preoperatively to a mean of 0.15 diopters at between four and six weeks postoperatively. Moreover, 98% of eyes achieved postoperative astigmatism of 0.5 diopters or less, and 56% of eyes exhibited no residual astigmatism.

 

   

Results from a separate retrospective study of 54 eyes that underwent femtosecond laser-assisted cataract surgery and toric IOL implantation using the LENSAR Laser System were presented at the 2019 American Academy of Ophthalmology, or AAO, Annual Meeting. The purpose of the study was to evaluate the outcomes of toric IOL implantation based upon iris registration guided femtosecond laser assisted capsular marks. IOL placement was confirmed by an intraoperative wavefront aberrometer used to confirm IOL spherical power, placement of the toric and magnitude of cylinder. The study demonstrated a reduction in mean corneal astigmatism from a mean of 1.01 diopters preoperatively to a mean of 0.11 diopters at between four and six weeks postoperatively. Moreover, 95% of eyes achieved postoperative astigmatism of 0.5 diopters or less, 97.3% of eyes achieved a post-operative UDVA of 20/30 or better and 94.6% achieved a manifest refraction spherical equivalent, or MRSE, of less than 0.75 diopters. Notably, the aberrometer confirmed the IOL position and none of the IOLs required repositioning at the time of surgery.

 

   

Also presented at the 2019 AAO Annual Meeting were the results of a retrospective study of 590 eyes of patients that desired to be spectacle independent and underwent laser-assisted cataract surgery with a single surgeon using the LENSAR Laser System. Patients with a preoperative astigmatism of less than 0.5 diopters received no astigmatic treatment. Patients with preoperative astigmatism of greater than 0.5 diopters were considered for astigmatic treatment with arcuate keratotomy, or AK, and multifocal or toric IOL. Toric IOLs were used instead of multifocal in eyes where the astigmatism was too high to treat with AKs in the eye that would have received the multifocal IOL. Of the 590 eyes, 475 received a multifocal IOL with or without AK, and 115 eyes received a toric IOL. For the multifocal subgroup, approximately 91% of eyes were within 0.5 diopters of emmetropia, which occurs when the eye is without refractive error, 96.6% of eyes achieved a UDVA of 20/40 or better and 93.2% achieved uncorrected near vision acuity, or UNVA, of 20/40 or better. The multifocal group also achieved a mean MRSE of -.04 ± 0.35, a postoperative UDVA. Similarly, eyes in the toric subgroup achieved a significant decrease in mean corneal astigmatism from 1.55 diopters preoperatively to 0.47 diopters postoperatively. Additionally, 93.9% of eyes achieved a UDVA of 20/40 or better and 83.2% achieved UNVA of 20/40 or better.

 

   

Lastly, in another retrospective study published in the Journal of Cataract Refractive Surgery in 2019, 189 eyes of 143 patients were analyzed to evaluate the outcomes of femtosecond laser-assisted arcuate

 

128


Table of Contents
 

keratotomy combined with cataract surgery in eyes with low to medium astigmatism. Each procedure was performed using the LENSAR Laser System and all eyes received the implantation of a nontoric monofocal or multifocal IOL. Results were analyzed at three months postoperatively and showed that 181 eyes (95.8%) demonstrated post-operative refractive astigmatism of 0.5 diopters or less and 170 eyes (90%) had a post-operative UDVA of 20/30 or better. Outcomes from the procedures were demonstrated to be stable for at least one year postoperatively.

Sales and Distribution

We have built and are continuing to grow our commercial organization, which includes a direct sales force in the United States and distributors in Germany, China, South Korea and other targeted international geographies. Depending on the dynamics of a particular geographic region, we and our distributors typically market and sell our systems to ASCs, hospitals and physicians. In the United States, we sell our products through a direct sales organization that, as of December 31, 2019, consisted of 30 commercial team professionals, including regional sales managers, clinical applications and outcomes specialists, field service, technology and customer support personnel. As of December 31, 2019, we had a total of 207 systems installed in a total of 15 countries, including 79 in the United States, and with China, South Korea and Germany representing our largest markets outside the United States. We believe there is significant opportunity for us to expand our presence in these countries, countries where we have only a limited number of installed systems, and other markets and regions.

In the United States, we anticipate adding additional field sales professionals and plan to invest in marketing and education efforts to support this expansion. Outside the United States, we expect to expand the geographical reach of our distributors. We believe the expansion of our domestic and international commercialization efforts will provide us with significant opportunity for future growth as we continue to penetrate existing and new markets.

We primarily focus our selling efforts on converting existing femtosecond laser users utilizing competitive systems. We believe this will evolve over time with the expansion of the commercial field organization to include a broader base of surgeons not currently performing refractive cataract surgery.

Manufacturing

We currently manufacture our LENSAR Laser System at a facility in Orlando, Florida. We purchase custom and off-the-shelf components from a number of suppliers and subject them to stringent quality specifications and processes. Some of the components necessary for the assembly of the LENSAR Laser System are currently provided by single-sourced suppliers (the only approved supply source for us among other sources). We have entered into various purchase orders, as well as a limited number of long-term supply agreements, for the manufacture and supply of certain components. These arrangements commit us to a minimum purchase obligation of approximately $10.4 million from January 1, 2020 through March 31, 2021 of which $9.6 million is due by December 31, 2020. We expect to meet these requirements. We are also relying on a third party to develop and manufacture the phacoemulsification component of ALLY. We purchase the majority of our components and major assemblies through purchase orders with limited long-term supply agreements and generally do not maintain large volumes of finished goods. We strive to maintain enough inventory of our various component parts to avoid the impact of a potential short-term disruption in the supply.

Intellectual Property

We seek patent and trademark protection for our key technology, products and product improvements, both in the United States and in selected foreign countries. We plan to continue to enforce and defend our patent and trademark rights. While our patents protect, among other things, the aspects of our technology that provide us with a competitive advantage, we also rely upon trade secrets and continuing technological innovations to develop and maintain our competitive position. In an effort to protect our trade secrets, we have a policy of

 

129


Table of Contents

requiring our employees, consultants and advisors to execute proprietary information and invention assignment agreements upon commencement of employment or consulting relationships with us. These agreements also provide that all confidential information developed or made known to the individual during the course of their relationship with us must be kept confidential, except in specified circumstances.

We own numerous issued patents and pending patent applications. As of June 16, 2020, we held 29 U.S. patents, 26 pending U.S. patent applications, 69 issued foreign patents, 30 pending foreign patent applications and one pending Patent Cooperation Treaty application, and we also exclusively licensed two U.S. patents, four pending U.S. patent applications and one pending Patent Cooperation Treaty application. Our patents are expected to expire between 2021 and 2037. We have 69 issued foreign patents in a total of 10 countries and regions, including China, Macau, Germany, France, United Kingdom, Italy, Australia, Canada and the European Patent Office. Our patents contain a broad range of claims related to devices and methods for performing cataract surgery using, among other things, refractive corrections, lens targeting and positioning and provide significant protection for our current commercialized products.

Our material registered and unregistered trademarks include: LENSAR, ALLY, INTELLIAXIS, INTELLIAXIS REFRACTIVE CAPSULORHEXIS, STREAMLINE, CATARACT LASER UNIVERSITY, CLU CATARACT LASER UNIVERSITY, LENSAR CATARACT LASER WITH AUGMENTED REALITY AND DESIGN, LensDoctor Software, IntelliAxis-C, and IntelliAxis-L.

Our intellectual property portfolio further secures a premier technology position for the development and commercialization of devices that incorporate both a phacoemulsification system and a femtosecond laser, such as our ALLY device. In addition to patent applications we have filed related to ALLY devices, we have pursued and consummated agreements with third parties to acquire and license patent rights, such as those described below, which provide important exclusivity with respect to our development and commercialization of ALLY devices. Our business plan includes aggressively pursuing additional patent rights related to ALLY, and we expect to continue to add to our current portfolio.

Patton License Agreement

In September 2019, we entered into a license agreement, or the Patton License, with Doug Patton and Ophthalmic Synergies, LLC, or the Licensors, pursuant to which we were granted a worldwide, exclusive license to use certain patents held by, and patent applications made by, the Licensors relating to combining a femtosecond laser and phacoemulsification system into a single device. Under the Patton License, we made an initial, upfront payment to the Licensors of $3.5 million and are required to make certain milestone payments relating to regulatory approval and commercial sales, in an aggregate amount of $2.4 million. We are not required to make any royalty payments under the Patton License.

The Patton License will expire upon the last date on which a valid claim exists for any of the licensed patent rights or, if later, the final expiration of any pending but unissued patents owned or controlled by a Licensor or one of its affiliates either at the Effective Date or during the Term, as defined in the Patton License. We have the right the terminate the Patton License for any reason upon 60 days’ prior written notice to the Licensors. Both we and the Licensors have the right to terminate the Patton License upon 30 days’ prior written notice of an uncured material breach by the other party, or within 90 days of certain bankruptcy-related events involving the other party. Notwithstanding the foregoing, upon completion of the payment of all milestone payments required under the Patton License, the license granted to us will become fully paid up, irrevocable and perpetual for the term of the agreement.

Development Agreement with Oertli

In January 2020, we entered into a development agreement, or the Oertli Agreement, with Oertli, pursuant to which we are collaborating in the development of a key component in our ALLY system. The Oertli

 

130


Table of Contents

Agreement provides that we and Oertli will be joint and several owners of intellectual property resulting from inventive contributions from both parties, and that we and Oertli will each be entitled to practice such intellectual property rights in our respective sole discretion, without regard to the other party. Additionally, we pay Oertli an hourly fee for their work under the Oertli Agreement.

The Oertli Agreement will expire in January 2022. Both we and Oertli have the right to terminate the Oertli Agreement for any reason upon 60 days’ prior written notice to the nonterminating party. Additionally, both we and Oertli have the right to terminate the Oertli Agreement upon 30 days’ prior written notice of an uncured material breach by the other party. Pursuant to the Oertli Agreement, if the development project is successful, we will negotiate with Oertli to enter into a supply agreement, whereby Oertli will supply to us the key components, as well as phaco instruments and single use consumables for inclusion in the ALLY system.

Competition

We participate in the highly competitive global market for treatments for cataracts. We face significant competition from large multinational medical device companies as well as smaller, emerging players focused on product innovation. In providing surgical solutions for cataract patients, our primary competitors are Alcon Inc.; Bausch + Lomb, a division of Bausch Health Companies Inc.; and AMO, a division of Johnson & Johnson, each of which have their own femtosecond lasers and phacoemulsification devices. Additionally, we compete with Ziemer Ophthalmic Systems AG, a private Swiss based company, in the femtosecond laser market. If our second-generation product were to be cleared for commercial use, we would also face competition from Beaver-Visitec International, Carl Zeiss AG, D.O.R.C. Holding B.V., KeraNova S.A., Lumenis, a division of XIO Group, and Oertli Instrumente AG in the standalone phacoemulsification market. In addition, we are aware of several smaller companies with IOL technologies under development or that have limited approvals.

These competitors are focused on bringing new technologies to market and acquiring products and technologies that directly compete with our products or have potential product advantages that could render our products obsolete or noncompetitive.

Many of these competitors are large public companies or divisions of publicly-traded companies and have several competitive advantages, including:

 

   

greater financial and human resources for product development and sales and marketing;

 

   

significantly greater name recognition;

 

   

their own IOLs;

 

   

longer operating histories; and

 

   

more established sales and marketing programs and distribution networks.

Because of the size of the cataract market, we expect that companies will continue to dedicate significant resources to developing and commercializing competing products, and we anticipate that our current marketed products and any future products will be subject to intense competition. We believe that the principal competitive factors in our market include:

 

   

improved outcomes for patients;

 

   

acceptance by surgeons;

 

   

ease of use and reliability;

 

   

product price and availability of reimbursement;

 

   

product bundling and multiple product purchasing agreements;

 

   

technical leadership;

 

131


Table of Contents
   

effective marketing and distribution; and

 

   

speed to market.

Regulation

United States

We are a manufacturer and marketer of medical devices, and therefore are subject to extensive regulation by the FDA and other federal and state authorities in the United States, as well as comparable authorities in foreign jurisdictions. Our products are subject to regulation in the United States under the Federal Food, Drug, and Cosmetic Act, or FDCA, as implemented and enforced by the FDA. The FDA regulates the development, design, non-clinical and clinical research, manufacturing, safety, efficacy, labeling, packaging, storage, installation, servicing, recordkeeping, premarket clearance or approval, adverse event reporting, advertising, promotion, marketing and distribution, and import and export of medical devices to ensure that medical devices distributed domestically are safe and effective for their intended uses and otherwise meet the requirements of the FDCA.

FDA Premarket Clearance and Approval Requirements

Under the FDCA, medical devices are classified into one of three classes—Class I, Class II or Class III—depending on the degree of risk associated with each medical device and the extent of control needed to ensure safety and effectiveness. Class I devices are those for which safety and effectiveness can be assured by adherence to FDA’s general controls for medical devices, or General Controls, which include compliance with the applicable portions of the FDA’s QSR, facility registration and product listing, reporting of adverse medical events, and appropriate, truthful and non-misleading labeling, advertising, and promotional materials. Some Class I devices also require premarket clearance by the FDA through the 510(k) premarket notification process described below. Class II devices are subject to FDA’s General Controls, and any other special controls as deemed necessary by FDA to ensure the safety and effectiveness of the device. Premarket review and clearance by the FDA for Class II devices is accomplished through the 510(k) premarket notification procedure, unless an exemption applies. A Class III product is a product which has a new intended use or uses advanced technology that is not substantially equivalent to that of a legally marketed device. The safety and effectiveness of Class III devices cannot be assured solely by the General Controls and the other requirements described above. These devices almost always require formal clinical studies to demonstrate safety and effectiveness. Our currently marketed medical device products are Class II medical devices subject to 510(k) clearance.

510(k) Clearance Marketing Pathway

When a 510(k) is required, the manufacturer must submit to the FDA a premarket notification submission demonstrating that the device is “substantially equivalent” to a predicate device already on the market. A predicate device is a legally marketed device that is not subject to premarket approval, i.e., a device that was legally marketed prior to May 28, 1976 (pre-amendments device) and for which a premarket approval application, or PMA, is not required, a device that has been reclassified from Class III to Class II or I, or a device that was found substantially equivalent through the 510(k) process.

If the FDA agrees that the device is substantially equivalent to a predicate device, it will grant clearance to commercially market the device in the U.S. The FDA’s 510(k) clearance process usually takes from three to twelve months from the date the application is submitted and filed with the FDA but may take significantly longer and clearance is never assured. Although many 510(k) pre-market notifications are cleared without clinical data, in some cases, the FDA requires significant clinical data to support substantial equivalence. In reviewing a pre-market notification, the FDA may request additional information, including clinical data, which may significantly prolong the review process. If the FDA determines that the device, or its intended use, is not “substantially equivalent,” the FDA may deny the request for clearance.

 

132


Table of Contents

After a device receives 510(k) clearance, any subsequent modification of the device that could significantly affect its safety or effectiveness, or that would constitute a major change in its intended use, will require a new 510(k) clearance or could require pre-market approval. The FDA requires each manufacturer to make this determination initially, but the FDA may review any such decision and may disagree with a manufacturer’s determination. If the FDA disagrees with a manufacturer’s determination, the FDA may require the manufacturer to cease marketing or recall the modified device, or both, until 510(k) clearance or pre-market approval is obtained. We have modified aspects of some of our devices since receiving regulatory clearance and we have made the determination that new 510(k) clearances or pre-market approvals were not required.

Over the last several years, the FDA has proposed reforms to its 510(k) clearance process, and such proposals could include increased requirements for clinical data and a longer review period, or could make it more difficult for manufacturers to utilize the 510(k) clearance process for their products. For example, in November 2018, FDA officials announced forthcoming steps that the FDA intends to take to modernize the premarket notification pathway under Section 510(k) of the FDCA. Among other things, the FDA announced that it planned to develop proposals to drive manufacturers utilizing the 510(k) pathway toward the use of newer predicates. These proposals included plans to potentially sunset certain older devices that were used as predicates under the 510(k) clearance pathway, and to potentially publish a list of devices that have been cleared on the basis of demonstrated substantial equivalence to predicate devices that are more than 10 years old. The FDA also announced that it intends to finalize guidance to establish a premarket review pathway for “manufacturers of certain well-understood device types” as an alternative to the 510(k) clearance pathway and that such premarket review pathway would allow manufacturers to rely on objective safety and performance criteria recognized by the FDA to demonstrate substantial equivalence, obviating the need for manufacturers to compare the safety and performance of their medical devices to specific predicate devices in the clearance process.

In May 2019, the FDA solicited public feedback on its plans to develop proposals to drive manufacturers utilizing the 510(k) pathway toward the use of newer predicates, including whether the FDA should publish a list of devices that have been cleared on the basis of demonstrated substantial equivalence to predicate devices that are more than 10 years old. The FDA requested public feedback on whether it should consider certain actions that might require new authority, such as whether to sunset certain older devices that were used as predicates under the 510(k) clearance pathway. These proposals have not yet been finalized or adopted, and the FDA may work with Congress to implement such proposals through legislation. More recently, in September 2019, the FDA finalized the aforementioned guidance to describe an optional “safety and performance based” premarket review pathway for manufacturers of “certain, well-understood device types” to demonstrate substantial equivalence under the 510(k) clearance pathway, by demonstrating that such device meets objective safety and performance criteria established by the FDA, obviating the need for manufacturers to compare the safety and performance of their medical devices to specific predicate devices in the clearance process. The FDA intends to maintain a list of device types appropriate for the “safety and performance based pathway” and develop product-specific guidance documents that identify the performance criteria for each such device type, as well as the testing methods recommended in the guidance documents, where feasible.

FDA PMA Approval Process

Although unlikely for the types of medical devices marketed by us, the FDA may classify devices, or the particular use of a device, into Class III, and the device sponsor must then fulfill more rigorous PMA requirements. A PMA application, which is intended to demonstrate that a device is safe and effective, must be supported by extensive data, including extensive technical and manufacturing data and data from preclinical studies and human clinical trials. After a PMA application is submitted and filed, the FDA begins an in-depth review of the submitted information, which typically takes between one and three years, but may take significantly longer. During this review period, the FDA may request additional information or clarification of information already provided. Also, during the review period, an advisory panel of experts from outside the FDA will usually be convened to review and evaluate the application and provide recommendations to the FDA as to the approvability of the device. In addition, the FDA will conduct a pre-approval inspection of the manufacturing

 

133


Table of Contents

facility to ensure compliance with the QSR, which imposes stringent design development, testing, control, documentation and other quality assurance procedures in the design and manufacturing process. The FDA may approve a PMA application with post-approval conditions intended to ensure the safety and effectiveness of the device including, among other things, restrictions on labeling, promotion, sale and distribution and collection of long-term follow-up data from patients in the clinical study that supported approval. Failure to comply with the conditions of approval can result in materially adverse enforcement action, including the loss or withdrawal of the approval. New PMA applications or PMA supplements are required for significant modifications to the manufacturing process, labeling of the product and design of a device that is approved through the PMA process. PMA supplements often require submission of the same type of information as an original PMA, except that the supplement is limited to information needed to support any changes from the device covered by the original PMA, and may not require as extensive clinical data or the convening of an advisory panel.

A clinical trial is typically required to support a PMA application and is sometimes required for a 510(k) pre-market notification. Clinical trials generally require submission of an application for an Investigational Device Exemption, or IDE, to the FDA. The IDE application must be supported by appropriate data, such as animal and laboratory testing results, showing that it is safe to test the device in humans and that the investigational protocol is scientifically sound. The IDE application must be approved in advance by the FDA for a specified number of patients, unless the product is deemed a non-significant risk device and eligible for more abbreviated IDE requirements. Clinical trials for a significant risk device may begin once the IDE application is approved by the FDA as well as the appropriate institutional review boards at the clinical trial sites, and the informed consent of the patients participating in the clinical trial is obtained. After a trial begins, the FDA may place it on hold or terminate it if, among other reasons, it concludes that the clinical subjects are exposed to an unacceptable health risk. Any trials we conduct must be conducted in accordance with FDA regulations as well as other federal regulations and state laws concerning human subject protection and privacy.

Post-Market Regulation

After a device is cleared or approved for marketing, numerous and pervasive FDA and other regulatory requirements continue to apply. These include establishment registration and device listing with the FDA; compliance with medical device reporting regulations, which require that manufacturers report to the FDA if their device may have caused or contributed to a death or serious injury or malfunctioned in a way that would likely cause or contribute to a death or serious injury if it were to recur; and compliance with corrections and removal reporting regulations, which require that manufacturers report to the FDA field corrections and product recalls or removals if undertaken to reduce a risk to health posed by the device or to remedy a violation of the FDCA that may present a risk to health. The FDA and the Federal Trade Commission also regulate the advertising and promotion of our products to ensure that the claims we make are consistent with our regulatory clearances, that there is scientific data to substantiate the claims and that our advertising is neither false nor misleading. In general, we may not promote or advertise our products for uses not within the scope of our intended use statement in our clearances or make unsupported safety and effectiveness claims. Many regulatory jurisdictions outside of the United States have similar regulations to which we are subject.

We are also required to register with the FDA as a medical device manufacturer. As such, our manufacturing sites are subject to periodic inspection by the FDA for compliance with the FDA’s QSR. These regulations cover the methods and the facilities and controls for the design, manufacture, testing, production, processes, controls, quality assurance, labeling, packaging, distribution, installation and servicing of finished devices intended for human use. The QSR also requires, among other things, maintenance of a device master file, device history file, and complaint files. As a manufacturer, we are subject to periodic scheduled or unscheduled inspections by the FDA. Our failure to maintain compliance with the QSR requirements could result in the shut-down of, or restrictions on, our manufacturing operations and the recall or seizure of our products, which would have a material adverse effect on our business. The discovery of previously unknown problems with any of our products, including unanticipated adverse events or adverse events of increasing severity or frequency, whether resulting from the use of the device within the scope of its clearance or off-label by a physician in the practice of

 

134


Table of Contents

medicine, could result in restrictions on the device, including the removal of the product from the market or voluntary or mandatory device recalls.

The FDA has broad regulatory compliance and enforcement powers. If the FDA determines that we failed to comply with applicable regulatory requirements, it can take a variety of compliance or enforcement actions, which may result in any of the following sanctions:

 

   

warning letters, untitled letters, fines, injunctions, consent decrees and civil penalties;

 

   

recalls, withdrawals, or administrative detention or seizure of our products;

 

   

operating restrictions or partial suspension or total shutdown of production;

 

   

refusing or delaying requests for 510(k) marketing clearance or PMA approvals of new products or modified products;

 

   

withdrawing 510(k) clearances or PMA approvals that have already been granted;

 

   

refusal to grant export approvals for our products; or

 

   

criminal prosecution.

Requirements for Surgical Lasers as Radiation Emitting Products

In addition to the requirements that apply to medical devices, our devices must also comply with an independent set of requirements that apply to radiation emitting electronic products, which includes lasers. Under the electronic product radiation control provisions of the FDCA, the FDA has established regulations specifying certain requirements for different types of radiation emitting electronic products. Among other requirements, manufacturers of surgical lasers must comply with FDA regulations that establish performance standards for laser products, and require that manufacturers of products subject to performance standards submit reports to FDA demonstrating compliance. Unless otherwise exempted, manufacturers of certain radiation emitting devices must submit certain reports to FDA, including for new and modified products, for product defects, and annual reports, and comply with recordkeeping requirements. FDA’s regulations also provide specific certification and labeling requirements, and the labels for these products must contain certain information, such as warnings, declarations, and instructions for use.

Outside the United States

In order for us to market our products in countries outside the United States, we must obtain regulatory approvals and comply with extensive product and quality system regulations in other countries. These regulations, including the requirements for approvals or clearance and the time required for regulatory review, vary from country to country. Some countries have regulatory review processes which are substantially longer than U.S. processes. Failure to obtain regulatory authorizations or approvals in a timely manner and to meet all local requirements including language and specific safety standards in any foreign country in which we plan to market our products could prevent us from marketing products in such countries or subject us to sanctions and fines.

Commercialization of medical devices in the European Economic Area or EEA (comprised of the 27 EU Member States plus Iceland, Liechtenstein and Norway, and the United Kingdom, until the end of the transition period on 31 December provided for in the Withdrawal Agreement between the EU and the UK), is regulated by the European Union. The EU requires that all medical devices placed on the market in the EEA must meet the relevant essential requirements laid down in Annex I of Council Directive 93/42/EEC, or the Medical Devices Directive, and of Council Directive 90/385/EEC, or the Active Implantable Medical Devices Directive. The most fundamental essential requirement is that a medical device must be designed and manufactured in such a way that it will not compromise the clinical condition or safety of patients, or the safety and health of users and

 

135


Table of Contents

others. In addition, the device must achieve the performances intended by the manufacturer and be designed, manufactured, and packaged in a suitable manner. To demonstrate compliance with the essential requirements laid down in Annex I to the Medical Devices Directive, medical device manufacturers must undergo a conformity assessment procedure, which varies according to the type of medical device and its classification. Conformity assessment procedures require an assessment of available clinical evidence, literature data for the product, and post-market experience in respect of similar products already marketed. Except for low-risk medical devices (Class I non-sterile, non-measuring devices), where the manufacturer can self-declare the conformity of its products with the essential requirements (except for any parts which relate to sterility or metrology), a conformity assessment procedure requires the intervention of a Notified Body. Notified bodies are often separate entities and are authorized or licensed to perform such assessments by government authorities. The notified body would typically audit and examine a product’s technical dossiers and the manufacturers’ quality system. If satisfied that the relevant product conforms to the relevant essential requirements, the notified body issues a certificate of conformity, which the manufacturer uses as a basis for its own declaration of conformity. The manufacturer may then apply the CE Mark to the device, which allows the device to be placed on the market throughout the EEA. Once the product has been placed on the market in the EEA, the manufacturer must comply with requirements for reporting incidents and field safety corrective actions associated with the medical device.

In April 2017, the European Parliament passed the Medical Devices Regulation (Regulation 2017/745), which repeals and replaces the EU Medical Devices Directive and the Active Implantable Medical Devices Directive. Unlike directives, which must be implemented into the national laws of the EEA Member States, the regulations would be directly applicable, i.e., without the need for adoption of EEA member State laws implementing them, in all EEA Member States and are intended to eliminate current differences in the regulation of medical devices among EEA Member States. The Medical Devices Regulation, among other things, is intended to establish a uniform, transparent, predictable and sustainable regulatory framework across the EEA for medical devices and ensure a high level of safety and health while supporting innovation. The Medical Devices Regulation was meant to become applicable three years after publication (in May 2020). However, on April 23, 2020, to take the pressure off EEA national authorities, notified bodies, manufacturers and other actors so they can focus fully on urgent priorities related to the COVID 19 pandemic, the European Council and Parliament adopted Regulation 2020/561, postponing the date of application of the Medical Devices Regulation by one year (to May 2021). Once applicable, the Medical Devices Regulation will among other things:

 

   

strengthen the rules on placing devices on the market and reinforce surveillance once they are available;

 

   

establish explicit provisions on manufacturers’ responsibilities for the follow-up of the quality, performance and safety of devices placed on the market;

 

   

improve the traceability of medical devices throughout the supply chain to the end-user or patient through a unique identification number;

 

   

set up a central database to provide patients, healthcare professionals and the public with comprehensive information on products available in the EU; and

 

   

strengthen rules for the assessment of certain high-risk devices, such as implants, which may have to undergo an additional check by experts before they are placed on the market.

Once applicable, the Medical Devices Regulation may impose increased compliance obligations for us to access the EU market.

Other Healthcare Laws

Although none of the procedures using our products are currently covered by any government or commercial third-party payors, applicable agencies and regulators may nonetheless interpret that we are subject to numerous state and federal healthcare fraud and abuse laws, including anti-kickback, false claims and

 

136


Table of Contents

physician payment transparency laws that are intended to reduce waste, fraud and abuse in the health care industry and analogous state laws that may apply to healthcare items and services by any payors including private insurers and self-pay patients. These laws are broad, subject to evolving interpretations and vigorously enforced against medical device manufacturers and have resulted in manufacturers paying significant fines and penalties and being subject to stringent corrective action plans and reporting obligations. We must operate our business within the requirements of these laws and, if we were accused of violating them, could be forced to expend significant resources on investigation, remediation and monetary penalties. Companies targeted in such prosecutions have paid substantial fines in the hundreds of millions of dollars or more, have been forced to implement extensive corrective action plans, can be excluded from federal health care programs and become subject to substantial civil and criminal penalties, and have often become subject to consent decrees, settlement agreements or corporate integrity agreements severely restricting the manner in which they conduct their business.

Because we have commercial operations overseas, we are also subject to the Foreign Corrupt Practices Act, or FCPA, and other countries’ anti-corruption/anti-bribery regimes, such as the U.K. Bribery Act. The FCPA prohibits, among other things, improper payments or offers of payments to foreign governments and their officials for the purpose of obtaining or retaining business. Safeguards we implement to discourage improper payments or offers of payments by our employees, consultants, sales agents or distributors may be ineffective, and violations of the FCPA and similar laws may result in severe criminal or civil sanctions, or other liabilities or proceedings against us, any of which would likely harm our reputation, business, financial condition and result of operations.

Many foreign countries have similar laws relating to healthcare fraud and abuse. Foreign laws and regulations may vary greatly from country to country. For example, the advertising and promotion of our products is subject to EU Directives concerning misleading and comparative advertising and unfair commercial practices, as well as other EEA Member State legislation governing the advertising and promotion of medical devices. These laws may limit or restrict the advertising and promotion of our products to the general public and may impose limitations on our promotional activities with healthcare professionals.

Coverage and Reimbursement

In the United States and markets in other countries, patients who are prescribed treatments for their conditions and providers performing the prescribed services generally rely on third-party payors to reimburse all or part of the associated healthcare costs. Physicians may be less likely to use ALLY or other future products, if approved, unless coverage is provided, and reimbursement is adequate to cover a significant portion of the cost. Sales of any of our products may therefore depend, in part, on the availability of coverage and adequate reimbursement from third-party payors. Third-party payors include government authorities, managed care plans, private health insurers and other organizations.

For devices like ALLY, we expect the reimbursement to the facility or physician from third-party payors would be intended to cover the overall cost of treatment, including the cost of our devices used during the procedure as well as the overhead cost associated with the facility where the procedure is performed. We do not directly bill any third-party payors; instead, we receive payment from the physician practice, hospital or other facility that uses our devices. Cataract surgery, including the implantation of a basic, single focus IOL, is reimbursed by Medicare but at a relatively low level and that level of reimbursement is expected to decline in 2020. Failure by physicians, hospitals, and other users of ALLY or other devices we may develop the future, if cleared, to obtain sufficient coverage and reimbursement from healthcare payors for procedures in which such devices are used, or adverse changes in government and private third-party payors’ policies could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and future growth prospects.

In addition, there are periodic changes to reimbursement. Third-party payors regularly update reimbursement amounts and also from time to time revise the methodologies used to determine reimbursement

 

137


Table of Contents

amounts. This includes annual updates to payments to physicians, hospitals and other facilities for procedures during which our devices are used. Because we expect the cost of ALLY, if approved, would generally be recovered by the healthcare provider as part of the payment for performing a procedure and not separately reimbursed, these updates could directly impact the demand for our devices. An example of such payment updates is the Medicare program’s updates to hospital and physician payments, which are done on an annual basis using a prescribed statutory formula. In the past, with respect to reimbursement for physician services under the Medicare Physician Fee Schedule, when the application of the formula resulted in lower payment, Congress has passed interim legislation to prevent the reductions.

The containment of healthcare costs is a priority of federal, state and foreign governments, and the prices of pharmaceutical or device products have been a focus in this effort. Third-party payors are increasingly challenging the prices charged for medical products and services, examining the medical necessity and reviewing the cost-effectiveness of pharmaceutical products, medical devices and medical services, in addition to questioning safety and efficacy. If these third-party payors do not consider ALLY or other products we may develop in the future, if cleared, to be cost-effective compared to other available therapies, they may not cover our products or, if they do, the level of payment may not be sufficient to allow us to sell our products at a profit.

With respect to our LENSAR Laser System, surgeons typically charge the patient a separate out-of-pocket fee for procedures using our device. The use of advanced IOLs designed to improve vision is also not reimbursed by Medicare beyond the standard reimbursement for a monofocal IOL and physicians charge the patient for the difference between the lower reimbursed amount and the cost of the advanced IOL. Surgeons typically offer the option of an advanced IOL to patients explaining that it is not covered by Medicare and will be an out-of-pocket expense. Use of our LENSAR Laser System is often accompanied by the implantation of a advanced IOL. We believe that the ability of our LENSAR Laser System, when used with advanced IOLs to optimize vision results, will encourage surgeons to perform the procedure and their patients to pay the additional out-of-pocket costs.

Healthcare Reform

The United States and some foreign jurisdictions are considering or have enacted a number of legislative and regulatory proposals to change the healthcare system in ways that could affect our ability to sell our products profitably. Among policy makers and payors in the United States and elsewhere, there is significant interest in promoting changes in healthcare systems with the stated goals of containing healthcare costs, improving quality or expanding access. Current and future legislative proposals to further reform healthcare or reduce healthcare costs may limit coverage of or lower reimbursement for the procedures associated with the use of ALLY or other products we may develop in the future, if cleared. The cost containment measures that payors and providers are instituting, and the effect of any healthcare reform initiative implemented in the future could impact our revenue from the sale of our products.

The implementation of the Affordable Care Act, or the ACA, in the United States, for example, has changed healthcare financing and delivery by both governmental and private insurers substantially, and affected medical device manufacturers significantly. The ACA imposed, among other things, a 2.3% federal excise tax, with limited exceptions, on any entity that manufactures or imports Class I, II and III medical devices offered for sale in the United States that began on January 1, 2013. Through a series of legislative amendments, the tax was suspended for 2016 through 2019 and permanently repealed on December 20, 2019. The ACA also provided incentives to programs that increase the federal government’s comparative effectiveness research, and implemented payment system reforms including a national pilot program on payment bundling to encourage hospitals, physicians and other providers to improve the coordination, quality and efficiency of certain healthcare services through bundled payment models. Additionally, the ACA has expanded eligibility criteria for Medicaid programs and created a new Patient-Centered Outcomes Research Institute to oversee, identify priorities in, and conduct comparative clinical effectiveness research, along with funding for such research.

Since its enactment, there have been judicial and Congressional challenges to certain aspects of the ACA, and we expect additional challenges and amendments in the future. By way of example, the Tax Cuts and Jobs

 

138


Table of Contents

Act, or the Tax Act, included a provision repealing, effective January 1, 2019, the tax-based shared responsibility payment imposed by the ACA on certain individuals who fail to maintain qualifying health coverage for all or part of a year, a requirement commonly referred to as the “individual mandate”. On December 14, 2018, a U.S. District Court Judge in the Northern District of Texas, ruled that the individual mandate is a critical and inseverable feature of the ACA, and therefore, because it was repealed as part of the Tax Act, the remaining provisions of the ACA are invalid as well. On December 18, 2019, the U.S. Court of Appeals for the 5th Circuit upheld the District Court’s decision that the individual mandate was unconstitutional but remanded the case back to the District Court to determine whether the remaining provisions of the ACA are invalid as well. On March 2, 2020, the U.S. Supreme Court granted the petitions for writs of certiorari to review the case, although it is unclear when a decision will be made or how the Supreme Court will rule. In addition, there may be other efforts to challenge, repeal or replace the ACA in the future.

Moreover, other legislative changes have been proposed and adopted since the ACA was enacted. For example, the Budget Control Act of 2011, among other things, included reductions to Medicare payments to providers of 2% per fiscal year, which went into effect on April 1, 2013 and, due to subsequent legislative amendments to the statute, will remain in effect through 2025 unless additional Congressional action is taken. The Coronavirus Aid, Relief, and Economic Security Act, which was signed into law on March 27, 2020, designed to provide financial support and resources to individuals and businesses affected by the COVID-19 pandemic, suspended the 2% Medicare sequester from May 1, 2020 through December 31, 2020, and extended the sequester by one year, through 2030. Additionally, the American Taxpayer Relief Act of 2012, among other things, reduced Medicare payments to several providers, including hospitals, and increased the statute of limitations period for the government to recover overpayments to providers from three to five years.

We expect additional state and federal healthcare reform measures to be adopted in the future, any of which could limit the amounts that federal and state governments will pay for healthcare products and services, which could result in reduced demand for our products or additional pricing pressure.

In addition, changes in existing regulations could have a material adverse effect on us or our licensees, borrowers or royalty-agreement counterparties. For a discussion of the risks associated with government regulations, see the section of this information statement titled “Risk Factors—Risks Related to Government Regulation.”

Employees

As of December, 2019, we had 75 employees. None of our employees are covered by a collective bargaining agreement, and we consider our relationship with our employees to be good.

Facilities

After giving effect to the Spin-Off, we will continue to operate out of our headquarters and operations facility in Orlando, Florida that is 33,946 square feet in which our products are designed, developed, manufactured, marketed and distributed. The lease term for this facility expires July 31, 2021 with a renewal of an additional five years at our option. LENSAR plans to extend the manufacturing space of the existing building to accommodate the anticipated launch of our second-generation product. As such approximately an additional 15,000 square feet, not contiguous with the current facility but nearby will be required to house general & administrative, research & development and portions of QA.

Legal Proceedings

From time to time, we are subject to legal proceedings and claims in the ordinary course of business. While management presently believes that the ultimate outcome of these proceedings, individually and in the aggregate, will not materially harm our financial position, cash flows, or overall trends in results of operations, legal proceedings are subject to inherent uncertainties, and unfavorable rulings or outcomes could occur that have individually or in aggregate, a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition or operating results.

 

139


Table of Contents

MANAGEMENT

Executive Officers and Directors Following the Spin-Off

The following table sets forth information as of September 14, 2020 regarding certain individuals who are expected to serve as our executive officers and directors following the Spin-Off, including their anticipated titles. All of the currently known expected executive officers are currently employees of PDL. After the Spin-Off, none of the executive officers will continue to be employed by PDL. Information concerning any additional directors elected by the board of directors of PDL prior to Spin-Off will be included in an amendment to this information statement.

 

Name    Age    Position

Nicholas Curtis

   64    Chief Executive Officer, Director

Alan Connaughton

   49    Chief Operating Officer

Thomas Staab, II

   52    Chief Financial Officer

William Link, PhD(1)(2)(3)

   74    Chairperson

Richard Lindstrom, MD(1)(2)(3)

   72    Director

John McLaughlin

   68    Director

Gary Winer(1)(2)(3)

   60    Director

 

(1)

Member of the Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee.

(2)

Member of the Audit Committee.

(3)

Member of the Compensation Committee.

Biographical Summaries of Directors and Executive Officers

Nicholas Curtis has served as our chief executive officer and as a member of our board of directors since February 2012. Prior to this, Mr. Curtis served as our chief commercial officer from August 2010 until February 2012. Before joining us, Mr. Curtis was the vice president of sales and chief commercial officer of WaveTec Vision Systems, Inc., a privately held ophthalmic medical device company. Mr. Curtis served as a senior vice president of sales and marketing at STAAR Surgical Company, a publicly held company specializing in the manufacturing and marketing of ophthalmic surgery devices, from August 2002 until August 2008. Mr. Curtis has a B.S. from Northwestern University.

We believe Mr. Curtis is qualified to serve as a member of our board of directors due to his extensive experience in the ophthalmology industry and long history with our company.

Alan Connaughton has served as our chief operating officer since April 2015. Prior to this, Mr. Connaughton was our vice president of operations from January 2008 until April 2015. Mr. Connaughton has over 20 years of experience working with medical device companies. Mr. Connaughton received a B.S. from University College Galway, an M.S. from Queens University College and an M.B.A. from Rollins College.

Thomas Staab, II has served as our Chief Financial Officer since May 2020. Before joining us, Mr. Staab served as a Senior Vice President, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer at BioCryst Pharmaceuticals, Inc., a biopharmaceutical company, from July 2011 to February 2020. Prior to BioCryst, Mr. Staab served as Executive Vice President, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer of Inspire Pharmaceuticals from May 2003 through its acquisition by Merck & Co., Inc. in May 2011, and acting Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer at Triangle Pharmaceuticals, Inc. through its acquisition by Gilead Sciences, Inc. in 2003. Before joining industry, Mr. Staab spent eight years working for PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP providing audit and business advisory services to national and multi-national corporations in various industries. He is a Certified Public Accountant and received a B.S. in Business Administration and a Master of Accounting from the University of North Carolina at Chapel Hill.

William Link, PhD, has served as a member of our board of directors since November 2017, and will serve as chairperson of our board of directors upon completion of the Spin-Off. Dr. Link is the co-founder of two healthcare investment firms: in 2016 Dr. Link co-founded and is Managing Partner of Flying L Partners, and

 

140


Table of Contents

Dr. Link is a co-founder and a Managing Director of Versant Ventures Management LLC, or Versant Ventures, which was founded in 1999. Dr. Link has also been a general partner at Brentwood Venture Capital, a venture capital firm and private equity company, since March 1998. Previously, Dr. Link served as founder, chairman, and chief executive officer of Chiron Vision Corporation, an ophthalmic medical device company which was sold to Bausch & Lomb, Inc. in 1997. Before his time with Chiron Vision Corporation, Dr. Link founded and served as president of American Medical Optics, or AMO, a division of American Hospital Supply Corporation, which was sold to Allergan in 1986. Later, he served on the board of directors of AMO’s successor company, Advanced Medical Optics, which was acquired by Abbott in 2009. Before entering the healthcare industry, Dr. Link was an assistant professor in the Department of Surgery at the Indiana University School of Medicine. Dr. Link also serves on the board of directors of several private companies and three public companies: Oyster Point Pharma since July 2015, Edwards Lifesciences since May 2009 and Chairman of Glaukos Corporation since June 2001. Dr. Link previously served on the board of directors of Second Sight Medical Products from 2004 until May 2020. Dr. Link received a B.S., an M.S. and a Ph.D. in mechanical engineering from Purdue University.

We believe Dr. Link is qualified to serve as chairperson of our board of directors due to his extensive experience as a founder of multiple healthcare-related companies, his medical background, and his experience serving on the board of directors of other companies.

Richard Lindstrom, MD, has served as a member of our board of directors since February 2018. Dr. Lindstrom is the founder and an attending surgeon at Minnesota Eye Consultants P.A., a private medical practice specializing in ophthalmology, since 1989. Since 1996, Dr. Lindstrom has served as chief executive officer and the chairman of the board of directors of Lindstrom Restoration, a privately held company specializing in restoration and contaminant mitigation. Since January 2007, Dr. Lindstrom has served as the chief medical officer and member of the board of directors of AcuFocus, Inc., an ophthalmic medical device company. Dr. Lindstrom has served as a member of the board of directors of Ocular Therapeutix, Inc. since 2012, Harrow Health, Inc. since 2015 and TearLab Corporation since 2010. Dr. Lindstrom served as associate director of the Minnesota Lions Eye Bank from 1987 to 2017 and as a trustee of the University of Minnesota Foundation for four terms. He is a medical advisor for several medical device and pharmaceutical manufacturers and serves on the boards or directors of several privately-held life science companies. Dr. Lindstrom previously served as President of the International Society of Refractive Surgery, the International Intraocular Implant Society, the International Refractive Surgery Club and the American Society of Cataract and Refractive Surgery. From 1980 to 1989, he served as a professor of ophthalmology at the University of Minnesota, where he is currently adjunct clinical professor emeritus. Dr. Lindstrom holds a B.A. in Pre-Medical Studies, a B.S. in Medicine and an M.D. from the University of Minnesota.

We believe that Dr. Lindstrom is qualified to serve as a member of our board of directors because of his practical experience and background in ophthalmology and extensive experience serving on the board of directors of other life science companies.

John McLaughlin has served as a member of our board of directors since May 2017. Mr. McLaughlin was appointed a director of the PDL BioPharma, Inc. in October 2008 and served its Chief Executive Officer from December 2008 until his retirement in December 2018. He was the Chief Executive Officer and a director of Anesiva, Inc., formerly known as Corgentech, Inc., a publicly-traded biopharmaceutical company, from January 2000 to June 2008. From December 1997 to September 1999, Mr. McLaughlin was President of Tularik Inc., a biopharmaceutical company. From September 1987 to December 1997, Mr. McLaughlin held a number of senior management positions at Genentech, Inc., a biopharmaceutical company, including Executive Vice President. From January 1985 to September 1987, Mr. McLaughlin was a partner at a Washington, D.C. law firm specializing in food and drug law. Prior to that, Mr. McLaughlin served as counsel to various subcommittees of the United States House of Representatives, where he drafted numerous measures that became Food and Drug Administration laws. Mr. McLaughlin has co-founded two companies: Eyetech Pharmaceuticals, Inc., where he served as Chairman of the board of directors from 2000 until 2006, and Peak Surgical, Inc., where he was a

 

141


Table of Contents

director from 2005 until it was acquired by Medtronic in 2011. Additionally, Mr. McLaughlin has previously served on the board of directors for the following publicly-traded biopharmaceutical companies: AxoGen, Inc., from 2012 until 2014, Adverum Biotechnologies, Inc., from 2014 until 2016, and Seattle Genetics, Inc., from 2007 until 2016. Since September 2019, he has served on the board of directors of Rockwell Medical Inc. He received a B.A. from the University of Notre Dame and a J.D. from Catholic University of America.

We believe Mr. McLaughlin is qualified to serve as a member of our board of directors due to his extensive management and directorship experience in the healthcare industry.

Gary Winer has served as a member of our board of directors since April 2018. Since April 2019, Mr. Winer has served as the president and chief executive officer of ORGENTEC Diagnostika GmbH, a private equity owned specialty manufacturer of autoimmune and infectious disease diagnostic tests. Since January 2015, Mr. Winer also works as a consultant for DRC Health Care Advisors, which consults with companies in the biopharma, medical device and diagnostic health sectors, including the Noden business of PDL where he executed a ten-month project to establish a commercialization and distribution partnership in Japan. From 2003 to January 2013, Mr. Winer served as divisional vice president for Abbott Laboratories, or Abbott, a public company focusing on multinational medical devices and healthcare, in Abbott’s Latin America and Canadian diagnostic business unit, divisional vice president for Abbott’s U.S. Commercial Operations, and corporate vice president and president for Abbott Japan. After AbbVie, Inc., or AbbVie, separated from Abbott in January 2013, Mr. Winer served as AbbVie Japan’s executive president and chief executive officer until March 2014. For over 25 years, Mr. Winer has been proving his leadership abilities in the healthcare and biopharmaceutical industry on an international platform that includes such notable markets as the United States, Europe, Latin America, Asia, and Japan. In addition to serving on the board of directors for our company, Mr. Winer also serves on the board of directors for several private healthcare companies.

We believe Mr. Winer is qualified to serve as a member of our board of directors due to his experience leading and managing biotechnology companies, as well as his healthcare industry knowledge and his experience serving on the board of directors of other companies.

Board of Directors

Our business and affairs will be managed under the direction of our board of directors. Our amended and restated bylaws permit our board of directors to establish by resolution the authorized number of directors. Effective upon the Distribution, our board of directors will consist of five directors.

Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation provides that our board of directors will be divided into three classes with staggered three-year terms. Only one class of directors will be elected at each annual meeting of our stockholders, with the other classes continuing for the remainder of their respective three-year terms. We anticipate that our directors will be divided among the three classes as follows:

 

   

Class I consists of two directors, Mr. McLaughlin and Mr. Winer, each with a term expiring at the 2021 annual meeting of stockholders;

 

   

Class II consists of one director, Mr. Curtis, with a term expiring at the 2022 annual meeting of stockholders; and

 

   

Class III consists of two directors, Dr. Lindstrom and Dr. Link, each with a term expiring at the 2023 annual meeting of stockholders.

Any additional directorships resulting from an increase in the number of directors will be distributed among the three classes so that, as nearly as possible, each class will consist of one-third of our directors.

The division of our board of directors into three classes with staggered three-year terms may delay or prevent a change of our management or a change in control.

 

142


Table of Contents

Board Leadership and Structure

In accordance with our amended and restated bylaws, our board of directors will appoint our officers, including our chief executive officer. Our board of directors does not have a policy on whether the role of the chairperson and chief executive officer should be separate and, if it is to be separate, whether the chairperson should be selected from the non-employee directors or be an employee and if it is to be combined, whether a lead independent director should be selected.

Following the Spin-Off, our board of directors will have three members who are independent, as defined by the Nasdaq Listing Rules. We will have three standing board committees comprised solely of directors who are considered independent under the Nasdaq Listing Rules. We believe that the number of independent, experienced directors that will make up our board of directors will benefit LENSAR and our stockholders.

In general, our board of directors will have overall responsibility for the oversight of risk management at LENSAR. The board of directors will delegate responsibility for the oversight of certain areas of risk management to various committees of the board of directors. Each board committee will report to the full board of directors following each committee meeting.

Board Committees

Our board of directors will have an audit committee, a compensation committee and a nominating and corporate governance committee, each of which will have the composition and the responsibilities described below. In addition, from time to time, special committees may be established under the direction of our board of directors when necessary to address specific issues.

Each of the audit committee, the compensation committee and the nominating and corporate governance committee will operate under a written charter that has been approved by our board of directors in connection with this Spin-Off. A copy of each of the audit committee, compensation committee and nominating and corporate governance committee charters will be available on our corporate website. The reference to our website in this information statement does not include or incorporate by reference the information on our website into this information statement.

Audit Committee

Our audit committee will oversee our corporate accounting and financial reporting process and assist our board of directors in its oversight of (i) the integrity of our financial statements, (ii) our risk assessment and risk management program, and (iii) the performance of our independent auditor. Our audit committee will be responsible for, among other things:

 

   

appointing, compensating, retaining and overseeing the work of our independent auditor and any other registered public accounting firm engaged for the purpose of preparing or issuing an audit report or related work or performing other audit, review or attest services for us;

 

   

discussing with our independent auditor any audit problems or difficulties and management’s response;

 

   

pre-approving all audit and non-audit services provided to us by our independent auditor (other than those provided pursuant to appropriate preapproval policies established by the audit committee or exempt from such requirement under the rules of the Securities and Exchange Commission);

 

   

reviewing and discussing our annual and quarterly financial statements with management and our independent auditor; and

 

   

establishing procedures for the receipt, retention and treatment of complaints received by us regarding accounting, internal accounting controls or auditing matters, and for the confidential and anonymous submission by our employees of concerns regarding questionable accounting or auditing matters.

 

143


Table of Contents

Effective immediately prior to the effectiveness of the registration statement of which this information statement forms a part, our audit committee will consist of Drs. Link and Lindstrom and Mr. Winer, with Dr. Link serving as chair. Our board of directors has affirmatively determined that Drs. Link and Lindstrom and Mr. Winer meet the requirements for independence under the current Nasdaq listing standards and Securities and Exchange Commission rules and regulations. In addition, our board of directors has determined that each of Drs. Link and Lindstrom and Mr. Winer is an “audit committee financial expert” as defined in Item 407(d) of Regulation S-K promulgated under the Securities Act. Each of the expected members of our audit committee will qualify as financially literate.

Compensation Committee

Our compensation committee will oversee our compensation policies, plans and benefits programs. Our compensation committee will be responsible for, among other things:

 

   

reviewing and approving corporate goals and objectives with respect to the compensation of our Chief Executive Officer, evaluating our Chief Executive Officer’s performance in light of these goals and objectives and setting compensation;

 

   

reviewing and setting or making recommendations to our board of directors regarding the compensation of our other executive officers;

 

   

reviewing and making recommendations to our board of directors regarding director compensation;

 

   

reviewing and approving or making recommendations to our board of directors regarding our incentive compensation and equity-based plans and arrangements; and

 

   

appointing and overseeing any compensation consultants.

Effective immediately prior to the effectiveness of the registration statement of which this information statement forms a part, our compensation committee will consist of Drs. Link and Lindstrom and Mr. Winer, with Dr. Lindstrom serving as chair. The composition of our compensation committee will meet the requirements for independence under the current Nasdaq listing standards and Securities and Exchange Commission rules and regulations. Each of the expected members of this committee will qualify as a non-employee director, as defined in Section 16b-3 of the Exchange Act.

Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee

Our nominating and corporate governance committee will oversee and assist our board of directors in reviewing and recommending nominees for election as directors. Our nominating and corporate governance committee will be responsible for, among other things:

 

   

identifying individuals qualified to become members of our board of directors, consistent with criteria approved by our board of directors;

 

   

recommending to our board of directors the nominees for election to our board of directors at annual meetings of our stockholders;

 

   

overseeing the self-evaluations of our board of directors and management; and

 

   

developing and recommending to our board of directors any proposed changes to our corporate governance guidelines and principles.

Effective immediately prior to the effectiveness of this registration statement of which this information statement forms a part, our nominating and corporate governance committee will consist of Drs. Link and Lindstrom and Mr. Winer, with Mr. Winer serving as chair. The expected composition of our nominating, governance, and corporate responsibility committee will meet the requirements for independence under the current Nasdaq listing standards and Securities and Exchange Commission rules and regulations.

 

144


Table of Contents

Code of Business Conduct and Ethics

Prior to the Spin-Off, we will adopt a code of business conduct and ethics that will apply to all of our employees, officers and directors, including those officers responsible for financial reporting. The code of business conduct and ethics will be available on our website at www.Lensar.com upon the completion of the Spin-Off. We expect that any amendments to the code, or any waivers of its requirements, will be disclosed on our website.

 

145


Table of Contents

DIRECTOR COMPENSATION

We provide compensation to our non-employee directors in the form of cash retainers and phantom stock awards under the LENSAR, Inc. Phantom Stock Plan. During 2019, we paid Dr. Link an annual cash retainer of $100,000, we paid Mr. McLaughlin an annual cash retainer of $50,000, and we paid each of our other non-employee directors an annual cash retainer of $36,000. We have reimbursed, and will continue to reimburse, our non-employee directors for their actual out-of-pocket costs and expenses incurred in connection with attending board meetings.

Each of Drs. Link and Lindstrom and Mr. Winer have also received awards of phantom stock under the Phantom Stock Plan. As of December 31, 2019, only Drs. Link and Lindstrom held outstanding awards of phantom stock, as reflected in the table below. For Dr. Link, these awards were scheduled to vest and be eligible for settlement in two remaining installments on November 14, 2020 and 2021, subject to his continued service on our board of directors on each such settlement date. For Dr. Lindstrom, 32,100 of these awards vested on February 20, 2020, and the remaining awards were scheduled to vest and be eligible for settlement in two remaining installments on February 20, 2021 and 2022, subject to his continued service on our board of directors on each such settlement date. In addition, all of the phantom stock awards were scheduled to vest and be settled in an equivalent number of shares of our common stock immediately prior to the consummation of the Distribution pursuant to the terms of the Phantom Stock Plan. For more information about our Phantom Stock Plan, see “Executive Compensation—Incentive Plans—Phantom Stock Plan” below.

The following table summarizes compensation received by our non-employee directors during the year ended December 31, 2019. Nicholas Curtis is not included in the following table as he served as an executive officer during 2019 and his compensation is included in the Summary Compensation Table in the “Executive Compensation and Other Information” section below.

 

    

Fees Earned
or

Paid in Cash

     Stock Awards      Total  

Name

   ($)      ($)      ($)  

Richard Lindstrom, M.D.

     36,000        —          36,000  

William Link

     100,000        —          100,000  

John McLaughlin

     50,000        —          50,000  

Gary Winer

     36,000        —          36,000  

The aggregate number of shares subject to phantom stock awards outstanding at December 31, 2019 for the individuals who served as non-employee directors during 2019 was as follows:

 

Name

   Number of Phantom Stock
Awards Outstanding at
December 31, 2019
 

Richard Lindstrom, M.D.

     16,050  

William Link

     26,750  

John McLaughlin

     —    

Gary Winer

     —    

In July 2020, Dr. Lindstrom, Mr. Link and Mr. Winer were granted 160,636, 400,787 and 20,079 shares of restricted stock, respectively, under our 2020 Incentive Award Plan, or the 2020 Plan, with “target percentages” under such awards of 1.6%, 4% and 0.20%, respectively. The restricted stock awards are subject to the same terms and conditions as the awards granted to our executive officers in July 2020 and described below under “Executive Compensation—Narrative Disclosure to Compensation Tables—Equity Base Incentive Awards.” All outstanding phantom stock awards held by our non-employee directors were also cancelled.

In connection with the Distribution, we intend to adopt our non-employee director compensation program. The material terms of the non-employee director compensation program, as it is currently contemplated, are

 

146


Table of Contents

summarized below. Our board of directors is still in the process of considering the non-employee director compensation program and, accordingly, this summary is subject to change.

The non-employee director compensation policy will provide for annual retainer fees and long-term equity awards for our non-employee directors. We expect each non-employee director will receive an annual retainer of $50,000, with a non-employee director serving as chairperson of the board of directors or lead independent director instead receiving an annual retainer of $75,000. Non-employee directors serving as the chairs of the audit, compensation and nominating and corporate governance committees will receive additional annual retainers of $15,000, $10,000 and $9,000, respectively. Non-employee directors serving as members of the audit, compensation and nominating and corporate governance committees will receive additional annual retainers of $7,500, $5,000 and $4,500, respectively. Following the Spin-Off, the non-employee directors will also receive initial grants of restricted stock units having a value of $200,000, calculated based on the closing price per share of our common stock on the grant date, vesting over three years in equal annual installments, upon initial election or appointment to the board of directors, and thereafter annual grants of options having a value of $100,000, calculated based on the closing price per share of our common stock on the date of each annual meeting of stockholders following the Spin-Off, vesting on the first to occur of (1) the first anniversary of the grant date or (2) the next occurring annual meeting of our stockholders. In addition, equity awards granted to our non-employee directors will vest upon a change in control of our company or upon a director’s death or disability.

Compensation under our non-employee director compensation policy will be subject to the annual limits on non-employee director compensation set forth in the 2020 Plan, as described above. Our board of directors or its authorized committee may modify the non-employee director compensation program from time to time in the exercise of its business judgment, taking into account such factors, circumstances and considerations as it shall deem relevant from time to time, subject to the annual limit on non-employee director compensation set forth in the 2020 Plan. As provided in the 2020 Plan, our board of directors or its authorized committee may make exceptions to this limit for individual non-employee directors in extraordinary circumstances, as the board of directors or its authorized committee may determine in its discretion, provided that the non-employee director receiving such additional compensation may not participate in the decision to award such compensation or in other compensation decisions involving non-employee directors.

 

147


Table of Contents

EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

This section discusses the material components of the executive compensation program for our executive officers who are named in the “Summary Compensation Table” below, whom we refer to as our named executive officers. Mr. Staab, our Chief Financial Officer, is not a named executive officer since he commenced employment with us in May 2020, but certain information about his compensation arrangements is included to the extent we believe it is helpful to an overall understanding of our executive compensation programs.

This discussion may contain forward-looking statements that are based on our current plans, considerations, expectations and determinations regarding future compensation programs. Actual compensation programs that we adopt following the Distribution may differ materially from the currently planned programs summarized in this discussion.

Summary Compensation Table

The following table presents summary information regarding the total compensation that was awarded to, earned by or paid to our named executive officers for services rendered during the year ended December 31, 2019.

 

Name and principal position

   Year      Salary
($)
     Bonus
($)(1)
     Stock
awards
($)(2)
     Option
awards
($)
     Non-equity
incentive
plan
compensation
($)(3)
     All other
compensation
($)(4)
     Total
($)
 

Nicholas Curtis

     2019        340,000                132,903                650,000        18,727        1,141,630  

Chief Executive Officer

                       

Alan Connaughton

     2019        300,000                26,276                355,000        16,529        697,805  

Chief Operating Officer

                       

 

(1)

Represents amounts earned for 2019 paid in early 2020 under our long-term incentive plan, as described below.

(2)

Represents the grant date fair value of a restricted stock award granted to Mr. Curtis by PDL during 2019,

as determined using the fair market value of PDL’s common stock on the date of the grant. These amounts also include the grant date fair value of stock awards granted to Mr. Curtis and Mr. Connaughton in 2019 computed in accordance with FASB ASC 718. These additional awards under our Phantom Stock Plan were vested upon issuance. Mr. Curtis was awarded 6,298 shares of phantom stock, which were immediately settled in shares of our common stock. Mr. Connaughton was awarded 3,943 shares of phantom stock, which were settled partially through the immediate issuance of 50 shares of our common stock to him and partially through our payment to him of $25,736 in January 2020 in satisfaction of the remainder of the award. See Note 13 to our audited financial statements included in this information statement for the year ended December 31, 2019 for a description of the assumptions used in valuing these awards.

(3)

Represents amounts earned for 2019 paid in early 2020 under our annual performance bonus plan, as described below.

(4)

Includes a 401(k) matching contributions made by us on behalf of the named executive officer ($17,877 for Mr. Curtis and $15,679 for Mr. Connaughton) and a company contribution of $850 to the named executive officer’s health savings account.

Narrative Disclosure to Compensation Tables

The primary elements of compensation for our named executive officers are base salary, annual performance bonuses, long-term incentive payouts and equity awards. The named executive officers also participate in employee benefit plans and programs that we offer to our other employees, as described below.

 

148


Table of Contents

Annual Base Salary

We pay our named executive officers a base salary to compensate them for the satisfactory performance of services rendered to us. The base salary payable to each named executive officer is intended to provide a fixed component of compensation reflecting the executive’s skill set, experience, role and responsibilities. Base salaries for our named executive officers have generally been set at levels deemed necessary to attract and retain individuals with superior talent.

Mr. Curtis’s annual base salary for 2019 was $340,000, which was increased for 2020 to $400,000. Mr. Connaughton’s annual base salary for 2019 was $300,000, which was increased for 2020 to $345,000.

Effective July 21, 2020, our board of directors approved an increase in Mr. Curtis’s and Mr. Connaughton’s base salaries to $480,000 and $360,000, respectively.

Mr. Staab’s annual base salary of $340,000 was set in connection with his commencement of employment in May 2020.

Annual Bonus Program

Each year our board of directors establishes a performance-based annual bonus program for our employees and our named executive officers based on individual performance, company performance or as otherwise determined appropriate.

Each named executive officer has an established target annual bonus amount. The target annual bonus amounts for each named executive officer, expressed as a percentage of annual base salary, are 50% for Mr. Curtis and 35% for Mr. Connaughton.

For 2019, annual bonuses were based on company performance relative to revenue and operating expenses, as well as each individual named executive officer’s performance as it relates to his areas of responsibility. In early 2020, our board of directors determined that we achieved all of the performance objectives under the annual bonus plan at 100% achievement and approved the payout of bonuses to our named executive officers. The annual bonuses paid to our named executive officers for 2019 are reflected in the Summary Compensation Table above.

Effective July 21, 2020, our board of directors approved an increase in Mr. Curtis’s and Mr. Connaughton’s annual target bonuses to 60% and 40%, respectively.

Mr. Staab’s annual target bonus percentage is 30%, and his 2020 bonus will be prorated for the portion of the year following his commencement of employment.

Long-Term Incentive Program

Each of Messrs. Curtis and Connaughton were eligible for an annual long-term incentive payout.

Specifically, Mr. Curtis was entitled to participate in a performance-based long-term incentive plan under which the board of directors could award up to $600,000 in value annually, segmented into cash and restricted equity. Additionally, Mr. Connaughton was entitled to participate in a performance-based long-term incentive plan under which the board of directors could award up to $250,000 in value annually, segmented into cash and restricted equity.

For 2019 performance, the board of directors determined that no LENSAR equity would be issued in connection with the long-term incentive arrangements under the employment letters. Instead, the board of directors approved a payment of $480,000 to Mr. Curtis and $250,000 to Mr. Connaughton in respect of their 2019 long-term incentive payouts based on the board’s assessment of their performance and the company’s performance for the applicable year.

Commencing in 2020, these long-term incentive arrangements have been discontinued.

 

149


Table of Contents

Equity-Based Incentive Awards

Our equity-based incentive awards are designed to align our interests and the interests of our stockholders with those of our employees and other service providers, including our named executive officers. The board of directors is responsible for approving equity grants. To date, the equity awards to our named executive officers have been awarded under our Phantom Stock Plan, as described below. As part of his long-term incentive compensation, Mr. Curtis has also been granted equity by PDL on occasion.

In December 2017, our named executive officers were granted phantom stock awards under our Phantom Stock Plan. Mr. Curtis was awarded 12,777 shares of phantom stock and Mr. Connaughton was awarded 8,000 shares of phantom stock. These awards had a base price of $0 and vested on December 31, 2018, subject to continued employment through such date. We settled these awards in shares of LENSAR common stock in early 2019.

In April 2018, our named executive officers were granted additional phantom stock awards under our Phantom Stock Plan. Mr. Curtis was awarded 12,777 shares of phantom stock and Mr. Connaughton was awarded 8,000 shares of phantom stock. These awards had a base price of $0 and vested on December 31, 2019, subject to continued employment through such date. We settled these awards in shares of LENSAR common stock in early 2020.

In April 2019, our named executive officers were granted additional awards under our Phantom Stock Plan, which awards were vested upon issuance. Mr. Curtis was awarded 6,298 shares of phantom stock, which were immediately settled in shares of our common stock. Mr. Connaughton was awarded 3,943 shares of phantom stock, which were settled partially through the immediate issuance of 50 shares of our common stock to him and partially through our payment to him of $25,736 in January 2020 in satisfaction of the remainder of the award. These awards had a base price of $0.

In April 2019, PDL granted to Mr. Curtis 18,750 restricted PDL shares, which shares vested in February 2020 based on Mr. Curtis’ continued employment with us through such date. These awards were issued under PDL’s equity plan.

On July 22, 2020, we granted restricted stock awards covering an aggregate of 1,847,298 shares under our 2020 Plan to our officers, key employees, one consultant and three of our non-employee directors. Our named executive officers received the following restricted stock awards: Mr. Curtis, 583,109 shares; Mr. Connaughton, 195,976 shares; and Mr. Staab, 96,381 shares. The restricted stock awards will vest based on continued employment or service over three years, with 40% of the restricted shares vesting 3 months following the Spin-Off (or, if later, the date that is 6 months following the grant date, provided the Spin-Off has occurred prior to such date), 30% of the restricted shares vesting on the date that is 18 months following the grant date, and 30% of the restricted shares vesting on the third anniversary of the grant date. The restricted shares will vest on an accelerated basis upon an involuntary termination without cause, upon death or disability, and upon a change in control (as defined in the 2020 Plan).

The number of restricted shares granted to each named executive officer is intended to result in the recipient owning a percentage of our common stock at the time of the Spin-Off equal to his or her “target percentage.” The shares awarded were calculated using certain assumptions about the timing of the Spin-Off and PDL contributions expected to occur prior to the Spin-Off. As a result, the restricted stock awards contain a “clawback” provision. In addition to the vesting requirements, the restricted stock will be subject to potential forfeiture in the event future anticipated contributions by PDL prior to the Spin-Off do not reach the levels currently proposed, or if there are changes in the valuation assumptions for such contributions, or in the event of a change in control of LENSAR prior to the Spin-Off. On the “measurement date” (as defined below), the total shares of our common stock held by a recipient under his or her restricted stock award (together with any other shares of common stock held by the recipient and his or her affiliates) as a percentage of our outstanding

 

150


Table of Contents

common stock (on an as-converted basis) on the measurement date will be compared to the recipient’s “target percentage” set forth in his or her restricted stock award agreement. In the event a recipient’s total ownership percentage on the measurement date (including both restricted shares and any other shares held by the recipient or his or her affiliates) exceeds this “target percentage,” any excess shares will automatically be forfeited. The “target percentages” for Mr. Curtis, Mr. Connaughton and Mr. Staab are 5.75%, 1.98% and 0.90%, respectively. The aggregate “target percentages” for all officers, employees and non-employee directors under these restricted stock awards is 18.23%.

The “measurement date” will be the earliest of (1) a change in control of LENSAR (as defined in the 2020 Plan), (2) the date of the closing of the Spin-Off or (3) a recipient’s termination of employment or service (including by reason of death or disability).

Employment Agreements with our Named Executive Officers

Nick Curtis Employment Letter

In July 2020, we entered into an employment letter with Mr. Curtis. Pursuant to his employment letter, Mr. Curtis serves as the Chief Executive Officer of the Company and reports directly to our board of directors. Under the employment letter, Mr. Curtis is entitled to receive an annual base salary as specified above and is eligible to receive an annual performance bonus based on his target annual bonus. His annual base salary and target annual bonus will be subject to review by our board of directors or its compensation committee on an annual basis and at the time we become an independent public company. The actual amount of any such bonus will be determined by reference to the attainment of applicable performance objectives, as determined by the Company’s board of directors, and to Mr. Curtis’s continued employment with us through the applicable payment date.

Mr. Curtis’s employment letter provides that if he is terminated without cause or he resigns for good reason (each as defined in the employment letter), in each case prior to a change in control (as defined in our 2020 Plan), then he is entitled to the following: (1) a lump sum payment equal to the sum of (i) his base salary as in effect immediately prior to the separation, (ii) his target bonus for the year in which the separation occurs, and (iii) 12 months of premium payments to maintain health coverage under COBRA, and (2) accelerated vesting of such portion of his time-based equity awards as would have vested during the 12 months following his termination had he remained employed during such period.

Mr. Curtis’s employment letter further provides that if he is terminated without cause or he resigns for good reason, in each case within 12 months following a change in control, then he is entitled to the following: (1) a lump sum payment equal to the sum of (i) 18 months’ base salary as in effect immediately prior to the separation, (ii) 150% multiplied by his target bonus for the year in which the separation occurs, and (iii) 18 months of premium payments to maintain health coverage under COBRA, and (2) accelerated vesting of all of his time-based equity awards.

In addition, all of his time-based equity awards will vest on an accelerated basis in the event of a change in control on or prior to December 31, 2021, provided Mr. Curtis is employed by or providing services to us on such date.

Payments due to Mr. Curtis in connection with his termination without cause or resignation for good reason are subject to his execution of a general release of claims and continued compliance with applicable restrictive covenants.

Alan Connaughton Employment Letter

In July 2020, we entered into an employment letter with Mr. Connaughton. Pursuant to his employment letter, Mr. Connaughton serves as the Chief Operating Officer of the Company and reports directly to our Chief

 

151


Table of Contents

Executive Officer. Under the employment letter, Mr. Connaughton is entitled to receive an annual base salary as specified above and is eligible to receive an annual performance bonus based on his target annual bonus. His annual base salary and target annual bonus will be subject to review by our board of directors or its compensation committee on an annual basis and at the time we become an independent public company. The actual amount of any such bonus will be determined by reference to the attainment of applicable performance objectives, as determined by the Company’s board of directors, and to Mr. Connaughton’s continued employment with us through the applicable payment date.

Mr. Connaughton’s employment letter provides that if he is terminated without cause or he resigns for good reason (each as defined in the employment letter), then he is entitled to the following: (1) a lump sum payment equal to the sum of (i) 10 months’ base salary, as in effect immediately prior to the separation, (ii) 85% of his target bonus for the year in which the separation occurs, and (iii) 10 months of premium payments to maintain health coverage under COBRA, and (2) accelerated vesting of such portion of his time-based equity awards as would have vested during the 12 months following his termination had he remained employed during such period.

Mr. Connaughton’s employment letter further provides that if he is terminated without cause or he resigns for good reason, in each case within 12 months following a change in control, then he is entitled to the following: (1) a lump sum payment equal to the sum of (i) 15 months’ base salary as in effect immediately prior to the separation, (ii) 125% multiplied by his target bonus for the year in which the separation occurs, and (iii) 15 months of premium payments to maintain health coverage under COBRA, and (2) accelerated vesting of all of his time-based equity awards.

In addition, all of his time-based equity awards will vest on an accelerated basis in the event of a change in control on or prior to December 31, 2021, provided Mr. Connaughton is employed by or providing services to us on such date.

Payments due to Mr. Connaughton in connection with his termination without cause or resignation for good reason are subject to his execution of a general release of claims and continued compliance with applicable restrictive covenants.

Thomas Staab Employment Letter

In July 2020, we entered into an employment letter with Mr. Staab. Pursuant to his employment letter, Mr. Staab serves as the Chief Financial Officer of the Company and reports to Mr. Curtis. Under the employment letter, Mr. Staab is entitled to receive an annual base salary as specified above and is eligible to receive an annual performance bonus based on his target annual bonus. His annual base salary and target annual bonus will be subject to review by our board of directors or its compensation committee on an annual basis and at the time we become an independent public company. The actual amount of any such bonus will be determined by reference to the attainment of applicable performance objectives, as determined by the Company’s board of directors, and to Mr. Staab’s continued employment with us through the applicable payment date.

Mr. Staab’s employment letter provides that if he is terminated without cause or he resigns for good reason (each as defined in the employment letter), in each case prior to a change in control (as defined in our 2020 Plan), then he is entitled to the following: (1) a lump sum payment equal to the sum of (i) 9 months’ base salary, as in effect immediately prior to the separation, (ii) 75% of his target bonus for the year in which the separation occurs, and (iii) 9 months of premium payments to maintain health coverage under COBRA, and (2) accelerated vesting of such portion of his time-based equity awards as would have vested during the 9 months following his termination had he remained employed during such period (but no less than 25% of the unvested equity awards will vest if such termination occurs during his first year of employment). In addition, if Mr. Staab’s termination occurs during his first nine months of employment, the foregoing cash and healthcare severance benefits will be reduced by 50%.

 

152


Table of Contents

Mr. Staab’s employment letter further provides that if he is terminated without cause or he resigns for good reason, in each case within 12 months following a change in control, then he is entitled to the following: (1) a lump sum payment equal to the sum of (i) 12 months’ base salary as in effect immediately prior to the separation, (ii) his target bonus for the year in which the separation occurs, and (iii) 12 months of premium payments to maintain health coverage under COBRA, and (2) accelerated vesting of all of his time-based equity awards. In addition, if Mr. Staab’s termination occurs during his first nine months of employment, but following a change in control, the foregoing cash and healthcare severance benefits will be reduced by 50%.

In addition, all of his time-based equity awards will vest on an accelerated basis in the event of a change in control on or prior to December 31, 2021, provided Mr. Staab is employed by or providing services to us on such date.

Payments due to Mr. Staab in connection with his termination without cause or resignation for good reason are subject to his execution of a general release of claims and continued compliance with applicable restrictive covenants.

Defined Terms Under Employment Letters

For purposes of the employment letters with our named executive officers:

 

   

“Cause” means a named executive officer’s: (1) intentional theft, willful misconduct, or breach of fiduciary duty for personal gain, (2) material failure to comply with our code of conduct and other written policies, (3) material and intentional theft or destruction of company property, (4) willful act that is detrimental to our reputation or business, (5) repeated failure to perform the named executive officer’s duties after an opportunity to cure the failure, (6) material breach of any agreement or covenant with the Company that is not cured within 20 days, or (7) conviction of any criminal act involving moral turpitude.

 

   

“Good reason” means a named executive officer’s voluntary resignation following our failure to cure: (1) a material diminution in authority, duties or responsibilities, (2) for Mr. Curtis, a requirement that he report to anyone other than our board of directors, (3) a material reduction in the named executive officer’s base salary, (4) a material change in the location at which he must perform his duties, or (5) any material breach of the employment letters.

Outstanding Equity Awards at Fiscal Year-End

The following table sets forth information with respect to outstanding equity awards for each of our named executive officers as of December 31, 2019.

 

Name

   Number of Shares or
Units of Stock That
Have Not Vested
(#)
    Market Value
of Shares or
Units of Stock
That Have
Not Vested

($)(1)
 

Nicholas Curtis

     19,076 (1)      285,005 (2) 
     18,750 (3)      60,938 (4) 

Alan Connaughton

     11,943 (1)      178,438 (2) 

 

(1)

Represents phantom stock awards granted to the named executive officers under the Phantom Stock Plan. The phantom stock awards reflected in the table vested on December 31, 2019. We settled these awards in shares of LENSAR common stock (and for Mr. Connaughton, in shares and cash) in early 2020.

(2)

The market value was computed using $14.94 per share, the fair market value of our common stock as of December 31, 2019, based on a valuation of our common stock as of such date.

(3)

Represents restricted PDL shares issued to Mr. Curtis by PDL in February 2019, which shares vested in February 2020 based on Mr. Curtis’ continued employment with us through such vesting date.

(4)

The market value of the PDL awards held by Mr. Curtis was computed using $3.25 per share, the closing price per share of PDL’s common stock on December 31, 2019.

 

153


Table of Contents

Other Elements of Compensation

Perquisites, Health, Welfare and Retirement Benefits

Our named executive officers are eligible to participate in our employee benefit plans, including our medical, dental, vision, group life, disability and accidental death and dismemberment insurance plans, in each case on the generally on same basis as all of our other employees. We provide a 401(k) plan to our employees, including our current named executive officers, as discussed in the section below entitled “401(k) Plan.”

We generally do not provide perquisites or personal benefits to our named executive officers, except in limited circumstances. Our board of directors may elect to adopt qualified or non-qualified benefit plans in the future if it determines that doing so is in our best interests.

401(k) Plan

Our employees participate in a defined contribution employee retirement plan, or 401(k) plan, maintained by PDL. Our named executive officers are eligible to participate in the 401(k) plan on the same basis as other eligible employees. The 401(k) plan is intended to qualify as a tax-qualified plan under Section 401(k) of the Code. The 401(k) plan provides that each participant may make pre-tax deferrals from his or her compensation up to the statutory limit, which is $19,500 for calendar year 2020, and other testing limits. Participants that are 50 years or older can also make “catch-up” contributions, which in calendar year 2020 may be up to an additional $6,500 above the statutory limit. We also provide a matching contribution equal to 100% of an employee’s first 3% of contributions and 50% of the next 2% of contributions. Participant contributions are held and invested, pursuant to the participant’s instructions, by the plan’s trustee.

Nonqualified Deferred Compensation

We have not historically maintained nonqualified defined contribution plans or other nonqualified deferred compensation plans.

Termination or Change in Control Benefits

Our executive officers may become entitled to certain benefits or enhanced benefits in connection with a qualifying termination or a change in control of our company. Each of our executive officers’ employment agreements entitles them to certain benefits, upon a qualifying termination and in connection with a change in control of our company. For additional discussion, please see “Employment Agreements with our Named Executive Officers.”

Incentive Award Plans

Phantom Stock Plan

Our board of directors adopted our Phantom Stock Plan in December 2017. As of July 22, 2020, no additional awards of phantom stock were outstanding and the Phantom Stock Plan was terminated.

The Phantom Stock Plan provided for the grant of phantom stock, which was a hypothetical share of our company representing the contractual right to receive compensation equal to the fair market value of a share of our common stock on the applicable settlement date less the base price per share of the phantom stock, if any. Our Phantom Stock Plan permitted the grant of phantom stock to our employees, directors, and consultants.

The number of shares of phantom stock that could be subject to awards under the Phantom Stock Plan was determined from time to time by our board of directors or a duly authorized committee thereof.

 

154


Table of Contents

Our board of directors, or a duly authorized committee of our board of directors to which the board delegates its administrative authority, administered our Phantom Stock Plan and was referred to as the “plan administrator.”

Under the Phantom Stock Plan, phantom stock could be settled in one of the following forms, at the election of the recipient: (i) cash, (ii) LENSAR common stock (with the consent of the our board of directors), or (iii) any other valid consideration determined by the plan administrator. On the applicable settlement date, participants were entitled to receive a payout in respect of each share of phantom stock an amount equal to the fair market value per share of our common stock on the applicable settlement date, or, subject to our consent, a share of LENSAR common stock.

All phantom stock awards (including any proceeds, gains or other economic benefit actually or constructively received by participants upon the settlement of any phantom stock award or upon the receipt or resale of any shares issued upon settlement of the phantom stock award) are subject to the provisions of any claw-back policy we adopt to comply with the requirements of the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act and any rules or regulations promulgated thereunder.

2020 Incentive Award Plan

In July 2020, our board of directors and our stockholders approved our 2020 Incentive Award Plan, or the 2020 Plan, which became effective immediately. Under the 2020 Plan, we may grant cash and equity incentive awards to eligible service providers in order to attract, motivate and retain the talent for which we compete. The material terms of the 2020 Plan are summarized below.

Eligibility and Administration. Our employees, consultants and directors, and employees and consultants of our subsidiaries, are eligible to receive awards under the 2020 Plan. The 2020 Plan will generally be administered by our board of directors, which may delegate its duties and responsibilities to our compensation committee or one or more committees of our directors or officers, as applicable (referred to collectively as the plan administrator below), subject to certain limitations that may be imposed under the 2020 Plan, Section 16 of the Exchange Act or stock exchange rules, as applicable. The plan administrator has the authority to make all determinations and interpretations under, prescribe all forms for use with, and adopt rules for the administration of, the 2020 Plan, subject to its express terms and conditions. The plan administrator will also set the terms and conditions of all awards under the 2020 Plan, including any vesting and vesting acceleration conditions.

Limitation on Awards and Shares Available. The number of shares initially available for issuance under awards granted pursuant to the 2020 Plan is the sum of (a) 3,333,333 shares of our common stock, plus (b) if on the date we become publicly-traded (including the date of the Spin-Off), the aggregate number of shares remaining available for issuance under the 2020 Plan (not including shares that are subject to outstanding awards under the 2020 Plan) is less than 10% of the total shares outstanding on such date, an increase in the share reserve so that the total number of shares available for issuance under the 2020 Plan (not including shares that are subject to outstanding awards under the 2020 Plan) is equal to 10% of the total shares outstanding on such date (or such lesser number determined by our board of directors). The number of shares initially available for issuance will be further increased by an annual increase on January 1 of each calendar year beginning in 2022 and ending in 2030, equal to the lesser of (a) 5% of the shares of common stock outstanding on the final day of the immediately preceding calendar year and (b) such smaller number of shares as determined by our board of directors. No more than 22,222,222 shares of common stock may be issued upon the exercise of incentive stock options under the 2020 Plan. Shares issued under the 2020 Plan may be authorized but unissued shares, shares purchased in the open market or treasury shares. As of July 31, 2020, a total of 1,847,298 shares of restricted stock have been granted under the 2020 Plan, and 1,486,019 shares remain available for issuance under the 2020 Plan.

If an award under the 2020 Plan expires, lapses or is terminated, exchanged for cash, surrendered, repurchased, canceled without having been fully exercised or forfeited, any shares subject to such award will, as

 

155


Table of Contents

applicable, become or again be available for new grants under the 2020 Plan. Awards granted under the 2020 Plan upon the assumption of, or in substitution for, awards authorized or outstanding under a qualifying equity plan maintained by an entity with which we enter into a merger or similar corporate transaction will not reduce the shares available for grant under the 2020 Plan.

Awards. The 2020 Plan provides for the grant of stock options, including incentive stock options, or ISOs, and nonqualified stock options, or NSOs, restricted stock, dividend equivalents, restricted stock units, or RSUs, stock appreciation rights, or SARs, and other stock or cash-based awards. Certain awards under the 2020 Plan may constitute or provide for a deferral of compensation, subject to Section 409A of the Code, which may impose additional requirements on the terms and conditions of such awards. All awards under the 2020 Plan will be set forth in award agreements, which will detail the terms and conditions of the awards, including any applicable vesting and payment terms and post-termination exercise limitations. A brief description of each award type follows.

 

   

Stock options. Stock options provide for the purchase of shares of our common stock in the future at an exercise price set on the grant date. ISOs, by contrast to NSOs, may provide tax deferral beyond exercise and favorable capital gains tax treatment to their holders if certain holding period and other requirements of the Code are satisfied. The exercise price of a stock option will not be less than 100% of the fair market value of the underlying share on the date of grant (or 110% in the case of ISOs granted to certain significant stockholders), except with respect to certain substitute options granted in connection with a corporate transaction. The term of a stock option may not be longer than ten years (or five years in the case of ISOs granted to certain significant stockholders). Vesting conditions determined by the plan administrator may apply to stock options and may include continued service, performance and other conditions. ISOs generally may be granted only to our employees and employees of our parent or subsidiary corporations, if any.

 

   

SARs. SARs entitle their holder, upon exercise, to receive from us an amount equal to the appreciation of the shares subject to the award between the grant date and the exercise date. The exercise price of a SAR will not be less than 100% of the fair market value of the underlying share on the date of grant (except with respect to certain substitute SARs granted in connection with a corporate transaction), and the term of a SAR may not be longer than ten years. Vesting conditions determined by the plan administrator may apply to SARs and may include continued service, performance and other conditions.

 

   

Restricted stock and RSUs. Restricted stock is an award of nontransferable shares of our common stock that remain forfeitable unless and until specified conditions are met, and which may be subject to a purchase price. RSUs are contractual promises to deliver shares of our common stock in the future, which may also remain forfeitable unless and until specified conditions are met and may be accompanied by the right to receive the equivalent value of dividends paid on shares of our common stock prior to the delivery of the underlying shares. Delivery of the shares underlying RSUs may be deferred under the terms of the award or at the election of the participant, if the plan administrator permits such a deferral. Conditions applicable to restricted stock and RSUs may be based on continuing service, the attainment of performance goals and such other conditions as the plan administrator may determine.

 

   

Other stock or cash-based awards. Other stock or cash-based awards are awards of cash, fully vested shares of our common stock and other awards valued wholly or partially by referring to, or otherwise based on, shares of our common stock. Other stock or cash-based awards may be granted to participants and may also be available as a payment form in the settlement of other awards, as standalone payments and as payment in lieu of base salary, bonus, fees or other cash compensation otherwise payable to any individual who is eligible to receive awards. The plan administrator will determine the terms and conditions of other stock or cash-based awards, which may include vesting conditions based on continued service, performance and other conditions.

 

156


Table of Contents
   

Performance Awards. Performance awards include any of the foregoing awards that are granted subject to vesting or payment, as applicable, based on the attainment of specified performance goals or other criteria the plan administrator may determine, which may or may not be objectively determinable. Performance criteria upon which performance goals are established by the plan administrator may include: net earnings or losses (either before or after one or more of interest, taxes, depreciation, amortization and non-cash equity-based compensation expense); gross or net sales or revenue or sales or revenue growth; net income (either before or after taxes) or adjusted net income; profits (including, but not limited to, gross profits, net profits, profit growth, net operation profit or economic profit), profit return ratios or operating margin; budget or operating earnings (either before or after taxes or before or after allocation of corporate overhead and bonus); cash flow (including operating cash flow and free cash flow or cash flow return on capital); return on assets; return on capital or invested capital; cost of capital; return on stockholders’ equity; total stockholder return; return on sales; costs, reductions in costs and cost control measures; expenses; working capital; earnings or loss per share; adjusted earnings or loss per share; price per share or dividends per share (or appreciation in or maintenance of such price or dividends); regulatory achievements or compliance; implementation, completion or attainment of objectives relating to research, development, regulatory, commercial or strategic milestones or developments; market share; economic value or economic value added models; division, group or corporate financial goals; customer satisfaction/growth; customer service; employee satisfaction; recruitment and maintenance of personnel; human resources management; supervision of litigation and other legal matters; strategic partnerships and transactions; financial ratios (including those measuring liquidity, activity, profitability or leverage); debt levels or reductions; sales-related goals; financing and other capital raising transactions; cash on hand; acquisition activity; investment sourcing activity; and marketing initiatives, any of which may be measured in absolute terms or as compared to any incremental increase or decrease. Such performance goals also may be based solely by reference to our performance or the performance of a subsidiary, division, business segment or business unit, or based upon performance relative to performance of other companies or upon comparisons of any of the indicators of performance relative to performance of other companies.

Provisions of the 2020 Plan Relating to Director Compensation. The 2020 Plan provides that the plan administrator may establish compensation for non-employee directors from time to time subject to the 2020 Plan’s limitations. Prior to commencing the Spin-Off, we intend to adopt a non-employee director compensation program, which is described above under the heading “Director Compensation.” Our board of directors or its authorized committee may modify the non-employee director compensation program from time to time in the exercise of its business judgment, taking into account such factors, circumstances and considerations as it shall deem relevant from time to time, provided that, commencing in the first calendar year following the year in which we become publicly-traded, the sum of any cash compensation or other compensation and the grant date fair value (as determined in accordance with ASC 718, or any successor thereto) of any equity awards granted as compensation for services as a non-employee director during any fiscal year may not exceed $750,000, increased to $1,000,000, in the fiscal year of a non-employee director’s initial service as a non-employee director. The plan administrator may make exceptions to this limit for individual non-employee directors in extraordinary circumstances, as the plan administrator may determine in its discretion, provided that the non-employee director receiving such additional compensation may not participate in the decision to award such compensation or in other contemporaneous compensation decisions involving non-employee directors.

Certain Transactions. In connection with certain transactions and events affecting our common stock, including a change in control, or change in any applicable laws or accounting principles, the plan administrator has broad discretion to take action under the 2020 Plan to prevent the dilution or enlargement of intended benefits, facilitate such transaction or event, or give effect to such change in applicable laws or accounting principles. This includes canceling awards in exchange for either an amount in cash or other property with a value equal to the amount that would have been obtained upon exercise or settlement of the vested portion of such award or realization of the participant’s rights under the vested portion of such award, accelerating the vesting of awards, providing for the assumption or substitution of awards by a successor entity, adjusting the

 

157


Table of Contents

number and type of shares available, replacing awards with other rights or property or terminating awards under the 2020 Plan. In the event of a change in control where the acquirer does not assume awards granted under the 2020 Plan, awards issued under the 2020 Plan may be subject to accelerated vesting such that 100% of the awards will become vested and exercisable or payable, as applicable. In addition, in the event of certain non-reciprocal transactions with our stockholders, or an “equity restructuring,” the plan administrator will make equitable adjustments to the 2020 Plan and outstanding awards as it deems appropriate to reflect the equity restructuring. In no event will the Spin-Off constitute a change in control under the 2020 Plan.

Foreign Participants, Claw-back Provisions, Transferability and Participant Payments. With respect to foreign participants, the plan administrator may modify award terms, establish subplans and adjust other terms and conditions of awards, subject to the share limits described above. All awards will be subject to the provisions of any claw-back policy implemented by our company to the extent set forth in such claw-back policy or in the applicable award agreement. With limited exceptions for estate planning, domestic relations orders, certain beneficiary designations and the laws of descent and distribution, awards under the 2020 Plan are generally non-transferable prior to vesting and are exercisable only by the participant. With regard to tax withholding obligations arising in connection with awards under the 2020 Plan and exercise price obligations arising in connection with the exercise of stock options under the 2020 Plan, the plan administrator may, in its discretion, accept cash, wire transfer, or check, shares of our common stock that meet specified conditions, a “market sell order” or such other consideration as it deems suitable or any combination of the foregoing.

Plan Amendment and Termination. Our board of directors may amend or terminate the 2020 Plan at any time; however, except in connection with certain changes in our capital structure, stockholder approval will be required for any amendment that increases the number of shares available under the 2020 Plan. The plan administrator will have the authority, without the approval of our stockholders, to amend any outstanding stock option or SAR to reduce its price per share. No award may be granted pursuant to the 2020 Plan after the tenth anniversary of the date on which our board of directors adopted the 2020 Plan.

Securities Laws. The 2020 Plan is intended to conform to all provisions of the Securities Act, and the Exchange Act and any and all regulations and rules promulgated by the SEC thereunder, including, without limitation, Rule 16b-3. The 2020 Plan will be administered, and awards will be granted and may be exercised, only in such a manner as to conform to such laws, rules and regulations.

Federal Income Tax Consequences. The material federal income tax consequences of the 2020 Plan under current federal income tax law are summarized in the following discussion, which deals with the general tax principles applicable to the 2020 Plan. The following discussion is based upon laws, regulations, rulings and decisions now in effect, all of which are subject to change. Foreign, state and local tax laws, and employment, estate and gift tax considerations are not discussed due to the fact that they may vary depending on individual circumstances and from locality to locality.

 

   

Stock options and SARs. A 2020 Plan participant generally will not recognize taxable income and we generally will not be entitled to a tax deduction upon the grant of a stock option or SAR. The tax consequences of exercising a stock option and the subsequent disposition of the shares received upon exercise will depend upon whether the option qualifies as an ISO or an NSO. Upon exercising an NSO when the fair market value of our stock is higher than the exercise price of the option, a 2020 Plan participant generally will recognize taxable income at ordinary income tax rates equal to the excess of the fair market value of the stock on the date of exercise over the purchase price, and we (or our subsidiaries, if any) generally will be entitled to a corresponding tax deduction for compensation expense, in the amount equal to the amount by which the fair market value of the shares purchased exceeds the purchase price for the shares. Upon a subsequent sale or other disposition of the option shares, the participant will recognize a short-term or long-term capital gain or loss in the amount of the difference between the sales price of the shares and the participant’s tax basis in the shares.

 

158


Table of Contents

Upon exercising an ISO, a 2020 Plan participant generally will not recognize taxable income, and we will not be entitled to a tax deduction for compensation expense. However, upon exercise, the amount by which the fair market value of the shares purchased exceeds the purchase price will be an item of adjustment for alternative minimum tax purposes. The participant will recognize taxable income upon a sale or other taxable disposition of the option shares. For federal income tax purposes, dispositions are divided into two categories: qualifying and disqualifying. A qualifying disposition generally occurs if the sale or other disposition is made more than two years after the date the option was granted and more than one year after the date the shares are transferred upon exercise. If the sale or disposition occurs before these two periods are satisfied, then a disqualifying disposition generally will result.

Upon a qualifying disposition of ISO shares, the participant will recognize long-term capital gain in an amount equal to the excess of the amount realized upon the sale or other disposition of the shares over their purchase price. If there is a disqualifying disposition of the shares, then the excess of the fair market value of the shares on the exercise date (or, if less, the price at which the shares are sold) over their purchase price will be taxable as ordinary income to the participant. If there is a disqualifying disposition in the same year of exercise, it eliminates the item of adjustment for alternative minimum tax purposes. Any additional gain or loss recognized upon the disposition will be recognized as a capital gain or loss by the participant.

We will not be entitled to any tax deduction if the participant makes a qualifying disposition of ISO shares. If the participant makes a disqualifying disposition of the shares, we should be entitled to a tax deduction for compensation expense in the amount of the ordinary income recognized by the participant.

Upon exercising or settling an SAR, a 2020 Plan participant will recognize taxable income at ordinary income tax rates, and we should be entitled to a corresponding tax deduction for compensation expense, in the amount paid or value of the shares issued upon exercise or settlement. Payments in shares will be valued at the fair market value of the shares at the time of the payment, and upon the subsequent disposition of the shares the participant will recognize a short-term or long-term capital gain or loss in the amount of the difference between the sales price of the shares and the participant’s tax basis in the shares.

 

   

Restricted stock and RSUs. A 2020 Plan participant generally will not recognize taxable income at ordinary income tax rates and we generally will not be entitled to a tax deduction upon the grant of restricted stock or RSUs. Upon the termination of restrictions on restricted stock or the payment of RSUs, the participant will recognize taxable income at ordinary income tax rates, and we should be entitled to a corresponding tax deduction for compensation expense, in the amount paid to the participant or the amount by which the then fair market value of the shares received by the participant exceeds the amount, if any, paid for them. Upon the subsequent disposition of any shares, the participant will recognize a short-term or long-term capital gain or loss in the amount of the difference between the sales price of the shares and the participant’s tax basis in the shares. However, a 2020 Plan participant granted restricted stock that is subject to forfeiture or repurchase through a vesting schedule such that it is subject to a “risk of forfeiture” (as defined in Section 83 of the Code) may make an election under Section 83(b) of the Code to recognize taxable income at ordinary income tax rates, at the time of the grant, in an amount equal to the fair market value of the shares of common stock on the date of grant, less the amount paid, if any, for such shares. We will be entitled to a corresponding tax deduction for compensation, in the amount recognized as taxable income by the participant. If a timely Section 83(b) election is made, the participant will not recognize any additional ordinary income on the termination of restrictions on restricted stock, and we will not be entitled to any additional tax deduction.

 

   

Other stock or cash-based awards. A 2020 Plan participant will not recognize taxable income and we will not be entitled to a tax deduction upon the grant of other stock or cash-based awards until cash or shares are paid or distributed to the participant. At that time, any cash payments or the fair market

 

159


Table of Contents
 

value of shares that the participant receives will be taxable to the participant at ordinary income tax rates and we should be entitled to a corresponding tax deduction for compensation expense. Payments in shares will be valued at the fair market value of the shares at the time of the payment, and upon the subsequent disposition of the shares, the participant will recognize a short-term or long-term capital gain or loss in the amount of the difference between the sales price of the shares and the participant’s tax basis in the shares.

2020 Employee Stock Purchase Plan

In connection with the Spin-Off, our board of directors will adopt, and our stockholders will approve, our 2020 Employee Stock Purchase Plan, or the ESPP, which will become effective prior to the Spin-Off upon such approval. The material terms of the ESPP are summarized below.

Shares available; administration. A total of 340,000 shares of our common stock will be initially reserved for issuance under our ESPP. In addition, the number of shares available for issuance under the ESPP will be annually increased on January 1 of each calendar year beginning in 2022 and ending in 2030, by an amount equal to the lesser of: (a) 1% of the shares outstanding on the final day of the immediately preceding calendar year and (b) such smaller number of shares as is determined by our board of directors. In no event will more than 5,000,000 shares of our common stock be available for issuance under the ESPP.

Our board of directors or its committee will have authority to interpret the terms of the ESPP and determine eligibility of participants. The compensation committee will be the initial administrator of the ESPP.

Eligibility. Our employees are eligible to participate in the ESPP if they meet the eligibility requirements under the ESPP established from time to time by the plan administrator. However, an employee may not be granted rights to purchase stock under our ESPP if such employee, immediately after the grant, would own (directly or through attribution) stock possessing 5% or more of the total combined voting power or value of all classes of our common or other class of stock.

Grant of rights. The ESPP is intended to qualify under Section 423 of the Code and stock will be offered under the ESPP during offering periods. The length of the offering periods under the ESPP will be determined by the plan administrator and may be up to 27 months long. Employee payroll deductions will be used to purchase shares on each purchase date during an offering period. The number of purchase periods within, and purchase dates during each offering period will be established by the plan administrator prior to the commencement of each offering period. Offering periods under the ESPP will commence when determined by the plan administrator. The plan administrator may, in its discretion, modify the terms of future offering periods.

The ESPP permits participants to purchase common stock through payroll deductions of up to 20% of their eligible compensation, which includes a participant’s gross base compensation for services to us, including overtime payments and excluding sales commissions, incentive compensation, bonuses, expense reimbursements, fringe benefits and other special payments. The plan administrator will establish a maximum number of shares that may be purchased by a participant during any offering period, which, in the absence of a contrary designation, will be 50,000 shares. In addition, no employee will be permitted to accrue the right to purchase stock under the ESPP at a rate in excess of $25,000 worth of shares during any calendar year during which such a purchase right is outstanding (based on the fair market value per share of our common stock as of the first day of the offering period).

On the first trading day of each offering period, each participant will automatically be granted an option to purchase shares of our common stock. The option will be exercised on the applicable purchase date(s) during the offering period, to the extent of the payroll deductions accumulated during the applicable purchase period. The purchase price of the shares, in the absence of a contrary determination by the plan administrator, will be 85% of the lower of the fair market value of our common stock on the first trading day of the offering period or on the

 

160


Table of Contents

applicable purchase date, which will be the final trading day of the applicable purchase period. Participants may voluntarily end their participation in the ESPP at any time at least one week prior to the end of the applicable offering period (or such shorter or longer period specified by the plan administrator), and will be paid their accrued payroll deductions that have not yet been used to purchase shares of common stock. Participation ends automatically upon a participant’s termination of employment.

A participant may not transfer rights granted under the ESPP other than by will, the laws of descent and distribution or as otherwise provided under the ESPP.

Certain Transactions. In the event of certain transactions or events affecting our common stock, such as any stock dividend or other distribution, change in control, reorganization, merger, consolidation or other corporate transaction, the plan administrator will make equitable adjustments to the ESPP and outstanding rights. In addition, in the event of the foregoing transactions or events or certain significant transactions, including a change in control, the plan administrator may provide for (1) either the replacement of outstanding rights with other rights or property or termination of outstanding rights in exchange for cash, (2) the assumption or substitution of outstanding rights by the successor or survivor corporation or parent or subsidiary thereof, if any, (3) the adjustment in the number and type of shares of stock subject to outstanding rights, (4) the use of participants’ accumulated payroll deductions to purchase stock on a new purchase date prior to the next scheduled purchase date and termination of any rights under ongoing offering periods, or (5) the termination of all outstanding rights. Under the ESPP, a change of control has the same definition as given to such term in the 2020 Plan.

Plan Amendment; Termination. The plan administrator may amend, suspend or terminate the ESPP at any time. However, stockholder approval of any amendment to the ESPP will be obtained for any amendment which increases the aggregate number or changes the type of shares that may be sold pursuant to rights under the ESPP, changes the corporations or classes of corporations whose employees are eligible to participate in the ESPP or changes the ESPP in any manner that would cause the ESPP to no longer be an employee stock purchase plan within the meaning of Section 423(b) of the Code. The ESPP will terminate on the tenth anniversary of the date it is initially approved by our board of directors.

This discussion may contain forward-looking statements that are based on our current plans, considerations, expectations and determinations regarding future compensation programs. Actual compensation programs that we adopt following the closing of this offering may differ materially from the currently planned programs summarized in this discussion.

Federal Income Taxes. The material federal income tax consequences of the ESPP under current federal income tax law are summarized in the following discussion, which deals with the general tax principles applicable to the ESPP. The following discussion is based upon laws, regulations, rulings and decisions now in effect, all of which are subject to change. Foreign, state and local tax laws, and employment, estate and gift tax considerations are not discussed due to the fact that they may vary depending on individual circumstances and from locality to locality.

The ESPP, and the right of participants to make purchases thereunder, is intended to qualify under the provisions of Section 423 of the Code. Under the applicable Code provisions, no income will be taxable to a participant until the sale or other disposition of the shares purchased under the ESPP. This means that an eligible employee will not recognize taxable income on the date the employee is granted an option under the ESPP (i.e., the first day of the offering period). In addition, the employee will not recognize taxable income upon the purchase of shares. Upon such sale or disposition, the participant will generally be subject to tax in an amount that depends upon the length of time such shares are held by the participant prior to disposing of them. If the shares are sold or disposed of more than two years from the first day of the offering period during which the shares were purchased and more than one year from the date of purchase, or if the participant dies while holding the shares, the participant (or his or her estate) will recognize ordinary income measured as the lesser of: (1) the

 

161


Table of Contents

excess of the fair market value of the shares at the time of such sale or disposition over the purchase price; or (2) an amount equal to 15% of the fair market value of the shares as of the first day of the offering period. Any additional gain will be treated as long-term capital gain. If the shares are held for the holding periods described above but are sold for a price that is less than the purchase price, there is no ordinary income and the participating employee has a long-term capital loss for the difference between the sale price and the purchase price.

If the shares are sold or otherwise disposed of before the expiration of the holding periods described above, the participant will recognize ordinary income generally measured as the excess of the fair market value of the shares on the date the shares are purchased over the purchase price and we will be entitled to a tax deduction for compensation expense in the amount of ordinary income recognized by the employee. Any additional gain or loss on such sale or disposition will be long-term or short-term capital gain or loss, depending on how long the shares were held following the date they were purchased by the participant prior to disposing of them. If the shares are sold or otherwise disposed of before the expiration of the holding periods described above but are sold for a price that is less than the purchase price, the participant will recognize ordinary income equal to the excess of the fair market value of the shares on the date of purchase over the purchase price (and we will be entitled to a corresponding deduction), but the participant generally will be able to report a capital loss equal to the difference between the sales price of the shares and the fair market value of the shares on the date of purchase.

 

162


Table of Contents

SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT

As of August 31, 2020, approximately 81.5% of the outstanding shares of our capital stock are beneficially owned by PDL, with the remainder being beneficially owned by certain of our directors, executive officers and other employees. After the Spin-Off, PDL will not own, directly or beneficially, any shares of our capital stock. The following table sets forth certain information with respect to the anticipated beneficial ownership of our common stock following the consummation of the Distribution for:

 

   

each of our stockholders who we believe (based on the assumptions described below) will beneficially own more than 5% of our outstanding shares of common stock;

 

   

each person who is expected to serve on our board of directors following the Spin-Off;

 

   

each of the officers named in the 2019 Summary Compensation Table in “Executive Compensation”; and

 

   

all of our directors and executive officers following the Spin-Off, as a group.

Except as otherwise noted below, we based the share amounts on each person’s beneficial ownership of PDL common stock on August 31, 2020, assuming a distribution ratio of 0.075879 shares of our common stock for every one share of PDL common stock held by such person and reflecting the one-for-nine reverse stock split of our common stock, which became effective as of September 10, 2020.

To the extent our directors and executive officers own PDL common stock on the Record Date, they will participate in the Distribution on the same terms as other holders of PDL common stock.

Unless otherwise indicated, the address of each beneficial owner listed in the table below is c/o 2800 Discovery Drive, Orlando, FL 32826.

 

Name

   Shares
Beneficially
Owned
     Percentage
of
Outstanding
Common
Stock(1)
 

5% Beneficial Owners

     

BlackRock, Inc.(2)

     817,596        7.71

Dimensional Fund Advisors LP (3)

     723,198        6.82

Renaissance Technologies LLC (4)

     619,979        5.84
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Directors and Executive Officers

     

Nicholas Curtis (5)

     624,229        5.88

Alan Connaughton (6)

     212,026        2.00

Thomas Staab (7)

     96,381        *  

Richard Lindstrom, MD (8)

     171,336        1.61

William Link, PhD (9)

     427,537        4.03

John McLaughlin (10)

     40,059        *  

Gary Winer (11)

     21,190        *  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

All executive officers and directors as a group (7 persons) (12)

     1,592,758        15.01

 

*

Represents beneficial ownership of less than 1%.

(1)

Assuming 10,609,803 LENSAR shares outstanding immediately following the separation (based on 114,111,359 PDL shares outstanding on August 31, 2020, giving effect to a distribution ratio of 0.075879 shares of LENSAR common stock for every one share of PDL common stock held by such person and reflecting the one-for-nine reverse stock split of our common stock, which became effective as of September 10, 2020). The actual number of our outstanding shares of common stock following the

 

163


Table of Contents
  distribution will be determined on the record date for the distribution. Except as otherwise noted in the footnotes below, to our knowledge the persons and entities named in the table below have sole voting and investment power with respect to all shares of common stock that they beneficially own, subject to applicable community property laws.
(2)

All information included in this footnote and table regarding the beneficial ownership of BlackRock, Inc., a Delaware corporation, is based on our review of the Schedule 13G/A filed with the SEC on February 5, 2020. BlackRock, Inc. discloses the identity of the subsidiaries that acquired the securities being reported by BlackRock, Inc. as BlackRock (Netherlands) B.V.; BlackRock Advisors, LLC; BlackRock Asset Management Canada Limited; BlackRock Asset Management Ireland Limited; BlackRock Asset Management Schweiz AG; BlackRock Financial Management, Inc.; BlackRock Fund Advisors; BlackRock Institutional Trust Company, N.A.; BlackRock Investment Management (Australia) Limited; BlackRock Investment Management (UK) Limited; and BlackRock Investment Management, LLC.

(3)

All information included in this footnote and table regarding the beneficial ownership of Dimensional Fund Advisors LP, a Delaware limited partnership, is based on our review of the Schedule 13G filed with the SEC on February 12, 2020.

(4)

All information included in this footnote and table regarding the beneficial ownership of Renaissance Technologies LLC (RTC), a Delaware limited liability company, and Renaissance Technologies Holdings Corporation (RTHC), a Delaware corporation, is based on our review of the Schedule 13G/A filed with the SEC on February 13, 2020. RTHC maintains a majority ownership of RTC.

(5)

Consists of (i) 31,854 shares of common stock, (ii) 583,109 shares of restricted stock that have not yet vested and (iii) 9,266 shares of common stock estimated to be received by Mr. Curtis in the Distribution on account of his ownership of PDL common stock.

(6)

Consists of (i) 16,050 shares of common stock and (ii) 195,976 shares of restricted stock that have not yet vested held by Mr. Connaughton.

(7)

Consists of 96,381 shares of restricted stock that have not yet vested held by Mr. Staab.

(8)

Consists of (i) 10,700 shares of common stock and (ii) 160,636 shares of restricted stock that have not yet vested held by Dr. Lindstrom.

(9)

Consists of (i) 26,750 shares of common stock and (ii) 400,787 shares of restricted stock that have not yet vested held by Dr. Link.

(10)

Consists of 40,059 shares of common stock estimated to be received by Mr. McLaughlin in the Distribution on account of his ownership of PDL common stock.

(11)

Consists of (i) 1,111 shares of common stock and (ii) 20,079 shares of restricted stock that have not yet vested held by Mr. Winer.

(12)

Consists of (i) 86,465 shares of common stock, (ii) 1,456,968 shares of restricted stock that have not yet vested and (iii) 49,325 shares of common stock estimated to be received in the Distribution held by all our current directors and executive officers as a group.

 

164


Table of Contents

CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS

Agreements between PDL and LENSAR Relating to the Spin-Off

Following the Spin-Off, we and PDL will operate independently, and neither will have any ownership interest in the other. In order to govern certain ongoing relationships between PDL and us after the Spin-Off and to provide mechanisms for an orderly transition, we and PDL intend to enter into agreements pursuant to which certain services and rights will be provided for following the Spin-Off, and we and PDL will indemnify each other against certain liabilities arising from our respective businesses, as provided for below. The following is a summary of the terms of the material agreements we expect to enter into with PDL. As is customary in spin-off transactions, the agreements between the applicable parties which serve to allocate the assets and liabilities that relate to the parties’ respective businesses do not typically expire, so that such allocation can be assured over time. Accordingly, the Separation and Distribution Agreement and the Tax Matters Agreement do not terminate upon the expiration of a specified period of time.

This summary does not purport to be complete and may not contain all of the information about these agreements that is important to you. These summaries are subject to, and qualified by reference to, the agreements described below, the form of each of which will be included as an exhibit to the registration statement on Form 10 of which this information statement is a part. You are encouraged to read each of these agreements carefully and in their entirety, as they are the primary legal documents governing the relationship between PDL and us following the Spin-Off.

Separation and Distribution Agreement

We will enter into the Separation and Distribution Agreement with PDL before the Spin-Off. The Separation and Distribution Agreement will set forth the agreements between PDL and us regarding the principal transactions necessary to separate us from PDL. It also will set forth other agreements that govern certain aspects of our relationship with PDL after the completion of the Spin-Off.

Except for matters covered by the Separation and Distribution Agreement, the Transition Services Agreement, the Tax Matters Agreement and the other transactions entered into in the ordinary course of business, any and all agreements, arrangements, commitments and understandings, between the LENSAR Entities and the PDL Entities will terminate prior to or as of the Distribution date.

In general, neither we nor PDL will make any representations or warranties regarding the transactions contemplated by the Separation and Distribution Agreement or the respective businesses, assets, liabilities, condition or prospects of PDL or us.

Distribution. On the Distribution date, PDL will distribute to its stockholders 0.075879 shares of our common stock for every one share of PDL common stock held by PDL stockholders.

Conditions. The Separation and Distribution Agreement will provide that the Distribution is subject to several conditions that must be satisfied or waived by PDL in its sole discretion. For further information regarding these conditions, see “The Spin-Off—Conditions to the Spin-Off.” Even if all of the conditions have been satisfied, PDL’s board of directors may, in its sole and absolute discretion, terminate and abandon the Distribution and the related transactions at any time prior to the Distribution date.

Removal of Guarantees and Releases from Liabilities. The Separation and Distribution Agreement will require each party to use commercially reasonable efforts to remove as the other party and its subsidiaries and affiliates as guarantor of any of the first party’s obligations. The Separation and Distribution Agreement will also provide for the settlement or extinguishment of certain liabilities and other obligations between any of the PDL Entities and any of the LENSAR Entities.

 

165


Table of Contents

Release of Claims. The Separation and Distribution Agreement will provide for a full and complete release and discharge of all liabilities existing or arising from any acts or events occurring or failing to occur or alleged to have occurred or to have failed to occur or any conditions existing or alleged to have existed at or before the effective time of the Distribution, between or among any of the PDL Entities and any of the LENSAR Entities, except as expressly set forth in the Separation and Distribution Agreement.

Indemnification. We and PDL will agree to indemnify each other and each of our and their respective affiliates and representatives, and each of the heirs, executors, successors and assigns of such representatives against all liabilities to the extent relating to or arising out of our or their respective business as conducted at any time, including any breach by such company of the Separation and Distribution Agreement, and, with respect to information contained in the registration statement on Form 10 of which this information statement is a part, any untrue statement or alleged untrue statement of a material fact or omission or alleged omission to state a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to make the statements therein not misleading, provided that PDL will agree to indemnify us solely with respect to information regarding any of the PDL Entities provided to us by any of the PDL Entities for inclusion therein.

Exchange of Information. We and PDL will agree to provide each other with information relating to the other party or the conduct of its business prior to the Spin-Off, and information reasonably necessary to prepare financial statements and any reports or filings to be made with any governmental authority. We and PDL will also agree to retain such information in accordance with our and their respective record retention policies as in effect on the date of the Separation and Distribution Agreement and to afford each other access to former and current representatives as witnesses or records as reasonably required in connection with any relevant litigation.

Further Assurances. We and PDL will agree to take all actions reasonably necessary or desirable to consummate and make effective the transactions contemplated by the Separation and Distribution Agreement and the ancillary agreements related thereto, including using commercially reasonable efforts to promptly obtain all consents and approvals, to enter into all agreements and to make all filings and applications that may be required for the consummation of such transactions.

Termination. The Separation and Distribution Agreement will provide that it may be terminated by PDL at any time prior to the Spin-Off by and in the sole discretion of PDL without our approval or the approval of the stockholders of PDL.

Transition Services Agreement

PDL provides us with certain support functions, including accounting and other financial functions. Prior to the Spin-Off and to help ensure an orderly transition, LENSAR and PDL will enter into the Transition Services Agreement, pursuant to which, in exchange for the fees specified in such agreement, PDL will continue to provide such services (through various separate work streams) to us on an interim basis, ranging in duration from two to nine months, with the majority of such services being provided for a duration of six months. We believe that the terms and conditions under the Transition Services Agreement, including the pricing, are arms’ length.

The agreed upon charges for such services are either (i) generally intended to allow PDL to recover all out-of-pocket costs and expenses, along with a pre-determined mark-up of such out-of-pocket costs and expenses or (ii) where available, a benchmark market based rate for the service. We estimate that we will pay PDL up to an aggregate of approximately $94,000 over the term of the Transition Services Agreement for the services provided thereunder. In addition, we expect the vast majority of the expenses, up to approximately $90,000, to be incurred and paid during the first six months following the Distribution. These costs are estimates and may vary based on need and the pace at which we transition from PDL.

Pursuant to the Transition Services Agreement, each of PDL and LENSAR will agree to customary confidentiality agreements regarding any confidential information of the other party received in the course of performance of the services.

 

166


Table of Contents

The Transition Services Agreement will continue in effect until the earliest of (i) the date all transition services have expired in accordance with the terms of the agreement, (ii) the date all transition services have been terminated in accordance with the terms of the agreement or (iii) the date on which the agreement is terminated as a whole. If one party defaults under the agreement, the non-defaulting party may terminate any service affected by such breach or the agreement in its entirety.

We also may incur direct fees for any additional services that we ask PDL to provide. In the event that we ask PDL to provide such additional services, we will negotiate with PDL regarding the terms and conditions for such services and the fees related thereto.

Tax Matters Agreement

In connection with the Distribution, we and PDL will enter into the Tax Matters Agreement. The Tax Matters Agreement will generally govern the respective rights, responsibilities and obligations of us and PDL with respect to tax liabilities and benefits, tax attributes, the preparation and filing of tax returns, the control of audits and other tax proceedings and certain other matters regarding taxes.

Our obligations under the Tax Matters Agreement are not limited in amount or subject to any cap. Further, even if we are not responsible for tax liabilities of PDL and its subsidiaries under the Tax Matters Agreement, we nonetheless could be liable under applicable tax law for such liabilities if PDL were to fail to pay them. If we are required to pay any liabilities under the circumstances set forth in the Tax Matters Agreement or pursuant to applicable tax law, the amounts may be significant.

Under the Tax Matters Agreement and subject to certain exceptions, we generally will be liable for, and will indemnify PDL against, taxes reported on our separate tax returns, and PDL generally will be liable for, and will indemnify us against, taxes reported on its tax returns. Each party will generally be responsible for preparing and filing its own tax returns.

Related Party Transactions

Set forth below is a description of certain relationships and related person transactions between us or our subsidiaries and our directors, executive officers and holders of more than 5% of our voting securities during the fiscal years ended December 31, 2019, 2018 and 2017. We believe that all of the following transactions were entered into with terms as favorable as could have been obtained from unaffiliated third parties in an arm’s length transaction.

Historical Relationship with PDL

From October 2013 to May 2017, PDL provided us debt financing under various credit agreements. We became a direct subsidiary of PDL as of May 11, 2017 when PDL acquired all of our outstanding equity in exchange for cancellation of PDL’s claims as a secured creditor in Chapter 11 bankruptcy proceedings. At that time, PDL also expanded the debtor-in-possession financing to a broader, secured, first priority $8.6 million term loan facility, or the Credit Agreement, to support our operations post-bankruptcy. The Credit Agreement was amended in April 2019 to increase the size of the term loan facility by an additional $17.0 million dollars, and it was further amended in April 2020 to increase the size of the term loan facility by an additional $7.0 million dollars. In July 2020, we entered into a contribution and exchange agreement with PDL, whereby we issued to PDL a total of 2,806,244 shares of our common stock in exchange for the extinguishment of the $32.6 million outstanding, including accrued interest, we owed to PDL under the Credit Agreement.

In connection with our bankruptcy proceedings, we issued to PDL an aggregate of 30,000 shares of Series A Preferred Stock for an aggregate price of approximately $30 million. The Series A Preferred Stock has an aggregate liquidation preference of $30,000, plus all accrued and unpaid dividends (whether or not declared). Dividends on each share of preferred stock initially accrued on an annual basis at a rate of 15.00% per annum of

 

167


Table of Contents

the stated value, and subsequently decreased to 5.0% per annum of the liquidation price effective January 1, 2019 as amended in December 2018. In July 2020, we exchanged all 30,000 shares of our Series A Preferred Stock, including any accrued and unpaid dividends thereon, for a total of 3,414,825 shares of our common stock. We currently do not have any shares of Series A Preferred Stock outstanding.

PDL currently provides certain corporate support services to us and costs associated with these functions historically have been charged to us. Such charges include costs related to organizational oversight, employee benefits, finance and accounting, risk management, professional services, and legal, among others. For the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018, expenses allocated to us, including those charged to us, were $4.4 million and $5.0 million, respectively. In July 2020, we issued an additional 740,740 shares of our common stock to PDL in exchange for $8.0 million. In August 2020, we received cash of $29.0 million from PDL. We issued 746,767 shares of common stock to PDL in exchange for $8.3 million. The remaining $20.7 million was a cash contribution from PDL.

In August 2020, we distributed 100% of our ownership interest in our wholly owned subsidiary, PDLIH, to PDL. PDLIH does not and did not hold any assets related to our business.

The charges described above may not necessarily be indicative of the actual expenses we would have incurred as an independent company during the periods prior to the Spin-Off or of the costs we will incur in the future. Any similar corporate support services to us provided by PDL are expected to be settled in cash after the Spin-Off pursuant to the Transition Services Agreement.

Potential Conflicts of Interest

A number of our directors and officers continue to own PDL common stock, as well as, in some cases, equity awards covering PDL stock. The direct interests of our directors and officers in common stock of PDL could create, or appear to create, potential conflicts of interest with respect to matters involving both PDL and us that could have different implications for PDL than they do for us. As a result, we may be precluded from pursuing certain opportunities on which we would otherwise act, including growth opportunities.

Following the Spin-Off, we and PDL will operate independently, and neither will have any ownership interest in the other. Our executive officers and members of our board of directors have fiduciary duties to our stockholders. Likewise, any such persons who serve in similar capacities at PDL have fiduciary duties to that company’s stockholders. Therefore, such persons may have conflicts of interest or the appearance of conflicts of interest with respect to matters involving or affecting more than one of the companies to which they owe fiduciary duties. For example, there may be the potential for a conflict of interest when we or PDL looks at acquisitions and other corporate opportunities that may be suitable for each of them. Any potential conflicts that arise will be addressed on a case-by-case basis, keeping in mind the applicable fiduciary duties owed by the directors of each issuer. From time to time, we may enter into transactions with PDL, its subsidiaries or other affiliates. There can be no assurance that the terms of any such transactions will be as favorable to us, PDL, or any of their subsidiaries or affiliates as would be the case where there is no overlapping director. See “—Policies and Procedures for Related Party Transactions” below for a discussion of certain procedures we will institute to address any such potential conflicts that may arise.

Policies and Procedures for Related Party Transactions

Our board of directors has adopted a written related person transaction policy, to be effective upon the effectiveness of the registration statement of which this information statement forms a part, setting forth the policies and procedures for the review and approval or ratification of related person transactions. This policy will cover, with certain exceptions set forth in Item 404 of Regulation S-K under the Securities Act, any transaction, arrangement or relationship, or any series of similar transactions, arrangements or relationships, in which we

 

168


Table of Contents

were or are to be a participant, where the amount involved exceeds $120,000 in any fiscal year and a related person had, has or will have a direct or indirect material interest, including without limitation, purchases of goods or services by or from the related person or entities in which the related person has a material interest, indebtedness, guarantees of indebtedness and employment by us of a related person. In reviewing and approving any such transactions, our audit committee is tasked to consider all relevant facts and circumstances, including, but not limited to, whether the transaction is on terms comparable to those that could be obtained in an arm’s length transaction and the extent of the related person’s interest in the transaction. All of the transactions described in this section occurred prior to the adoption of this policy.

Indemnification Agreements

We will enter into indemnification agreements with each of our directors and executive officers that may, in some cases, be broader than the specific indemnification provisions contained under Delaware law. Further, pursuant to our indemnification agreements and directors’ and officers’ liability insurance, our directors and executive officers are indemnified and insured against the cost of defense, settlement or payment of a judgment under certain circumstances.

 

169


Table of Contents

DESCRIPTION OF LENSAR CAPITAL STOCK

General

Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation will authorize us to issue up to 150,000,000 shares of common stock, $0.01 par value per share and up to 10,000,000 shares of preferred stock, $0.01 par value per share. The following description of our capital stock and provisions of our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws are summaries and are qualified by reference to the forms of amended and restated certificate of incorporation and the amended and restated bylaws. Copies of these documents are filed with the SEC as exhibits to our registration statement on Form 10 of which this information statement forms a part.

All of our issued and outstanding shares of common stock are duly authorized, validly issued, fully paid and nonassessable. Our shares of common stock are not redeemable and, following the Distribution, will not have preemptive rights.

Common Stock

The holders of our common stock are entitled to the following rights.

Dividend Rights

Subject to preferences that may be applicable to any then outstanding preferred stock, holders of our common stock are entitled to receive dividends, if any, as may be declared from time to time by our board of directors out of legally available funds. We have never declared or paid dividends on our common stock and currently do not anticipate paying any cash dividends after the Spin-Off or in the foreseeable future.

Voting Rights

Each holder of our common stock is entitled to one vote for each share on all matters submitted to a vote of the stockholders, including the election of directors. Our stockholders do not have cumulative voting rights in the election of directors. Accordingly, holders of a majority of the voting shares are able to elect all of the directors.

Liquidation

In the event of our liquidation, dissolution or winding up, holders of our common stock will be entitled to share ratably in the net assets legally available for distribution to stockholders after the payment of all of our debts and other liabilities and the satisfaction of any liquidation preference granted to the holders of any then outstanding shares of preferred stock.

Rights and Preferences

Holders of our common stock have no preemptive, conversion, subscription or other rights, and there are no redemption or sinking fund provisions applicable to our common stock. The rights, preferences and privileges of the holders of our common stock are subject to and may be adversely affected by, the rights of the holders of shares of any series of our preferred stock that we may designate in the future.

Preferred Stock

Upon the completion of the Distribution, our board of directors will have the authority, without further action by our stockholders, to issue up to 10,000,000 shares of preferred stock in one or more series and to fix the rights, preferences, privileges and restrictions thereof. These rights, preferences and privileges could include

 

170


Table of Contents

dividend rights, conversion rights, voting rights, terms of redemption, liquidation preferences and the number of shares constituting any series or the designation of such series, any or all of which may be greater than the rights of common stock. The issuance of our preferred stock could adversely affect the voting power of holders of common stock and the likelihood that such holders will receive dividend payments and payments upon liquidation. In addition, the issuance of preferred stock could have the effect of delaying, deferring or preventing a change of control of LENSAR or other corporate action. Upon completion of the Distribution, no shares of preferred stock will be outstanding, and we have no present plan to issue any shares of preferred stock.

Provisions of Our Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation and Amended and Restated Bylaws that May Have an Anti-Takeover Effect

Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation and Amended and Restated Bylaws

Certain provisions of our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws that are summarized below may be deemed to have an anti-takeover effect and may delay, deter or prevent a tender offer or takeover attempt that a stockholder might consider to be in its best interests, including attempts that might result in a premium being paid over the market price for the shares held by stockholders.

Among other things, our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws:

 

   

establish a classified board of directors, with three classes of directors;

 

   

authorize the issuance of blank check preferred stock that our board of directors could issue to increase the number of outstanding shares and to discourage a takeover attempt;

 

   

limit the ability of stockholders to remove directors, such that directors can only be removed for cause, and a supermajority stockholder vote is required to remove directors;

 

   

prohibit our stockholders from calling a special meeting of stockholders;

 

   

prohibit stockholder action by written consent, which requires all stockholder actions to be taken at a meeting of our stockholders;

 

   

provide for plurality voting in the election of directors;

 

   

require that all board of directors vacancies resulting from the expansion of the board of directors or the resignation, death or removal of a director be filled by the board of directors;

 

   

provide that the board of directors is expressly authorized to adopt, alter or repeal our bylaws;

 

   

require a 66 2/3% vote of stockholders, voting together as a single class, to amend the provisions of our amended and restated bylaws and certain provisions of our amended and restated certificate of incorporation; and

 

   

establish advance notice requirements for nominations for election to our board of directors or for proposing matters that can be acted upon by stockholders at stockholder meetings.

The foregoing provisions of our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws could discourage potential acquisition proposals and could delay or prevent a change in control. These provisions are intended to enhance the likelihood of continuity and stability in the composition of the board of directors and in the policies formulated by our board of directors and to discourage certain types of transactions that may involve an actual or threatened change of control. These provisions are designed to reduce our vulnerability to an unsolicited acquisition proposal. The provisions also are intended to discourage certain tactics that may be used in proxy fights. However, such provisions could have the effect of discouraging others from making tender offers for our shares and, as a consequence, they also may inhibit fluctuations in the market price of our common stock that could result from actual or rumored takeover attempts. Such provisions also may have the effect of preventing changes in our management.

 

171


Table of Contents

Finally, our amended and restated certificate of incorporation will provide that, unless we consent in writing to the selection of an alternative forum, to the fullest extent permitted by law, the Court of Chancery of the State of Delaware will be the sole and exclusive forum for: (i) any derivative action or proceeding brought on behalf of us; (ii) any action asserting a claim of breach of a fiduciary duty owed by any of our directors, officers or other employees or agents to us or our stockholders; (iii) any action asserting a claim against us arising pursuant to any provision of the Delaware General Corporation Law or our amended and restated certificate of incorporation or amended and restated bylaws; or (iv) any action asserting a claim against us governed by the internal affairs doctrine; provided that, the exclusive forum provision will not apply to suits brought to enforce any liability or duty created by the Exchange Act or any other claim for which the federal courts have exclusive jurisdiction; and provided further that, if and only if the Court of Chancery of the State of Delaware dismisses any such action for lack of subject matter jurisdiction, such action may be brought in another state or federal court sitting in the State of Delaware. Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation will also provide that the federal district courts of the United States of America will be the exclusive forum for the resolution of any complaint asserting a cause of action against us or any of our directors, officers, employees or agents and arising under the Securities Act. The enforceability of similar choice of forum provisions in other companies’ certificates of incorporation has been challenged in legal proceedings, and it is possible that, in connection with any action, a court could find the choice of forum provisions contained in our amended and restated certificate of incorporation to be inapplicable or unenforceable in such action.

Delaware Takeover Statute

Subject to certain exceptions, Section 203 prohibits a Delaware corporation from engaging in any “business combination” with any “interested stockholder” for a period of three years following the date that such stockholder became an interested stockholder, unless: (i) prior to such date, the board of directors of the corporation approved either the business combination or the transaction that resulted in the stockholder becoming an interested stockholder; (ii) on consummation of the transaction that resulted in the stockholder becoming an interested stockholder, the interested stockholder owned at least 85% of the voting stock of the corporation outstanding at the time the transaction commenced, excluding for purposes of determining the number of shares outstanding those shares owned (a) by persons who are directors and also officers and (b) by employee stock plans in which employee participants do not have the right to determine confidentially whether shares held subject to the plan will be tendered in a tender or exchange offer; or (iii) on or subsequent to such date, the business combination is approved by the board of directors and authorized at an annual or special meeting of stockholders, and not by written consent, by the affirmative vote of at least 66 2/3% of the outstanding voting stock that is not owned by the interested stockholder.

In our amended and restated certificate of incorporation, we do not elect “opt out” of being governed by Section 203 of the DGCL, as permitted under and pursuant to subsection (b)(3) of Section 203. Accordingly, we will be governed by Section 203 of the DGCL.

Listing

We have applied to list our common stock on the Nasdaq Capital Market under the symbol “LNSR.”

Transfer Agent and Registrar

The transfer agent and registrar for our common stock is Computershare Trust Company, N.A. at (877) 424-4271.

 

172


Table of Contents

RECENT SALES OF UNREGISTERED SECURITIES

In the three years preceding the date of this registration statement, we have issued to our employees, officers and directors an aggregate of 119,871 shares as part of our Phantom Stock Plan. For more information about the Phantom Stock Plan, see “Executive Compensation—Incentive Award Plans.”

Since July 2017, we have issued and sold the following securities:

 

  1.

In July 2020, in connection with the exchange of our 30,000 Series A Preferred Stock, including any accrued and unpaid dividends thereon, we issued 3,414,825 shares of our common stock to PDL.

 

  2.

In July 2020, in connection with the contribution and exchange agreement with PDL, we exchanged $32.6 million outstanding under our Credit Agreement for 2,806,244 shares of our common stock issued to PDL.

 

  3.

In July 2020, we completed the sale of an aggregate of 740,740 shares of our common stock to PDL for an aggregate purchase price of approximately $8.0 million.

 

  4.

In July 2020, we granted restricted stock awards covering an aggregate of 1,847,298 shares under our 2020 Plan to our employees, consultants and directors.

 

  5.

In August 2020, we completed the sale of an aggregate of 746,767 shares of our common stock to PDL for a purchase price of approximately $8.3 million.

The issuances of securities described above were pursuant to Section 4(a)(2) or Rule 701 under the Securities Act, relative to transactions by an issuer not involving any public offering, to the extent an exemption from such registration was required.

None of the transactions set forth in Item 15 involved any underwriters, underwriting discounts or commissions or any public offering. All recipients had adequate access, through their relationships with us, to information about us. The sales of these securities were made without any general solicitation or advertising.

 

173


Table of Contents

INDEMNIFICATION AND LIMITATION OF LIABILITY OF DIRECTORS AND OFFICERS

We are governed by the Delaware General Corporation Law, or DGCL. Section 145 of the DGCL provides that a corporation may indemnify any person, including an officer or director, who was or is, or is threatened to be made, a party to any threatened, pending or completed legal action, suit or proceeding, whether civil, criminal, administrative or investigative (other than an action by or in the right of such corporation), by reason of the fact that such person was or is an officer, director, employee or agent of such corporation or is or was serving at the request of such corporation as a director, officer, employee or agent of another corporation or enterprise. The indemnity may include expenses (including attorneys’ fees), judgments, fines and amounts paid in settlement actually and reasonably incurred by such person in connection with such action, suit or proceeding, provided such officer, director, employee or agent acted in good faith and in a manner such person reasonably believed to be in, or not opposed to, the corporation’s best interest and, for criminal proceedings, had no reasonable cause to believe that such person’s conduct was unlawful. A Delaware corporation may indemnify any person, including an officer or director, who was or is, or is threatened to be made, a party to any threatened, pending or contemplated action or suit by or in the right of such corporation, under the same conditions, except that such indemnification is limited to expenses (including attorneys’ fees) actually and reasonably incurred by such person, and except that no indemnification is permitted without judicial approval if such person is adjudged to be liable to such corporation. Where an officer or director of a corporation is successful, on the merits or otherwise, in the defense of any action, suit or proceeding referred to above, or any claim, issue or matter therein, the corporation must indemnify that person against the expenses (including attorneys’ fees) which such officer or director actually and reasonably incurred in connection therewith.

Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws will authorize the indemnification of our officers and directors, consistent with Section 145 of the DGCL.

Reference is made to Section 102(b)(7) of the DGCL, which enables a corporation in its original certificate of incorporation or an amendment thereto to eliminate or limit the personal liability of a director for violations of the director’s fiduciary duty, except (i) for any breach of the director’s duty of loyalty to the corporation or its stockholders, (ii) for acts or omissions not in good faith or which involve intentional misconduct or a knowing violation of law, (iii) pursuant to Section 174 of the DGCL, which provides for liability of directors for unlawful payments of dividends of unlawful stock purchase or redemptions or (iv) for any transaction from which a director derived an improper personal benefit.

We expect to enter into indemnification agreements with each of our directors and officers. These indemnification agreements may require us, among other things, to indemnify our directors and officers for some expenses, including attorneys’ fees, judgments, fines and settlement amounts incurred by a director or officer in any action or proceeding arising out of his or her service as one of our directors or officers, or any of our subsidiaries or any other company or enterprise to which the person provides services at our request.

We maintain a general liability insurance policy that covers certain liabilities of directors and officers of our corporation arising out of claims based on acts or omissions in their capacities as directors or officers.

 

174


Table of Contents

WHERE YOU CAN FIND MORE INFORMATION

We have filed a registration statement on Form 10 with the SEC with respect to the shares of our common stock being distributed as contemplated by this information statement. This information statement, which constitutes a part of the registration statement on Form 10, does not contain all of the information set forth in the registration statement on Form 10 or the exhibits and schedules filed therewith. For further information about us and the common stock offered hereby, we refer you to the registration statement on Form 10 and the exhibits and schedules filed thereto. Statements contained in this information statement regarding the contents of any contract or any other document that is filed as an exhibit to the registration statement on Form 10 are not necessarily complete, and each such statement is qualified in all respects by reference to the full text of such contract or other document filed as an exhibit to the registration statement on Form 10. Following the Distribution, we will be required to file periodic reports, proxy statements and other information with the SEC pursuant to the Exchange Act. You may read and copy this information at the Public Reference Room of the SEC, 100 F Street, N.E., Room 1580, Washington, D.C. 20549. You may obtain information on the operation of the Public Reference Room by calling the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330. The SEC also maintains a website at www.sec.gov that contains reports, proxy statements and other information about issuers, like us, that file electronically with the SEC. Information contained on any website referenced in this information statement does not and will not constitute a part of this information statement or the registration statement on Form 10 of which this information statement is a part.

Information that we file with the SEC after the date of this information statement may supersede the information in this information statement. You may read these reports, proxy statements and other information and obtain copies of such documents and information as described above. You should rely only on the information contained in this information statement or to which we have referred you. We have not authorized any person to provide you with different information or to make any representation not contained in this information statement. Neither the delivery of this information statement nor any distribution of securities made hereunder shall imply that there has been no change in the information set forth or in our affairs since the date hereof.

 

175


Table of Contents

LENSAR, Inc.

INDEX TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

As of December 31, 2019 and 2018 and for the Years Ended December 31, 2019 and 2018

 

AUDITED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

  

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

     F-2  

STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS

     F-3  

BALANCE SHEETS

     F-4  

STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

     F-5  

STATEMENT OF CHANGES IN STOCKHOLDERS’ DEFICIT

     F-7  

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

     F-8  

As of December 31, 2019 and June 30, 2020 and for the Six Months Ended June 30, 2020 and 2019 (Unaudited)

 

UNAUDITED CONDENSED INTERIM FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

  

CONDENSED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS (UNAUDITED)

     F-37  

CONDENSED BALANCE SHEETS (UNAUDITED)

     F-38  

CONDENSED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS (UNAUDITED)

     F-39  

CONDENSED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS, continued (UNAUDITED)

     F-40  

CONDENSED STATEMENT OF CHANGES IN STOCKHOLDERS’ DEFICIT (UNAUDITED)

     F-41  

NOTES TO CONDENSED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (UNAUDITED)

     F-42  

 

F-1

 


Table of Contents

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

To the Board of Directors and Stockholders of LENSAR, Inc.

Opinion on the Financial Statements

We have audited the accompanying balance sheets of LENSAR, Inc. (the “Company”) as of December 31, 2019 and 2018, and the related statements of operations, of changes in stockholders’ deficit and of cash flows for the years then ended, including the related notes (collectively referred to as the “financial statements”). In our opinion, the financial statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Company as of December 31, 2019 and 2018, and the results of its operations and its cash flows for the years then ended in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.

Change in Accounting Principle

As discussed in Note 2 to the financial statements, the Company changed the manner in which it accounts for leases in 2019.

Basis for Opinion

These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s financial statements based on our audits. We are a public accounting firm registered with the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (PCAOB) and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.

We conducted our audits of these financial statements in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB and in accordance with auditing standards generally accepted in the United States of America. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement, whether due to error or fraud.

Our audits included performing procedures to assess the risks of material misstatement of the financial statements, whether due to error or fraud, and performing procedures that respond to those risks. Such procedures included examining, on a test basis, evidence regarding the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. Our audits also included evaluating the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the financial statements. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

Emphasis of Matter

As discussed in Note 1 to the financial statements, the Company has incurred recurring losses and operating cash outflows since its inception and COVID-19 has adversely affected the Company’s results of operations, financial condition and cash flows. Management’s evaluation of the events and conditions and management’s plans to mitigate these matters have been described in Note 1.

/s/ PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP

Orlando, Florida

June 19, 2020, except for the effects of the distribution of LENSAR, Inc.’s ownership interest in PDL Investment Holdings, LLC. to PDL BioPharma, Inc. described in Note 1, as to which the date is August 25, 2020, and except for the effects of the reverse stock split described in Note 17 as to which the date is September 14, 2020

We have served as the Company’s auditor since 2020.

 

F-2

 


Table of Contents

LENSAR, Inc.

STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS

(In thousands, except share and per share amounts)

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
     2019     2018  

Revenue

    

Product

   $ 23,254     $ 17,239  

Lease

     4,181       4,567  

Service

     3,093       2,582  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total revenue

     30,528       24,388  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cost of revenue (exclusive of amortization)

    

Product

     12,030       8,315  

Lease

     2,264       2,854  

Service

     3,005       2,471  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total cost of revenue

     17,299       13,640  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating expenses

    

Selling, general and administrative expenses

     17,147       16,143  

Research and development expenses

     7,569       2,784  

Amortization of intangible assets

     1,227       1,137  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating loss

     (12,714     (9,316
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other income (expense)

    

Interest expense

     (2,001     (3,321

Other income, net

     58       64  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loss before income taxes

     (14,657     (12,573

Income tax expense

     —         20  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loss

   $ (14,657   $ (12,593
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cumulative dividends in excess of interest expense on mandatorily redeemable preferred stock

     —         (1,451
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loss attributable to common stockholders

   $ (14,657   $ (14,044
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loss per share attributable to common stockholders

    

Basic and diluted

   $ (13.70   $ (13.13
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Weighted-average number of shares used in calculation of net loss per share:

    

Basic and diluted

     1,070,000       1,070,000  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements

 

F-3

 


Table of Contents

LENSAR, Inc.

BALANCE SHEETS

(In thousands, except share and per share amounts)

 

     As of December 31,  
     2019     2018  

Assets

    

Current assets:

    

Cash

   $ 4,615     $ 3,344  

Accounts receivable, net

     3,384       3,302  

Notes receivable, net

     502       472  

Inventories

     8,064       4,062  

Prepaid and other current assets

     618       567  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current assets

     17,183       11,747  

Property and equipment, net

     720       699  

Equipment under lease, net

     1,431       2,917  

Notes and other receivables, long-term, net

     827       753  

Intangible assets, net

     13,366       12,293  

Other assets

     1,009       476  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets

   $ 34,536     $ 28,885  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Liabilities and stockholders’ deficit

    

Current liabilities:

    

Accounts payable

   $ 1,577     $ 1,412  

Accrued liabilities

     4,778       3,623  

Deferred revenue

     777       871  

Contingent consideration

     —         1,071  

Other current liabilities

     697       683
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current liabilities

     7,829       7,660  

Long-term operating lease liabilities

     333       —    

Note payable due to related party

     20,200       6,321  

Mandatorily redeemable preferred stock

     36,417       34,890  

Other long-term liabilities

     310       479  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

     65,089       49,350  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Commitments and contingencies (Note 11)

    

Stockholders’ deficit:

    

Common stock, par value $0.01 per share, 9,630,000 shares authorized, 1,070,000 shares issued and outstanding at December 31, 2019 and 2018, respectively

     11       11  

Additional paid-in capital

     7,621       3,052  

Accumulated deficit

     (38,185     (23,528
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total stockholders’ deficit

     (30,553     (20,465
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities and stockholders’ deficit

   $ 34,536   $ 28,885  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements

 

F-4

 


Table of Contents

LENSAR, Inc.

STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

(In thousands)

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
           2019                 2018        

Cash flows from operating activities

    

Net loss

   $ (14,657   $ (12,593

Adjustments to reconcile net loss to net cash used in operating activities:

    

Depreciation

     2,639       3,453  

Amortization of intangible assets

     1,227       1,137  

Non-cash operating lease cost

     537       —    

Provision for bad debts

     (78     8  

Loss on disposal of property and equipment

     —         66  

Stock-based compensation expense

     102       123  

Changes in operating assets and liabilities:

    

Accounts receivable, net

     14       443  

Prepaid and other current assets

     (51     (5

Inventories

     (4,773     (876

Accounts payable

     127       663  

Accrued liabilities

     1,929       3,024  

Other

     395       2,672  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash used in operating activities

     (12,589     (1,885
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash flows from investing activities

    

Acquisition of intangibles

     (1,700     (2,092

Payment of contingent consideration

     —         (644

Purchase of property and equipment

     (389     (1,156
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash used in investing activities

     (2,089     (3,892
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash flows from financing activities

    

Contributions from PDL

     3,826       3,867  

Distributions to PDL

     (31     (198

Proceeds from notes payable

     13,225       3,500  

Payment of contingent consideration

     (1,071     (214
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash provided by financing activities

     15,949       6,955  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net increase in cash and restricted cash

     1,271       1,178  

Cash and restricted cash at beginning of the year(1)

     3,444       2,266  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash and restricted cash at end the year(2)

   $ 4,715     $ 3,444  

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements

 

(1)

Includes restricted cash of $100 as of December 31, 2018 and 2017, respectively.

(2)

Includes restricted cash of $100 as of December 31, 2019 and 2018, respectively.

The restricted cash balance is included as part of Other assets in the Balance Sheets.

 

F-5

 


Table of Contents

LENSAR, Inc.

STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS, continued

(In thousands)

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
           2019                  2018        

Supplemental cash flow information

     

Cash paid for income taxes

   $ —        $ —    

Cash paid for interest

   $ 473      $ 272  

Supplemental schedule of non-cash investing and financing activities

     

Transfer to equipment under lease, net

   $ 745      $ 284  

Phantom stock liability settled with common stock

   $ 784      $ —    

Contingent consideration related to asset acquisition

   $ —        $ 1,929  

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements

 

F-6

 


Table of Contents

LENSAR, Inc.

STATEMENT OF CHANGES IN STOCKHOLDERS’ DEFICIT

(In thousands, except share and per share amounts)

 

     Common Stock      Additional
Paid-in
Capital
    Accumulated
Deficit
    Total
Stockholders’
Deficit
 
     Shares      Amount  

Balance as of December 31, 2017

     1,070,000      $ 11      $ (818   $ (10,973   $ (11,780

Impact of adoption of ASC 606

     —          —          —         38       38  

Net loss

     —          —          —         (12,593     (12,593

Contributions from PDL

     —          —          3,989       —         3,989  

Distributions to PDL

     —          —          (119     —         (119
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance as of December 31, 2018

     1,070,000        11        3,052       (23,528     (20,465

Net loss

     —          —          —         (14,657     (14,657

Contributions from PDL

     —          —          3,928       —         3,928  

Distributions to PDL

     —          —          (143     —         (143

Settlement of phantom stock-based awards

     —          —          784       —         784  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance as of December 31, 2019

     1,070,000      $ 11      $ 7,621     $ (38,185   $ (30,553

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements

 

F-7

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(In thousands, except share and per share amounts)

Note 1. Overview and Basis of Presentation

Overview and Organization

LENSAR, Inc. (“LENSAR” or the “Company”) is a global medical device business focused on the design, development and commercialization of advanced technology for the treatment of cataracts and management of astigmatisms to achieve improved vision outcomes for patients. The Company’s revenue is derived from the sale and lease of the LENSAR Laser System, which may include equipment, a consumable referred to as the Patient Interface Devices (“PIDs”), procedure licenses, training, installation, limited warranty and maintenance agreements through extended warranty.

The Company’s parent entity, PDL BioPharma, Inc. (“PDL” or the “Parent”) intends to pursue a separation and distribution of its medical device segment, which is solely comprised of its majority owned subsidiary LENSAR. The proposed separation and distribution is intended to take the form of a spin-off and result in LENSAR becoming a stand-alone publicly traded company.

The Company has incurred recurring losses and operating cash outflows since its inception and as of December 31, 2019 had an accumulated deficit of $38,185. The Company expects to continue to incur losses and cash outflows from operating activities for the foreseeable future. In addition, the Company’s results of operations, financial condition and cash flows have been adversely affected by the COVID-19 pandemic. Refer to Note 17, Subsequent Events for further information. Accordingly, the Company does not currently have, nor does it expect to generate from operations, adequate liquidity to fund its operations for the next twelve months. To alleviate such conditions, PDL has committed that through June 20, 2021 it will provide financial support of up to $20,000 to support the operating, investing and financing activities of the Company. In addition, during this period, PDL will not accelerate repayment of any loans between the Company and PDL. Accordingly, management believes that cash on hand and the financial support from PDL will provide sufficient liquidity to meet the Company’s projected obligations for at least twelve months from June 19, 2020, the date these financial statements were issued.

Basis of Presentation

These financial statements have been prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles in the United States of America (“U.S. GAAP”) and pursuant to the regulations of the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”).

These financial statements were prepared on a stand-alone basis derived from the consolidated financial statements and accounting records of PDL and are presented as if LENSAR had been operating as a stand-alone company for all years presented. These financial statements exclude the assets, liabilities, revenue and expenses directly attributable to LENSAR’s wholly owned subsidiary, PDL Investment Holdings, LLC (“PDLIH”). On August 20, 2020, the Company distributed 100% of its ownership interest in its wholly owned subsidiary, PDLIH, to PDL.

The assets, liabilities, revenue and expenses directly attributable to the Company’s operations have been reflected in these financial statements on a historical cost basis, as included in the consolidated financial statements of PDL. The statements of operations include expenses for certain corporate support functions that are provided by the Parent such as administration and organizational oversight; including employee benefits, finance and accounting, treasury and risk management, professional and legal services, among others. These expenses have been allocated to the Company on the basis of direct usage when identifiable, with the remainder allocated on a proportional basis of expenses of the Company and the Parent. Management of the Company and Parent considered the basis on which the expenses have been allocated to be a reasonable reflection of the utilization of services provided to or the benefit received by the Company during the periods presented. These allocations may

 

F-8

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(In thousands, except share and per share amounts)

 

not be reflective of the expenses that would have been incurred had the Company operated as a separate, unaffiliated entity apart from PDL. Actual costs that would have been incurred if LENSAR had been a stand-alone, public company would depend on multiple factors, including the chosen organizational structure and strategic decisions made in various areas, including information technology and infrastructure. Following a separation, the Company expects to perform these functions using its own resources or purchased services. For an interim period, however, some of these functions may continue to be provided by the Parent as the Company may enter into one or more transition service agreements with the Parent in connection with a separation.

The Company was historically funded as part of the Parent’s treasury program. Cash and restricted cash managed through bank accounts legally owned by the Parent at the corporate level were not attributable to the Company for any of the periods presented. Only cash and restricted cash legally owned by the Company are reflected in the balance sheets. All significant transactions between the Company and the Parent are considered to be effectively settled for cash at the time the transaction is recorded, unless otherwise noted. Such transfers of cash to and from PDL have been included in these financial statements as a component of equity in the balance sheets and as a financing activity in the statements of cash flows, unless otherwise noted.

The Parent’s third-party debt has not been attributed and the related interest expense has not been allocated to the Company for any of the periods presented, as the Company was not the legal obligor of the debt and the Parent’s borrowings were not directly attributable to the Company’s business.

During the periods presented in these financial statements, the operations of the Company were included in the consolidated U.S. federal and state income tax returns filed by the Parent. Income tax expense and other income tax related information contained in the financial statements are presented on a separate return basis as if the Company had filed its own tax returns. The deferred income taxes of the Company as presented in these financial statements, including tax attributes such as net operating losses or credit carryforwards, may not be indicative of the deferred tax assets available to the Company in the future. The Company’s uncertain tax positions recorded under the separate return method may also differ from those recorded in the PDL financial statements. See Note 14 for more information.

Note 2. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies

Accounting Estimates

The preparation of financial statements in conformity with U.S. GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the amounts reported in the financial statements and accompanying notes to the financial statements. The accounting estimates that require management’s most significant, difficult and subjective judgments include, but are not limited to, cost allocations from the Parent, revenue recognition and allowance for doubtful accounts, the valuation of notes receivable and inventory, the assessment of recoverability of intangible assets and their estimated useful lives, the valuation and recognition of stock-based compensation, operating lease right-of-use assets and liabilities, and the recognition and measurement of current and deferred income tax assets and liabilities. Furthermore, the impact on accounting estimates and judgments on the Company’s financial condition and results of operations due to COVID-19 has introduced additional uncertainties. Actual results could differ from these estimates.

Segments

Operating segments are defined as components of an entity for which separate financial information is available and that is regularly reviewed by the Chief Operating Decision Maker (“CODM”) in deciding how to allocate resources to an individual segment and in assessing performance. The Company’s CODM is its Chief

 

F-9

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(In thousands, except share and per share amounts)

 

Executive Officer. The Company has determined that it operates in one operating segment and one reportable segment, as the CODM reviews financial information presented on an entity-wide basis for purposes of making operating decisions, allocating resources, and evaluating financial performance. As of December 31, 2019, and 2018, 98% and 95% of long-lived assets were in the United States, respectively. Revenue is attributed to a geographic region based on the location of the customer.

Restricted Cash

Restricted cash primarily consists of funds reserved for bank business credit card service. The Company had $100 restricted cash as of December 31, 2019 and 2018. Restricted cash balances are included in other assets within the Company’s balance sheets.

Accounts Receivable

The Company had no allowance for doubtful accounts as of December 31, 2019 and $78 as of December 31, 2018. The Company provides an allowance for doubtful accounts based on experience and specifically identified risks. Accounts receivable are carried at estimated net realizable value and charged off against the allowance for doubtful accounts when the Company determines that recovery is unlikely, and the Company ceases collection efforts.

Fair Value Measurement

The fair value of the Company’s financial instruments are estimates of the amounts that would be received if the Company were to sell an asset or the Company paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date or exit price. The assets and liabilities are categorized and disclosed in one of the following three categories:

 

   

Level 1—based on quoted market prices in active markets for identical assets and liabilities.

 

   

Level 2—based on observable inputs other than quoted prices in active markets for identical assets and liabilities, quoted prices for identical or similar assets or liabilities in inactive markets, or other inputs that are or can be corroborated by observable market data for substantially the full term of the assets or liabilities.

 

   

Level 3—based on unobservable inputs using management’s best estimate and assumptions when inputs are unavailable.

Fair value measurements are classified in their entirety based on the lowest level of input that is significant to their fair value measurement.

The carrying value of the Company’s cash, accounts receivable, accounts payable, accrued liabilities, and other current liabilities approximate fair value based on the short-term maturities of these instruments. The carrying value of the Company’s notes receivable also approximates fair value based on the associated credit risk.

Inventory

Inventory, which consists of raw materials, work-in-process and finished goods, is stated at the lower of cost or net realizable value. The Company determines cost using standard costs which approximates actual costs determined on the first-in, first-out basis. Inventory levels are analyzed periodically and written down to their net

 

F-10

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(In thousands, except share and per share amounts)

 

realizable value if they have become obsolete, have a cost basis in excess of expected net realizable value or are in excess of expected requirements. The Company analyzes current and future product demand relative to the remaining product shelf life to identify potential excess inventory. The Company builds demand forecasts by considering factors such as, but not limited to, overall market potential, market share, market acceptance and patient usage. The Company classifies inventory as current on the balance sheets when the Company expects inventory to be consumed for commercial use within the next twelve months.

Intangible Assets

Intangible assets with finite useful lives consist primarily of acquired product rights, acquired technology, and customer relationships. Acquired product rights and acquired technology are amortized on a straight-line basis over their estimated useful lives of 15 to 20 years. Customer relationships are amortized on a straight-line basis or a double declining basis over their estimated useful lives up to 20 years, based on the method that better represents the economic benefits to be obtained. The estimated useful lives associated with finite-lived intangible assets are consistent with the estimated lives of the associated products and may be modified when circumstances warrant. Such assets are reviewed for impairment when events or circumstances indicate that the carrying value of an asset may not be recoverable. An impairment loss would be recognized when estimated undiscounted future cash flows expected to result from the use of an asset and its eventual disposition are less than its carrying amount. The Company has not recorded any impairment of its intangible assets for the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018.

Property and Equipment

Property and equipment is stated at cost less accumulated depreciation. Depreciation is calculated using the straight-line method over the following estimated useful lives:

 

Leasehold improvements

   Lesser of useful life or term of lease

Manufacturing equipment

   3-5 years

Computer and office equipment

   3 years

Transportation equipment

   3 years

Furniture and fixtures

   7 years

Equipment Under Lease

Equipment under lease is related to LENSAR laser systems which are leased to customers instead of sold. Equipment under operating lease is stated at cost less accumulated depreciation and is classified as equipment under lease, net on the balance sheets. Depreciation is computed using the straight-line method over an estimated useful life of the greater of the lease term or five years to ten years.

Note Payable Due to Related Party

Amounts loaned to the Company from PDL relate to funding the Company’s operations and are carried at the principal amount borrowed and accrued interest using the effective interest method. Balances that are due to PDL are to be cash settled and have been included in the balance sheets. Cash proceeds received from the Parent to fund the Company’s operations have been classified in the statements of cash flows as financing activities.

Mandatorily Redeemable Preferred Stock

The Company assessed the preferred stock’s provisions including redemption rights, dividends, voting rights and covenants to determine the classification of redeemable preferred stock. The Company’s preferred

 

F-11

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(In thousands, except share and per share amounts)

 

stock is mandatorily redeemable with cumulative dividends at a fixed rate and is to be cash settled at redemption. Therefore, LENSAR’s preferred stock is classified as a liability in the balance sheets and accreted to the redemption value at redemption using the effective interest method. Refer to Note 10, Mandatorily Redeemable Preferred Stock.

Revenue Recognition

The reported results for 2019 and 2018 reflect the application of ASC 606, Revenue from Contracts with Customers (“ASC 606”). The Company adopted ASC 606 on January 1, 2018 using the modified retrospective method for all contracts not substantially completed as of the date of adoption. ASC 340-40, Contracts with customers (“ASC 340”) was adopted on the same date and using the same methodology as ASC 606. The standard changes the Company’s accounting treatment for incremental costs to obtain a contract, including sales commissions. Historically, the Company expensed incremental costs to obtain a contract as incurred. Under ASC 606 and ASC 340, the Company capitalizes sales commissions when the associated revenue is expected to be earned over a period that exceeds one year. The cumulative impact of the adoption of $38 was recorded to retained earnings as of January 1, 2018.

Policy Elections and Practical Expedients Taken

Upon the Company’s adoption of ASC 606, the Company applied the following policy elections:

Taxes assessed by a governmental authority that are both imposed on and concurrent with a specific revenue-producing transaction, that are collected by the Company from a customer, are excluded from revenue.

The Company has elected to apply the practical expedient that allows an entity to not adjust the promised amount of consideration in customer contracts for the effect of a significant financing component when the period between the transfer of product and services and payment of the related consideration is less than one year.

Shipping and handling costs associated with outbound freight after control over a product has transferred to a customer are accounted for as a fulfillment cost and are included in cost of product revenue. Shipping and handling costs for the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018 were $100 and $150, respectively.

General

In accordance with ASC 606, revenue is recognized from the sale of products and services when the Company transfers control of such promised products and services. The amount of revenue recognized reflects the consideration to which LENSAR expects to be entitled to receive in exchange for these products and services. A five-step model is utilized to achieve the core principle and includes the following steps: (1) identify the customer contract; (2) identify the contract’s performance obligations; (3) determine the transaction price; (4) allocate the transaction price to the performance obligations; and (5) recognize revenue when the performance obligations are satisfied.

LENSAR principally derives its revenue from the sale and lease of the LENSAR Laser System and the sale of other related products and services, including PIDs, procedure licenses, and extended warranty service agreements. Most customers are on pre-paid or 30-day payment terms, depending on the product purchased. Typically, returns are not allowed.

Judgment is required to determine the level of interdependency between the LENSAR Laser System and the sale of other related products and services. For bundled packages, which include the sale or lease of a LENSAR Laser System and provision of other products and services, the Company accounts for individual products and

 

F-12

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(In thousands, except share and per share amounts)

 

services separately if they are distinct—i.e. if a product or service is separately identifiable from other items in the bundled package and if the customer can benefit from it on its own or with other resources that are readily available to the customer. The LENSAR Laser System, training and installation services are one performance obligation. The other products and services, including PIDs, procedure licenses, and extended warranty services, which are either sold together with the LENSAR Laser System or on a standalone basis, are all accounted for as separate performance obligations. The transaction price of bundled packages is allocated to each performance obligation on a relative standalone selling price basis. Standalone selling prices are based on observable prices at which the Company separately sells the products or services. If a standalone selling price is not directly observable, the Company estimates the selling price using available observable information.

The Company recognizes revenue as the performance obligations are satisfied by transferring control of the product or service to a customer, as described below.

Product Revenue. The Company recognizes revenue for the sale of the following products at a point in time:

Equipment. The Company’s LENSAR Laser System sales are recognized as Product revenue when the Company transfers control of the system. This usually occurs after the customer signs a contract, LENSAR installs the system, and LENSAR performs the requisite training for use of the system for direct customers. LENSAR Laser System sales to distributors are recognized as revenue upon shipment as they do not require training and installation.

PID and Procedure Licenses. The LENSAR Laser System requires both a PID and a procedure license to perform each procedure. The Company recognizes Product revenue for PIDs when the Company transfers control of the PID. The Company recognizes Product revenue for procedure licenses at the point in time when control of the procedure license is transferred to the customer. A procedure license represents a one-time right to utilize the LENSAR Laser System surgical application in connection with a surgery procedure. For the sale of PIDs and procedure licenses, the Company may offer volume discounts to certain customers. To determine the amount of revenue that should be recognized at the time control over these products transfers to the customer, the Company estimates the average per unit price, net of discounts.

Service Revenue. The Company offers an extended warranty that provides additional maintenance services beyond the standard limited warranty. The Company recognizes Service revenue from the sale of extended warranties over the warranty period on a ratable basis as the Company stands ready to provide services as needed. Customers have the option of renewing the warranty period, which is considered a new and separate contract.

Lease Revenue. For LENSAR Laser System operating leases, the Company recognizes lease revenue over the length of the lease in accordance with ASC Topic 840, Leases, through December 31, 2018 and recognizes lease revenue in accordance with ASC Topic 842, Leases, after January 1, 2019. For additional information regarding accounting for leases, see the Leases section within this footnote below and Note 6, Leases.

Contract Costs

The Company offers a variety of commission plans to the Company’s salesforce. Certain compensation under these plans is earned by sales representatives solely as a result of obtaining a customer contract. These are considered incremental costs of obtaining a contract and are eligible for capitalization under ASC 340-40 to the extent they are recoverable. Incremental costs of obtaining a contract are deferred over the period the related revenue is recognized and the Company has elected not to defer costs related to goods or services to be delivered over a period that is one year or less.

 

F-13

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(In thousands, except share and per share amounts)

 

Significant Financing Component

The Company provides extended payment terms to certain customers that represent a significant financing component. The Company adjusts the amount of promised consideration for the time value of money using its discount rate and recognizes interest income separate from the revenue recognized on contracts with customers.

Limited Warranty Obligations

The Company offers limited warranties on the Company’s products which provide the customer assurance that the product will function as the parties intended because it complies with agreed-upon specifications; therefore, these assurance-type warranties are not treated as a separate revenue performance obligation and are accounted for as guarantees under U.S. GAAP. The Company regularly reviews its warranty liability and updates these balances based on historical warranty cost trends.

Concentrations of Customers

For the year ended December 31, 2019, two customers accounted for 26% and 11% of the Company’s revenue, respectively, and one customer accounted for 25% of the Company’s accounts receivable, net as of December 31, 2019.

For the year ended December 31, 2018, two customers accounted for 12% each of the Company’s revenue and one customer accounted for 15% of the Company’s accounts receivable, net as of December 31, 2018.

Research and Development

The Company expenses research and development costs as incurred. Research and development expenses consist primarily of engineering, product development, clinical studies to develop and support the Company’s products, regulatory expenses, and other costs associated with products and technologies that are in development. Research and development expenses include employee compensation, including stock-based compensation, supplies, consulting, prototyping, testing, materials, travel expenses, and depreciation.

During September 2019, LENSAR exclusively licensed certain intellectual property from a third-party for $3,500 in cash for use in research and development activities. The amount was immediately expensed and is included in research and development expense in the statements of operations for the year ended December 31, 2019 because it had no alternative future use. The cash consideration transferred has been classified in the statements of cash flows as an operating activity.

Asset Acquisitions

The Company measures and recognizes asset acquisitions that are not deemed to be business combinations based on the cost to acquire the assets, which includes transaction costs. Goodwill is not recognized in asset acquisitions. Contingent consideration in asset acquisitions payable in the form of cash is recognized when payment becomes probable and reasonably estimable, unless the contingent consideration meets the definition of a derivative, in which case the amount becomes part of the asset acquisition cost when acquired. Upon recognition of the contingent consideration payment, the amount is included in the cost of the acquired asset or group of assets.

Income Taxes

The Company is subject to U.S. federal, state, and local corporate income taxes at the entity level. The Company’s losses were included with PDL’s consolidated U.S. federal and state income tax returns. Income taxes as presented in the Company’s financial statements have been prepared on the separate return method as if the Company were a taxpayer separate from PDL.

 

F-14

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(In thousands, except share and per share amounts)

 

The provision for income taxes is determined using the asset and liability approach. Tax laws require items to be included in tax filings at different times than the items are reflected in the financial statements. A current liability is recognized for the estimated taxes payable for the current year. Deferred taxes represent the future tax consequences expected to occur when the reported amounts of assets and liabilities are recovered or paid. Deferred taxes are adjusted for enacted changes in tax rates and tax laws in the year in which such laws are enacted. Valuation allowances are recorded to reduce deferred tax assets when it is more likely than not that a tax benefit will not be realized.

The Company recognizes tax benefits from uncertain tax positions only if it is more likely than not that the tax position will be sustained on examination by the taxing authorities, based on the technical merits of the position. The tax benefits recognized in the financial statements from such positions are then measured based on the largest benefit that has a greater than 50% likelihood of being realized upon ultimate settlement. The Company adjusts the level of the liability to reflect any subsequent changes in the relevant facts surrounding the uncertain positions. Any interest and penalties on uncertain tax positions are included within the tax provision.

Leases

In February 2016, the FASB issued ASU No. 2016-02, Leases, that supersedes ASC 840, Leases. Subsequently, the FASB issued several updates to ASU No. 2016-02, codified in ASC Topic 842 (“ASC 842”). The Company adopted ASC 842, Leases, on January 1, 2019 using the modified retrospective method for all leases not substantially completed as of the date of adoption. The reported results for the year ended December 31, 2019 reflect the application of ASC 842 guidance while the reported results for the year ended December 31, 2018 were prepared under the guidance of ASC 840, which is also referred to herein as “legacy GAAP” or the “previous guidance”. The cumulative impact of the adoption of ASC 842 was not material, therefore, the Company did not record any adjustments to retained earnings. As a result of adopting ASC 842, the Company recorded operating lease right-of-use (“ROU”) assets of $1,390 and operating lease liabilities of $1,424, primarily related to the corporate office lease, based on the present value of the future lease payments on the date of adoption. Changes to lessor accounting focused on conforming with certain changes made to lessee accounting and the recently adopted revenue recognition guidance. The adoption of ASC 842 did not materially change how the Company accounts for lessor arrangements.

The Company determines if an arrangement is a lease or contains an embedded lease at inception if it contains the right to control the use of an identified asset under a leasing arrangement with an initial term greater than 12 months. The Company determines whether a contract conveys the right to control the use of an identified asset for a period of time if the contract contains both the right to obtain substantially all of the economic benefits from the use of the identified asset and the right to direct the use of the identified asset.

Policy Elections and Practical Expedients Taken

The Company has lease arrangements with lease and non-lease components, which are accounted for separately.

For leases that commenced before the effective date of ASC 842, the Company elected the practical expedients to not reassess the following: (i) whether any expired or existing contracts contain leases; (ii) the lease classification for any expired or existing leases; and (iii) initial direct costs for any existing leases.

For short term leases, defined as leases with a lease term of 12 months or less, the Company elected to not recognize an associated lease liability and ROU asset. Lease payments for short term leases are expensed on a straight-line basis over the lease term.

 

F-15

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(In thousands, except share and per share amounts)

 

The Company has a policy to exclude from the consideration in a lessor contract all taxes assessed by a governmental authority that are both imposed on and concurrent with a specific lease revenue-producing transaction and collected by the Company from a lessee.

Lessee Arrangements

Lessee operating right of use assets are included in other assets in the Company’s balance sheet. Lessee operating lease liabilities are included in other current liabilities and long-term operating lease liabilities in the Company’s balance sheet. The Company does not have lessee financing leases.

Operating lease ROU assets represent the Company’s right to use an underlying asset for the lease term and lease liabilities represent its obligation to make lease payments arising from the lease. Operating lease ROU assets and liabilities are recognized at commencement date based on the present value of remaining lease payments over the lease term. The Company uses the implicit rate when readily determinable at lease inception. As most of the Company’s leases do not provide an implicit rate, the Company uses its incremental borrowing rate based on the information available at the commencement date, including the lease term and the Company’s credit risk, in determining the present value of lease payments. The Company’s remaining lease terms may include options to extend or terminate the lease when it is reasonably certain that the Company will exercise that option. Lease expense for lease payments is recognized on a straight-line basis as operating expense in the statements of operations over the lease term.

For lease arrangements with lease and non-lease components where the Company is the lessee, the Company separately accounts for lease and non-lease components, which consists primarily common area maintenance services. Non-lease components are expensed as incurred.

Lessor Arrangements

The Company leases equipment to customers under operating leases. Leases are generally not cancellable until after an initial term and may or may not require the customer to purchase a minimum number of procedures and consumables throughout the contract term.

For lease arrangements with lease and non-lease components where the Company is the lessor, the Company allocates the contract’s transaction price (including discounts) to the lease and non-lease components on a relative standalone selling price basis using the Company’s best estimate of the standalone selling price of each distinct product or service in the contract. Lease elements generally include a LENSAR Laser System, while non-lease elements generally include extended warranty services, PIDs and procedure licenses. The stand-alone selling prices for the extended warranty services, PIDs and procedure licenses are determined based on the prices at which the Company separately sells such products and services. The LENSAR Laser System stand-alone selling prices are determined using the expected cost plus a margin approach. Allocation of the transaction price is determined at the inception of the lease arrangement. The Company’s leases primarily consist of leases with fixed lease payments. For those leases with variable lease payments, the variable lease payment is typically based upon use of the leased equipment or the purchase of procedure licenses and consumables used with the leased equipment. Non-lease components are accounted for under ASC 606, Revenue from Contracts with Customers. For additional information regarding ASC 606, see Note 4, Revenue from Contracts with Customers.

Some leases include options to extend the leases on a month-to-month basis if the customer does not notify the Company of the intention to return the equipment at the end of the lease term. The Company typically does not offer options to terminate the leases before the end of the lease term. A new contract is generated if a customer intends to continue using the equipment under the initial term and the new contract term is not included in the initial lease term.

 

F-16

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(In thousands, except share and per share amounts)

 

In determining whether a transaction should be classified as a sales-type or operating lease, the Company considers the following criteria at lease commencement: (1) whether title of the system transfers automatically or for a nominal fee by the end of the lease term, (2) whether the present value of the minimum lease payments equals or exceeds substantially all of the fair value of the leased system, (3) whether the lease term is for the major part of the remaining economic life of the leased system, (4) whether the lease grants the lessee an option to purchase the leased system that the lessee is reasonably certain to exercise, and (5) whether the underlying system is of such a specialized nature that it is expected to have no alternative use to the Company at the end of the lease term. If any of these criteria are met, the lease is classified as a sales-type lease. If none of these criteria are met the lease is classified as an operating lease. For the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018, the Company does not have any sales-type leases.

For operating leases, rental income is recognized on a straight-line basis over the lease term as lease revenue. The cost of customer-leased equipment is recorded within equipment under lease, net in the balance sheets and depreciated over the equipment’s estimated useful life. Depreciation expense associated with the leased equipment under operating lease arrangements is reflected in cost of lease in the statements of operations. Some of the Company’s operating leases include a purchase option for the customer to purchase the leased asset at the end of the lease arrangement, subject to a new contract. The purchase price does not qualify as a bargain purchase option. The Company manages its risk on its investment in the equipment through pricing and the term of the leases. Lessees do not provide residual value guarantees on leased equipment. Equipment returned to the Company may be leased or sold to other customers. Initial direct costs, recorded in prepaid and other current assets, are deferred and recognized over the lease term.

Stock-Based Compensation

Stock-based compensation is measured at the grant date based on the fair value of the award and is generally expensed over the requisite service period. LENSAR employees and directors are also eligible for the LENSAR phantom stock plan. The holders of the phantom stock units have the right to receive cash upon settlement. Awards of phantom stock are accounted for as a liability under ASC Topic 718 and changes in the fair value of the Company’s liability are recognized as compensation cost over the remaining requisite service period. Changes in the fair value of the liability are recognized as compensation cost during the period in which the changes occur. The Company remeasures the liability for the outstanding awards at the end of each reporting period and the compensation cost is based on the change in fair market value for each reporting period. Forfeiture for both the Parent’s stock-based compensation plans and phantom stock plan are accounted for as they occur.

One LENSAR employee has historically participated in the Parent’s stock-based compensation plan. Stock-based compensation expense has been attributed to LENSAR based on the awards and terms previously granted to the LENSAR employee. The Parent issued restricted stock awards to the Company’s employee.

See Note 13 for a discussion of stock-based compensation plans.

Recently Issued Accounting Pronouncements Not Yet Adopted

In June 2016, the FASB issued ASU No. 2016-13, Financial Instruments—Credit Losses: Measurement of Credit Losses on Financial Instruments. The new guidance amends the impairment model to utilize an expected loss methodology in place of the currently used incurred loss methodology, which will result in more timely recognition of losses. ASU No. 2016-13, as amended by ASU 2019-10 has an effective date of the fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2022, including interim periods within those fiscal years. The Company does not expect this guidance to have a significant impact on its financial statements and related disclosures.

 

F-17

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(In thousands, except share and per share amounts)

 

In August 2018, the FASB issued ASU No. 2018-13, Fair Value Measurement. The new guidance modifies disclosure requirements related to fair value measurement. The amendments in ASU No. 2018-13 are effective for fiscal years, and interim periods within those fiscal years, beginning after December 15, 2019. Implementation on a prospective or retrospective basis varies by specific disclosure requirement. Early adoption is permitted. The standard also allows for early adoption of any removed or modified disclosures upon issuance of ASU No. 2018-13 while delaying adoption of the additional disclosures until their effective date. The Company does not expect this guidance to have a significant impact on its financial statements and related disclosures.

In December 2019, the FASB issued ASU No. 2019-12, which is intended to simplify various aspects related to accounting for income taxes. ASU 2019-12 removes certain exceptions to the general principles in Topic 740 and also clarifies and amends existing guidance to improve consistent application. The amendments in ASU No. 2019-12 are effective for fiscal years, and interim periods within those fiscal years, beginning after December 15, 2020, with early adoption permitted. The Company is currently evaluating the impact of this guidance on its financial statements.

Note 3. Asset Acquisitions

In January 2018, LENSAR entered into an agreement with a domestic distributor to purchase assets used in the distributors’ laser-assisted cataract surgery business. The transaction was closed on January 8, 2018 as the acquisition date. The assets purchased include equipment, inventory and the distributor’s customer relationships. No workforce was transferred as part of the transaction. The transaction was accounted for as an asset acquisition as the acquired assets did not constitute a business under U.S. GAAP. In connection with the acquisition, the Company contingently agreed to make payments related to milestones based on future operating performance during the 12 months following the close of the acquisition date, for a total value of up to $1,929 at the acquisition date. The Company’s payments for the contingent consideration were $1,071 and $858 during the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018, respectively. The contingent liability was paid in full as of December 31, 2019.

The following table summarizes the allocation of the purchase price to identifiable assets acquired based on management’s estimates of relative fair value:

 

     Amount  

Equipment and inventory

   $ 961  

Fixed assets

     76  

Intangible assets (Customer relationships)

     2,092  
  

 

 

 

Total identifiable assets

   $ 3,129  
  

 

 

 

The following table summarizes the purchase price:

 

     Amount  

Consideration paid at closing, cash

   $ 1,200  

Contingent consideration

     1,929  
  

 

 

 

Total consideration

   $ 3,129  
  

 

 

 

In December 2018 LENSAR entered into an agreement with a medical technology company to license certain patents and to obtain an option to purchase the medical technology company’s assets. The transaction was closed on April 9, 2019 as the acquisition date. LENSAR had 120 days to exercise the option and three months

 

F-18

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(In thousands, except share and per share amounts)

 

thereafter to negotiate the terms of the final purchase agreement. In April 2019, LENSAR entered into an agreement with the medical technology company to purchase patents, intellectual property, and products. The assets purchased included patents, patent applications, intellectual property, and prototypes. No workforce was transferred as part of the transaction. The Asset Assignment Agreement also provides for an additional $300 in contingent consideration if certain patents are revived. The full contingent consideration was included in the purchase price at the time of the acquisition. The contingent consideration was paid during 2019. The transaction was accounted for as an asset acquisition as the acquired assets did not constitute a business under U.S. GAAP.

The following table summarizes the identifiable assets acquired:

 

     Amount  
Intangible assets    $ 2,300  
  

 

 

 

Total identifiable assets

   $ 2,300  
  

 

 

 

The following table summarizes the purchase price:

 

     Amount  

Consideration paid for the License and Option Agreement

     300  

Cash consideration paid at closing

     1,700  

Contingent consideration

     300  
  

 

 

 

Total consideration

   $ 2,300  
  

 

 

 

Note 4. Revenue from Contracts with Customers

Disaggregation of Revenue

The following table summarizes the Company’s product and service revenue disaggregated by geographic region, which is determined based on customer location, for the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018:

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
           2019                  2018        

United States

   $ 10,918      $ 10,015  

South Korea

     7,876        2,840  

Europe

     3,448        2,375  

Asia (excluding South Korea)

     3,664        4,209  

Other

     441        382  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total1

   $ 26,347      $ 19,821  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

1

The table above does not include lease revenue of $4,181 and $4,567 for the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018, respectively. Refer to Note 6, Leases.

 

F-19

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(In thousands, except share and per share amounts)

 

Contract Balances

The following table provides information about receivables and contract liabilities from contracts with customers:

 

          As of December 31,  
    

Classification

       2019              2018      

Accounts receivable, current

  

Accounts receivable, net

   $ 3,384      $ 3,302  

Accounts receivable, non-current

  

Other assets

     —          18  

Notes receivable, current

  

Notes receivable, net

     502        472  

Notes receivable, long-term

  

Notes and other receivables, long-term, net

     827        753  

Contract liability, current

  

Deferred revenue

     777        871  

Contract liability, non-current

  

Other long-term liabilities

     118        123  

Accounts Receivables, Net—Accounts receivables, net, include amounts billed and due from customers. The amounts due are stated at their net estimated realizable value and are classified as current or noncurrent based on the timing of when the Company expects to receive payment. The noncurrent receivables relate to service revenue. Most customers are on pre-paid or 30-day payment terms, depending on the product purchased. The Company maintains an allowance for doubtful accounts to provide for the estimated amount of receivables that will not be collected. The allowance is based upon an assessment of customer creditworthiness, historical payment experience, the age of outstanding receivables and collateral to the extent applicable.

Notes Receivables, Net—Notes receivable, net includes amounts billed and due from customers under extended payment terms with a significant financing component. Interest rates on notes receivable range from 5.0% to 5.75%. The Company recorded interest income on notes receivable during the years ended December 31, 2019 and December 31, 2018 of $53 and $51 in other income, net in its statements of operations.

Maturities of notes receivables, net under extended payment terms with a significant financing component as of December 31, 2019 are as follows:

 

Fiscal Year

   Amount  

2020

   $ 538  

2021

     396  

2022

     350  

2023

     126  

2024

     —    

Thereafter

     —    
  

 

 

 

Total undiscounted cash flows

   $ 1,410  

Present value of notes receivable

     1,329  
  

 

 

 

Difference between undiscounted and discounted cash flows

   $ 81  
  

 

 

 

Contract Liabilities—The Company’s contract liabilities consist of deferred revenue related to services and products sold to customers for which the performance obligation has not been completed by the Company. The Company classifies deferred revenue as current or noncurrent based on the timing of when it expects to recognize revenue. The noncurrent portion of deferred revenue is included in other long-term liabilities in the Company’s balance sheets.

 

F-20

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(In thousands, except share and per share amounts)

 

The following table provides information about contract liabilities from contracts with customers:

 

     Amount  

Contract liabilities as of January 1, 2018

   $ 1,091  

Billings not yet recognized as revenue

     660  

Beginning contract liabilities recognized as revenue

     (757
  

 

 

 

Contract liabilities at December 31, 2018

   $ 994  

Billings not yet recognized as revenue

     739  

Beginning contract liabilities recognized as revenue

     (838
  

 

 

 

Contract liabilities at December 31, 2019

   $ 895  
  

 

 

 

Transaction Price Allocated to Future Performance Obligations

At December 31, 2019, the revenue expected to be recognized in future periods related to performance obligations that are unsatisfied for executed contracts with an original duration of one year or more was approximately $11,199. The Company expects to satisfy its remaining performance obligations over the next four years, with $5,291 to be satisfied in the next twelve months, $3,620 to be satisfied in the next two years, and $2,288 to be satisfied thereafter. The Company does not disclose the value of unsatisfied performance obligations for (i) contracts with original expected lengths of one year or less or (ii) contracts for which the Company recognizes revenue at the amount to which it has the right to invoice for the products delivered or services performed.

Costs to Obtain Contracts

The following table provides information about the costs to obtain contracts associated with contracts with customers for the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018:

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
         2019              2018      

Beginning balance

   $ 80      $ 38  

Additions

     452        256  

Amortization

     (342      (214
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Ending balance

   $ 190      $ 80  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Note 5. Inventories

Inventory balances were as follows:

 

     As of December 31,  
     2019      2018  

Finished Goods

   $ 3,156      $ 1,592  

Work-in-progress

     1,170        549  

Raw Materials

     3,738        1,921  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 8,064      $ 4,062  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Write downs of inventories to net realizable value for the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018 were immaterial.

 

F-21

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(In thousands, except share and per share amounts)

 

Note

 6. Leases

Lessee Arrangements

The Company has an operating lease for a corporate office. The Company’s operating lease has a remaining lease term of 1.6 years as of December 31, 2019, and contains an option to extend the lease for five years.

The components of lease expense are as follows:

 

     Year ended
December 31,
2019
 

Operating lease cost

   $ 576  

Short-term lease cost

     8  
  

 

 

 

Total lease cost

   $ 584  
  

 

 

 

Supplemental cash flow information related to leases is as follows:

 

     Year ended
December
31, 2019
 

Cash paid for amounts included in the measurement of lease liabilities:

  

Operating cash flows from operating leases

   $ 575  

Right-of-use-assets obtained in exchange for lease obligations:

  

Operating leases

   $ 1,390  

The following table presents the lease balances within the balance sheet, weighted-average remaining lease term, and weighted-average discount rates related to the Company’s operating leases:

 

Operating Leases

  

Classification

   As of December 31, 2019  

Operating lease ROU assets

  

Other assets

   $ 853  
     

 

 

 

Operating lease liabilities, current

  

Other current liabilities

   $ 555  

Operating lease liabilities, long-term

  

Long-term operating lease liabilities

     333  
     

 

 

 

Total operating lease liabilities

      $ 888  
     

 

 

 

Weighted-average remaining lease term

        1.6 years  

Weighted-average discount rate

        6.04

Maturities of operating lease liabilities as of December 31, 2019 are as follows:

 

Fiscal Year

   Amount  

2020

   $ 592  

2021

     353  

2022

     —    

2023

     —    

2024

     —    

Thereafter

     —    
  

 

 

 

Total operating lease payments

     945  

Less: imputed interest

     (57
  

 

 

 

Total operating lease liabilities

   $ 888  
  

 

 

 

 

F-22

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(In thousands, except share and per share amounts)

 

Future minimum operating lease payments as of December 31, 2018 were as follows:

 

Fiscal Year

   Amount  

2019

   $ 719  

2020

     735  

2021

     436  

2022

     —    

2023

     —    

Thereafter

     —    
  

 

 

 

Total operating lease payments

   $ 1,890  
  

 

 

 

Lessor Arrangements

The Company has operating leases for the LENSAR Laser System. The Company’s leases have remaining lease terms of less than one year to four years. Lease income related to non-cancellable lease payments for the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018 was as follows:

 

     Year ended
December 31,
 
     2019      2018  

Lease income related to non-cancellable lease payments

   $ 3,142      $ 2,918  

Equipment under lease is as follows:

 

     As of December 31,  
     2019      2018  

Equipment under lease

   $ 6,749      $ 6,625  

Less accumulated depreciation

     (5,318      (3,708
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Equipment under lease, net

   $ 1,431      $ 2,917  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Depreciation expense on equipment under lease amounted to $2,252 and $2,842 for the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018, respectively.

Maturities of operating lease payments as of December 31, 2019 are as follows:

 

Fiscal Year

   Amount  

2020

   $ 2,287  

2021

     1,218  

2022

     426  

2023

     81  

2024

     —    

Thereafter

     —    
  

 

 

 

Total undiscounted cash flows

   $ 4,012  
  

 

 

 

 

F-23

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(In thousands, except share and per share amounts)

 

Note 7. Property and Equipment

The following table provides details of property and equipment, net:

 

     As of December 31,  
     2019      2018  

Leasehold improvements

   $ 107      $ 107  

Manufacturing equipment

     203        203  

Computer and office equipment

     98        92  

System and laser

     1,304        1,195  

Furniture and fixtures

     50        50  

Transportation equipment

     76        76  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     1,838        1,723  

Less accumulated depreciation

     (1,543      (1,041

Construction in progress

     425        17  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Property and equipment, net

   $ 720      $ 699  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Depreciation expense on property and equipment amounted to $387 and $611 for the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018, respectively. The Company recognizes molds and tools that suppliers use in producing certain products under a long-term supply arrangement in construction in progress while the molds are under construction. When the molds are completed, they are transferred to property and equipment. The assets capitalized amounted to $425 and $17 as of December 31, 2019 and 2018, respectively.

Note 8. Intangible Assets

In April 2019, LENSAR acquired certain intellectual property from a third-party for $2,000 in cash and contingent obligations to pay a $300 milestone payment and royalties upon the completion of certain events, which were met prior to December 31, 2019. See Note 3 for more information.

The components of intangible assets were as follows:    

 

     As of December 31, 2019      As of December 31, 2018  
     Gross
Carrying
Amount
     Accumulated
Amortization
    Net
Carrying
Amount
     Gross
Carrying
Amount
     Accumulated
Amortization
    Net
Carrying
Amount
 

Finite-lived intangible assets:

               

Customer relationships1,2

   $ 4,292      $ (951   $ 3,341      $ 4,292      $ (557   $ 3,735  

Acquired technology1,3

     11,500        (1,741     9,759        9,200        (1,022     8,178  

Acquired trademarks1

     570        (304     266        570        (190     380  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 
   $ 16,362      $ (2,996   $ 13,366      $ 14,062      $ (1,769   $ 12,293  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

1

Certain intangible assets were established upon PDL’s acquisition of LENSAR in May 2017. They are being amortized on a straight-line basis over a weighted-average period of 15 years. The intangible assets for customer relationships are amortized on a straight-line basis or a double declining basis over their estimated useful lives up to 20 years based on the method that better represents the economic benefits to be obtained.

2

LENSAR acquired certain intangible assets for customer relationships from a domestic distributor in an asset acquisition, which are being amortized on a straight-line basis over a period of 10 years.

3

LENSAR acquired certain intangible assets from a medical technology company in an asset acquisition, which are being amortized on a straight-line basis over a period of 15 years.

 

F-24

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(In thousands, except share and per share amounts)

 

Amortization expense for the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018 was $1,227 and $1,137, respectively.

Based on the intangible assets recorded at December 31, 2019, and assuming no subsequent additions to or impairment of the underlying assets, the remaining amortization expense is expected to be as follows:

 

Fiscal Year

   Amount  

2020

   $ 1,256  

2021

     1,240  

2022

     1,149  

2023

     1,097  

2024

     1,085  

Thereafter

     7,539  
  

 

 

 

Total remaining estimated amortization expense

   $ 13,366  
  

 

 

 

Note 9. Accrued Liabilities

Accrued liabilities consist of the following:

 

     As of December 31,  
     2019      2018  

Compensation

   $ 3,972      $ 3,236  

Warranty

     58        39  

Other

     748        348  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 4,778      $ 3,623  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Note 10. Mandatorily Redeemable Preferred Stock

The Company authorized and issued 30,000 shares of Series A preferred stock, par value $0.01 to Parent in May 2017. The Series A preferred stock has an aggregate liquidation preference of $30,000 (“stated value”), plus all accumulated and unpaid dividends (whether or not declared). Dividends on each share of preferred stock initially accrued on an annual basis at a rate of 15.00% per annum of the stated value, and subsequently decreased to 5.0% per annum of the stated value effective January 1, 2019 as amended in December 2018. Dividends are payable when and if declared by the board of directors. No dividends have been declared by the board of directors since issuance.

The Series A preferred stock is mandatorily redeemable on May 11, 2027, the tenth anniversary of the date of issuance, equal to its stated value plus any accrued and unpaid dividends. Prior to May 11, 2027, the Company may redeem the outstanding Series A preferred stock in whole or in part at its option for cash equal to the stated value per share plus any accrued and unpaid dividends. In the event of any voluntary or involuntary liquidation, dissolution, or winding up of the Company, the Series A preferred stock will be redeemed for cash equal to its stated value plus any accrued and unpaid dividends. As of December 31, 2019 and 2018, the redemption amounts were $38,885 or $1,296 per share and $37,385 or $1,246 per share, respectively.

The holder of Series A preferred stock is entitled to elect one member of the board of the directors, but are otherwise not entitled to vote on matters with the common shareholders. The Series A preferred stock rank senior to the Company’s common stock. The Series A preferred stock is not entitled to participate in distributions with common shareholders; however, the Company may not declare dividends to common shareholders so long as there are accumulated and unpaid dividends on the Series A preferred stock.

 

F-25

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(In thousands, except share and per share amounts)

 

The Series A preferred stock is accounted for as a liability on the Company’s balance sheets because it is mandatorily redeemable. Prior to the amendment in December 2018, the Series A preferred stock was measured based on the present value of the expected redemption value of $75,000 at the mandatory redemption date, accruing interest cost at an effective interest rate of 9.6%.

Upon the amendment, the reduction of the cumulative dividend rate to 5.0% was accounted for as a debt modification, wherein interest cost is accrued prospectively using the new effective interest rate of 4.4% based on the modified redemption value of $49,923 on the May 11, 2027 mandatory redemption date.

The carrying value of Series A preferred stock is $36,417 and $34,890 inclusive of interest accrued as of December 31, 2019 and 2018, respectively. Interest expenses recognized on the Series A preferred is $1,528 and $3,049 for the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018, respectively.

Note 11. Commitments and Contingencies

Purchase Obligation

LENSAR entered into various supply agreements for the manufacture and supply of certain components. The supply agreements commit LENSAR to a minimum purchase obligation of approximately $10,400 over the next 24 months, of which $9,600 is due in the next 12 months, $1,000 of which are guaranteed by the Parent. LENSAR expects to meet these requirements. LENSAR made purchases of $9,600 and $4,492 under these supply agreements during the year ended December 31, 2019 and 2018, respectively.

Royalty and Milestone Payments

In connection with the acquisition of certain intellectual property the Company could be required to make milestone payments in the amount of $2,400 (refer to Note 2, Research and Development), which are contingent upon the regulatory approval and commercialization of the next generation system. In addition, the Company acquired certain intellectual property, which if used in the development of the next generation system could result in additional royalty payments.

Legal Matters

The medical device market in which LENSAR participates is largely technology driven. As a result, intellectual property rights, particularly patents and trade secrets, play a significant role in product development and differentiation. The Company makes provisions for liabilities when it is both probable that a liability has been incurred and the amount of the loss can be reasonably estimated. Management believes that there are currently no claims or legal actions that would reasonably be expected to have a material adverse effect on the Company’s results of operations, financial condition or cash flows.

Note 12. Stockholders’ Deficit

Common Stock

The Company has a single class of common stock in which stockholders are entitled to one vote for each share of common stock. No cash dividend was declared on common stock during the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018.

 

F-26

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(In thousands, except share and per share amounts)

 

Note 13. Stock-Based Compensation

Phantom Stock Plan

LENSAR has an phantom stock plan under which it grants phantom stock units (“PSUs”) to LENSAR directors and employees. The aggregate number of shares of common stock that may be subject to                  awards of phantom stock are determined from time to time by the plan administrator. The total shares authorized for grant were 1,560,240 and 1,503,100, as of December 31, 2019 and 2018, respectively and such awards are all granted to eligible award holders. PSUs are awards in the form of phantom shares, denominated in a hypothetical equivalent number of shares of LENSAR common stock and with the value of each PSU equal to the fair value of LENSAR common stock at the date of grant. PSUs may be settled in cash, common stock or both, as determined by the board of LENSAR at the time of grant. Each PSU grant is subject to service-based vesting, where a specific period of continued employment, typically one to four years, must pass before an award vests and can be accelerated at the occurrence of a change-in-control event or completion of an initial public offering.

The estimated fair value of the common stock underlying the PSUs is determined by the board of directors, with input from management. In the absence of a public trading market for the common stock, the Company develops an estimate of the fair value of the common stock based on the information known on the reporting date, upon a review of any recent events and their potential impact on the estimated fair value, and valuations from an independent third-party valuation firm. Valuations of the Company’s common stock were determined in accordance with the guidelines outlined in the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants Practice Aid, Valuation of Privately-Held-Company Equity Securities Issued as Compensation, or the Practice Aid. In evaluating the PSUs, the Company first established the enterprise value of the Company using generally accepted valuation methodologies including discounted cash flow analysis, comparable public company analysis and comparable acquisitions analysis. Then the Company allocated the equity value among the securities that comprise the capital structure of the Company using the Black Scholes Option-Pricing model after deducting the liquidation preference. Under the Option-Pricing model, the common stock is modeled as a call option that gives its owner the right but not the obligation to buy the underlying enterprise value at a predetermined or exercise price. Common stock is considered to be a call option with a claim on the enterprise at an exercise price equal to the remaining value immediately after the preferred stock is liquidated.

The fair value of the Company’s common stock, as used for purposes of determining the fair value of the PSUs, was estimated using the following assumptions:

 

     As of and Year Ended December 31,  
     2019     2018  

Risk-free interest rate

     1.6     2.5

Expected term (years)

     3       3  

Expected volatility

     60     63

Dividends

     0.0     0.0

Marketability discount

     23     23

Expected term: As its share-based compensation awards were generally non-transferrable and represented in substance a liquidation interest in the Company, the Company estimated the expected term input to the Black-Scholes model to be equivalent to the Company’s expected time to a liquidity event.

Risk-free interest rate: The risk-free interest rate was based on the rates paid on securities issued by the U.S. Treasury with a term approximating the expected time to liquidity of the Company’s common stock.

Expected volatility: The expected volatility for the Company’s stock-based compensation awards was based on an index of the historical volatilities of a group of comparable publicly-traded medical device peer companies,

 

F-27

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(In thousands, except share and per share amounts)

 

which the Company believes will be representative of the volatility over the time to liquidity of its common stock.

Expected dividend yield: The Company does not intend to pay dividends for the foreseeable future. Accordingly, the Company used a dividend yield of zero in the assumptions.

Marketability discount: The estimated fair value reflects a non-marketability discount to reflect the fact that the stockholders could not freely trade the common stock in the public markets and is based on the anticipated likelihood and timing of a future liquidity event.

LENSAR common shares are transferred from PDL’s ownership to award owners if the PSU holder elects to settle in common stock. Compensation expense is recognized over the vesting period with a corresponding liability, which is recorded in accrued liabilities and other long-term liabilities in the balance sheet. The liability is remeasured to fair value at each reporting date with any change in fair value recorded as stock-based compensation over the remaining vesting period. If equity settlement is elected upon vesting, the liability amount is converted to equity. The Parent then transfers LENSAR shares to the employee in settlement of the award. The following table sets forth the total stock-based compensation expense recognized under the phantom stock plan in the Company’s statements of operations:

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
           2019                  2018        

Cost of revenue—product

   $ 29      $ 75  

Cost of revenue—service

     17        42  

Selling, general and administrative expenses

     696        969  

Research and development expenses

     76        136  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 818      $ 1,222  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

As of December 31, 2019 and 2018, the Company’s liabilities related to the PSU recorded in liabilities were $1,179 and $1,114 respectively. The fair values of the PSUs at each reporting date are $14.94 and $10.80 as of December 31, 2019 and 2018, respectively. The following table summarizes the phantom share activity during the year ended December 31, 2019:

 

     2019  
     Number of Units      Weighted-average grant-
date fair value per share
 

Non-vested at beginning of year

     109,191      $ 6.39  

Granted

     6,348      $ 10.80  

Vested

     (71,573    $ 6.75  

Forfeited

     (1,166    $ 6.39  
  

 

 

    

Non-vested at end of year

     42,800      $ 6.39  
  

 

 

    

 

     2018  
     Number of Units      Weighted-average grant-
date fair value per share
 

Non-vested at beginning of year

     97,944      $ 6.39  

Granted

     69,066      $ 6.39  

Vested

     (57,819    $ 6.39  

Forfeited

     —        $ —    
  

 

 

    

Non-vested at end of year

     109,191      $ 6.39  
  

 

 

    

 

F-28

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(In thousands, except share and per share amounts)

 

During the year ended December 31, 2019, $92 was paid and 67,473 shares were transferred from PDL to settle vested shares. As of December 31, 2019, 51,737 units are vested but unsettled.

Unrecognized compensation cost for all unvested PSUs as of December 31, 2019 was $234 based on the fair market value of the awards on that date, which is expected to be recognized over a weighted-average period of 1.3 years.

Stock-Based Incentive Plans

PDL has equity incentive plans under which it grants equity awards, including stock options, stock appreciation rights, restricted stock awards, restricted stock unit awards, performance share and performance unit awards, deferred compensation awards and other stock-based or cash-based awards. As of December 31, 2019 and 2018, awards granted by PDL to one LENSAR employee which consisted of restricted stock awards. There were no other grants to LENSAR employees of any other award types under the Parent’s equity incentive plan.

Restricted Stock Awards

PDL granted restricted stock awards to an employee of LENSAR pursuant to a stockholder approved stock-based incentive plan. As LENSAR receives the employee’s services in consideration for these awards, stock-based compensation expense for the awards granted to the LENSAR employee has been reflected in the statements of operations. As the stock-based compensation plans are the Parent’s plans and the awards are settled by the Parent, the offset to the expense has been recognized through additional paid-in capital on the balance sheets. Stock-based compensation expense related to the PDL awards for the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018 was approximately $100 and $100 recorded in selling, general, and administrative expense, respectively.

Restricted stock has the same rights as other issued and outstanding shares of PDL’s common stock, including, in some cases, the right to accrue dividends, which are held in escrow until the award vests. The compensation expense related to these awards is determined using the fair market value of PDL’s common stock on the date of the grant, and the compensation expense is recognized ratably over the vesting period. The restricted stock award granted to the LENSAR employees vests over one to two years and compensation expense associated with these awards is recognized on a straight-line basis over the vesting period.

The total fair value of restricted stock awards vested during the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018 was approximately $100 and $100, respectively.

The weighted-average grant date fair value for restricted stock awards granted under PDL’s 2005 Amended and Restated Equity Incentive Plan for the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018 was $3.46 and $2.52, respectively.

At December 31, 2019, there was approximately $38 of total unrecognized compensation expense related to restricted stock awards, which is expected to be recognized over a weighted-average period of one year.

Note 14. Income Taxes

The Company is included in the consolidated federal tax return of PDL. The provision for income taxes is calculated by using a “separate return” method. Under this method, the Company is assumed to file a separate return with the applicable tax authority(ies). The current provision is the amount of tax payable or refundable on the basis of a hypothetical, current-year separate return. Deferred taxes are provided on temporary differences and on any attributes being carried forward that could be claimed on the hypothetical return. The need for a valuation allowance is assessed on a separate company basis and on projected separate return assets.

 

F-29

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(In thousands, except share and per share amounts)

 

For financial reporting purposes, loss before income taxes includes the following components:

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
         2019              2018      

United States

     (14,657      (12,573
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Foreign

     —          —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     (14,657      (12,573
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

The provision for income taxes for the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018 consisted of the following:

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
         2019              2018      

Current income tax expense (benefit)

     

Federal

   $ —        $ —    

State

     —          —    

Foreign

     —          20  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Current

     —          20  

Deferred income tax (benefit)

     

Federal

     —          —    

State

     —          —    

Foreign

     —          —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total deferred

     —          —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total provision

   $ —        $ 20  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

A reconciliation of the income tax provision computed using the U.S. statutory federal income tax rate compared to the income tax provision included in the statements of operations is as follows:

 

    Year Ended December 31,  
          2019     2018  

Tax at U.S. statutory rate on income before income taxes

  $ (3,078   $ (2,640

Change in valuation allowance

    2,218       2,821  

State taxes

    543       (837

Accrued preferred dividend

    321       640  

Other

    (4     36  
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

  $ —       $ 20  
 

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-30

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(In thousands, except share and per share amounts)

 

Deferred tax assets and liabilities are determined based on the differences between financial reporting and income tax bases of assets and liabilities, as well as net operating loss carryforwards, and are measured using the enacted tax rates and laws in effect when the differences are expected to reverse. The significant components of the Company’s net deferred tax assets and liabilities are as follows:

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
           2019                  2018        

Deferred tax assets:

     

Net operating loss carryforwards

   $ 38,781      $ 36,347  

Intangible assets

     3,827        4,206  

Other

     2,064        1,694  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total deferred tax assets

     44,672        42,247  

Valuation allowance

     (44,465      (42,247
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total deferred tax assets, net of valuation allowance

     207        —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Deferred tax liabilities:

     
     

 

 

 

Other

     (207      —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total deferred tax liabilities

     (207      —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net deferred tax assets

   $ —        $ —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

The deferred tax assets associated with net operating losses included in the table above reflect net operating losses as if the Company was a taxpayer separate from PDL Biopharma, Inc. As of December 31, 2019 and December 31, 2018, the Company maintained federal net operating loss carryforwards of $158,297 and $145,012, respectively. As of December 31, 2019 and 2018, the Company also maintained state net operating loss carryforwards of $131,761 and $121,664, respectively (as corrected from approximately $57,795 in 2019 and $68,835 in 2018). The net operating loss carryforwards will begin expiring in the year 2023, if not utilized. As of December 31, 2019 and 2018, the Company had $2,234 and $2,234 of R&D credits, respectively that will begin expiring in the year 2025. The Company expects a portion of these tax return attributes will be eliminated at the time a separation is executed.

Utilization of the federal and state net operating loss and tax credit carryforwards may be subject to a substantial annual limitation due to the “change in ownership” provisions of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986. The annual limitation may result in the expiration of net operating losses and credits before utilization. Under the 2017 Tax Act, although the treatment of tax losses generated in taxable years ending before December 31, 2017 has not changed, tax losses generated in taxable years beginning after December 31, 2017 may only be utilized to offset 80% of taxable income annually and may be carried forward indefinitely. This change may require the Company to pay additional federal income taxes in future years if additional losses are generated post 2017.

As of December 31, 2019, the Company determined that it was more likely than not that certain deferred tax assets would not be realized in the near future and maintained a $44,465 valuation allowance against deferred tax assets. The net change in total valuation allowance between the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018, was an increase of $2,218. The $44,465 valuation allowance at December 31, 2019 is related to federal and state deferred tax assets that the Company determined it was more likely than not would be realized.

 

F-31

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(In thousands, except share and per share amounts)

 

A reconciliation of the Company’s unrecognized tax benefits, excluding accrued interest and penalties, for 2019 and 2018 is as follows:

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
           2019                  2018        

Balance at the beginning of the year

   $ 2,255      $ 2,255  

Decreases related to prior year tax positions

     —          —    

Increases related to tax positions from prior fiscal years

     —          —    

Increases related to tax positions taken during current fiscal year

     —          —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Balance at the end of the year

   $ 2,255      $ 2,255  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

The future impact of the unrecognized tax benefit of $2,255, if recognized, is as follows: it would affect the effective tax rate by $2,255 and $2,255 would result in adjustments to deferred tax assets, which may be offset with valuation allowance. The Company periodically evaluates its exposures associated with its tax filing positions. At this time, the Company does not anticipate a material change in the unrecognized tax benefits that would affect the effective tax rate or deferred tax assets or valuation allowances over the next 12 months.

Estimated interest and penalties associated with unrecognized tax benefits increased the Company’s income tax expense in the statements of operations by $0, during the years ended December 31, 2019 and December 31, 2018. In general, the Company’s income tax returns are subject to examination by U.S. federal, state and local tax authorities for tax years 2009 forward. The Company is not currently under examination in any significant tax jurisdictions. Interest and penalties associated with unrecognized tax benefits accrued on the balance sheet were $0 and $0 as of December 31, 2019 and 2018, respectively.

In response to the COVID-19 pandemic, many governments have enacted or are contemplating measures to provide aid and economic stimulus. The Coronavirus Aid, Relief, and Economic Security Act (the “CARES Act”), which was enacted on March 27, 2020 in the U.S., includes measures to assist companies, including temporary changes to income and non-income-based tax laws. The Company will monitor additional guidance and impact that the CARES Act and other potential legislation may have on its income taxes.

Note 15. Net Loss per Share

The following is a reconciliation of the numerator (net loss) and the denominator (number of shares) used in the basic and diluted net loss per share calculations:

 

     Year Ended December 31,  
     2019     2018  

Net loss

   $ (14,657   $ (12,593

Less: Cumulative dividends in excess of interest expense on mandatorily redeemable preferred stock

     —         (1,451
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loss attributable to common stockholders

   $ (14,657   $ (14,044

Weighted average number of shares of common stock

     1,070,000       1,070,000  

Basic and diluted net loss per share

     (13.70     (13.13

The Company applied the two-class method for calculating net loss per share. The two-class method is an allocation of losses between the holders of common stock and the Company’s participating securities. Net loss attributable to common stockholders is computed by deducting the dividends accumulated for the period on the Series A preferred stock from the Company’s net loss. Interest expense on the Series A preferred stock is

 

F-32

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(In thousands, except share and per share amounts)

 

calculated using the effective interest method. The adjustment, if any, to the net loss is the portion of the cumulative dividends in excess of the interest expense on the mandatorily redeemable preferred stock.

The Company’s basic net loss per share attributable to common stockholders is computed by dividing the net loss attributable to common stockholders by the weighted-average number of shares of common stock outstanding during the period. The Company’s shares eligible for phantom stock awards (non-vested shares or non-settled awards) are held by Parent and are outstanding. If equity settlement is elected by the award holder, shares of LENSAR common stock are transferred from PDL’s ownership to award owners. These shares are included in the Company’s computation of weighted-average shares outstanding in the determination of basic net loss per share attributable to common stockholders.

As the Company has reported a net loss for all periods presented, basic and diluted net loss per share attributable to common stockholders are the same for those periods. The Company does not have potential dilutive impacts from common stock equivalents for the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018, respectively.

Note 16. Related Party Transactions

In the ordinary course of business, the Company enters into transactions with the Parent.

Corporate Allocations

The Company’s Financial Statements include expenses of $4,371 and $4,985 for the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018, respectively, allocated to the Company by PDL for corporate support functions that are provided by the Parent such as administration and organizational oversight; including employee benefits, finance and accounting, treasury and risk management, professional and legal services, among others. Allocated costs are included within selling, general and administrative expenses in the accompanying statements of operations. A portion of these allocated costs related to certain cross charges that have historically been cash settled and included in our statements of cash flows as operating activities. As of December 31, 2019 and 2018, $142 and $30, respectively, related to the allocation of corporate costs are included in other current liabilities as those amounts are to be cash settled.

No costs related to the separation of LENSAR have been incurred by the Parent for the year ended December 31, 2019.

Parent Loan

In May 2017, the Company entered into a loan agreement with PDL. Under the loan agreement, the maximum aggregate principal amount that LENSAR can draw from the loan agreement is $25,600. As of December 31, 2019 and 2018, LENSAR borrowed $20,200 and $6,975 respectively, from PDL at an interest rate of 4% per annum. The long-term portion of the loan is included in Note payable due to related party on the Company’s balance sheet at December 31, 2019 and 2018. The current portion of the loan is included in other current liabilities of $654 as of December 31, 2018. In 2019, the payment terms were adjusted such that the entire outstanding principal balance is payable at the maturity date, and therefore, all borrowings under the loan agreement are non-current as of December 31, 2019. The loan is due on May 11, 2023. The loan can be prepaid without penalty in whole or in part in aggregate amounts of $1,000. The interest expense incurred during the years ended December 31, 2019 and 2018 was $473 and $272, respectively, and is included in interest expense.

The Parent has committed through June 20, 2021 to provide financial support to the Company of up to $20.0 million.

 

F-33

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(In thousands, except share and per share amounts)

 

Mandatorily Redeemable Preferred Stock

Refer to Note 10, Mandatorily Redeemable Preferred Stock.

Note 17. Subsequent Events

Management evaluated all activity of LENSAR through March 11, 2020, the date on which PDL’s consolidated financial statements were issued, and, with respect to the distribution of LENSAR’s ownership interest in PDLIH to PDL discussed in Note 1, through August 25, 2020, and, with respect to the one-for-nine reverse stock split of the Company’s common stock discussed below, through September 14, 2020, and concluded that no subsequent events have occurred that would require recognition in the Company’s financial statements or disclosure in the notes to the financial statements herein, except as below:

In March 2020, the World Health Organization declared the outbreak of a novel coronavirus (COVID-19) a pandemic. The outbreak of the COVID-19 pandemic is significantly affecting the Company’s employees, patients, communities and business operations, as well as the U.S. economy and financial markets. The full extent to which the COVID-19 outbreak will impact the Company’s business, results of operations, financial condition and cash flows will depend on future developments that are highly uncertain and the estimates of the impact on the Company’s business may change based on new information that may emerge concerning COVID-19 and the actions to contain it or treat its impact and the economic impact on local, regional, national and international markets.

The Company’s results of operations, financial condition and cash flows have been adversely affected by the COVID-19 pandemic. The extent to which the COVID-19 outbreak will negatively impact the Company’s business or operating results can not be determined with certainty at this time. In geographies in which the Company or its customers, partners and service providers operate, health concerns as well as political or governmental developments in response to COVID-19 could result in economic, social or labor instability or prolonged contractions in the industries in which the Company’s customers or partners operate, slow the sales process, result in customers not purchasing or renewing the Company’s products or failing to make payments, and could otherwise have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business and results of operations and financial condition.

On March 27, 2020, the Coronavirus Aid, Relief, and Economic Security Act (“CARES Act”) was enacted. The CARES Act, among other things, includes provisions relating to refundable payroll tax credits, deferment of employer side social security payments, net operating loss carryback periods, alternative minimum tax credit refunds, modifications to the net interest deduction limitations and technical corrections to tax depreciation methods for qualified improvement property. The Company did not receive a stimulus payment related to the CARES Act.

On April 15, 2020, the Company and the Parent, upon mutual agreement, increased the credit limit that LENSAR can draw from PDL under the loan agreement by $7,000 to a total of $32,600. LENSAR drew an additional $10,400 under the loan agreement subsequent to December 31, 2019 with $2,000 remaining to be drawn under the current credit limit.

On September 10, 2020, the Company amended its amended and restated certificate of incorporation to effect a one-for-nine reverse stock split of the Company’s common stock. The par value of the Company’s common stock and the total number of shares of common stock that the Company is authorized to issue remained unchanged. All issued and outstanding shares of common stock, other common stock share numbers, equity

 

F-34

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(In thousands, except share and per share amounts)

 

awards and per share amounts contained in the financial statements have been retroactively adjusted to give effect to the reverse stock split for all periods presented.

Events Subsequent to Original Issuance of Financial Statements (Unaudited)

On July 2, 2020, the Company drew an additional $2,000 under the loan agreement with PDL. The total loans now due and owing under such loan agreement were settled as part of the Note Payable Recapitalization, as defined below.

On July 10, 2020, the Company amended and restated its certificate of incorporation to, among other things, (a) increase the number of shares of common stock ($0.01 par value per share) the Company is authorized to issue to 150,000,000 shares and (b) issue to the Parent a total of 3,414,825 shares of the Company’s common stock in exchange for the extinguishment of all 30,000 shares of the Company’s Series A Preferred Stock, including any accrued and unpaid dividends thereon (the “Series A Preferred Stock Recapitalization”). The Company does not currently have any shares of Series A Preferred Stock outstanding.

On July 13, 2020, the Company and the Parent entered into a contribution and exchange agreement whereby the Company issued to the Parent a total of 2,806,244 shares of the Company’s common stock in exchange for the extinguishment of the $32,600 outstanding that the Company owed the Parent under the loan agreement (the “Note Payable Recapitalization”).

The Series A Preferred Stock Recapitalization, together with the Note Payable Recapitalization, is defined as the “Recapitalization Transactions”. The Recapitalization Transactions resulted in the issuance of 6,221,069 shares of common stock to extinguish an aggregate of $69,879 carrying value of liabilities recognized for the Series A Preferred Stock and loans outstanding under the Credit Agreement together with accrued interest, resulting in an approximate $2,691 extinguishment gain which will be recognized directly within equity during the three months ended September 30, 2020.

On July 9, 2020, our Board of Directors approved the LENSAR Inc. 2020 Incentive Award Plan (the “2020 Plan”). Under the 2020 Plan, we may grant stock options, restricted stock, restricted stock unit awards and other stock-based awards.

On July 21, 2020, the Company issued an additional 740,740 shares of additional common stock to PDL in exchange for $8,000 in cash (the “Capital Contribution”).

On July 22, 2020, our Board of Directors also approved the grants of 1,847,298 shares of restricted stock in connection with the proposed separation to certain individuals under the 2020 Plan in consideration of future services to be rendered to the Company. The aggregate grant date fair value of these restricted stock awards was determined to be $19,951 based on the fair value of our underlying common stock using preliminary valuation techniques with the most reliable information currently available. The vesting schedule of the restricted stock awards is (i) 40% vest on the later of three months following the closing of the proposed separation or six months following the grant date (provided the proposed separation has occurred prior to such date), (ii) 30% vest 18 months following grant date, and (iii) 30% vest 36 months following grant date. Additionally, these shares of restricted stock are subject to an excess share forfeiture restriction, whereby, as of the measurement date defined in the grant notice, the number of shares issued to a participant pursuant to the grant notice plus all other shares of common stock held by such participant shall not exceed the target percentage stated in the participant’s restricted stock agreement multiplied by LENSAR’s fully diluted capitalization as of that measurement date. Following the application of the excess share forfeiture restriction, the remaining shares shall be eligible to vest based on the aforementioned vesting schedule.

 

F-35

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(In thousands, except share and per share amounts)

 

On August 4, 2020, PDL committed that through August 5, 2021 it will provide financial support of up to $20,000 to support the operating, investing and financing activities of the Company. On August 24, 2020, the Company received cash of $29,000 from PDL (the “Additional Capital Contribution”). The Company issued 746,767 shares of common stock to PDL in exchange for $8,334. The remaining $20,666 was a cash contribution from PDL. In connection with the Additional Capital Contribution, PDL’s financial support under its commitment on August 4, 2020 was fulfilled.

 

F-36

 


Table of Contents

LENSAR, Inc.

CONDENSED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS

(Unaudited)

(In thousands, except share and per share amounts)

 

     Six Months Ended June 30,  
     2020     2019  

Revenue

    

Product

   $ 8,096     $ 10,433  

Lease

     1,446       2,060  

Service

     1,411       1,507  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total revenue

     10,953       14,000  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cost of revenue (exclusive of amortization)

    

Product

     3,468       5,806  

Lease

     696       1,267  

Service

     1,275       1,638  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total cost of revenue

     5,439       8,711  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating expenses

    

Selling, general and administrative expenses

     8,820       8,314  

Research and development expenses

     3,005       1,828  

Amortization of intangible assets

     631       593  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating loss

     (6,942     (5,446
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other income (expense)

    

Interest expense

     (1,275     (953

Other income, net

     34       28  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loss before income taxes

     (8,183     (6,371

Income tax expense

     —         —    
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loss

   $ (8,183   $ (6,371
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cumulative dividends in excess of interest expense on Series A Preferred Stock

     —         —    
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loss attributable to common stockholders

   $ (8,183   $ (6,371
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net loss per share attributable to common stockholders

    

Basic and diluted

   $ (7.65   $ (5.95
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Weighted-average number of shares used in calculation of net loss per share:

    

Basic and diluted

     1,070,000       1,070,000  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these condensed financial statements

 

F-37

 


Table of Contents

LENSAR, Inc.

CONDENSED BALANCE SHEETS

(Unaudited)

(In thousands, except share and per share amounts)

 

     June 30,
2020
    December 31,
2019
 

Assets

    

Current assets:

    

Cash

   $ 4,715     $ 4,615  

Accounts receivable, net of allowance for doubtful accounts of $24 and $0, respectively

     2,565       3,384  

Notes receivable, net of allowance for doubtful accounts of $11 and $0, respectively

     516       502  

Inventories

     12,633       8,064  

Prepaid and other current assets

     415       618  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current assets

     20,844       17,183  

Property and equipment, net

     843       720  

Equipment under lease, net

     2,147       1,431  

Notes and other receivables, long-term, net of allowance for doubtful accounts of $13 and $0, respectively

     636       827  

Intangible assets, net

     12,735       13,366  

Other assets

     816       1,009  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets

   $ 38,021     $ 34,536  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Liabilities and stockholders’ deficit

    

Current liabilities:

    

Accounts payable

   $ 1,515     $ 1,577  

Accrued liabilities

     3,255       4,778  

Deferred revenue

     864       777  

Other current liabilities

     565       697  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total current liabilities

     6,199       7,829  

Long-term operating lease liabilities

     48       333  

Note payable due to related party

     30,600       20,200  

Series A Preferred Stock

     37,214       36,417  

Other long-term liabilities

     235       310  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

     74,296       65,089  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Commitments and contingencies (Note 9)

    

Stockholders’ deficit:

    

Common stock, par value $0.01 per share, 9,630,000 shares authorized, 1,070,000 shares issued and outstanding at June 30, 2020 and December 31, 2019 respectively

     11       11  

Additional paid-in capital

     10,116       7,621  

Accumulated deficit

     (46,402     (38,185
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total stockholders’ deficit

     (36,275     (30,553
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities and stockholders’ deficit

   $ 38,021     $ 34,536  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these condensed financial statements

 

F-38

 


Table of Contents

LENSAR, Inc.

CONDENSED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

(Unaudited)

(In thousands)

 

     Six Months Ended
June 30,
 
     2020     2019  

Cash flows from operating activities

    

Net loss

   $ (8,183   $ (6,371

Adjustments to reconcile net loss to net cash used in operating activities:

    

Depreciation

     808       1,495  

Amortization of intangible assets

     631       593  

Non-cash operating lease cost

     269       268  

Provision for bad debts

     33       (7

Loss on disposal of property and equipment

     11       —    

Stock-based compensation expense

     38       45  

Changes in operating assets and liabilities:

    

Accounts receivable, net

     751       999  

Prepaid and other current assets

     203       (363

Inventories

     (5,986     (1,151

Accounts payable

     (68     732  

Accrued liabilities

     (741     152  

Other

     495       335  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash used in operating activities

     (11,739     (3,273
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash flows from investing activities

    

Acquisition of intangibles

     —         (1,700

Purchase of property and equipment

     (255     (35

Proceeds from sale of property and equipment

     20       —    
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash used in investing activities

     (235     (1,735
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash flows from financing activities

    

Contributions from PDL

     1,771       1,821  

Distributions to PDL

     (97     (52

Proceeds from notes payable

     10,400       4,225  

Payment of contingent consideration

     —         (1,071
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash provided by financing activities

     12,074       4,923  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net increase (decrease) in cash and restricted cash

     100       (85

Cash and restricted cash at beginning of the period (1)

     4,715       3,444  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash and restricted cash at end the period (2)

   $ 4,815     $ 3,359  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these condensed financial statements

 

 

(1)

Includes restricted cash of $100 as of December 31, 2019 and 2018.

(2)

Includes restricted cash of $100 as of June 30, 2020 and 2019.

The restricted cash balance is included as part of Other assets in the condensed balance sheets

 

F-39

 


Table of Contents

LENSAR, Inc.

CONDENSED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS, continued

(Unaudited)

(In thousands)

 

     Six Months Ended
June 30,
 
         2020              2019      

Supplemental cash flow information

     

Cash paid for income taxes

   $ —        $ —    

Cash paid for interest

   $ 478      $   189  

Supplemental schedule of non-cash investing and financing activities

     

Transfer to equipment under lease, net

   $ 1,419      $ 473  

Phantom stock liability settled with common stock

   $ 783      $ 584  

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these condensed financial statements

 

F-40

 


Table of Contents

LENSAR, Inc.

CONDENSED STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN STOCKHOLDERS’ DEFICIT

(Unaudited)

(In thousands, except share and per share amounts)

 

     Common Stock      Additional
Paid-in
Capital
    Accumulated
Deficit
    Total
Stockholders’
Deficit
 
   Shares      Amount  

Balance as of December 31, 2018

     1,070,000      $ 11      $ 3,052     $ (23,528   $ (20,465

Net loss

     —          —          —         (6,371     (6,371

Contributions from PDL

     —          —          1,866       —         1,866  

Distributions to PDL

     —          —          (52     —         (52

Settlement of phantom stock-based awards

     —          —          584       —         584  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance as of June 30, 2019

     1,070,000      $ 11      $ 5,450     $ (29,899   $ (24,438
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

     Common Stock      Additional
Paid-in
Capital
    Accumulated
Deficit
    Total
Stockholders’
Deficit
 
   Shares      Amount  

Balance as of December 31, 2019

     1,070,000      $ 11      $ 7,621     $ (38,185   $ (30,553

Impact of adoption of ASC 326

     —          —          —         (34     (34

Net loss

     —          —          —         (8,183     (8,183

Contributions from PDL

     —          —          1,809       —         1,809  

Distributions to PDL

     —          —          (97     —         (97

Settlement of phantom stock-based awards

     —          —          783       —         783  
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance as of June 30, 2020

     1,070,000      $ 11      $ 10,116     $ (46,402   $ (36,275
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these condensed financial statements

 

F-41

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO CONDENSED INTERIM FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(Unaudited)

(In thousands, except shares or per share amounts)

Note 1. Overview and Basis of Presentation

Overview and Organization

LENSAR, Inc. (“LENSAR” or the “Company”) is a global medical device business focused on the design, development and commercialization of advanced technology for the treatment of cataracts and management of astigmatisms to achieve improved vision outcomes for patients. The Company’s revenue is derived from the sale and lease of the LENSAR Laser System, which may include equipment, a consumable referred to as the Patient Interface Devices (“PIDs”), procedure licenses, training, installation, limited warranty and maintenance agreements through extended warranty.

The Company’s parent entity, PDL BioPharma, Inc. (“PDL” or the “Parent”) intends to pursue a separation and distribution of its medical device segment, which is solely comprised of its majority owned subsidiary LENSAR. The proposed separation and distribution are intended to take the form of a spin-off and result in LENSAR becoming a stand-alone publicly traded company.

The Company has incurred recurring losses and operating cash outflows since its inception and as of June 30, 2020 had an accumulated deficit of $46,402. The Company expects to continue to incur losses and cash outflows from operating activities for the foreseeable future. In addition, the Company’s results of operations, financial condition and cash flows have been adversely affected by the COVID-19 pandemic. The extent to which the COVID-19 outbreak will further negatively impact the Company’s business or operating results can not be determined with certainty at this time. In geographies in which the Company or its customers, partners and service providers operate, health concerns as well as political or governmental developments in response to COVID-19 could result in further economic, social or labor instability or prolonged contractions in the industries in which the Company’s customers or partners operate, slow the sales process, result in customers not purchasing or renewing the Company’s products or failing to make payments, and could otherwise have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business and results of operations and financial condition.

Prior to the Additional Capital Contribution (as defined below), the Company did not currently have, nor did it expect to generate from operations, adequate liquidity to fund its operations for the next twelve months. To alleviate such conditions, on August 4, 2020, PDL committed that through August 5, 2021 it will provide financial support of up to $20,000 to support the operating, investing and financing activities of the Company. On August 24, 2020, the Company received cash of $29,000 from PDL (the “Additional Capital Contribution”). The Company issued 746,767 shares of common stock to PDL in exchange for $8,334. The remaining $20,666 was a cash contribution from PDL. In connection with the Additional Capital Contribution, PDL’s financial support under its commitment on August 4, 2020 was fulfilled. Accordingly, management believes the Company’s cash on hand (inclusive of the Additional Cash Contribution) will provide sufficient liquidity to meet the Company’s projected obligations for at least twelve months from August 25, 2020, the date these condensed financial statements were issued and from September 14, 2020, the date these condensed financial statements were reissued. Refer to Note 15, Subsequent Events for additional information on the Recapitalization Transactions, Capital Contribution and Additional Capital Contribution, as defined therein.

Basis of Presentation

The condensed interim financial statements of the Company are unaudited and have been prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles in the United States of America (“U.S. GAAP”) and pursuant to the regulations of the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”) for interim financial information and, therefore, omit or condense certain footnotes and other information normally included. The financial statements include all adjustments (consisting only of normal recurring adjustments), that management of the Company believes are necessary for a fair statement of the periods presented. These interim financial results are not necessarily indicative of results expected for the full fiscal year.

 

F-42

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO CONDENSED INTERIM FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(Unaudited)

(In thousands, except shares or per share amounts)

 

The accompanying unaudited condensed interim financial statements and related financial information should be read in conjunction with the Company’s annual financial statements and the related notes thereto for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2019, included elsewhere in this information statement.

These interim financial statements were prepared on a stand-alone basis derived from the unaudited condensed consolidated financial statements and accounting records of PDL and are presented as if LENSAR had been operating as a stand-alone company for all periods presented. These financial statements exclude the assets, liabilities, revenue and expenses directly attributable to LENSAR’s wholly owned subsidiary, PDL Investment Holdings, LLC (“PDLIH”), as, in August 2020, prior to effecting a separation, the Company effected a reorganization and distributed PDLIH to PDL. Refer to Note 15, Subsequent Events.

The assets, liabilities, revenue and expenses directly attributable to the Company’s operations have been reflected in these condensed financial statements on a historical cost basis, as included in the consolidated financial statements of PDL. The condensed statements of operations include expenses for certain corporate support functions that are provided by the Parent such as administration and organizational oversight; including employee benefits, finance and accounting, treasury and risk management, professional and legal services, among others. These expenses have been allocated to the Company on the basis of direct usage when identifiable, with the remainder allocated on a proportional basis of expenses of the Company and the Parent. Management of the Company and Parent considered the basis on which the expenses have been allocated to be a reasonable reflection of the utilization of services provided to or the benefit received by the Company during the periods presented These allocations may not be reflective of the expenses that would have been incurred had the Company operated as a separate, unaffiliated entity apart from PDL. Actual costs that would have been incurred if LENSAR had been a stand-alone, public company would depend on multiple factors, including the chosen organizational structure and strategic decisions made in various areas, including information technology and infrastructure. Following a separation, the Company expects to perform these functions using its own resources or purchased services. For an interim period, however, some of these functions will continue to be provided by the Parent as the Company expects to enter into one or more transition service agreements with the Parent in connection with a separation.

The Company was historically funded as part of the Parent’s treasury program. Cash and restricted cash managed through bank accounts legally owned by the Parent at the corporate level were not attributable to the Company for any of the periods presented. Only cash and restricted cash legally owned by the Company are reflected in the condensed balance sheets. All significant transactions between the Company and the Parent are considered to be effectively settled for cash at the time the transaction is recorded, unless otherwise noted. Such transfers of cash to and from PDL have been included in these condensed financial statements as a component of equity in the condensed balance sheets and as a financing activity in the condensed statements of cash flows, unless otherwise noted.

The Parent’s third-party debt has not been attributed and the related interest expense has not been allocated to the Company for any of the periods presented, as the Company was not the legal obligor of the debt and the Parent’s borrowings were not directly attributable to the Company’s business.

During the periods presented in these financial statements, the operations of the Company were included in the consolidated U.S. federal and state income tax returns filed by the Parent. Income tax expense and other income tax related information contained in the condensed financial statements are presented on a separate return basis as if the Company had filed its own tax returns. The deferred income taxes of the Company as presented in these condensed financial statements, including tax attributes such as net operating losses or credit carryforwards, are not indicative of the deferred tax assets available to the Company in the future. The Company’s uncertain tax

 

  F-43  

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO CONDENSED INTERIM FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(Unaudited)

(In thousands, except shares or per share amounts)

 

positions recorded under the separate return method may also differ from those recorded in the PDL financial statements. See Note 12 for more information.

In addition, as a result of the impact of COVID-19 as discussed above, the Company determined certain impairment triggers had occurred during the three months ended March 31, 2020 related to the Company’s finite-lived tangible and intangible assets. Accordingly, the Company analyzed undiscounted cash flows at the asset group level for certain finite-lived tangible and intangible assets as of March 31, 2020. Based on that undiscounted cash flow analysis, the Company determined that estimated undiscounted future cash flows substantially exceeded their net carrying values, and, therefore, as of March 31, 2020, the Company’s finite-lived tangible and intangible assets were not impaired.

Note 2. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies

Other than policies noted below, there have been no significant changes to the significant accounting policies disclosed in Note 2 of the annual financial statements included elsewhere in the information statement.

Accounting Estimates

The preparation of condensed financial statements in conformity with U.S. GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the amounts reported in the condensed financial statements and accompanying notes to the condensed financial statements. The accounting estimates that require management’s most significant, difficult and subjective judgments include, but are not limited to, cost allocations from the Parent, revenue recognition and allowance for doubtful accounts, the valuation of notes receivable and inventory, the assessment of recoverability of intangible assets and their estimated useful lives, the valuation and recognition of stock-based compensation, operating lease right-of-use assets and liabilities, and the recognition and measurement of current and deferred income tax assets and liabilities. Management evaluates its estimates on an ongoing basis as there are changes in circumstances, facts, and experience. Changes in estimates are recorded in the period in which they become known. Actual results could differ from these estimates.

The full extent to which the COVID-19 pandemic will directly or indirectly impact the Company’s business, results of operations and financial condition, including revenue, expenses, reserves and allowances, will depend on future developments that are highly uncertain, including as a result of new information that may emerge concerning COVID-19 and the actions taken to contain or treat it, as well as the economic impact on domestic and international customers and markets. The Company has made estimates of the impact of COVID-19 within its condensed financial statements and there may be changes to those estimates in future periods.

As of the date of issuance of these unaudited condensed interim financial statements, the Company is not aware of any specific event or circumstance that would require the Company to update estimates, judgments or revise the carrying value of any assets or liabilities.

Fair Value Measurement

The fair value of the Company’s financial instruments are estimates of the amounts that would be received if the Company were to sell an asset or the Company paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date or exit price. The assets and liabilities are categorized and disclosed in one of the following three categories:

 

   

Level 1—based on quoted market prices in active markets for identical assets and liabilities.

 

  F-44  

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO CONDENSED INTERIM FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(Unaudited)

(In thousands, except shares or per share amounts)

 

   

Level 2—based on observable inputs other than quoted prices in active markets for identical assets and liabilities, quoted prices for identical or similar assets or liabilities in inactive markets, or other inputs that are or can be corroborated by observable market data for substantially the full term of the assets or liabilities.

 

   

Level 3—based on unobservable inputs using management’s best estimate and assumptions when inputs are unavailable.

Fair value measurements are classified in their entirety based on the lowest level of input that is significant to their fair value measurement.

The carrying value of the Company’s cash, accounts receivable, accounts payable, accrued liabilities, and other current liabilities approximate fair value based on the short-term maturities of these instruments. The carrying value of the Company’s notes receivable also approximates fair value based on the associated credit risk.

Adopted Accounting Pronouncement

In June 2016, the FASB issued Accounting Standard Update (“ASU”) No. 2016-13, Financial Instruments—Credit Losses: Measurement of Credit Losses on Financial Instruments (“ASC 326”). The new guidance amends the impairment model to utilize an expected loss methodology in place of the currently used incurred loss methodology, which will result in more timely recognition of losses. The Company adopted ASU No. 2016-13 on January 1, 2020 using a modified retrospective approach. The adoption resulted in a $34 adjustment to the Company’s accumulated deficit opening balance within the condensed balance sheets. As a consequence of adopting ASU 2016-13, the Company’s accounts and notes receivable accounting policy has been updated, as follows:

Accounts and Notes Receivable

The Company makes estimates of the collectability of accounts receivable. In doing so, the Company analyzes historical bad debt trends, customer credit worthiness, current economic trends, changes in customer payment patterns, and possible impact of current conditions and reasonable forecasts not already reflected in historical loss information when evaluating the adequacy of the allowance for credit losses. Amounts are charged off against the allowance for credit losses when the Company determines that recovery is unlikely, and the Company ceases collection efforts.

In August 2018, the FASB issued ASU No. 2018-15, Intangibles-Goodwill and Other-Internal-Use Software. The new guidance reduces complexity for the accounting for costs of implementing a cloud computing service arrangement and aligns the requirements for capitalizing implementation costs incurred in a hosting arrangement that is a service contract with the requirements for capitalizing implementation costs incurred to develop or obtain internal-use software (and hosting arrangements that include an internal use software license). The Company adopted ASU No. 2018-15 on January 1, 2020 using the prospective transition option. The adoption did not have a material impact on the financial statements.

In April 2020, the FASB issued a staff question-and-answer document, “Topic 842 and Topic 840: Accounting for Lease Concessions Related to the Effects of the COVID-19 Pandemic” (the “COVID-19 Q&A”), to address certain frequently-asked questions pertaining to lease concessions arising from the effects of the COVID-19 pandemic. Existing lease guidance requires entities to determine if a lease concession was a result of a new arrangement reached with the lessee (which would be addressed under the lease modification accounting

 

  F-45  

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO CONDENSED INTERIM FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(Unaudited)

(In thousands, except shares or per share amounts)

 

framework) or if a lease concession was under the enforceable rights and obligations within the existing lease agreement (which would not fall under the lease modification framework). The COVID-19 Q&A clarifies that entities may elect to not evaluate whether lease-related relief granted in light of the effects of COVID-19 is a lease or obligations of the lease. This election is available for concessions that result in the total payments required by the modified contract being substantially the same or less than the total payments required by the original contract.

The Company elected to account for lease concessions related to the effects of COVID-19 pandemic in accordance with the COVID-19 Q&A. LENSAR entered into agreements with 22 customers through which LENSAR agreed to waive monthly rental fees ranging from one to three months. A total of $335 in lease revenue was not recognized during the six months ended June 30, 2020 related to the waived lease payments. There were no concessions provided for any non-lease components of the lease arrangements. In return for these concessions the related contracts were extended by the same number of months waived. No amounts of accounts receivable or notes receivable were deemed uncollectible due to COVID-19 as of June 30, 2020; however, the Company considered the effects of COVID-19 in estimating its credit losses for the period.

Recently Issued Accounting Pronouncements Not Yet Adopted

In December 2019, the FASB issued ASU No. 2019-12, which is intended to simplify various aspects related to accounting for income taxes. ASU 2019-12 removes certain exceptions to the general principles in Topic 740 and also clarifies and amends existing guidance to improve consistent application. The amendments in ASU No. 2019-12 are effective for fiscal years, and interim periods within those fiscal years, beginning after December 15, 2020, with early adoption permitted. The Company is currently evaluating the impact of this guidance on its financial statements.

Note 3. Revenue from Contracts with Customers

Disaggregation of Revenue

The following table summarizes the Company’s product and service revenue disaggregated by geographic region, which is determined based on customer location, for the six months ended June 30, 2020 and 2019:

 

     Six Months Ended June 30,  
     2020      2019  

United States

   $ 4,439      $ 4,658  

South Korea

     1,406        3,822  

Europe

     1,540        1,726  

Asia (excluding South Korea)

     1,985        1,547  

Other

     137        187  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total1

   $ 9,507      $ 11,940  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

1 The table above does not include lease revenue of $1,446 and $2,060 for the six months ended June 30, 2020 and 2019, respectively. Refer to Note 5, Leases.

 

F-46

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO CONDENSED INTERIM FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(Unaudited)

(In thousands, except shares or per share amounts)

 

Contract Balances

The following table provides information about receivables and contract liabilities from contracts with customers:

 

    

Classification

   As of
June 30,
2020
     As of
December 31,
2019
 

Accounts receivable, current

   Accounts receivable, net    $ 2,565      $ 3,384  

Notes receivable, current

   Notes receivable, net      516        502  

Notes receivable, long-term

   Notes and other receivables, long-term, net      636        827  

Contract liability, current

   Deferred revenue      864        777  

Contract liability, non-current

   Other long-term liabilities      58        118  

Accounts Receivables, Net – Accounts receivables, net, include amounts billed and due from customers. The amounts due are stated at their net estimated realizable value and are classified as current or noncurrent based on the timing of when the Company expects to receive payment. The noncurrent receivables relate to service revenue. Most customers are on pre-paid or 30-day payment terms, depending on the product purchased. The Company maintains an allowance for credit losses to provide for the estimated amount of receivables that will not be collected. The allowance is based upon an assessment of customer credit worthiness, historical payment experience, the age of outstanding receivables, collateral to the extent applicable and reflects the possible impact of current conditions and reasonable forecasts not already reflected in historical loss information.

The following table summarizes the activity in the allowance for accounts receivable:

 

     Amount  

Accounts receivable, allowance for doubtful accounts as of January 1, 2020

   $ —    

Impact of adoption of ASC 326

     15  

Provision for doubtful accounts

     29  

Write-offs

     (20
  

 

 

 

Accounts receivable, allowance for doubtful accounts as of June 30, 2020

   $ 24  
  

 

 

 

Notes Receivables, Net – Notes receivable, net includes amounts billed and due from customers under extended payment terms with a significant financing component. Interest rates on notes receivable range from 5.0% to 5.75%. The Company recorded interest income on notes receivable during the six months ended June 30, 2020 and June 30, 2019 of $29 and $26 in Other income, net in its condensed statements of operations.

The following table summarizes the activity in the allowance for notes receivable:

 

     Amount  

Notes receivable, allowance for doubtful accounts as of January 1, 2020

   $ —    

Impact of adoption of ASC 326

     19  

Provision for doubtful accounts

     5  

Write-offs

     —    
  

 

 

 

Notes receivable, allowance for doubtful accounts as of June 30, 2020

   $ 24  
  

 

 

 

 

F-47

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO CONDENSED INTERIM FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(Unaudited)

(In thousands, except shares or per share amounts)

 

Contract Liabilities – The Company’s contract liabilities consist of deferred revenue related to services and products sold to customers for which the performance obligation has not been completed by the Company. The Company classifies deferred revenue as current or noncurrent based on the timing of when it expects to recognize revenue. The noncurrent portion of deferred revenue is included in other long-term liabilities in the Company’s condensed balance sheets.

The following table provides information about contract liabilities from contracts with customers:

 

     Amount  

Contract liabilities as of December 31, 2018

   $ 994  

Billings not yet recognized as revenue

     432  

Beginning contract liabilities recognized as revenue

     (531
  

 

 

 

Contract liabilities as of June 30, 2019

   $ 895  
  

 

 

 

Contract liabilities as of December 31, 2019

   $ 895  

Billings not yet recognized as revenue

     537  

Beginning contract liabilities recognized as revenue

     (510
  

 

 

 

Contract liabilities as of June 30, 2020

   $ 922  
  

 

 

 

Transaction Price Allocated to Future Performance Obligations

At June 30, 2020, the revenue expected to be recognized in future periods related to performance obligations that are unsatisfied for executed contracts with an original duration of one year or more was approximately $10,295. The Company expects to satisfy its remaining performance obligations over the next four years, with $5,441 to be satisfied in the next twelve months, $3,261 to be satisfied in the next two years, and $1,593 to be satisfied thereafter. The Company does not disclose the value of unsatisfied performance obligations for (i) contracts with original expected lengths of one year or less or (ii) contracts for which the Company recognizes revenue at the amount to which it has the right to invoice for the products delivered or services performed.

Note 4. Inventories

Inventory balances were as follows:

 

     As of
June 30,
2020
     As of
December 31,
2019
 

Finished Goods

   $ 6,640      $ 3,156  

Work-in-progress

     1,612        1,170  

Raw Materials

     4,381        3,738  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 12,633      $ 8,064  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

F-48

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO CONDENSED INTERIM FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(Unaudited)

(In thousands, except shares or per share amounts)

 

Note 5. Leases

Lessor Arrangements

The Company has operating leases for the LENSAR Laser System. The Company’s leases have remaining lease terms of less than one year to four years. Lease income related to non-cancellable lease payments for the six months ended June 30, 2020 and 2019 was as follows:

 

     Six Months ended
June 30,
 
     2020      2019  

Lease income related to non-cancellable lease payments

   $ 1,196      $ 1,559  

Note 6. Intangible Assets

In April 2019, LENSAR acquired certain intellectual property from a third-party for $2,000 in cash and contingent obligations to pay a $300 milestone payment and royalties upon the completion of certain events, which were met prior to December 31, 2019.

The components of intangible assets were as follows:

 

     As of June 30, 2020      As of December 31, 2019  
     Gross
Carrying
Amount
     Accumulated
Amortization
    Net
Carrying
Amount
     Gross
Carrying
Amount
     Accumulated
Amortization
    Net
Carrying
Amount
 

Finite-lived intangible assets:

               

Customer relationships1,2

   $ 4,292      $ (1,141   $ 3,151      $ 4,292      $ (951   $ 3,341  

Acquired technology1,3

     11,500        (2,125     9,375        11,500        (1,741     9,759  

Acquired trademarks 1

     570        (361     209        570        (304     266  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 
   $ 16,362      $ (3,627   $ 12,735      $ 16,362      $ (2,996   $ 13,366  
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

1 

Certain intangible assets were established upon PDL’s acquisition of LENSAR in May 2017. They are being amortized on a straight-line basis over a weighted-average period of 15 years. The intangible assets for customer relationships are amortized on a straight-line basis or a double declining basis over their estimated useful lives up to 20 years based on the method that better represents the economic benefits to be obtained.

 

2 

LENSAR acquired certain intangible assets for customer relationships from a domestic distributor in an asset acquisition, which are being amortized on a straight-line basis over a period of 10 years.

 

3 

LENSAR acquired certain intangible assets from a medical technology company in an asset acquisition, which are being amortized on a straight-line basis over a period of 15 years.

Amortization expense for the six months ended June 30, 2020 and 2019 was $631 and $593, respectively.

 

F-49

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO CONDENSED INTERIM FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(Unaudited)

(In thousands, except shares or per share amounts)

 

Based on the intangible assets recorded at June 30, 2020, and assuming no subsequent additions to or impairment of the underlying assets, the remaining amortization expense is expected to be as follows:

 

Fiscal Year

   Amount  

2020 (Remaining six months)

   $ 625  

2021

     1,240  

2022

     1,149  

2023

     1,097  

2024

     1,085  

Thereafter

     7,539  
  

 

 

 

Total remaining estimated amortization expense

   $ 12,735  
  

 

 

 

Note 7. Accrued Liabilities

Accrued liabilities consist of the following:

 

     As of
June 30,
2020
     As of
December 31,
2019
 

Compensation

   $ 2,176      $ 3,972  

Warranty

     40        58  

Other

     1,039        748  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 3,255      $ 4,778  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Note 8. Series A Preferred Stock

The Company authorized and issued 30,000 shares of Series A Preferred Stock, par value $0.01 to Parent in May 2017. The Series A Preferred Stock has an aggregate liquidation preference of $30,000 (“stated value”), plus all accumulated and unpaid dividends (whether or not declared). Dividends on each share of Series A Preferred Stock initially accrued on an annual basis at a rate of 15.00% per annum of the stated value, and subsequently decreased to 5.0% per annum of the stated value effective January 1, 2019 as amended in December 2018. Dividends are payable when and if declared by the board of directors. No dividends have been declared by the board of directors since issuance.

The Series A Preferred Stock is mandatorily redeemable on May 11, 2027, the tenth anniversary of the date of issuance, equal to its stated value plus any accrued and unpaid dividends. Prior to May 11, 2027, the Company may redeem the outstanding Series A Preferred Stock in whole or in part at its option for cash equal to the stated value per share plus any accrued and unpaid dividends. In the event of any voluntary or involuntary liquidation, dissolution, or winding up of the Company, the Series A Preferred Stock will be redeemed for cash equal to its stated value plus any accrued and unpaid dividends. As of June 30, 2020 and December 31, 2019, the redemption amounts were $39,635 or $1,321 per share and $38,885 or $1,296 per share, respectively.

The holder of Series A Preferred Stock is entitled to elect one member of the board of the directors but is otherwise not entitled to vote on matters with the common shareholders. The Series A Preferred Stock rank senior to the Company’s common stock. The Series A Preferred Stock is not entitled to participate in distributions with common shareholders; however, the Company may not declare dividends to common shareholders so long as there are accumulated and unpaid dividends on the Series A Preferred Stock.

 

F-50

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO CONDENSED INTERIM FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(Unaudited)

(In thousands, except shares or per share amounts)

 

The Series A Preferred Stock is accounted for as a liability on the Company’s condensed balance sheets because it is mandatorily redeemable. Prior to the amendment in December 2018, the Series A Preferred Stock was measured based on the present value of the expected redemption value of $75,000 at the mandatory redemption date, accruing interest cost at an effective interest rate of 9.6%.

Upon the amendment, the reduction of the cumulative dividend rate to 5.0% was accounted for as a debt modification, wherein interest cost is accrued prospectively using the new effective interest rate of 4.4% based on the modified redemption value of $49,923 on the May 11, 2027 mandatory redemption date.

The carrying value of Series A Preferred Stock is $37,214 and $36,417 inclusive of interest accrued as of June 30, 2020 and December 31, 2019, respectively. Interest expenses recognized on the Series A Preferred Stock is $797 and $764 for the six months ended June 30, 2020 and 2019, respectively.

In July 2020, the Company entered into a series of transactions in connection with the proposed separation, including the issuance of common stock in exchange for the extinguishment of all 30,000 shares of our Series A Preferred Stock (the “Series A Preferred Stock Recapitalization”). Refer to Note 15, Subsequent Events.

Note 9. Commitments & Contingencies

Purchase Obligation

LENSAR entered into various supply agreements for the manufacture and supply of certain components.

The supply agreements commit LENSAR to a minimum purchase obligation of approximately $5,252 over the next 18 months, of which $3,944 is due in the next 12 months, $1,000 of which are guaranteed by the Parent. LENSAR expects to meet these requirements. LENSAR made purchases of $312 and $0 under these supply agreements during the six months ended June 30, 2020 and 2019, respectively.

Royalty and Milestone Payments

In connection with the acquisition of certain intellectual property the Company could be required to make milestone payments in the amount of $2,400 which are contingent upon the regulatory approval and commercialization of the next generation system. In addition, the Company acquired certain intellectual property, which if used in the development of the next generation system could result in additional royalty payments.

Legal Matters

The medical device market in which LENSAR participates is largely technology driven. As a result, intellectual property rights, particularly patents and trade secrets, play a significant role in product development and differentiation. The Company makes provisions for liabilities when it is both probable that a liability has been incurred and the amount of the loss can be reasonably estimated. Management believes that there are currently no claims or legal actions that would reasonably be expected to have a material adverse effect on the Company’s results of operations, financial condition or cash flows.

Note 10. Stockholders’ Deficit

Common Stock

The Company has a single class of common stock in which stockholders are entitled to one vote for each share of common stock. No cash dividend was declared on common stock during the six months ended June 30, 2020 and 2019.

 

  F-51  

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO CONDENSED INTERIM FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(Unaudited)

(In thousands, except shares or per share amounts)

 

Note 11. Stock-Based Compensation

Phantom Stock Plan

LENSAR has a phantom stock plan under which it grants phantom stock units (“PSUs”) to LENSAR directors and employees.

The following table sets forth the total stock-based compensation expense recognized under the phantom stock plan in the Company’s condensed statements of operations:

 

     Six Months Ended
June 30,
 
     2020      2019  

Cost of revenue – product

   $ —        $ (1

Selling, general and administrative expenses

     88        149  

Research and development expenses

     —          7  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 88      $ 155  
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

As of June 30, 2020, and December 31, 2019, the Company’s liabilities related to the PSU recorded in liabilities were $414 and $1,179 respectively. The fair value of the PSUs at each reporting date is $14.94 as of June 30, 2020 and December 31, 2019. The following table summarizes the phantom share activity during the six months ended June 30, 2020:

 

     Number of Units      Weighted-average grant-
date fair value per share
 

Non-vested at beginning of year

     42,800      $ 6.39  

Granted

     —        $ —    

Vested

     (5,350    $ 6.39  

Forfeited

     —        $ —    
  

 

 

    

Non-vested at end of the period

     37,450      $ 6.39  

Stock-Based Incentive Plans

Parent Equity Incentive Plan

PDL has equity incentive plans under which it grants equity awards, including stock options, stock appreciation rights, restricted stock awards, restricted stock unit awards, performance share and performance unit awards, deferred compensation awards and other stock-based or cash-based awards.

Stock-based compensation expense related to the PDL awards for the six months ended June 30, 2020 and 2019 was approximately $38 and $45 recorded in selling, general, and administrative expense, respectively.

The total fair value of restricted stock awards vested during the six months ended June 30, 2020 and 2019 was approximately $65 and zero, respectively.

Subsequent Event—LENSAR Equity Incentive Plan

In July 2020, the Company entered into a series of transactions in connection with the proposed separation, including the grant of restricted stock awards to certain individuals under the Company’s incentive plan. Refer to Note 15, Subsequent Events.

 

  F-52  

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO CONDENSED INTERIM FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(Unaudited)

(In thousands, except shares or per share amounts)

 

Note 12. Income Taxes

The Company is included in the consolidated federal tax return of PDL. The provision for income taxes is calculated by using a “separate return” method. Under this method, the Company is assumed to file a separate return with the applicable tax authority(ies). The current provision is the amount of tax payable or refundable on the basis of a hypothetical, current-year separate return. Deferred taxes are provided on temporary differences and on any attributes being carried forward that could be claimed on the hypothetical return. The need for a valuation allowance is assessed on a separate company basis and on projected separate return assets.

Income tax expense/(benefit) from continuing operations for the six months ended June 30, 2020 and 2019, was $0 in each period which resulted primarily from maintaining a full valuation allowance against the Company’s deferred tax assets.

In response to the COVID-19 pandemic, many governments have enacted or are contemplating measures to provide aid and economic stimulus. The Coronavirus Aid, Relief, and Economic Security Act (the “CARES Act”), which was enacted on March 27, 2020 in the U.S., includes measures to assist companies, including temporary changes to income and non-income-based tax laws. The enactment of the CARES Act did not have a material effect on current income tax expense or the realizability of deferred income tax assets. The Company will monitor additional guidance and impact that the CARES Act and other potential legislation may have on its income taxes.

Note 13. Net Loss per Share

The following is a reconciliation of the numerator (net loss) and the denominator (number of shares) used in the basic and diluted net loss per share calculations:

 

     Six Months Ended June 30,  
     2020      2019  

Net loss

   $ (8,183    $ (6,371

Less: Cumulative dividends in excess of interest expense on Series A Preferred Stock

     —          —    
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net loss attributable to common stockholders

   $ (8,183    $ (6,371

Weighted average number of shares of common stock

     1,070,000        1,070,000  

Basic and diluted net loss per share

     (7.65      (5.95

The Company applied the two-class method for calculating net loss per share. The two-class method is an allocation of losses between the holders of common stock and the Company’s participating securities. Net loss attributable to common stockholders is computed by deducting the dividends accumulated for the period on the Series A Preferred Stock from the Company’s net loss. Interest expense on the Series A Preferred Stock is calculated using the effective interest method. The adjustment, if any, to the net loss is the portion of the cumulative dividends in excess of the interest expense on the Series A Preferred Stock. There were no cumulative dividends in excess of interest expense during the six months ended June 30, 2020 and 2019, respectively.

The Company’s basic net loss per share attributable to common stockholders is computed by dividing the net loss attributable to common stockholders by the weighted-average number of shares of common stock outstanding

 

  F-53  

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO CONDENSED INTERIM FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(Unaudited)

(In thousands, except shares or per share amounts)

 

during the period. The Company’s shares eligible for phantom stock awards (non-vested shares or non-settled awards) are held by Parent and are outstanding. If equity settlement is elected by the award holder, shares of LENSAR common stock are transferred from PDL’s ownership to award owners. These shares are included in the Company’s computation of weighted-average shares outstanding in the determination of basic net loss per share attributable to common stockholders.

As the Company has reported a net loss for all periods presented, basic and diluted net loss per share attributable to common stockholders are the same for those periods. The Company does not have potential dilutive impacts from common stock equivalents for the six months ended June 30, 2020 and 2019, respectively.

Note 14. Related Party Transactions

In the ordinary course of business, the Company enters into transactions with the Parent.

Corporate Allocations

The Company’s condensed financial statements include expenses of $2,750 and $2,261 for the six months ended June 30, 2020 and 2019, respectively, allocated to the Company by PDL for corporate support functions that are provided by the Parent such as administration and organizational oversight; including employee benefits, finance and accounting, treasury and risk management, professional and legal services, among others. Allocated costs are included within selling, general and administrative expenses in the accompanying condensed statements of operations. A portion of these allocated costs related to certain cross charges that have historically been cash settled and included in our condensed statements of cash flows as operating activities. As of June 30, 2020 and December 31, 2019, $0 and $142, respectively, related to the allocation of corporate costs are included in other current liabilities as those amounts are to be cash settled.

No costs related to the separation of LENSAR incurred by PDL have been allocated to the Company for the six months ended June 30, 2020.

Parent Loan

In May 2017, the Company entered into a loan agreement with PDL. Under the loan agreement, the maximum aggregate principal amount that LENSAR can draw from the loan agreement is $25,600. On April 15, 2020, the Company and the Parent, upon mutual agreement, increased the credit limit that LENSAR can draw from PDL under the loan agreement by $7,000 to a total of $32,600. LENSAR drew an additional $10,400 under the loan agreement during the six months ended June 30, 2020. As of June 30, 2020, and December 31, 2019, LENSAR borrowed $30,600 and $20,200 respectively, from PDL at an interest rate of 4% per annum. All borrowings under the loan agreement are non-current as of June 30, 2020 and December 31, 2019 as the loan is due on May 11, 2023. The loan can be prepaid without penalty in whole or in part in aggregate amounts of $1,000. The interest expense incurred during the six months ended June 30, 2020 and 2019 was $478 and $189, respectively, and is included in interest expense.

In July 2020, the Company entered into a series of transactions with PDL in connection with the proposed separation, including the issuance of common stock to PDL in exchange for the extinguishment of all amounts outstanding, including accrued interest, LENSAR owed to PDL under the loan agreement. Refer to Note 15, Subsequent Events.

In August 2020, the Parent fulfilled its commitment to provide financial support to the Company. Refer to Note 15, Subsequent Events.

 

  F-54  

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO CONDENSED INTERIM FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(Unaudited)

(In thousands, except shares or per share amounts)

 

Series A Preferred Stock

Refer to Note 8, Series A Preferred Stock and to Note 15, Subsequent Events.

Note 15. Subsequent Events

Management evaluated all activity of LENSAR through August 25, 2020, the date the condensed financial statements were available to be issued, and, with respect to the one-for-nine reverse stock split of the Company’s common stock discussed below, through September 14, 2020.

In July 2020, the Company entered into a series of transactions in connection with the proposed separation:

On July 2, 2020, the Company drew an additional $2,000 under the loan agreement with PDL. The total loans now due and owing under such loan agreement were fully settled as part of the Note Payable Recapitalization described below.

On July 10, 2020, the Company amended and restated its certificate of incorporation to, among other things, (a) increase the number of shares of common stock ($0.01 par value per share) the Company is authorized to issue to 150,000,000 shares and (b) issue to the Parent a total of 3,414,825 shares of the Company’s common stock in exchange for the extinguishment of all 30,000 shares of the Company’s Series A Preferred Stock, including any accrued and unpaid dividends thereon (the “Series A Preferred Stock Recapitalization”). The Company does not currently have any shares of Series A Preferred Stock outstanding.

On July 13, 2020, the Company and the Parent entered into a contribution and exchange agreement whereby the Company issued to the Parent a total of 2,806,244 shares of the Company’s common stock in exchange for the extinguishment of the $32,600 outstanding that the Company owed the Parent under the loan agreement (the “Note Payable Recapitalization”).

The Series A Preferred Stock Recapitalization, together with the Note Payable Recapitalization, is defined as the “Recapitalization Transactions”. The Recapitalization Transactions resulted in the issuance of 6,221,069 shares of common stock to extinguish an aggregate of $69,879 carrying value of liabilities recognized for the Series A Preferred Stock and loans outstanding under the loan agreement together with accrued interest, resulting in an approximate $2,691 extinguishment gain which will be recognized directly within equity during the three months ended September 30, 2020.

On July 9, 2020, our Board of Directors approved the LENSAR Inc. 2020 Incentive Award Plan (the “2020 Plan”). Under the 2020 Plan, we may grant stock options, restricted stock, restricted stock unit awards and other stock-based awards.

On July 21, 2020, the Company issued an additional 740,740 shares of additional common stock to PDL in exchange for $8,000 in cash (the “Capital Contribution”).

On July 22, 2020, our Board of Directors also approved the grants of 1,847,298 shares of restricted stock in connection with the proposed separation to certain individuals under the 2020 Plan in consideration of future services to be rendered to the Company. The aggregate grant date fair value of these restricted stock awards was determined to be $19,951 based on the fair value of our underlying common stock using preliminary valuation techniques with the most reliable information currently available. The vesting schedule of the restricted stock awards is (i) 40% vest on the later of three months following the completion of the proposed separation or six months following the grant date (provided the proposed separation has occurred prior to such date), (ii) 30% vest

 

  F-55  

 


Table of Contents

NOTES TO CONDENSED INTERIM FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

(Unaudited)

(In thousands, except shares or per share amounts)

 

18 months following grant date, and (iii) 30% vest 36 months following grant date. Additionally, these shares of restricted stock are subject to an excess share forfeiture restriction, whereby, as of the measurement date defined in the grant notice, the number of shares issued to a participant pursuant to the grant notice plus all other shares of common stock held by such participant shall not exceed the target percentage stated in the participant’s restricted stock agreement multiplied by LENSAR’s fully diluted capitalization as of that measurement date. Following the application of the excess share forfeiture restriction, the remaining shares shall be eligible to vest based on the aforementioned vesting schedule.

On August 4, 2020, PDL committed that through August 5, 2021 it will provide financial support of up to $20,000 to support the operating, investing and financing activities of the Company.

On August 20, 2020, the Company distributed 100% of its ownership interest in its wholly owned subsidiary, PDLIH, to PDL. This distribution will have US Federal and State income tax effects subject to certain elections and the timing of the Company’s separation from PDL. The Company continues to analyze the tax impact of this event.

On August 20, 2020, the Company amended its lease pursuant to which the term of the lease was extended through November 30, 2027. The lease amendment constitutes a modification as it extends the original lease term, which requires evaluation of the remeasurement of the lease liability and corresponding right-of-use-asset. The reassessment resulted in continuing to classify the lease as an operating lease and remeasurement of the lease liability on the basis of the extended lease term and the incremental borrowing rate at the effective date of modification of 10%. The remeasurement for the modification resulted in an increase to the lease liability and the right-of-use-asset of $3,320.

On August 24, 2020, the Company received cash of $29,000 from PDL pursuant to the Additional Capital Contribution. The Company issued 746,767 shares of common stock to PDL in exchange for $8,334. The remaining $20,666 was a cash contribution from PDL. In connection with the Additional Capital Contribution, PDL’s financial support under its commitment on August 4, 2020 was fulfilled.

Events Subsequent to Original Issuance of Financial Statements

On September 10, 2020, the Company amended its amended and restated certificate of incorporation to effect a one-for-nine reverse stock split of the Company’s common stock. The par value of the Company’s common stock and the total number of shares of common stock that the Company is authorized to issue remained unchanged. All issued and outstanding shares of common stock, other common stock share numbers, equity awards and per share amounts contained in the financial statements have been retroactively adjusted to give effect to the reverse stock split for all periods presented.

 

F-56